424B3
Table of Contents

Filed Pursuant to Rule 424(b)(3)
Registration No. 333-195185

 

PROSPECTUS

DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP

OFFER TO EXCHANGE

$275,000,000 aggregate principal amount of its

4.500% Senior Notes due 2023

which have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended,

for any and all of its outstanding 4.500% Senior Notes due 2023

 

 

 

    The exchange offer expires at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on May 26, 2014, unless extended.

 

    We will exchange all outstanding private notes that are validly tendered and not validly withdrawn for an equal principal amount of new notes which are registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Act.

 

    You may withdraw tenders of outstanding private notes at any time before the exchange offer expires.

 

    The exchange of notes will not be a taxable event for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

 

    We will not receive any proceeds from the exchange offer.

 

    The terms of the new notes are substantially identical to the outstanding private notes, except the new notes will not be subject to transfer restrictions or any increase in annual rate.

 

    The outstanding private notes are, and the new notes will be, fully and unconditionally guaranteed by DCT Industrial Trust Inc., a Maryland real estate investment trust, our sole general partner, and each of our wholly owned subsidiaries that guarantees borrowings under our revolving credit facility.

 

    You may tender outstanding private notes only in denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.

 

    Our affiliates may not participate in the exchange offer.

 

    No public market exists for the outstanding private notes. We do not intend to list the exchange notes on any securities exchange and, therefore, no active public market is anticipated for the exchange notes.

 

    Each broker-dealer that receives exchange notes for its own account pursuant to the exchange offer must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of such exchange notes. The letter of transmittal delivered with this prospectus states that by so acknowledging and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act. This prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, may be used by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of exchange notes received in exchange for outstanding private notes where such outstanding private notes were acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities.

 

 

Investing in our securities involves various risks. See “Risk Factors” beginning on Page 7 as well as the risk factors contained in documents DCT Industrial Trust Inc. files with the Securities and Exchange Commission and which are incorporated by reference in this prospectus.

 

 

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or determined if this prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

 

 

The date of this prospectus is April 25, 2014.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

     Page  

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

     2   

OUR COMPANY

     2   

THE EXCHANGE OFFER

     3   

THE EXCHANGE NOTES

     5   

RISK FACTORS

     7   

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

     23   

THE EXCHANGE OFFER

     24   

USE OF PROCEEDS

     35   

SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

     36   

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

     42   

DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS

     76   

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

     81   

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

     106   

DESCRIPTION OF NOTES

     108   

DESCRIPTION OF THE PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT OF DCTOP

     127   

U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

     131   

PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

     135   

LEGAL MATTERS

     136   

EXPERTS

     136   

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

     137   

INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE

     137   

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     F-1   

 

i


Table of Contents

You should rely only on the information contained in or incorporated by reference in this prospectus. We have not authorized anyone to provide you with different information. If anyone provides you with different or inconsistent information, you should not rely on it. You should assume that the information contained in this prospectus, as well as information that DCT has previously filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and incorporated by reference, is accurate only as of the date of the applicable document. Our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects may have changed since those dates.

Each broker-dealer that receives exchange notes for its own account pursuant to the exchange offer will acknowledge by participating in this exchange offer, as a condition to participating in this exchange offer, that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of such exchange notes. By so acknowledging and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act. This prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, may be used by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of exchange notes received in exchange for outstanding private notes where such outstanding private notes were acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities. We have agreed that, starting on the expiration date of the exchange offer and ending on the close of business one year after such expiration date, subject to extension in limited circumstances, we will make this prospectus available to any broker-dealer for use in connection with any such resale. See “Plan of Distribution.”


Table of Contents

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

This summary highlights the information contained elsewhere in this prospectus. This summary is not complete and does not contain all of the information that you should consider before participating in the exchange offer. You should read this prospectus, as well as the documents incorporated herein by reference. Unless otherwise indicated, property and financial information in this prospectus is presented as of, or for the year ended, December 31, 2013.

Except as otherwise indicated herein, the terms “Company,” “we,” “our” and “us” refer to DCT Industrial Trust Inc. and its subsidiaries, including its operating partnership, DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP, which is referred to as “DCTOP.” When we use the term “DCT,” we are referring to DCT Industrial Trust Inc. by itself, and not including any of its subsidiaries, and when we use the term “DCTOP,” we are referring to DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP, by itself and not including any of its subsidiaries. The term “you” refers to a prospective investor.

OUR COMPANY

We are a leading industrial real estate company specializing in the acquisition, development, leasing and management of bulk distribution and light industrial properties located in high-volume distribution markets in the United States. DCT was formed as a Maryland corporation in April 2002 and has elected to be treated as a real estate investment trust, or REIT, for U.S. federal income tax purposes. We are structured as an umbrella partnership REIT under which substantially all of our current and future business is, and will be, conducted through a majority owned and controlled subsidiary, DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP, a Delaware limited partnership, for which DCT is the sole general partner. We own our properties through DCTOP and its subsidiaries. Each subsidiary guarantor was formed under the laws of Delaware, with the exception of Run Deep, L.L.C., Western Avenue Associates, L.L.C. and Route One Hundred Limited Partnership, which are Maryland entities. As of December 31, 2013, we owned approximately 94.8% of the outstanding equity interests in DCTOP.

As of December 31, 2013, the Company owned interests in approximately 75.5 million square feet of properties leased to approximately 900 customers, including:

 

    62.1 million square feet comprising 396 consolidated operating properties, which were 93.3% occupied, including 0.2 million square feet comprising one building classified as held for sale;

 

    12.3 million square feet comprising 38 unconsolidated properties which were 94.1% occupied and operated on behalf of four institutional capital management partners;

 

    0.2 million square feet comprising two consolidated properties under redevelopment; and

 

    0.9 million square feet comprising two consolidated buildings which are shell-complete and in lease-up and eight land sites under construction.

As of December 31, 2013, our total consolidated portfolio consisted of 400 properties with an average size of 158,000 square feet and an average age of 21 years.

The principal executive offices of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP, DCT Industrial Trust Inc., and the subsidiary guarantors are located at 518 Seventeenth Street, Suite 800, Denver, Colorado 80202; our telephone number is (303) 597-2400. We also maintain regional offices in Atlanta, Georgia; Baltimore, Maryland; Chicago, Illinois; Cincinnati, Ohio; Dallas, Texas; Houston, Texas; Paramus, New Jersey; Newport Beach, California; Emeryville, California; Orlando, Florida; and Seattle, Washington. Our website address is www.dctindustrial.com.

 

 

2


Table of Contents

THE EXCHANGE OFFER

 

The Exchange Offer    We are offering to exchange the 4.500% Senior Notes due 2023 offered by this prospectus, referred to as the exchange notes, for the outstanding 4.500% Senior Notes due 2023, referred to as the private notes, that are properly tendered and accepted. You may tender outstanding private notes only in denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof. We will issue the exchange notes on or promptly after the exchange offer expires. As of the date of this prospectus, $275,000,000 aggregate principal amount of private notes is outstanding.
Expiration Date    The exchange offer will expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on May 26, 2014 (the 21st business day following commencement of the exchange offer), unless extended, in which case the expiration date will mean the latest date and time to which we extend the exchange offer.
Conditions to the
Exchange Offer
  

The exchange offer is not subject to any condition other than that it not violate applicable law or any applicable interpretation of the staff of the SEC. The exchange offer is not conditioned upon any minimum principal amount of private notes being tendered for exchange.

 

We intend to conduct the exchange offer in accordance with the provisions of the registration rights agreement with respect to the private notes and the applicable requirements of the Securities Act, the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange Act, and the rules and regulations of the SEC.

Procedures for

Tendering Private
Notes

  

If you wish to tender your private notes for the exchange notes pursuant to the exchange offer, you must complete and sign a letter of transmittal in accordance with the instructions contained in the letter and forward it by mail, facsimile or hand delivery, together with any other documents required by the letter of transmittal, to the exchange agent (as defined below), either with the private notes to be tendered or in compliance with the specified procedures for guaranteed delivery of notes. Certain brokers, dealers, commercial banks, trust companies and other nominees may also effect tenders by book-entry transfer. Holders of private notes registered in the name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee are urged to contact such person promptly if they wish to tender private notes pursuant to the exchange offer. See “The Exchange Offer—Procedures for Tendering.”

 

Letters of transmittal and certificates representing private notes should not be sent to us. Such documents should only be sent to the exchange agent. Questions regarding how to tender private notes and requests for information should be directed to the exchange agent. See “The Exchange Offer—Exchange Agent.” You do not have any appraisal or dissenters’ rights under the indenture in connection with the exchange offer.

Acceptance of the
Private Notes and
Delivery of the
Exchange Notes
   Subject to the satisfaction or waiver of the conditions to the exchange offer, we will accept for exchange any and all private notes which are validly tendered in the exchange offer and not withdrawn before 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the expiration date.
Withdrawal Rights    You may withdraw the tender of your private notes at any time before 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the expiration date, by complying with the procedures for withdrawal described in this prospectus under the heading “The Exchange Offer—Withdrawal of Tenders.”

 

 

3


Table of Contents
U.S. Federal Tax Consequences    The exchange of notes will not be a taxable event for U.S. federal income tax purposes. For a discussion of material federal tax considerations relating to the exchange of notes, see “U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences.”
Exchange Agent    U.S. Bank National Association, the registrar and paying agent for the notes under the indenture governing the notes, is serving as the exchange agent for the notes.
Consequences of Failure to Exchange    If you do not exchange your private notes for the exchange notes, you will continue to be subject to the restrictions on transfer provided in the private notes and in the indenture governing the private notes. In general, the private notes may not be offered or sold, unless registered under the Securities Act, except pursuant to an exemption from, or in a transaction not subject to, the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws. We do not currently plan to register the resale of the private notes under the Securities Act.
Registration Rights Agreement    You are entitled to exchange your private notes for the exchange notes with substantially identical terms. This exchange offer satisfies this right. After the exchange offer is completed, you will no longer be entitled to any exchange or registration rights with respect to your private notes.

We explain the exchange offer in greater detail beginning on page 24.

 

 

4


Table of Contents

THE EXCHANGE NOTES

The following summary contains basic information about the exchange notes and is not intended to be complete. It does not contain all the information that may be important to you. For a more complete understanding of the exchange notes, please refer to the section entitled “Description of Notes.”

The form and terms of the exchange notes are the same as the form and terms of the private notes, except that the exchange notes will be registered under the Securities Act and, therefore, the exchange notes will not be subject to the transfer restrictions, registration rights and provisions providing for an increase in the interest rate applicable to the private notes. The exchange notes will evidence the same debt as the private notes, and both the private notes and the exchange notes are governed by the same indenture.

The following summary of the offering is provided solely for your convenience. This summary is not intended to be complete. You should read the full text and more specific details contained elsewhere in this prospectus. For a more detailed description of the notes, see “Description of Notes.” As used in this section and “Description of Notes” references to “we,” “us,” “our” and similar terms refer to DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP and not to DCT Industrial Trust Inc. or any of its subsidiaries.

 

Issuer of Notes

   DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP

Notes Offered

   $275,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 4.500% senior notes due 2023.

Interest

   The notes will bear interest at a rate of 4.500% per year. Interest will be payable semi-annually in arrears on April 15 and October 15 of each year, beginning April 15, 2014.

Maturity

   The notes will mature on October 15, 2023 unless previously redeemed by DCTOP at its option prior to such date.

Guarantees

  

The notes will be initially guaranteed by DCT Industrial Trust Inc. and each of our wholly owned subsidiaries that guarantees borrowings under our revolving credit facility. In addition, we will cause any consolidated subsidiary (including any future subsidiary) that guarantees our indebtedness for money borrowed in an amount greater than $5.0 million at any time after the issuance of the notes to also guarantee the notes. The guarantors will jointly and severally guarantee our obligations under the notes, on a senior unsecured basis.

 

A subsidiary guarantor will be automatically released from its guarantee if, among other things, it ceases to guarantee our indebtedness for money borrowed in an amount greater than $5.0 million. We currently intend to pursue an amendment to our revolving credit facility and term loan facilities to remove all of the subsidiary guarantors as guarantors thereunder and the requirement for our future subsidiaries to guarantee these facilities in order to enable our subsidiary guarantors to be released from their guarantees under our outstanding senior unsecured notes and the notes offered hereby.

Ranking of Notes

   The notes and the guarantees will be our and the guarantors’ senior unsecured obligations and will rank equally in right of payment with all of such entities’ existing and future senior indebtedness. The notes and guarantees, however, will be effectively subordinated to all of our and the guarantors’ existing and future secured indebtedness (to the extent of the value of the collateral securing such indebtedness). The notes and the guarantees will also be structurally subordinated to all existing and future indebtedness and other obligations, including preferred stock, of our subsidiaries that do not guarantee the notes. As of December 31, 2013, we and the guarantors had $1.5 billion of indebtedness ($291.0 million of which was secured indebtedness), and our consolidated subsidiaries that will not guarantee the notes had $256.5 million of indebtedness and $25.0 million of other liabilities, all of which would have been structurally senior to the notes, and $528.2 million of assets, representing 16.2% of DCT’s and its consolidated subsidiaries’ consolidated total assets.

 

 

5


Table of Contents
Optional Redemption    We may redeem the notes at our option and in our sole discretion, at any time in whole or from time to time in part, at the applicable redemption price specified herein. If the notes are redeemed on or after 90 days prior to the maturity date, the redemption price will be equal to 100% of the principal amount of the notes being redeemed plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon to, but not including, the redemption date. See “Description of Notes—Redemption of the Notes at the Option of the Partnership.”
Certain Covenants   

The indenture governing the notes contains certain covenants that, among other things, limit our and our subsidiaries’ ability to:

 

•   consummate a merger, consolidate or sell all or substantially all of our consolidated assets; and

 

•   incur secured and unsecured indebtedness.

 

In addition, we and our subsidiaries are required to maintain at all times total unencumbered assets of not less than 150% of the aggregate outstanding principal amount of our unsecured debt. These covenants are subject to a number of important exceptions and qualifications. See “Description of Notes.”

Use of Proceeds    The exchange offer satisfies an obligation under the registration rights agreement. We will not receive any cash proceeds from the exchange offer. The net proceeds from the sale of the private notes after deducting discounts and offering expenses were approximately $269.6 million. We used the net proceeds from the sale of the private notes to repay borrowing under a $175.0 million senior unsecured term loan, $50.0 million of senior unsecured notes, borrowings under our revolving credit facility and for general corporate purposes.
Trading    The notes are a new issue of securities with no established trading market. We do not intend to apply for listing of the notes on any securities exchange or for quotation of the notes on any automated dealer quotation system.
Book-Entry Form    The notes will be issued in the form of one or more fully-registered global notes in book-entry form, which will be deposited with, or on behalf of, The Depository Trust Company, commonly known as DTC, in New York, New York. Beneficial interests in the global certificate representing the notes will be shown on, and transfers will be effected only through, records maintained by DTC and its direct and indirect participants and such interests may not be exchanged for certificated notes, except in limited circumstances.
Additional Notes    We may from time to time, without notice to or consent of existing noteholders, create and issue additional notes having the same terms and conditions as the notes offered by this prospectus in all respects, except for the issue date and, under certain circumstances, the issue price, interest accrued prior to the issue date and first payment of interest thereon. Additional notes issued in this manner will be consolidated with and will form a single series with the previously outstanding notes, provided, however, that such additional notes may not be fungible with the previously outstanding notes for U.S. federal income tax purposes, in which case the additional notes would have a different CUSIP number than the notes offered hereby.
Risk Factors    See “Risk Factors” included in this prospectus and in DCT’s most recent Annual Report on Form 10-K, as updated by its subsequent filings under the Exchange Act, as well as other information included in this prospectus, for a discussion of factors you should carefully consider before deciding to invest in the notes.
Trustee and Paying Agent    U.S. Bank National Association is the trustee and paying agent under the indenture relating to the notes.

Governing Law

   The indenture, the notes and the guarantees endorsed on the notes will be governed by the laws of the State of New York.

 

 

6


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS

You should carefully consider the risks described below as well as other information and data included in this prospectus before making a decision to exchange your private notes for the exchange notes in the exchange offer. If any of the events described in the risk factors below occur, our business, financial condition, operating results and prospects could be materially adversely affected, which in turn could adversely affect our ability to repay the notes. The risk factors set forth below are generally applicable to the private notes as well as the exchange notes.

RISKS RELATED TO RECENT ECONOMIC CONDITIONS

Adverse economic conditions will negatively affect our returns and profitability.

Our operating results may be affected by weakness in the national and/or international economy as well as in the local economies where our properties are located. Specific impacts, among others, may include:

 

    increased levels of tenant defaults under leases;

 

    re-leasing which may require concessions, tenant improvement expenditures or reduced rental rates due to reduced demand for industrial space;

 

    overbuilding which may increase vacancies;

 

    adverse capital and credit market conditions may restrict our development and redevelopment activities; and

 

    reduced access to credit may result in tenant defaults, non-renewals under leases or inability of potential buyers to acquire our properties held for sale, including properties held through joint ventures.

The value of our investments may not appreciate or may decline in value significantly below the amount we pay for these investments. The length and severity of any economic slowdown or downturn cannot be predicted. Our operations could be negatively affected to the extent that an economic slowdown or downturn is prolonged or becomes more severe.

RISKS RELATED TO OUR BUSINESS AND OPERATIONS

Our investments are concentrated in the industrial real estate sector, and our business would be adversely affected by an economic downturn in that sector.

Our investments in real estate assets are primarily concentrated in the industrial real estate sector. This concentration may expose us to the risk of economic downturns in this sector to a greater extent than if our business activities included a more significant portion of other sectors of the real estate industry.

We depend on key personnel.

Our success depends to a significant degree upon the continued contributions of certain key personnel including, but not limited to, our management group, each of whom would be difficult to replace. If any of our key personnel were to cease employment with us, our operating results, financial condition and cash flows could suffer. Our ability to retain our management group, attract suitable replacements, or to attract new hires as needed, is dependent on the competitive nature of the employment market. Further, the loss of key personnel, or our inability to replace them, could be negatively perceived in the capital markets. We do not carry key man life insurance on any of our personnel.

 

7


Table of Contents

Our operating results and financial condition could be adversely affected if we do not continue to have access to capital on favorable terms.

DCT, as a REIT, must meet certain annual distribution requirements. Consequently, we are largely dependent on asset sales or external capital to fund our development and acquisition activities. Further, in order to maintain DCT’s REIT status and avoid the payment of income and excise taxes, we may need to borrow funds on a short-term basis to meet the REIT distribution requirements even if the then-prevailing market conditions are not favorable for these borrowings. These short-term borrowing needs could result from differences in timing between the actual receipt of cash and inclusion of income for U.S. federal income tax purposes or the effect of non-deductible capital expenditures, the creation of reserves or required debt or amortization payments. Additionally, our ability to sell assets or access capital is dependent upon a number of factors, including general market conditions and competition from other real estate companies. To the extent that capital is not available to acquire or develop properties, profits may not be realized or their realization may be delayed, which could result in an earnings stream that is less predictable than some of our competitors and result in us not meeting our projected earnings and distributable cash flow levels in a particular reporting period. Failure to meet our projected earnings and distributable cash flow levels in a particular reporting period could have an adverse effect on our financial condition.

Our long-term growth will partially depend upon future acquisitions of properties, and we may be unable to consummate acquisitions on advantageous terms or acquisitions may not perform as we expect.

We acquire and intend to continue to acquire primarily high-quality generic bulk distribution warehouses and light industrial properties. The acquisition of properties entails various risks, including the risks that our investments may not perform as we expect, that we may be unable to integrate our new acquisitions into our existing operations quickly and efficiently and that our cost estimates for bringing an acquired property up to market standards may prove inaccurate. Further, we face significant competition for attractive investment opportunities from other well-capitalized real estate investors, including both publicly-traded REITs and private institutional investment funds, and these competitors may have greater financial resources than us and a greater ability to borrow funds to acquire properties. This competition increases as investments in real estate become increasingly attractive relative to other forms of investment. As a result of competition, we may be unable to acquire additional properties as we desire or the purchase price may be significantly elevated. Similarly, we seek to acquire new properties in off-market transactions, because such properties are typically more attractively priced, but we may be unable to obtain off-market deal flow in the future. In addition, we expect to finance future acquisitions through a combination of borrowings under our senior unsecured credit facility, proceeds from equity or debt offerings and proceeds from property contributions and sales which may not be available and which could adversely affect our cash flows. Any of the above risks could adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Our real estate development strategies may not be successful.

We are involved in the construction and expansion of distribution facilities and we intend to continue to pursue development and renovation activities as opportunities arise either on our own or in joint ventures. We will be subject to risks associated with our development and renovation activities that could adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and/or cash flows.

Actions of our joint venture partners could negatively impact our performance.

Our organizational documents do not limit the amount of available funds that we may invest in partnerships, limited liability companies or joint ventures, and we intend to selectively continue to develop and acquire properties through joint ventures, limited liability companies and partnerships with other persons or entities when warranted by the circumstances. Such partners may share certain approval rights over major decisions. Such investments may involve risks not otherwise present with other methods of investment in real estate, including, but not limited to:

 

    that our partner in an investment might become bankrupt, which would mean that we could generally remain liable for the joint venture’s liabilities;

 

8


Table of Contents
    that such partner may at any time have economic or business interests or goals which are or which become inconsistent with our business interests or goals;

 

    that such partner may be in a position to take action contrary to our instructions or requests or contrary to our policies or objectives, including our current policy with respect to maintaining DCT’s qualification as a REIT;

 

    that, if our partners fail to fund their share of any required capital contributions, we may be required to contribute such capital;

 

    that joint venture agreements often restrict the transfer of a partner’s interest or may otherwise restrict our ability to sell the interest when we desire or on advantageous terms;

 

    that our relationships with our partners are contractual in nature and may be terminated or dissolved under the terms of the agreements and, in such event, we may not continue to own or operate the interests or assets underlying such relationship or may need to purchase such interests or assets at an above-market price to continue ownership;

 

    that disputes between us and our partners may result in litigation or arbitration that would increase our expenses and prevent our officers and directors from focusing their time and effort on our business and result in subjecting the properties owned by the applicable partnership, limited liability company or joint venture to additional risk;

 

    that we may in certain circumstances be liable for the actions of our partners; and

 

    that we may, as a general partner investing in a limited partnership, have liability for all of the liabilities of such partnership, even if we do not have full management rights or control, and our liability may far exceed the amount or value of the investment we initially made or then had in the partnership.

We generally seek to maintain sufficient control of our partnerships, limited liability companies and joint ventures to permit us to achieve our business objectives; however, we may not be able to do so, and the occurrence of one or more of the events described above could adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and/or cash flows.

Declining real estate valuations and impairment charges could adversely affect our earnings and financial condition. We may decide to dispose of select real estate assets, thereby changing the holding period assumption in our valuation analyses for those assets, which could result in material impairment losses and adversely affect our financial results.

Economic conditions have required or could require us to recognize real estate impairment charges on some of our assets and equity investments. We conduct a comprehensive review of all our real estate assets in accordance with our policy of accounting for impairments (see further discussion of our accounting policies in “Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” and “Item 7—Critical Accounting Polices and Estimates”). The principal factor which has led to impairment charges in the recent past was the severe economic deterioration in many markets resulting in a decrease in leasing demand, rental rates, rising vacancies and an increase in capitalization rates.

There can be no assurance that the estimates and assumptions we use to assess impairments are accurate and will reflect actual results, or that we will not change our intended holding period for real estate assets. A worsening real estate market or the failure for that market to continue to improve may cause us to reevaluate the assumptions used in our impairment analysis and our intent to hold, sell, develop or contribute properties. Changes in these assumptions, or changes in our anticipated holding period, may result in impairment charges or losses that could adversely affect our financial condition and/or results of operations. An impairment loss could be material to our results of operations in the period that it is recognized.

 

9


Table of Contents

Events or occurrences that affect areas in which our properties are geographically concentrated may impact financial results.

In addition to general, regional, national and international economic conditions, our operating performance is impacted by the economic conditions of the specific markets in which we have concentrations of properties. We have significant holdings in the following markets of our consolidated portfolio: Atlanta, Baltimore/Washington D.C., Chicago, Cincinnati, Columbus, Dallas, Houston, Miami, Memphis, Nashville, Northern California, Pennsylvania, Seattle and Southern California. Our operating performance could be adversely affected if conditions become less favorable in any of the markets in which we have a concentration of properties.

Our business could be adversely impacted if we have deficiencies in our disclosure controls and procedures or internal control over financial reporting.

Although continuously reviewed, the design and effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting may not prevent all errors, misstatements or misrepresentations and could materially adversely affect our business, reputation, results of operations, financial condition or liquidity.

RISKS RELATED TO CONFLICTS OF INTEREST

Our UPREIT structure may result in potential conflicts of interest.

As of December 31, 2013, DCT owned 94.8% of the units of limited partnership interest in DCTOP, or OP Units, certain unaffiliated limited partners owned 4.7% of the OP Units and certain of our officers and directors, owned the remaining 0.5% of the OP Units. Persons holding OP Units in DCTOP have the right to vote on certain amendments to the limited partnership agreement of DCTOP, as well as on certain other matters. Persons holding such voting rights may exercise them in a manner that conflicts with the interests of our holders of the notes. Furthermore, circumstances may arise in the future when the interest of limited partners in DCTOP may conflict with the interests of holders of our notes. For example, the timing and terms of dispositions of properties held by DCTOP may result in tax consequences to certain limited partners and not to holders of our notes.

GENERAL REAL ESTATE RISKS

Our performance and value are subject to general economic conditions and risks associated with our real estate assets.

The investment returns from equity investments in real estate depend in part on the amount of income earned and capital appreciation generated by the properties, as well as the expenses incurred in connection with the properties. If our properties do not generate income sufficient to meet operating expenses, including debt service and capital expenditures. In addition, there are significant expenditures associated with an investment in real estate (such as mortgage payments, real estate taxes and maintenance costs) that generally do not decline when circumstances reduce the income from the property. Income from, and the value of, our properties may, in addition to risks discussed elsewhere in this section, be adversely affected by:

 

    changes in supply of or demand for similar or competing properties in an area;

 

    changes in interest rates and availability of permanent mortgage funds that may render the sale of a property difficult or unattractive or otherwise reduce returns;

 

    changes in or increased costs of compliance with governmental rules, regulations and fiscal policies, including changes in tax, real estate, environmental and zoning laws, and our potential liability thereunder;

 

    our ability to provide adequate maintenance and insurance;

 

    customer turnover;

 

10


Table of Contents
    general overbuilding or excess supply in the market areas; and

 

    disruptions in the global supply chain caused by political, regulatory or other factors including terrorism.

In addition, periods of economic slowdown or recession, rising interest rates or declining demand for real estate, or public perception that any of these events may occur, would result in a general decrease in rents or an increased occurrence of defaults under existing leases, which would adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations. Future terrorist attacks may result in declining economic activity, which could reduce the demand for, and the value of, our properties. To the extent that future attacks impact our customers, their businesses similarly could be adversely affected, including their ability to continue to honor their existing leases.

For these and other reasons, we cannot assure holders of our notes that we will be profitable or that we will realize growth in the value of our real estate properties.

Actions by our competitors may decrease or prevent increases in the occupancy and rental rates of our properties.

We compete with other developers, owners and operators of real estate. If our competitors offer space at rental rates or terms more attractive than we currently offer to our customers, we may lose customers or we may be pressured to reduce our rental rates or provide more favorable lease terms. As a result, our financial condition, cash flows, cash available for distribution, and ability to satisfy our debt service obligations could be materially adversely affected.

We are dependent on customers for our revenues.

Lease payment or performance defaults by customers could adversely affect our financial condition. A default by a customer on its lease payments could force us to find an alternative source of revenues to pay any mortgage loan on the property. In the event of a customer default, we may experience delays in enforcing our rights as landlord and may incur substantial costs, including litigation and related expenses, in protecting our investment and re-leasing our property. If a lease is terminated, we may be unable to lease the property for the rent previously received or sell the property without incurring a loss.

Our ability to renew leases or re-lease space on favorable terms as leases expire significantly affects our business.

Our results of operations and distributable cash flows would be adversely affected if we are unable to lease, on economically favorable terms, a significant amount of space in our operating properties.

We may be unable to sell or re-lease a property if or when we decide to do so, including as a result of uncertain market conditions or vacancy.

We expect to hold the various real properties in which we invest until such time as we decide that a sale or other disposition is appropriate given our investment objectives. Our ability to dispose of properties on advantageous terms depends on factors beyond our control, including competition from other sellers, the availability of attractive financing for potential buyers of our properties and the rate of occupancy of the property. We cannot predict the various market conditions affecting real estate investments which will exist at any particular time in the future. Due to the uncertainty of market conditions which may affect the future disposition of our properties, we cannot assure holders of our notes that we will be able to sell our properties at a profit in the future. Accordingly, our financial condition will be dependent upon fluctuating market conditions.

Furthermore, we may be required to expend funds to correct defects or to make improvements before a property can be sold. We cannot assure holders of our notes that we will have funds available to correct such defects or to make such improvements.

 

11


Table of Contents

In acquiring a property, we may agree to restrictions that prohibit the sale of that property for a period of time or impose other restrictions, such as a limitation on the amount of debt that can be placed or repaid on that property. These provisions would restrict our ability to sell a property.

A property may incur a vacancy either by the continued default of a customer under its lease or the expiration of one of our leases. We have significant lease expirations in 2014, as outlined in “Business and Properties—Lease Expirations.” In addition, certain of the properties we acquire may have some level of vacancy at the time of closing. We may have difficulty obtaining a new customer for any vacant space we have in our properties. If the vacancy continues for a long period of time, we may suffer reduced revenues resulting in reduced cash flows. In addition, the resale value of a property could be diminished because of vacancy.

The fact that real estate investments are not as liquid as other types of assets may reduce economic returns to investors.

Real estate investments are not as liquid as other types of investments, and this lack of liquidity may limit our ability to react promptly to changes in economic or other conditions. In addition, our ability at any time to sell assets or contribute assets to property funds or other entities in which we have an ownership interest may be restricted by the potential for the imposition of the 100% “prohibited transactions” tax on gains from certain dispositions of property by REITs unless a safe harbor exception applies. This lack of liquidity may limit our ability to change our portfolio composition promptly in response to changes in economic or other conditions and, as a result, could adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Delays in acquisition and development of properties may have adverse effects.

Delays we encounter in the selection, acquisition and development of properties could adversely affect our returns. Where land is acquired for purposes of developing a new property prior to the start of construction, it will typically take 12 to 18 months to complete construction and lease up the newly completed building. Therefore, there could be delays in the payment of cash distributions attributable to those particular properties.

Acquired properties may be located in new markets where we may face risks associated with investing in an unfamiliar market.

We have acquired, and may continue to acquire, properties in markets that are new to us. When we acquire properties located in these markets, we may face risks associated with a lack of market knowledge or understanding. We work to mitigate such risks through extensive diligence and research; however, there can be no guarantee that all such risks will be eliminated.

Uninsured losses relating to real property may adversely affect our returns.

We attempt to ensure that all of our properties are adequately insured to cover casualty losses. However, there are certain losses, including losses from floods, earthquakes, acts of war, acts of terrorism or riots, that are not generally insured against or that are not generally fully insured against because it is not deemed economically feasible or prudent to do so. In addition, changes in the cost or availability of insurance could expose us to uninsured casualty losses. In the event that any of our properties incurs a casualty loss that is not fully covered by insurance, the value of our assets will be reduced, and we could experience a significant loss of capital invested and potential revenues in these properties and could potentially remain obligated under any recourse debt associated with the property. Any such losses could adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. In addition, we may have no source of funding to repair or reconstruct the damaged property, and we cannot assure that any such sources of funding will be available to us for such purposes in the future.

A number of our consolidated operating properties are located in areas that are known to be subject to earthquake activity. Properties located in active seismic areas include properties in Northern California, Southern California, Memphis and Seattle. We carry reasonable and customary earthquake insurance on all of our

 

12


Table of Contents

properties located in areas historically subject to seismic activity with coverage limitations and deductibles that we believe are commercially reasonable. We evaluate our earthquake insurance coverage annually in light of current industry practice through an analysis prepared by outside consultants.

A number of our properties are located in Houston, Miami and Orlando, which are areas that are known to be subject to hurricane and/or flood risk. We carry replacement-cost hurricane and flood hazard insurance on all of our properties located in areas historically subject to such activity with coverage limitations and deductibles that we believe are commercially reasonable. We evaluate our hurricane and flood damage insurance coverage annually in light of current industry practice through an analysis prepared by outside consultants.

Contingent or unknown liabilities could adversely affect our financial condition.

We have acquired and may in the future acquire properties without any recourse, or with only limited recourse, with respect to unknown or contingent liabilities, including, without limitation, environmental liabilities. As a result, if a claim was asserted against us based upon current or previous ownership of any of these properties or related entities, we might have to pay substantial sums to settle it which could adversely affect our cash flows.

Environmentally hazardous conditions may adversely affect our operating results.

Under various federal, state and local environmental laws, a current or previous owner or operator of real property may be liable for the cost of removing or remediating hazardous or toxic substances on such property. Such laws often impose liability whether or not the owner or operator knew of, or was responsible for, the presence of such hazardous or toxic substances. Even if more than one person may have been responsible for the contamination, a single person may be held responsible for all of the clean-up costs incurred. In addition, third-parties may sue the owner or operator of a site for damages based on personal injury, natural resources, property damage or other costs, including investigation and clean-up costs, resulting from the environmental contamination. The presence of hazardous or toxic substances on one of our properties, or the failure to properly remediate a contaminated property, could give rise to a lien in favor of a government entity for costs it may incur to address the contamination, or otherwise could adversely affect our ability to sell or lease the property or borrow using the property as collateral. Environmental laws also may impose restrictions on the manner in which a property may be used or businesses may be operated. A property owner who violates environmental laws may be subject to sanctions enforceable by governmental agencies or, in certain circumstances, private parties. In connection with the acquisition and ownership of our properties, we may be exposed to such costs. The cost of defending environmental claims, of complying with environmental regulatory requirements or of remediating any contaminated property could materially adversely affect our business, assets or results of operations.

Environmental laws in the U.S. also require that owners or operators of buildings containing asbestos properly manage and maintain the asbestos, adequately inform or train those who may come into contact with asbestos and undertake special precautions, including removal or other abatement, in the event that asbestos is disturbed during building renovation or demolition. These laws may impose fines and penalties on building owners or operators who fail to comply with these requirements and may allow third-parties to seek recovery from owners or operators for personal injury associated with exposure to asbestos. Some of our properties may contain asbestos-containing building materials.

We invest in properties historically used for industrial, manufacturing and commercial purposes. Some of these properties contain, or may have contained, underground storage tanks for the storage of petroleum products and other hazardous or toxic substances. All of these operations create a potential for the release of petroleum products or other hazardous or toxic substances. Some of our properties are adjacent to or near other properties that may have contained or currently contain underground storage tanks used to store petroleum products, or other hazardous or toxic substances. In addition, previous or current occupants of our properties and adjacent properties may have engaged, or may in the future engage, in activities that may release petroleum products or other hazardous or toxic substances.

 

13


Table of Contents

We maintain a portfolio environmental insurance policy that provides coverage for potential environmental liabilities, subject to the policy’s coverage conditions and limitations, for most of our properties. From time to time, we may acquire properties or interests in properties, with known adverse environmental conditions where we believe that the environmental liabilities associated with these conditions are quantifiable and that the acquisition will yield a superior risk-adjusted return. In such an instance, we underwrite the costs of environmental investigation, clean-up and monitoring into the cost. Further, in connection with property dispositions, we may agree to remain responsible for, and to bear the cost of, remediating or monitoring certain environmental conditions on the properties.

All of our properties were subject to a Phase I or similar environmental assessment by independent environmental consultants at the time of acquisition. Phase I assessments are intended to discover and evaluate information regarding the environmental condition of the surveyed property and surrounding properties. Phase I assessments generally include a historical review, a public records review, an investigation of the surveyed site and surrounding properties, and preparation and issuance of a written report, but do not include soil sampling or subsurface investigations and typically do not include an asbestos survey. While some of these assessments have led to further investigation and sampling, none of our environmental assessments of our properties have revealed an environmental liability that we believe would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations taken as a whole. However, we cannot give any assurance that such conditions do not exist or may not arise in the future. Material environmental conditions, liabilities or compliance concerns may arise after the environmental assessment has been completed. Moreover, there can be no assurance that (i) future laws, ordinances or regulations will not impose any material environmental liability or (ii) the current environmental condition of our properties will not be affected by customers, by the condition of land or operations in the vicinity of our properties (such as releases from underground storage tanks), or by third-parties unrelated to us.

Costs of complying with governmental laws and regulations may adversely affect our income and the cash available for any distributions.

All real property and the operations conducted on real property are subject to federal, state and local laws and regulations relating to environmental protection and human health and safety. Customers’ ability to operate and to generate income to pay their lease obligations may be affected by permitting and compliance obligations arising under such laws and regulations. Some of these laws and regulations may impose joint and several liability on customers, owners or operators for the costs to investigate or remediate contaminated properties, regardless of fault or whether the acts causing the contamination were legal. Leasing properties to customers that engage in industrial, manufacturing, and commercial activities will cause us to be subject to the risk of liabilities under environmental laws and regulations. In addition, the presence of hazardous or toxic substances, or the failure to properly remediate these substances, may adversely affect our ability to sell, rent or pledge such property as collateral for future borrowings.

Some of these laws and regulations have been amended so as to require compliance with new or more stringent standards as of future dates. Compliance with new or more stringent laws or regulations or stricter interpretation of existing laws may require us to incur material expenditures. Future laws, ordinances or regulations may impose material environmental liability. Additionally, our customers’ operations, the existing condition of land when we buy it, operations in the vicinity of our properties, such as the presence of underground storage tanks, or activities of unrelated third-parties may affect our properties. In addition, there are various local, state and federal fire, health, life-safety and similar regulations with which we may be required to comply and which may subject us to liability in the form of fines or damages for noncompliance. Any material expenditures, fines or damages we must pay will adversely affect our cash flows and results of operations.

In addition, changes in these laws and governmental regulations, or their interpretation by agencies or the courts, could occur.

 

14


Table of Contents

Compliance or failure to comply with the Americans with Disabilities Act and other similar regulations could result in substantial costs.

Under the Americans with Disabilities Act, places of public accommodation must meet certain federal requirements related to access and use by disabled persons. Noncompliance could result in the imposition of fines by the federal government or the award of damages to private litigants. If we are required to make unanticipated expenditures to comply with the Americans with Disabilities Act, including removing access barriers, then our cash flows may be adversely affected. While we believe that our properties are currently in material compliance with these regulatory requirements, the requirements may change or new requirements may be imposed that could require significant unanticipated expenditures by us that will affect our cash flows and results of operations.

We may acquire properties with “lock-out” provisions which may affect our ability to dispose of the properties.

We may acquire properties through contracts that could restrict our ability to dispose of the property for a period of time. These “lock-out” provisions could affect our ability to turn our investments into cash and could affect cash flows. Lock-out provisions could also impair our ability to take actions during the lock-out period that would otherwise be in the best interest of our financial condition and, therefore, may have an adverse impact on the results of our operations relative to such results if the lock-out provisions did not exist.

RISKS RELATED TO OUR DEBT FINANCINGS

Our operating results and financial condition could be adversely affected if we are unable to make required payments on our debt.

Our organizational documents do not limit the amount or percentage of indebtedness that we may incur, and we are subject to risks normally associated with debt financing, including the risk that our cash flows will be insufficient to meet required payments of principal and interest. There can be no assurance that we will be able to refinance any maturing indebtedness, that such refinancing would be on terms as favorable as the terms of the maturing indebtedness or that we will be able to otherwise obtain funds by selling assets or raising equity to make required payments on maturing indebtedness.

In particular, loans obtained to fund property acquisitions may be secured by first mortgages on such properties. If we are unable to make our debt service payments as required, a lender could foreclose on the property or properties securing its debt. This could cause us to lose part or all of our investment, which in turn could cause an adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows. Certain of our existing and future indebtedness is and may be cross-collateralized and, consequently, a default on this indebtedness could cause us to lose part or all of our investment in multiple properties.

Increases in interest rates could increase the amount of our debt payments or make it difficult for us to finance or refinance properties, which could reduce the number of properties we can acquire.

We have incurred and may continue to incur variable rate debt whereby increases in interest rates raise our interest costs, which reduces our cash flows. If we are unable to refinance our indebtedness at maturity or meet our payment obligations, the amount of our distributable cash flows and our financial condition would be adversely affected, and the property securing such indebtedness may be sold on terms that are not advantageous to us or lost through foreclosure. Similarly, if debt is unavailable at reasonable rates, we may not be able to finance the purchase of properties. In addition, if we need to repay existing debt during periods of rising interest rates, we could be required to liquidate one or more of our investments in properties at times which may not permit realization of the maximum return on such investments.

 

15


Table of Contents

Covenants in our credit agreements could limit our flexibility and adversely affect our financial condition.

The terms of our senior credit facility and other indebtedness require us to comply with a number of customary financial and other covenants, such as covenants with respect to consolidated leverage, net worth and unencumbered assets. These covenants may limit our flexibility in our operations, and breaches of these covenants could result in defaults under the instruments governing the applicable indebtedness even if we have satisfied our payment obligations. As of December 31, 2013, we had certain non-recourse, secured loans which are cross-collateralized by multiple properties. If we default on any of these loans we may then be required to repay such indebtedness, together with applicable prepayment charges, to avoid foreclosure on all cross-collateralized properties within the applicable pool. In addition, our senior credit facility contains certain cross-default provisions which are triggered in the event that our other material indebtedness is in default. These cross-default provisions may require us to repay or restructure the senior credit facility in addition to any mortgage or other debt that is in default. If our properties were foreclosed upon, or if we are unable to refinance our indebtedness at maturity or meet our payment obligations, the amount of our distributable cash flows and our financial condition would be adversely affected.

If we enter into financing arrangements involving balloon payment obligations, it may adversely affect our ability to make distributions.

Some of our financing arrangements may require us to make a lump-sum or “balloon” payment at maturity. Our ability to make a balloon payment at maturity is uncertain and may depend upon our ability to obtain additional financing or our ability to sell the property. At the time the balloon payment is due, we may or may not be able to refinance the existing financing on terms as favorable as the original loan or sell the property at a price sufficient to make the balloon payment. The effect of a refinancing or sale could affect the results of our operations and the projected time of disposition of our assets. In addition, payments of principal and interest made to service our debts may leave us with insufficient cash to pay the distributions that we are required to pay to maintain our qualification as a REIT.

FEDERAL INCOME TAX RISKS

Failure to qualify as a REIT could adversely affect our operations and our ability to make distributions.

DCT operates in a manner so as to qualify as a REIT for U.S. federal income tax purposes. DCT’s qualification as a REIT will depend on its satisfaction of numerous requirements (some on an annual and quarterly basis) established under highly technical and complex provisions of the Code for which there are only limited judicial or administrative interpretations, and involves the determination of various factual matters and circumstances not entirely within our control. The fact that we hold substantially all of our assets through DCTOP and its subsidiaries further complicates the application of the REIT requirements for us. No assurance can be given that DCT will qualify as a REIT for any particular year. If DCT were to fail to qualify as a REIT in any taxable year for which a REIT election has been made, we would not be allowed a deduction for dividends paid to DCT’s stockholders in computing our taxable income and would be subject to federal income tax (including any applicable alternative minimum tax) on our taxable income at corporate rates unless certain relief provision apply. As a consequence, we would not be compelled to make distributions under the Code. Moreover, unless we were to obtain relief under certain statutory provisions, DCT would also be disqualified from treatment as a REIT for the four taxable years following the year during which qualification is lost. This treatment would reduce our net earnings available for investment and cash flows because of the additional tax liability to us for the years involved. As a result of the additional tax liability, we might need to borrow funds or liquidate certain investments on terms that may be disadvantageous to us in order to pay the applicable tax. If DCT fails to qualify as a REIT but we are eligible for certain relief provisions, then DCT may retain its status as a REIT but we may be required to pay a penalty tax, which could be substantial.

 

16


Table of Contents

To qualify as a REIT, DCT must meet annual distribution requirements.

To obtain the favorable tax treatment accorded to REITs, among other requirements, we normally will be required each year to distribute to DCT’s stockholders at least 90% of our REIT taxable income, determined without regard to the deduction for dividends paid and by excluding net capital gains. We will be subject to federal income tax on our undistributed taxable income and net capital gain. In addition, if we fail to distribute during each calendar year at least the sum of (a) 85% of our ordinary income for such year, (b) 95% of our capital gain net income for such year, and (c) any undistributed taxable income from prior periods, we will be subject to a 4% excise tax on the excess of the required distribution over the sum of (i) the amounts actually distributed by us, plus (ii) retained amounts on which we pay income tax at the corporate level. We intend to make distributions to DCT’s stockholders to comply with the requirements of the Code for REITs and to minimize or eliminate our corporate income tax obligation. However, differences between the recognition of taxable income and the actual receipt of cash could require us to sell assets or borrow funds on a short-term or long-term basis or partially pay dividends in shares of DCT’s common stock to meet the distribution requirements of the Code. Certain types of assets generate substantial mismatches between taxable income and available cash. Such assets include rental real estate that has been financed through financing structures which require some or all of available cash flows to be used to service borrowings. As a result, the requirement to distribute a substantial portion of our taxable income could cause us to: (1) sell assets in adverse market conditions, (2) borrow on unfavorable terms or (3) distribute amounts that would otherwise be invested in future acquisitions, capital expenditures or repayment of debt, in order to comply with REIT requirements. Further, amounts distributed will not be available to fund our operations.

Recharacterization of transactions under DCTOP’s private placement may result in a 100% tax on income from prohibited transactions, which would diminish our cash flows.

The IRS could recharacterize transactions under DCTOP’s private placement such that DCTOP is treated as the bona fide owner, for tax purposes, of properties acquired and resold by the entity established to facilitate the transaction. Such recharacterization could result in the income realized on these transactions by DCTOP being treated as gain on the sale of property that is held as inventory or otherwise held primarily for the sale to customers in the ordinary course of business. In such event, such gain would constitute income from a prohibited transaction and would be subject to a 100% tax. If this occurs, our cash flows and results of operations will be adversely affected.

In certain circumstances, we may be subject to federal and state income taxes, which would reduce our cash flows.

Even if we qualify and maintain our status as a REIT, we may be subject to federal income taxes or state taxes in various circumstances. For example, net income from a “prohibited transaction” will be subject to a 100% tax. In addition, we may not be able to distribute all of our income in any given year, which would result in corporate level taxes, and we may not make sufficient distributions to avoid excise taxes. We may also decide to retain certain gains from the sale or other disposition of our property and pay income tax directly on such gains. In that event, our stockholders would be required to include such gains in income and would receive a corresponding credit for their share of taxes paid by us. We may also be subject to U.S. state and local and non-U.S. taxes on our income or property, either directly or at the level of DCTOP or at the level of the other entities through which we indirectly own our assets. In addition, any net taxable income earned directly by any of our taxable REIT subsidiaries, which we refer to as TRSs, will be subject to federal and state corporate income tax. In addition, we may be subject to federal or state taxes in other various circumstances. Any taxes we pay will reduce our cash flows.

Certain property transfers may generate prohibited transaction income, resulting in a penalty tax on gain attributable to the transaction.

From time to time, we may transfer or otherwise dispose of some of our properties, including the contribution of properties to our joint venture funds or other commingled investment vehicles. Under the Code,

 

17


Table of Contents

any gain resulting from transfers of properties that we hold as inventory or primarily for sale to customers in the ordinary course of business would be treated as income from a prohibited transaction subject to a 100% penalty tax, unless a safe harbor exception applies. Since we acquire properties for investment purposes, we do not believe that our occasional transfers or disposals of property or our contributions of properties into our joint venture funds, or commingled investment vehicles, are properly treated as prohibited transactions. However, whether property is held for investment purposes is a question of fact that depends on all the facts and circumstances surrounding the particular transaction. The IRS may contend that certain transfers or disposals of properties by us or contributions of properties into our joint venture funds are prohibited transactions if they do not meet the safe harbor requirements. While we believe that the IRS would not prevail in any such dispute, if the IRS were to argue successfully that a transfer or disposition or contribution of property constituted a prohibited transaction, we would be required to pay a 100% penalty tax on any gain allocable to us from the prohibited transaction. In addition, income from a prohibited transaction might adversely affect our ability to satisfy the income tests for qualification as a real estate investment trust for federal income tax purposes.

Congress has introduced legislation that, if enacted, could cause DCTOP to be taxable as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes under the publicly traded partnership rules.

Congress has considered and the Obama administration has indicated its support for legislative proposals to treat all or part of certain income allocated to a partner by a partnership in respect of certain services provided to or for the benefit of the partnership (“carried interest revenue”) as ordinary income for U.S. federal income tax purposes. While more recent proposals would not adversely affect the character of the income for purposes of the REIT qualification tests, it is not clear what form any such final legislation would take. Additionally, while the more recent proposals purport to treat carried interest revenue as qualifying income of certain operating partnerships of publicly-traded REITs for purposes of the “qualifying income” exception to the publicly-traded partnership rules, DCTOP may not qualify under this exception in the proposed legislation. As a result, the proposed legislation, if enacted, could cause DCTOP to be taxable as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes if it is a publicly-traded partnership and the amount of any such carried interest revenue plus any other non-qualifying income earned by DCTOP exceeds 10% of its gross income in any taxable year.

RISKS RELATED TO THE NOTES AND THIS EXCHANGE OFFERING

Our substantial indebtedness could adversely affect our financial condition and ability to fulfill our obligations under the notes and otherwise adversely impact our business and growth prospects.

We have a substantial amount of debt. At December 31, 2013, our total consolidated indebtedness was approximately $1.5 billion, consisting of approximately $1.1 billion of senior unsecured notes, which includes $225.0 million of term loans; $291.0 million of mortgage notes; and $39.0 million outstanding under our revolving credit facility. In addition, at December 31, 2013, our revolving credit facility had total undrawn availability of $261.0 million. Our total consolidated indebtedness also does not include our proportionate share of the indebtedness of our unconsolidated joint ventures, which was $44.4 million at December 31, 2013.

Our substantial indebtedness could have significant adverse consequences to holders of the notes, including the following:

 

    our cash flow may be insufficient to meet our required principal and interest payments with respect to the notes and our other indebtedness;

 

    we could be more vulnerable to adverse economic and industry conditions and limited in our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the industry in which we operate;

 

    we may be unable to borrow additional funds as needed or on favorable terms;

 

    we may be unable to refinance our indebtedness at maturity or the refinancing terms may be less favorable than the terms of our original indebtedness;

 

18


Table of Contents
    because a portion of our debt bears interest at variable rates, increases in interest rates could increase our interest expense;

 

    we may be forced to dispose of one or more of our properties, possibly on disadvantageous terms, in order to meet our debt obligations;

 

    in the event of a decline in the value of our assets, our ability to fully satisfy our obligations under the notes may be reduced;

 

    if we violate restrictive covenants in the agreements governing our indebtedness, the lenders may be entitled to accelerate our debt obligations; and

 

    as a result of cross default provisions contained in the terms of our senior unsecured notes and revolving credit facility, our default under indebtedness representing a small percentage of our total consolidated indebtedness would result in defaults under all of our senior unsecured notes and our revolving credit facility.

In addition, our senior unsecured notes and our revolving credit facility require us to maintain specified financial ratios and comply with several restrictive covenants. All of these restrictions may limit our ability to execute our business strategy. Moreover, if operating results fall below current levels, we may be unable to maintain these ratios or comply with the covenants. If that occurs, our lenders could accelerate our indebtedness, in which case we may not be able to repay all of our indebtedness, and your notes may not be repaid fully, or at all.

The notes are effectively subordinated to our existing secured debt and any secured debt we may incur in the future.

The notes are not secured by any of our assets. As a result, the notes are effectively subordinated to our existing secured debt and any secured debt we may incur in the future to the extent of the value of the collateral securing such indebtedness. In any liquidation, dissolution, bankruptcy or other similar proceeding, holders of our secured debt may assert rights against any assets securing such debt in order to receive full payment of their debt before those assets may be used to pay the holders of the notes. As of December 31, 2013, we had approximately $291.0 million of secured consolidated debt outstanding and we will be permitted to incur significant additional secured debt under the terms of the indenture governing the notes.

The notes are structurally subordinated in right of payment to all liabilities of our existing and future subsidiaries that do not guarantee the notes and, if the guarantees are deemed unenforceable, to those of our subsidiary guarantors, and the remaining assets of such subsidiaries may not be sufficient to make any payments on the notes. In addition, the guarantors’ guarantees may be released in the future if certain events occur.

The notes are structurally subordinated to all liabilities of our current subsidiaries that are not subsidiary guarantors and will be structurally subordinated to all liabilities of any future subsidiaries that do not guarantee the notes. In addition, although the guarantees provide the holders of the notes with a direct claim as a creditor against the assets of the subsidiary guarantors, the guarantees may not be enforceable as described in more detail below. See “—Federal and state statutes allow courts, under specific circumstances, to void guarantees and require holders of notes to return payments received from guarantors.” If the guarantees by the subsidiary guarantors are not enforceable, the notes would be effectively subordinated to all liabilities of the subsidiary guarantors, including trade payables. As a result of being effectively subordinated to the liabilities of a subsidiary, if there was a dissolution, bankruptcy, liquidation or reorganization of such subsidiary, the holders of the notes would not receive any amounts with respect to the notes until after the payment in full of the claims of creditors of such subsidiary.

 

19


Table of Contents

A subsidiary guarantor will be automatically released from its guarantee if, among other things, it ceases to guarantee DCTOP’s indebtedness for money borrowed in an amount greater than $5.0 million. We currently intend to pursue an amendment to our revolving credit facility and term loan facilities to remove all of the subsidiary guarantors as guarantors thereunder and the requirement for our future subsidiaries to guarantee these facilities in order to enable our subsidiary guarantors to be released from their guarantees under our outstanding senior unsecured notes and the notes offered hereby.

As of December 31, 2013, DCTOP and the guarantors had $1.5 billion of indebtedness ($291.0 million of which was secured indebtedness), and our consolidated subsidiaries that will not guarantee the notes had $256.5 million of indebtedness and $25.0 million of other liabilities, all of which would have been structurally senior to the notes, and had $528.2 million of assets, representing 16.2% of our consolidated total assets.

We may not be able to generate sufficient cash flow to meet our debt service obligations.

Our ability to make payments on and to refinance our indebtedness, including the notes, and to fund our operations, working capital and capital expenditures, depends on our ability to generate cash in the future. To a certain extent, our cash flow is subject to general economic, industry, financial, competitive, operating, legislative, regulatory and other factors, many of which are beyond our control.

We cannot assure you that our business will generate sufficient cash flow from operations or that future sources of cash will be available to us in an amount sufficient to enable us to pay amounts due on our indebtedness, including the notes, or to fund our other liquidity needs. Additionally, if we incur additional indebtedness in connection with future acquisitions or development projects or for any other purpose, our debt service obligations could increase.

We may need or otherwise seek to refinance all or a portion of our indebtedness, including the notes, on or before maturity. Our ability to refinance our indebtedness or obtain additional financing will depend on, among other things:

 

    our financial condition and market conditions at the time; and

 

    restrictions in the agreements governing our indebtedness.

As a result, we may not be able to refinance any of our indebtedness, including the notes, on commercially reasonable terms, or at all. If we do not generate sufficient cash flow from operations, and additional borrowings or refinancings or proceeds of asset sales or other sources of cash are not available to us, we may not have sufficient cash to enable us to meet all of our obligations, including payments on the notes. Accordingly, if we cannot service our indebtedness, we may have to take actions such as seeking additional equity, delaying development or acquisition activities or capital expenditures or disposing of properties or other assets, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our operations. We cannot assure you that we will be able to effect any of these actions on commercially reasonable terms, or at all.

Despite our substantial indebtedness, we may still incur significantly more debt, which could exacerbate any or all of the risks related to our indebtedness, including our ability to pay the principal of or interest on the notes.

Although the agreements governing our existing indebtedness limit, and the indenture governing the notes limits, our ability to incur additional indebtedness, these restrictions are subject to a number of qualifications and exceptions and, under certain circumstances, debt incurred in compliance with these restrictions could be substantial. In addition, the indenture governing the notes will not prevent us from incurring obligations that do not constitute indebtedness. To the extent that we incur additional indebtedness or other such obligations, the risks associated with our substantial indebtedness described above, including our possible inability to service our debt obligations, would increase.

 

20


Table of Contents

A downgrade in our credit ratings could materially adversely affect the trading price of the notes and our business and financial condition.

In September 2013, we received investment grade corporate credit ratings from Moody’s and S&P. Any downgrades in terms of ratings or outlook by any rating agency could have a material adverse impact on the trading price of the notes and on our cost and availability of capital, which could in turn have a material adverse impact on our financial condition, results of operations and liquidity.

The indenture governing the notes contains and our revolving credit facility and senior unsecured notes contain restrictive covenants that limit our operating flexibility and could adversely affect our financial condition.

The indenture governing the notes contains financial and operating covenants that, among other things, restrict our ability to take specific actions, even if we believe them to be in our best interest, including restrictions on our ability to:

 

    consummate a merger, consolidation or sale of all or substantially all of our assets; and

 

    incur additional secured and unsecured indebtedness.

In addition, our senior unsecured notes and our revolving credit facility require us to maintain specified financial ratios and comply with several restrictive covenants. All of these restrictions may limit our ability to execute our business strategy. Moreover, if operating results fall below current levels, we may be unable to maintain these ratios or comply with the covenants. If that occurs, our lenders could accelerate our indebtedness, in which case we may not be able to repay all of our indebtedness, and your notes may not be repaid fully, or at all.

There is currently no trading market for the notes, and an active public trading market for the notes may not develop or, if it develops, may not be maintained or be public. The failure of an active liquid trading market for the notes to develop or be maintained is likely to adversely affect the market price and liquidity of the notes.

The notes are a new issue of securities, and there is currently no existing trading market for the notes. We do not intend to apply for listing of the notes on any securities exchange or for quotation of the notes on any automated dealer quotation system. An active trading market may not develop for the notes and, even if one develops, may not be maintained. If an active trading market for the notes does not develop or is not maintained, the market price and liquidity of the notes is likely to be adversely affected, and holders may not be able to sell their notes at desired times and prices or at all. If any of the notes are traded after their purchase, they may trade at a discount from their purchase price.

The liquidity of the trading market, if any, and future trading prices of the notes will depend on many factors, including, among other things, prevailing interest rates and our financial condition, results of operations, business, prospects and credit quality and those of other comparable companies, the market for similar securities and the overall securities market, and may be adversely affected by unfavorable changes in any of these factors, some of which are beyond our control. In addition, market volatility or events or developments in the credit markets could materially and adversely affect the market value of the notes, regardless of our financial condition, results of operations, business, prospects or credit quality.

Federal and state statutes allow courts, under specific circumstances, to void guarantees and require holders of notes to return payments received from guarantors.

Under the federal bankruptcy law and comparable provisions of state fraudulent transfer laws, a guarantee, such as the guarantees provided by DCT and the subsidiary guarantors, could be voided, or claims in respect of a

 

21


Table of Contents

guarantee could be subordinated to all other debts of that guarantor if, among other things, the guarantor, at the time it incurred the indebtedness evidenced by its guarantee:

 

    received less than reasonably equivalent value or fair consideration for the incurrence of the guarantee; and

either:

 

    was insolvent or rendered insolvent by reason of the incurrence of the guarantee;

 

    was engaged in a business or transaction for which the guarantor’s remaining assets constituted unreasonably small capital; or

 

    intended to incur, or believed that it would incur, debts beyond its ability to pay those debts as they mature.

In addition, any payment by that guarantor pursuant to its guarantee could be voided and required to be returned to the guarantor, or to a fund for the benefit of the creditors of the guarantor. The measures of insolvency for purposes of these fraudulent transfer laws will vary depending upon the law applied in any proceeding to determine whether a fraudulent transfer has occurred. Generally, however, a guarantor would be considered insolvent if:

 

    the sum of its debts, including contingent liabilities, was greater than the fair saleable value of all of its assets;

 

    the present fair saleable value of its assets was less than the amount that would be required to pay its probable liability on its existing debts, including contingent liabilities, as they became absolute and mature; or

 

    it could not pay its debts as they become due.

The court might also void such guarantee, without regard to the above factors, if it found that a guarantor entered into its guarantee with actual or deemed intent to hinder, delay, or defraud its creditors.

We cannot be certain as to the standards a court would use to determine whether reasonably equivalent value or fair consideration was received by a guarantor for its guarantee of the notes, but, as a result of the fact that the subsidiary guarantors generally will not directly benefit from the issuance of the notes, a court could find that a subsidiary guarantor did not receive reasonably equivalent value or fair consideration for its guarantee. If a court voided such guarantee, holders of the notes would no longer have a claim against such guarantor or the benefit of the assets of such guarantor constituting collateral that purportedly secured such guarantee and would be creditors solely of us. In addition, the court might direct holders of the notes to repay any amounts already received from a guarantor. If the court were to void the guarantee of DCT or any subsidiary guarantor we cannot assure you that funds would be available to pay the notes from any of our subsidiaries or from any other source.

Holders of the notes will not be entitled to require us to redeem or repurchase the notes upon the occurrence of change of control or highly levered transactions or other designated events.

Other than as provided in “Description of notes—Merger, consolidation or sale,” the indenture will not afford holders of the notes protection in the event of (1) a recapitalization transaction or other highly leveraged or similar transaction involving DCTOP or DCT, (2) a change of control of DCTOP or DCT or (3) a merger, consolidation, reorganization, restructuring or transfer or lease of all or substantially all of DCTOP’s or DCT’s assets or similar transactions that may adversely affect the holders of the notes. DCTOP or DCT may, in the future, enter into certain transactions, such as the sale of all or substantially all of DCTOP’s or DCT’s assets or a merger or consolidation that may increase the amount of DCTOP’s or DCT’s indebtedness or substantially change DCTOP’s or DCT’s assets, which may have a material adverse effect on DCTOP’s ability to service its indebtedness, including the notes, or on DCT’s ability to pay amounts due under its guarantees of the notes. Furthermore, the notes and the indenture will not include any provisions that would allow holders of the notes to require DCTOP or DCT to repurchase or redeem the notes in the event of a transaction of the nature described above.

 

22


Table of Contents

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This prospectus and the documents incorporated herein by reference contain “forward-looking” statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act, and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange Act, which are usually identified by the use of words such as “anticipates,” “believes,” “estimates,” “expects,” “intends,” “may,” “plans,” “projects,” “seeks,” “should,” “will,” and variations of such words or similar expressions. We intend these forward-looking statements to be covered by the safe harbor provisions for forward-looking statements contained in the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 and are including this statement for purposes of complying with those safe harbor provisions. These forward-looking statements reflect our current views about our plans, intentions, expectations, strategies and prospects, which are based on the information currently available to us and on assumptions we have made. Although we believe that our plans, intentions, expectations, strategies and prospects as reflected in or suggested by those forward-looking statements are reasonable, we can give no assurance that the plans, intentions, expectations or strategies will be attained or achieved. Furthermore, actual results may differ materially from those described in the forward-looking statements and will be affected by a variety of risks and factors that are beyond our control including, without limitation:

 

    national, international, regional and local economic conditions, including, in particular, the strength of the United States economic recovery and global economic recovery;

 

    the general level of interest rates and the availability of capital;

 

    the competitive environment in which we operate;

 

    real estate risks, including fluctuations in real estate values and the general economic climate in local markets and competition for tenants in such markets;

 

    decreased rental rates or increasing vacancy rates;

 

    defaults on or non-renewal of leases by tenants;

 

    acquisition and development risks, including failure of such acquisitions and development projects to perform in accordance with projections;

 

    the timing of acquisitions, dispositions and development;

 

    natural disasters such as fires, floods, tornadoes, hurricanes and earthquakes;

 

    energy costs;

 

    the terms of governmental regulations that affect us and interpretations of those regulations, including the costs of compliance with those regulations, changes in real estate and zoning laws and increases in real property tax rates;

 

    financing risks, including the risk that our cash flows from operations may be insufficient to meet required payments of principal, interest and other commitments;

 

    lack of or insufficient amounts of insurance;

 

    litigation, including costs associated with prosecuting or defending claims and any adverse outcomes;

 

    the consequences of future terrorist attacks or civil unrest;

 

    environmental liabilities, including costs, fines or penalties that may be incurred due to necessary remediation of contamination of properties presently owned or previously owned by us; and

 

    other risks and uncertainties detailed in the section entitled “Risk Factors.”

In addition, our current and continuing qualification as a real estate investment trust, or REIT, involves the application of highly technical and complex provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, or the Code, and depends on our ability to meet the various requirements imposed by the Code through actual operating results, distribution levels and diversity of stock ownership.

 

23


Table of Contents

THE EXCHANGE OFFER

Purpose of the Exchange Offer

On October 9, 2013, DCTOP issued $275.0 million of the private notes to J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, Comerica Securities, Inc., Mitsubishi UFJ Securities (USA), Inc., PNC Capital Markets LLC, Regions Securities LLC and U.S. Bancorp Investments, Inc., the initial purchasers, pursuant to a purchase agreement. The initial purchasers subsequently sold the private notes to “qualified institutional buyers,” as defined in Rule 144A under the Securities Act, in reliance on Rule 144A, and to certain non-U.S. persons located outside the United States, in reliance on Regulation S under the Securities Act. As a condition to the sale of the private notes, we entered into a registration rights agreement with the initial purchasers on October 9, 2013. The registration rights agreement provides that:

(1) DCTOP and DCT must use commercially reasonable efforts to cause an exchange offer registration statement to be declared effective by the SEC and to complete the exchange offer not later than 60 days after such registration statement becomes effective and not more than 270 days after the issuance of the private notes; and

(2) unless the exchange offer would not be permitted by applicable law or SEC policy or applicable interpretation of the staff of the SEC, DCTOP and DCT will commence the exchange offer promptly after the exchange offer registration statement is declared effective by the SEC and keep the exchange offer open for at least 20 business days (or longer, if required by applicable securities laws) after the date notice is sent to holders of entitled securities (as defined below); and

(3) if obligated to file a shelf registration statement, as discussed below, DCTOP and DCT will use all commercially reasonable efforts to file a shelf registration statement with the SEC as soon as reasonably practicable after such filing obligation arises, cause the shelf registration statement to be declared effective by the SEC and keep the shelf registration statement continuously effective until the securities cease to be registrable securities.

Upon the effectiveness of the exchange offer registration statement, we will offer the exchange notes in exchange for the private notes. The registration rights agreement is listed as an exhibit to the registration statement of which this prospectus is part.

Resale of the Exchange Notes

Under existing interpretations by the staff of the SEC contained in no-action letters to third parties, the exchange notes will generally be freely transferable by holders (other than by any holder that is an affiliate (as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act) of DCTOP or DCT) after the exchange offer without further registration under the Securities Act, except that participating broker-dealers (as defined below) will be required to deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale or other transfer of the exchange notes as described below.

If you wish to exchange your private notes for exchange notes in the exchange offer, you will be required to make certain representations. If you are not able to make these representations, you will not be entitled to participate in the exchange offer or to exchange your private notes for exchange notes.

Any broker-dealer who holds private notes acquired for its own account as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities (a participating broker-dealer) who exchanges those private notes for exchange notes in the exchange offer must deliver a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale of those exchange notes. We understand that the staff of the SEC has taken the position that participating broker-dealers may fulfill their prospectus delivery requirements with respect to exchange notes, other than a resale of an unsold allotment from the initial offering of the private notes, with the prospectus contained in the exchange offer registration statement. Under the registration rights agreement, for a

 

24


Table of Contents

period of 180 days following the expiration date of the exchange offer, participating broker-dealers will be entitled to use the prospectus contained in the exchange offer registration statement in connection with the resale of the exchange notes (and we will agree to keep the exchange offer registration statement continuously effective and the related prospectus current during such period).

Terms of the Exchange Offer

Upon the terms and subject to the conditions described in this prospectus and in the accompanying letter of transmittal, which together constitute the exchange offer, we will accept any and all private notes validly tendered and not withdrawn before the expiration date. We will issue $1,000 principal amount of exchange notes in exchange for each $1,000 principal amount of outstanding private notes surrendered pursuant to the exchange offer. You may tender private notes only in denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.

The form and terms of the exchange notes are the same as the form and terms of the private notes except that:

 

    the exchange notes will be registered with the SEC and thus will not be subject to restrictions on transfer or bear legends restricting their transfer; and

 

    the exchange notes will not provide for the payment of additional interest as described below or be entitled to registration rights under the registration rights agreement.

The exchange notes will evidence the same debt as the private notes and will be issued under the same indenture, so the exchange notes and the private notes will be treated as a single class of debt securities under the indenture.

As of the date of this prospectus, $275.0 million in aggregate principal amount of the private notes are outstanding and registered in the name of DTC or its nominee. Only registered holders of the private notes, or their legal representative or attorney-in-fact, as reflected on the records of the trustee under the indenture, may participate in the exchange offer. We will not set a fixed record date for determining registered holders of the private notes entitled to participate in the exchange offer.

You do not have any appraisal or dissenters’ rights under the indenture in connection with the exchange offer. We intend to conduct the exchange offer in accordance with the provisions of the registration rights agreement and the applicable requirements of the Securities Act, the Exchange Act and the rules and regulations of the SEC.

We will be deemed to have accepted validly tendered private notes when, as and if we have given written notice of acceptance to the exchange agent. The exchange agent will act as your agent for the purposes of receiving the exchange notes from us.

If you tender private notes in the exchange offer you will not be required to pay brokerage commissions or fees with respect to the exchange of private notes pursuant to the exchange offer. We will pay all charges and expenses, other than the applicable taxes described below, in connection with the exchange offer.

Expiration Date; Extensions; Amendments

The term “expiration date” will mean 5:00 p.m., New York City time on May 26, 2014 (the 21st business day following commencement of the exchange offer), unless we extend the exchange offer, in which case the term expiration date will mean the latest date and time to which we extend the exchange offer.

 

25


Table of Contents

To extend the exchange offer, we will notify the exchange agent and each registered holder of any extension in writing by a press release or other public announcement before 9:00 a.m., New York City time, on the next business day after the previously scheduled expiration date. The notice of extension will disclose the aggregate principal amount of the private notes that have been tendered as of the date of such notice.

We reserve the right, in our reasonable discretion:

 

    to delay accepting any private notes due to an extension of the exchange offer; or

 

    if any conditions listed below under “—Conditions” are not satisfied, to terminate the exchange offer,

in each case by written notice of the delay, extension or termination to the exchange agent and by press release or other public announcement.

We will follow any delay in acceptance, extension or termination as promptly as practicable by written notice to the registered holders by a press release or other public announcement. If we amend the exchange offer in a manner we determine constitutes a material change, we will promptly disclose the amendment in a prospectus supplement that we will distribute to the registered holders. We will also extend the exchange offer for a period of five to ten business days, depending upon the significance of the amendment and the manner of disclosure, if the exchange offer would otherwise expire during the five to ten business day period.

Interest on the Exchange notes

The exchange notes will bear interest at the same rate and on the same terms as the private notes. Consequently, the exchange notes will bear interest at a rate equal to 4.500% per year (calculated using a 360-day year). Interest will be payable on the exchange notes semi-annually on each April 15 and October 15.

Interest on the exchange notes will accrue from the last interest payment date on which interest was paid on the private notes or, if no interest has been paid on the private notes, from the date of initial issuance of the private notes. We will deem the right to receive any interest accrued but unpaid on the private notes waived by you if we accept your private notes for exchange.

Procedures for Tendering

Valid Tender

Except as described below, a tendering holder must, prior to the expiration date, transmit to the exchange agent, at the address listed under the heading “—Exchange Agent”:

 

    a properly completed and duly executed letter of transmittal, including all other documents required by the letter of transmittal; or

 

    if the private notes are tendered in accordance with the book-entry procedures listed below, an agent’s message.

In addition, a tendering holder must:

 

    deliver certificates, if any, for the private notes to the exchange agent at or before the expiration date; or

 

    deliver a timely confirmation of book-entry transfer of the private notes into the exchange agent’s account at DTC, the book-entry transfer facility, along with the letter of transmittal or an agent’s message; or

 

    comply with the guaranteed delivery procedures described below.

 

26


Table of Contents

The term “agent’s message” means a message, transmitted by DTC to and received by the exchange agent and forming a part of a book-entry confirmation, that states that DTC has received an express acknowledgment that the tendering holder agrees to be bound by the letter of transmittal and that we may enforce the letter of transmittal against this holder.

If the letter of transmittal is signed by a person other than the registered holder of private notes, the letter of transmittal must be accompanied by a written instrument of transfer or exchange in satisfactory form duly executed by the registered holder with the signature guaranteed by an eligible institution. The private notes must be endorsed or accompanied by appropriate powers of attorney. In either case, the private notes must be signed exactly as the name of any registered holder appears on the private notes.

If the letter of transmittal or any private notes or powers of attorney are signed by trustees, executors, administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact, officers of corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, these persons should so indicate when signing. Unless waived by us, proper evidence satisfactory to us of their authority to so act must be submitted.

By tendering private notes pursuant to the exchange offer, each holder will represent to us that the holder (1) owns the private notes tendered and is entitled to tender such notes, and (2) has full power and authority to tender, sell, exchange, assign and transfer the private notes and to acquire exchange notes issuable upon the exchange of such tendered private notes, and that, when the same are accepted for exchange, DCTOP will acquire good, marketable and unencumbered title to the tendered private notes, free and clear of all liens, restrictions, charges and encumbrances and not subject to any adverse claim or right or restriction or proxy of any kind. Each holder will warrant that it will, upon request, execute and deliver any additional documents deemed by the exchange agent or DCTOP to be necessary or desirable to complete the sale, exchange, assignment and transfer of tendered private notes or to transfer ownership of such notes on the account books maintained by DTC.

In addition, unless a box under the heading “Special Issuance Instructions” in the letter of transmittal is checked by a holder, by tendering private notes and executing the letter of transmittal, each holder will represent and warrant that:

(1) the holder or any beneficial owner of the private notes is acquiring the exchange notes in the ordinary course of business of the holder (or such other beneficial owner);

(2) neither the holder nor any beneficial owner is engaging in or intends to engage in a distribution of the exchange notes within the meaning of the federal securities laws;

(3) neither the holder nor any beneficial owner has an arrangement or understanding with any person or entity to participate in a distribution of the exchange notes;

(4) neither the holder nor any beneficial owner is an “affiliate,” as such term is defined under Rule 405 promulgated under the Securities Act, of DCTOP or of DCT. Upon request by DCTOP, the holder or such beneficial owner will deliver to DCTOP a legal opinion confirming it is not such an affiliate;

(5) the holder and each beneficial owner acknowledges and agrees that any person who is a broker-dealer registered under the Exchange Act, or is participating in the exchange offer for the purpose of distributing the exchange notes, must comply with the registration and delivery requirements of the Securities Act in connection with a secondary resale transaction of the exchange notes or interests therein acquired by such person and cannot rely on the position of the staff of the SEC set forth in certain no-action letters;

(6) a secondary resale transaction described in clause (5) above and any resales of exchange notes or interests therein obtained by such holder in exchange for private notes or interests therein originally acquired by such holder directly from DCTOP should be covered by an effective registration statement containing the selling security holder information required by Item 507 or Item 508, as applicable, of Regulation S-K or the SEC; and

 

27


Table of Contents

(7) the holder is not acting on behalf of any person or entity who could not truthfully make the foregoing representations.

If the holder is a broker-dealer that will receive exchange notes for its own account in exchange for private notes, it will represent that the private notes to be exchanged for the exchange notes were acquired by it for its own account as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities and acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale of such exchange notes; however, by so acknowledging and delivering a prospectus, the holder will not be deemed to admit that it is an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act. If the holder is a broker-dealer and private notes held for its own account were not acquired as a result of market-making or other trading activities, such private notes cannot be exchanged pursuant to the exchange offer.

The method of delivery of private notes, letters of transmittal and all other required documents is at your election and risk. If the delivery is by mail, we recommend that you use registered mail, properly insured, with return receipt requested. In all cases, you should allow sufficient time to assure timely delivery. You should not send letters of transmittal or private notes to us.

If you are a beneficial owner whose private notes are registered in the name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee, and wish to tender, you should promptly instruct the registered holder to tender on your behalf. Any registered holder that is a participant in DTC’s book-entry transfer facility system may make book-entry delivery of the private notes by causing DTC to transfer the private notes into the exchange agent’s account, including by means of DTC’s Automated Tender Offer Program.

Signature Guarantees

Signatures on a letter of transmittal or a notice of withdrawal must be guaranteed, unless the private notes surrendered for exchange are tendered:

 

    by a registered holder of the private notes who has not completed the box entitled “Special Issuance Instructions” or “Special Delivery Instructions” on the letter of transmittal; or

 

    for the account of an “eligible institution.”

If signatures on a letter of transmittal or a notice of withdrawal are required to be guaranteed, the guarantees must be by an “eligible institution.” An “eligible institution” is an “eligible guarantor institution” meeting the requirements of the registrar for the notes, which requirements include membership or participation in the Security Transfer Agent Medallion Program, or STAMP, or such other “signature guarantee program” as may be determined by the registrar for the notes in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP, all in accordance with the Exchange Act.

Book-Entry Transfer

The exchange agent will make a request to establish an account for the private notes at DTC for purposes of the exchange offer within two business days after the date of this prospectus. Any financial institution that is a participant in DTC’s systems must make book-entry delivery of private notes by causing DTC to transfer those private notes into the exchange agent’s account at DTC in accordance with DTC’s procedure for transfer. The participant should transmit its acceptance to DTC at or prior to the expiration date or comply with the guaranteed delivery procedures described below. DTC will verify this acceptance, execute a book-entry transfer of the tendered private notes into the exchange agent’s account at DTC and then send to the exchange agent confirmation of this book-entry transfer. The confirmation of this book-entry transfer will include an agent’s message confirming that DTC has received an express acknowledgment from this participant that this participant has received and agrees to be bound by the letter of transmittal and that we may enforce the letter of transmittal against this participant.

 

28


Table of Contents

Delivery of exchange notes issued in the exchange offer may be effected through book-entry transfer at DTC. However, the letter of transmittal or facsimile of it or an agent’s message, with any required signature guarantees and any other required documents, must:

 

    be transmitted to and received by the exchange agent at the address listed under “—Exchange Agent” at or prior to the expiration date; or

 

    comply with the guaranteed delivery procedures described below.

Delivery of documents to DTC in accordance with DTC’s procedures does not constitute delivery to the exchange agent.

Guaranteed Delivery

If a registered holder of private notes desires to tender the private notes, and the private notes are not immediately available, or time will not permit the holder’s private notes or other required documents to reach the exchange agent before the expiration date, or the procedure for book-entry transfer described above cannot be completed on a timely basis, a tender may nonetheless be made if:

 

    the tender is made through an eligible institution;

 

    prior to the expiration date, the exchange agent received from an eligible institution a properly completed and duly executed notice of guaranteed delivery, substantially in the form provided by us, by facsimile transmission, mail or hand delivery:

 

  1. stating the name and address of the holder of private notes and the amount of private notes tendered;

 

  2. stating that the tender is being made; and

 

  3. guaranteeing that within three New York Stock Exchange trading days after the expiration date, the certificates for all physically tendered private notes, in proper form for transfer, or a book-entry confirmation, as the case may be, and a properly completed and duly executed letter of transmittal, or an agent’s message, and any other documents required by the letter of transmittal will be deposited by the eligible institution with the exchange agent; and

 

    the certificates for all physically tendered private notes, in proper form for transfer, or a book-entry confirmation, as the case may be, and a properly completed and duly executed letter of transmittal, or any agent’s message, and all other documents required by the letter of transmittal, are received by the exchange agent within three New York Stock Exchange trading days after the expiration date.

Determination of Validity

We will determine in our sole discretion all questions as to the validity, form and eligibility of private notes tendered for exchange. This discretion extends to the determination of all questions concerning the time of receipt, acceptance and withdrawal of tendered private notes. These determinations will be final and binding. We reserve the absolute right to reject any and all private notes not properly tendered or any private notes our acceptance of which would, in the opinion of our counsel, be unlawful. We also reserve the right to waive any defects, irregularities or conditions of tender as to any particular private note either before or after the expiration date, including the right to waive the ineligibility of any tendering holder. Our interpretation of the terms and conditions of the exchange offer as to any particular private note either before or after the expiration date, including the letter of transmittal and the instructions to the letter of transmittal, shall be final and binding on all parties. Unless waived, you must cure any defects or irregularities with respect to tenders of private notes within the time we determine. Although we intend to notify you of defects or irregularities with respect to tenders of private notes, neither we, the exchange agent nor any other person will incur any liability for failure to give you that notification. Unless waived, we will not deem tenders of private notes to have been made until you cure the defects or irregularities.

 

29


Table of Contents

Other Rights

While we have no present plan to acquire any private notes that are not tendered in the exchange offer or to file a registration statement to permit resales of any private notes that are not tendered in the exchange offer, we reserve the right in our sole discretion to purchase or make offers for any private notes that remain outstanding after the expiration date.

Acceptance of Private Notes for Exchange; Issuance of Exchange Notes

Upon the terms and subject to the conditions of the exchange offer, we will accept, promptly after the expiration date, all private notes properly tendered. We will issue the exchange notes promptly after acceptance of the private notes. For purposes of the exchange offer, we will be deemed to have accepted properly tendered private notes for exchange when, as and if we have given oral or written notice to the exchange agent, with prompt written confirmation of any oral notice.

In all cases, issuance of exchange notes for private notes will be made only after timely receipt by the exchange agent of:

 

    certificates for the private notes, or a timely book-entry confirmation of the private notes, into the exchange agent’s account at the book-entry transfer facility;

 

    a properly completed and duly executed letter of transmittal or an agent’s message; and

 

    all other required documents.

For each private note accepted for exchange, the holder of the private note will receive an exchange note having a principal amount equal to that of the surrendered private note.

Return of Notes

Unaccepted or non-exchanged private notes will be returned without expense to the tendering holder of the private notes. In the case of private notes tendered by book-entry transfer in accordance with the book-entry procedures described above, the non-exchanged private notes will be credited to an account maintained with DTC as promptly as practicable after the expiration or termination of the exchange offer.

Withdrawal of Tenders

Except as otherwise provided in this prospectus, you may withdraw tenders of private notes at any time before 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the expiration date.

For a withdrawal to be effective, the exchange agent must receive a written notice of withdrawal at the address or, in the case of eligible institutions, at the facsimile number, indicated under “—Exchange Agent” before the expiration date. Any notice of withdrawal must:

 

    specify the name of the person, referred to as the depositor, having tendered the private notes to be withdrawn;

 

    identify the private notes to be withdrawn, including the certificate number or numbers and principal amount of the private notes;

 

    contain a statement that the holder is withdrawing its election to have the private notes exchanged;

 

    be signed by the holder in the same manner as the original signature on the letter of transmittal by which the private notes were tendered, including any required signature guarantees, or be accompanied by documents of transfer to have the trustee with respect to the private notes register the transfer of the private notes in the name of the person withdrawing the tender; and

 

    specify the name in which the private notes are registered, if different from that of the depositor.

 

30


Table of Contents

If certificates for private notes have been delivered or otherwise identified to the exchange agent, then, prior to the release of these certificates the withdrawing holder must also submit the serial numbers of the particular certificates to be withdrawn and signed notice of withdrawal with signatures guaranteed by an eligible institution, unless this holder is an eligible institution. If private notes have been tendered in accordance with the procedure for book-entry transfer described above, any notice of withdrawal must specify the name and number of the account at the book-entry transfer facility to be credited with the withdrawn private notes.

We will determine in our sole discretion all questions as to the validity, form and eligibility of the notices, and our determination will be final and binding on all parties. We will not deem any properly withdrawn private notes to have been validly tendered for purposes of the exchange offer, and we will not issue exchange notes with respect to those private notes, unless you validly retender the withdrawn private notes. You may retender properly withdrawn private notes by following the procedures described above under “—Procedures for Tendering” at any time before 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the expiration date.

Conditions

Notwithstanding any other term of the exchange offer, we will not be required to accept for exchange, or exchange the exchange notes for, any private notes, and may terminate the exchange offer as provided in this prospectus before the expiration of the exchange offer, if the exchange offer violates applicable law or an applicable interpretation of the staff of the SEC.

Termination of Rights

All of your rights under the registration rights agreement will terminate upon consummation of the exchange offer, except with respect to our continuing obligations:

 

    to indemnify you and parties related to you against liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act; and

 

    to provide, upon your request, the information required by Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities Act to permit resales of the notes pursuant to Rule 144A.

Shelf Registration

 

  If:

(1) DCTOP and DCT:

(a) do not cause the exchange offer registration statement to become effective on or prior to 270 days after the closing of the offering of private notes; or

(b) determine that the consummation of the exchange offer is not permitted because the exchange offer is not permitted by applicable law or SEC policy or applicable interpretations of the staff of the SEC; or

(c) receive a written request from any initial purchasers representing that it holds registrable securities that are or were ineligible to be exchange in the exchange offer;

then DCTOP and DCT will use commercially reasonable efforts to cause to be filed with the SEC as soon as reasonably practicable after such determination, date, or request, a shelf registration statement, and will use commercially reasonable efforts to have the shelf registration statement declared effective by the SEC after such determination, date, or request.

If:

(1) any registration statement as required by the registration rights agreement is not declared effective by the SEC on or prior to the date specified for such effectiveness; or

 

31


Table of Contents

(2) the exchange offer is not completed within 270 days of the closing of the offering of private notes; or

(3) the shelf registration statement is declared effective but thereafter ceases to be effective (other than under circumstances described below) during the periods specified in the registration rights agreement, or if DCTOP and DCT through their omission fail to name as a selling security holder any holder that had complied timely with its obligations under the registration rights agreement in a manner to entitle such holder to be named in the shelf registration statement or any prospectus (each such event referred to in clauses (1) through (3) above, a registration default),

then DCTOP will pay additional interest to each holder of registrable securities from and including the date on which any such registration default shall occur to but excluding the date on which all registration defaults have been cured or cease to exist.

With respect to the first 90-day period during which a registration default is continuing, additional interest will be paid at a rate equal to 0.25% per annum of the principal amount of entitled securities outstanding. If all registration defaults are not cured or cease to exist prior to the end of such 90-day period, then, from and including the first day after such 90-day period, the rate at which additional interest is payable will increase by an additional 0.25% per annum. However, the maximum rate of additional interest will in no event exceed 0.50% per annum. Additional interest will accrue and be payable to but excluding the date on which all registration defaults have been cured or cease to exist.

Additional interest will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year comprised of twelve 30-day months and will be paid to the holders of the registrable securities in the same manner and times as interest is otherwise payable on the registrable securities. From and including the date on which all registration defaults have been cured or otherwise ceased to exist, additional interest will cease to accrue unless and until a subsequent registration default occurs. Additional interest will not be payable on any private notes or exchange notes other than registrable securities.

Holders of the notes will be required to make certain representations to DCTOP (as described in the registration rights agreement) in order to participate in the exchange offer. In order to include registrable securities in the shelf registration statement, if filed, and receive additional interest relating to a registration default with respect to the shelf registration statement, a holder will be required to provide certain information to DCTOP and to be named as a selling security holder in the shelf registration statement and the related prospectus, and will be subject to certain civil liability provisions under the Securities Act in connection with sales under the shelf registration statement. By including registrable securities in the shelf registration statement, if any, a holder will be deemed to have agreed to indemnify us against certain losses arising out of information furnished by such holder in writing for inclusion in any shelf registration statement.

If a shelf registration statement becomes effective under the Securities Act then, during any 365-day period thereafter DCTOP may, by notice to holders of entitled securities registered pursuant to the shelf registration statement, suspend the availability of the shelf registration statement and the use of the related prospectus for up to two periods not to exceed a total of 60 days during any such 365-day period if:

 

    such action is required by applicable law; or

 

    the happening of any event or the discovery of any fact makes any statement made in the shelf registration statement or the related prospectus untrue in any material respect or constitutes an omission to state a material fact in the shelf registration statement or related prospectus.

Each holder of registrable securities will be required to discontinue disposition of those registrable securities pursuant to the shelf registration statement upon receipt from us of notice of any events described in the preceding sentence but will not be entitled to receive additional interest unless such suspension exceeds the

 

32


Table of Contents

number of days or periods specified above. If we effect the exchange offer, we will also be permitted to require any broker-dealers to discontinue disposition of exchange notes pursuant to this prospectus on the same terms and conditions described in this paragraph. If we suspend the use of the shelf registration statement or this prospectus during the period we are otherwise required to keep such registration statement effective, then the period that DCTOP and DCT are required to keep the shelf registration statement effective or during which the exchange offer registration statement must remain effective and participating broker-dealers are entitled to use such prospectus, as the case may be, will be extended by a number of days equal to the period of any such suspension.

Exchange Agent

We have appointed U.S. Bank National Association as exchange agent for the exchange offer of notes. All executed letters of transmittal and any other required documents should be directed to the exchange agent at the address or facsimile number set forth below. You should direct questions and requests for assistance and requests for additional copies of this prospectus or of the letter of transmittal and requests for notices of guaranteed delivery to the exchange agent addressed as follows:

U.S. Bank National Association

Global Corporate Trust Services

950 17th Street, 12th Floor

Denver, CO 80202

Attention: Sandra Richelmy, Corporate Trust Department

Reference: DCT Industrial Trust Inc.

4.500% Senior Notes due 2023

Fees and Expenses

We will bear the expenses of soliciting tenders. We have not retained any dealer manager in connection with the exchange offer and will not make any payments to brokers, dealers or others soliciting acceptances of the exchange offer. We will, however, pay the exchange agent reasonable and customary fees for its services and will reimburse it for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses.

We will pay the cash expenses incurred in connection with the exchange offer. These expenses include registration fees, fees and expenses of the exchange agent and the trustee, accounting and legal fees and printing costs, among others.

We will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the exchange of notes pursuant to the exchange offer. If, however, a transfer tax is imposed for any reason other than the exchange of the private notes pursuant to the exchange offer, then you must pay the amount of the transfer taxes. If satisfactory evidence of payment of such taxes or exemption therefrom is not submitted with the letter of transmittal, the amount of such transfer taxes will be billed directly to you.

Consequence of Failures to Exchange

Participation in the exchange offer is voluntary. We urge you to consult your financial and tax advisors in making your decisions on what action to take. Private notes that are not exchanged for exchange notes pursuant to the exchange offer will remain restricted securities. Accordingly, those private notes may be resold only:

 

    to a person whom the seller reasonably believes is a qualified institutional buyer in a transaction meeting the requirements of Rule 144A;

 

    in a transaction meeting the requirements of Rule 144 under the Securities Act;

 

    outside the United States to a foreign person in a transaction meeting the requirements of Rule 903 or 904 of Regulation S under the Securities Act;

 

33


Table of Contents
    in accordance with another exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act and based upon an opinion of counsel if we so request;

 

    to us; or

 

    pursuant to an effective registration statement.

In each case, the private notes may be resold only in accordance with any applicable securities laws of any state of the United States or any other applicable jurisdiction.

Accounting Treatment

The exchange notes will be recorded at the same carrying value as the original notes, as reflected in our accounting records on the date of the exchange. Accordingly, no gain or loss for accounting purposes will be recognized.

 

34


Table of Contents

USE OF PROCEEDS

The exchange offer satisfies an obligation under the registration rights agreement. We will not receive any cash proceeds from the exchange offer.

The net proceeds from the sale of the private notes after deducting discounts and offering expenses, were approximately $269.6 million. We used the net proceeds from the sale of the private notes to repay borrowing under a $175.0 million senior unsecured term loan, $50.0 million of senior unsecured notes, borrowings under our revolving credit facility and for general corporate purposes.

 

35


Table of Contents

SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

The following tables set forth summary historical consolidated financial and operating data for DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP and DCT Industrial Trust Inc. and their respective subsidiaries. You should read the following summary historical financial data in conjunction with the consolidated historical financial statements and notes thereto of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP and its subsidiaries, included elsewhere in this prospectus, and DCT Industrial Trust Inc. and its subsidiaries, incorporated by reference into this prospectus, and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” included elsewhere in this prospectus.

DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP

The consolidated balance sheet data as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 and the consolidated statement of operations data for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 have been derived from the historical consolidated financial statements of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP and subsidiaries audited by Ernst & Young LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, whose report with respect thereto is included elsewhere in this prospectus. The consolidated balance sheet data as of December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 and the consolidated statement of operations data for each of the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 have been derived from the unaudited historical consolidated financial statements of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP and subsidiaries, not included in this prospectus.

 

36


Table of Contents
     For the Years Ended December 31,  
     2013     2012     2011     2010     2009  
     (amounts in thousands, except per share data and building count)  

Operating Data:

      

Rental revenues

   $ 286,218     $ 236,839     $ 211,536     $ 190,404     $ 192,669  

Total revenues

   $ 289,005     $ 240,898     $ 215,827     $ 194,537     $ 195,370  

Rental expenses and real estate taxes

   $ 80,025     $ 66,390     $ 61,367     $ 58,437     $ 55,826  

Property net operating income(5)

   $ 206,193     $ 170,449     $ 150,169     $ 131,967     $ 136,843  

Total operating expenses

   $ 237,741     $ 200,972     $ 189,951     $ 178,400     $ 170,204  

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (9,251   $ (28,540   $ (42,503   $ (44,618   $ (34,624

Income from discontinued operations

   $ 26,723     $ 11,800     $ 13,660     $ 1,551     $ 12,911  

Gain on dispositions of real estate interests

   $ 31     $ —        $ —        $ 13     $ 5  

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 16,883     $ (16,468   $ (27,885   $ (42,524   $ (21,539

Earnings per OP Unit—Basic and Diluted:

      

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (0.03   $ (0.10   $ (0.16   $ (0.19   $ (0.16

Income from discontinued operations

     0.08        0.04       0.05       0.01       0.06  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 0.05     $ (0.06   $ (0.11   $ (0.18   $ (0.10
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average OP Units outstanding, basic and diluted

     317,848        278,189        267,901        238,763        223,560   

Amounts Attributable to OP Unitholders:

      

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (9,840   $ (28,268   $ (41,545   $ (44,075   $ (34,450

Income from discontinued operations (1)

     26,723       11,800       13,660       1,551        12,911  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

     16,883       (16,468     (27,885     (42,524     (21,539
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Distributed and undistributed earnings allocated to participating securities

     (692     (524     (443     (480     (436
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 16,191     $ (16,992   $ (28,328   $ (43,004   $ (21,975
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

OP Unit Distributions:

      

OP Unit cash distributions, declared

   $ 90,352     $ 79,459     $ 75,849     $ 67,380     $ 68,428  

OP Unit cash distributions, declared per unit

   $ 0.28     $ 0.28     $ 0.28     $ 0.28     $ 0.30  

Other Data:

      

Consolidated operating square feet

     61,896       58,132       58,099       56,652       52,910  

Consolidated operating buildings

     395       399       408       390       375  

Total consolidated buildings square feet

     63,172       61,410        58,255        57,777        56,847   

Total consolidated buildings

     400       409       409       398       394  

 

37


Table of Contents
     For the Years Ended December 31,  
     2013     2012     2011     2010     2009  
     (amounts in thousands, except per share data and building count)  

Balance Sheet Data:

          

Net investment in real estate

   $ 3,141,877     $ 2,910,613     $ 2,711,027     $ 2,647,186     $ 2,576,410  

Total assets

   $ 3,265,963     $ 3,057,199     $ 2,793,298     $ 2,719,889     $ 2,644,292  

Senior unsecured notes

   $ 1,122,407     $ 1,025,000     $ 935,000     $ 786,000     $ 625,000  

Mortgage notes

   $ 290,960     $ 317,314     $ 317,783     $ 425,359     $ 511,715  

Total liabilities

   $ 1,598,771     $ 1,583,640     $ 1,389,183     $ 1,319,051     $ 1,220,659  

Cash Flow Data:

          

Net cash provided by operating activities

   $ 152,893     $ 118,956     $ 106,482     $ 91,002     $ 109,749  

Net cash used in investing activities

   $ (301,058   $ (299,138   $ (177,,823   $ (138,334   $ (17,673

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

   $ 167,695     $ 180,044     $ 66,845     $ 45,542     $ (92,637

Funds From Operations:(2)

          

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 16,883     $ (16,468   $ (27,885   $ (42,524   $ (21,539

Adjustments:

          

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

     137,120       126,687       128,989       115,904       111,250  

Equity in (earnings) loss of unconsolidated joint ventures, net

     (2,405     (1,087     2,556       2,986       (2,698

Equity in FFO of unconsolidated joint ventures

     10,152       10,312       4,732       4,001       11,807  

Loss on business combinations

     —          —          —          395       10,325  

Impairment losses on depreciable real estate (4)

     13,279       11,422       10,160       8,012       681  

Gain on dispositions of real estate interests

     (33,650     (13,383     (12,030     (2,091     (1,354

Gain on dispositions of non-depreciable real estate

     31       —          —          13       783  

Noncontrolling interest in above adjustments

     (787     (1,397     (1,716     (54     (72
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO attributable to OP Unitholders—basic and diluted

     140,623       116,086       104,806       86,642       109,183  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjustments:

          

Impairment losses on non-depreciable real estate(3)

     —          —          —          3,992       300  

Debt modification costs

     —          —          —          1,136       —     

Acquisition costs(3)

     3,578       1,975       1,902       1,228       —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO, as adjusted, attributable to OP Unitholders, basic and diluted(2)(4):

   $ 144,201     $ 118,061     $ 106,708     $ 92,998     $ 109,483  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO per OP Unit—basic and diluted

   $ 0.44      $ 0.41      $ 0.39      $ 0.36      $ 0.48   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO as adjusted, per OP Unit—basic and diluted(2)(4):

   $ 0.45      $ 0.42      $ 0.40      $ 0.39      $ 0.49   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO weighted average OP Units outstanding:

          

OP Units

     317,848       278,189       267,901       238,763       223,560  

Participating securities

     2,462       1,896       1,601       1,689       1,535  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO weighted average OP Units and participating securities
outstanding—basic:

     320,310       280,085       269,502       240,452       225,095  

Dilutive unit equivalents

     893       623       449       357       189  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO weighted average OP Units outstanding—diluted:

     321,203       280,708       269,951       240,809       225,284  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

38


Table of Contents

DCT Industrial Trust Inc.

The consolidated balance sheet data as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 and the consolidated statement of operations data for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 have been derived from the historical consolidated financial statements of DCT Industrial Trust Inc. audited by Ernst & Young LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, whose report with respect thereto is incorporated by reference in this prospectus. The consolidated balance sheet data as of December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 and the consolidated statement of operations data for each of the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 have been derived from the historical consolidated financial statements of DCT Industrial Trust Inc., not included in or incorporated by reference in this prospectus.

 

     For the Years Ended December 31,  
     2013     2012     2011     2010     2009  
     (amounts in thousands, except per share data and building count)  

Operating Data:

          

Rental revenues

   $ 286,218      $ 236,839      $ 211,536      $ 190,404      $ 192,669   

Total revenues

   $ 289,005      $ 240,898      $ 215,827      $ 194,537      $ 195,370   

Rental expenses and real estate taxes

   $ 80,025      $ 66,390      $ 61,367      $ 58,437      $ 55,826   

Property net operating income(5)

   $ 206,193      $ 170,449      $ 150,169      $ 131,967      $ 136,843   

Total operating expenses

   $ 237,741      $ 200,972      $ 189,951      $ 178,400      $ 170,204   

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (9,251   $ (28,540   $ (42,503   $ (44,618   $ (34,624

Income from discontinued operations

   $ 26,723      $ 11,800      $ 13,660      $ 1,551      $ 12,911   

Gain on dispositions of real estate interests

   $ 31      $ —        $ —        $ 13      $ 5   

Net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

   $ 15,870      $ (15,086   $ (25,250   $ (37,830   $ (18,585

Earnings per Common Share—Basic and Diluted:

          

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (0.03   $ (0.10   $ (0.16   $ (0.18   $ (0.16

Income from discontinued operations

     0.08        0.04        0.05        0.00        0.06   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

   $ 0.05      $ (0.06   $ (0.11   $ (0.18   $ (0.10
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding, basic and diluted

     298,769        254,831       242,591       212,412       192,900  

Amounts Attributable to Common Stockholders:

          

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (9,250   $ (25,896   $ (37,621   $ (39,212   $ (29,725

Income from discontinued operations (1)

     25,120        10,810        12,371        1,382        11,140   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

     15,870        (15,086     (25,250     (37,830     (18,585
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Distributed and undistributed earnings allocated to participating securities

     (692     (524     (443     (480     (436
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

   $ 15,178      $ (15,610   $ (25,693   $ (38,310   $ (19,021
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common Share Distributions:

          

Common share cash distributions, declared

   $ 85,079      $ 73,200     $ 68,789     $ 60,110     $ 59,364  

Common share cash distributions, declared per share

   $ 0.28     $ 0.28     $ 0.28     $ 0.28      $ 0.30   

Other Data:

          

Consolidated operating square feet

     61,896        58,132       58,099       56,652       52,910  

Consolidated operating buildings

     395        399       408       390       375  

Total consolidated buildings square feet

     63,172        61,410        58,255        57,777        56,847   

Total consolidated buildings

     400        409       409       398       394  

 

39


Table of Contents
     For the Years Ended December 31,  
     2013     2012     2011     2010     2009  
     (amounts in thousands, except per share data and building count)  

Balance Sheet Data:

          

Net investment in real estate

   $ 3,141,877      $ 2,910,613     $ 2,711,027     $ 2,647,186     $ 2,576,410  

Total assets

   $ 3,265,963      $ 3,057,199     $ 2,793,298     $ 2,719,889     $ 2,644,292  

Senior unsecured notes

   $ 1,122,407      $ 1,025,000     $ 935,000     $ 786,000     $ 625,000  

Mortgage notes

   $ 290,960      $ 317,314     $ 317,783     $ 425,359     $ 511,715  

Total liabilities

   $ 1,598,771      $ 1,583,640     $ 1,389,183     $ 1,319,051     $ 1,220,659  

Cash Flow Data:

          

Net cash provided by operating activities

   $ 152,893      $ 118,956     $ 106,482     $ 91,002     $ 109,749  

Net cash used in investing activities

   $ (301,058   $ (299,138   $ (177,823   $ (138,334   $ (17,673

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

   $ 167,695      $ 180,044     $ 66,845     $ 45,542     $ (92,637

Funds From Operations:(2)

          

Net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

   $ 15,870      $ (15,086   $ (25,250   $ (37,830   $ (18,585

Adjustments:

          

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

     137,120        126,687       128,989       115,904       111,250  

Equity in (earnings) loss of unconsolidated joint ventures, net

     (2,405     (1,087     2,556       2,986       (2,698

Equity in FFO of unconsolidated joint

ventures

     10,152        10,312       4,732       4,001       11,807  

Loss on business combinations

     —          —          —          395       10,325  

Impairment losses on depreciable real estate(4)

     13,279        11,422       10,160       8,012       681  

Gain on dispositions of real estate interests

     (33,650     (13,383     (12,030     (2,091     (1,354

Gain on dispositions of non-depreciable real estate

     31        —          —          13       783  

Noncontrolling interest in the operating partnership’s share of the above adjustments

     (8,211     (12,522     (14,252     (13,426     (17,907

FFO attributable to OP Unitholders

     8,437        9,743       9,901       8,678       14,881  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO attributable to OP Unitholders—basic and diluted

     140,623        116,086       104,806       86,642       109,183  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjustments:

          

Impairment losses on non-depreciable real estate(3)

     —          —          —          3,992       300  

Debt modification costs

     —          —          —          1,136       —     

Acquisition costs(3)

     3,578        1,975       1,902       1,228       —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO, as adjusted, attributable to OP Unitholders, basic and diluted(2):

   $ 144,201      $ 118,061     $ 106,708     $ 92,998     $ 109,483  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO per common share and unit—basic and diluted

   $ 0.44      $ 0.41      $ 0.39      $ 0.36      $ 0.48   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO as adjusted, per common share and unit—basic and diluted(2)(4):

   $ 0.45      $ 0.42      $ 0.40      $ 0.39      $ 0.49   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO weighted average common shares and units outstanding:

          

Common shares

     298,769        254,831       242,591       212,412       192,900  

Participating securities

     2,462        1,896       1,601       1,689       1,535  

Units

     19,079        23,358       25,310       26,351       30,660  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO weighted average common shares, participating securities and units outstanding—basic:

     320,310        280,085       269,502       240,452       225,095  

Dilutive common stock equivalents

     893        623       449       357       189  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FFO weighted average common shares and units outstanding—diluted:

     321,203        280,708       269,951       240,809       225,284  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

40


Table of Contents
(1)  Includes gain on dispositions of real estate interests.
(2)  We believe that net income attributable to unitholders, as defined by GAAP, is the most appropriate earnings measure. However, we consider funds from operations (“FFO”), as defined by the National Association of Real Estate Investment Trusts (“NAREIT”), to be a useful supplemental non-GAAP measure of DCT Industrial’s operating performance. NAREIT developed FFO as a relative measure of performance of an equity REIT in order to recognize that the value of income-producing real estate historically has not depreciated on the basis determined under GAAP. FFO is generally defined as net income attributable to unitholders, calculated in accordance with GAAP, plus real estate-related depreciation and amortization, less gains from dispositions of operating real estate held for investment purposes, plus impairment losses on depreciable real estate and impairments of in substance real estate investments in investees that are driven by measureable decreases in the fair value of the depreciable real estate held by the unconsolidated joint ventures and adjustments to derive our pro rata share of FFO of unconsolidated joint ventures. We exclude gains and losses on business combinations and include the gains or losses from dispositions of properties which were acquired or developed with the intention to sell or contribute to an investment fund in our definition of FFO. Although the NAREIT definition of FFO predates the guidance for accounting for gains and losses on business combinations, we believe that excluding such gains and losses is consistent with the key objective of FFO as a performance measure. We also present FFO excluding acquisition costs, debt modification costs and impairment losses on properties which are not depreciable. We believe that FFO excluding acquisition costs, debt modification costs and impairment losses on non-depreciable real estate is useful supplemental information regarding our operating performance as it provides a more meaningful and consistent comparison of our operating performance and allows investors to more easily compare our operating results. Readers should note that FFO captures neither the changes in the value of our properties that result from use or market conditions, nor the level of capital expenditures and leasing commissions necessary to maintain the operating performance of our properties, all of which have real economic effect and could materially impact our results from operations. NAREIT’s definition of FFO is subject to interpretation, and modifications to the NAREIT definition of FFO are common. Accordingly, our FFO may not be comparable to other REITs’ FFO and FFO should be considered only as a supplement to net income as a measure of our performance.
(3)  Excluding amounts attributable to noncontrolling interests.
(4)  Under NAREIT’s definition of FFO, impairment write-downs of depreciable real estate should be excluded in calculating NAREIT FFO. In addition, impairments of in substance real estate investments in investees that are driven by measureable decreases in the fair value of the depreciable real estate held by the unconsolidated joint ventures should be excluded in determining NAREIT FFO.
(5)  Property net operating income, or property NOI, is defined as rental revenues, including reimbursements, less rental expenses and real estate taxes, which excludes depreciation, amortization, impairment, casualty gains, general and administrative expenses, loss on business combinations and interest expense. We consider property NOI to be an appropriate supplemental performance measure because property NOI reflects the operating performance of our properties and excludes certain items that are not considered to be controllable in connection with the management of the property such as depreciation, amortization, impairment, general and administrative expenses, interest income and interest expense. However, property NOI should not be viewed as an alternative measure of our financial performance since it excludes expenses which could materially impact our results of operations. Further, our property NOI may not be comparable to that of other real estate companies, as they may use different methodologies for calculating property NOI. Therefore, we believe net income, as defined by GAAP, to be the most appropriate measure to evaluate our overall financial performance.

 

41


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

Overview

DCTOP is an entity through which DCT, a fully-integrated and self-managed REIT, and our sole general partner, conducts all of its operations and owns all of its assets. We are engaged in the business of owning, operating, acquiring and developing high-quality bulk distribution and light industrial properties in high volume distribution markets in the United States (“U.S.”). As of December 31, 2013 DCT owned an approximate 94.8% ownership interest in DCTOP.

Our primary business objectives are to maximize long-term growth in Funds From Operations, or FFO, as defined in “Selected Consolidated Financial Data,” net asset value of our portfolio and total shareholder returns. In our pursuit of these long-term objectives, we seek to:

 

    maximize cash flows from existing properties;

 

    deploy capital into high quality acquisitions and development opportunities which meet our asset, location and financial criteria; and

 

    recycle capital by selling assets that no longer fit our investment criteria and reinvesting the proceeds into higher growth opportunities.

Outlook

We seek to maximize long-term earnings growth and value within the context of overall economic conditions, primarily through increasing occupancy, rents and operating income at existing properties and acquiring and developing high-quality properties with attractive operating income and value growth prospects. Fundamentals for industrial real estate continue to improve in response to general improvement in the economy as well as trends that particularly favor industrial assets, including the growth of e-commerce and United States based manufacturing. We expect moderate economic growth to continue throughout 2014, which should result in continued positive demand for warehouse space as companies expand and upgrade their distribution and production platforms.

In response to positive net absorption and lower market vacancy levels, rental rates are increasing in most of our markets, although they generally remain below peak levels. Rental concessions, such as free rent, have also declined in all markets. Consistent with recent experience and based on current market conditions, we expect average net effective rental rates on new leases signed in 2014 to be higher than the rates on expiring leases. As positive net absorption of warehouse space continues, we expect the rental rate environment to continue to improve.

New development has begun to increase in certain markets where fundamentals have improved, however construction is below current levels of net absorption in most markets and well below peak levels. We expect that the operating environment will continue to be favorable for landlords with meaningful improvement of rental and occupancy rates.

We expect same store net operating income to be higher in 2014 than it was in 2013, primarily as a result of higher occupancy in 2014 and the impact of increasing rental rates on leases signed in 2014 compared to expiring leases.

In terms of capital investment, we will continue to pursue the acquisition of well-located distribution facilities at prices where we can apply our leasing experience and market knowledge to generate attractive returns. Going forward, we will pursue the acquisition of buildings and land and consider selective development of new buildings in markets where we perceive demand and market rental rates will provide attractive financial returns.

 

42


Table of Contents

We anticipate having sufficient liquidity to fund our operating expenses, including costs to maintain our properties and distributions, though we may finance investments, including acquisitions and developments, with the issuance of new common shares, proceeds from asset sales or through additional borrowings. Please see “Liquidity and Capital Resources” for additional discussion.

Inflation

Although the U.S. economy has recently experienced a slight decrease in inflation rates, and a wide variety of industries and sectors are affected differently by changing commodity prices, inflation has not had a significant impact on us in our markets. Most of our leases require the customers to pay their share of operating expenses, including common area maintenance, real estate taxes and insurance, thereby reducing our exposure to increases in costs and operating expenses resulting from inflation. In addition, most of our leases expire within five years which enables us to replace existing leases with new leases at then-existing market rates.

Summary of Significant Transactions During 2013

Significant transactions for the year ended December 31, 2013

 

    Acquisitions

 

    During the year ended December 31, 2013, we acquired 38 buildings totaling approximately 7.1 million square feet. These properties were acquired for a total purchase price of $359.5 million, excluding our existing ownership of 3.6% in the seven properties previously held by TRT-DCT Venture I (see “Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 4—Investment in and Advances to Unconsolidated Joint Ventures” for further detail).

 

    During the year ended December 31, 2013, we acquired five land parcels for future development which total approximately 128.6 acres located in the Southern California, Seattle, Miami, and Houston markets for a total purchase price of $40.5 million.

 

43


Table of Contents
    Development Activities

During 2013, we continued to expand our development activities. The table below represents a summary of our consolidated development activity as of December 31, 2013:

 

Project

  Market     Acres     Number
of
Buildings
    Square Feet     Percent
Owned
    Cumulative
Costs at
12/31/2013
    Projected
Investment
    Completion
Date(1)
    Percent
Leased
 
                      (in thousands)           (in thousands)     (in thousands)              

Development Activities

                 

Projects in Lease Up

                 

DCT Airtex Industrial Center

    Houston        13        1        267        100   $ 12,161      $ 14,983        Q4-2013        100

DCT 55

    Chicago        33        1        604        100     26,218        28,318        Q4-2012        66
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total

      46        2        871        100   $ 38,379      $ 43,301          77
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Under Construction

                 

DCT Beltway Tanner Business Center

    Houston        11        1        133       100   $ 10,201      $ 15,153        Q1-2014        0

8th & Vineyard B

    So. California        4        1        99       91     5,243        6,197        Q1-2014        0

DCT Summer South Distribution Center

    Seattle        9        1        188       100     9,194        13,060        Q1-2014        0

DCT White River Corporate Center Phase I

    Seattle        30        1        649       100     23,051        42,433        Q2-2014        0

Slover Logistics Center II

    So. California        28        1        610       100     24,241        37,496        Q1-2014        100

DCT Auburn 44

    Seattle        3        1        49       100     3,341        4,547        Q1-2014        100

DCT Rialto Logistics Center

    So. California        42        1        928       100     21,480        59,523        Q3-2014        0
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total

      127        7        2,656       100   $ 96,751      $ 178,409          25
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Build-to-Suit for Sale

                 

8th & Vineyard A

    So. California        6        1        130        91   $ 7,773      $ 8,703        Q1-2014        N/A   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total

      6        1        130        91   $ 7,773      $ 8,703       
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Development Activities

      179        10        3,657        99   $ 142,903      $ 230,413          38
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

(1)  The completion date represents the date of building shell completion or estimated date of shell completion.

Construction was completed during the second quarter of 2013 on the Dulles Summit build-to-suit project. We recognized development profits, net of tax of approximately $0.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 related to the development of the Dulles Summit build-to-suit project. As of December 31, 2013, we had one build-to-suit for sale project, 8th and Vineyard A, under contract. Due to the terms of the contract, timing of payments and the sale recognition criteria of GAAP, no profit was recognized in 2013. The construction and sale were completed in January 2014, at which time the development profit was recognized.

 

    Dispositions

 

    During the year ended December 31, 2013, we sold 51 operating properties, totaling approximately 6.8 million square feet, to third-parties for combined gross proceeds of approximately $265.8 million. This included the disposition of our entire portfolio of Mexico assets consisting of 15 buildings totaling 1.7 million square feet, for gross proceeds of approximately $82.7 million.

 

    We recognized gains of approximately $33.6 million on the disposition of 36 operating properties and recognized an impairment loss of approximately $13.3 million on the disposition of a portfolio in Dallas.

 

44


Table of Contents
    Significant Activity with Joint Ventures

 

    During May 2013, we purchased the remaining 96.4% interest in seven properties from TRT-DCT JV I for additional consideration of $82.8 million. Additionally, we sold one of the properties during 2013 and the remaining six properties were consolidated as of December 31, 2013.

 

    Debt Activity

 

    During February 2013, we entered into an amendment with our syndicated bank group whereby we extended and increased our existing $175.0 million senior unsecured term loan to $225.0 million for a period of five years, extended our existing $300.0 million senior unsecured line of credit for a period of four years and received a commitment for an additional $175.0 million senior unsecured term loan with a term of two years. We closed on the additional $175.0 million in March 2013, which was used to refinance a scheduled June 2013 maturity of $175.0 million of other senior unsecured debt.

 

    During October 2013, we issued $275.0 million aggregate principal amount of 4.50% senior notes due 2023 at 99.038% of face value in a private placement for net proceeds of approximately $269.6 million after offering costs. We primarily used the net proceeds to repay a $15.9 million mortgage note that was scheduled to mature in October 2013, a $50.0 million senior unsecured note that was scheduled to mature in January of 2014 and our $175.0 million senior unsecured term loan that was scheduled to mature in February 2015, which were pre-payable without prepayment penalties.

 

    Equity activity

 

    On May 29, 2013, DCT registered a third continuous equity offering program, to replace its continuous equity offering program previously registered on November 20, 2012. Pursuant to this offering, DCT may sell up to 20 million shares of common stock from time-to-time through May 29, 2016 in “at-the-market” offerings or certain other transactions. During the year ended December 31, 2013, approximately 13.8 million were issued shares through the second and third continuous equity offering programs at an average price of $7.37 per share for proceeds of $100.4 million, net of offering expenses. The proceeds from the sale of shares were contributed to DCTOP in exchange for an equal number of OP Units in the DCTOP and were used for general corporate purposes, including funding acquisitions and repaying debt. As of December 31, 2013, 16.6 million shares remain available to be issued under the current offering.

 

    On August 13, 2013, DCT issued 23.0 million shares of common stock in a public offering at a price of $7.20 per share for proceeds of $158.2 million, net of offering expenses, used for acquisitions, development activities, repayment of amounts under our senior unsecured revolving credit facility and other general purposes. The proceeds from the sale of shares were contributed to DCTOP in exchange for an equal number of OP Units in DCTOP.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

General

Our discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations is based on our Consolidated Financial Statements which have been prepared in accordance with United States generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”). The preparation of these financial statements requires us to make estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities and contingencies as of the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting periods. We evaluate our assumptions and estimates on an on-going basis. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions. The following

 

45


Table of Contents

discussion pertains to accounting policies management believes are most critical to the portrayal of our financial condition and results of operations that require management’s most difficult, subjective or complex estimates.

Revenue Recognition

We record rental revenues on a straight-line basis under which contractual rent increases are recognized evenly over the lease term. Certain properties have leases that provide for customer occupancy during periods where no rent is due or where minimum rent payments change during the term of the lease. Accordingly, we record receivables from customers that we expect to collect over the remaining lease term, which are recorded as a straight-line rent receivable. When we acquire a property, the terms of existing leases are considered to commence as of the acquisition date for the purposes of this calculation.

Tenant recovery income includes payments and amounts due from customers pursuant to their leases for real estate taxes, insurance and other recoverable property operating expenses and is recognized as “Rental revenues” during the same period the related expenses are incurred.

We maintain an allowance for estimated losses that may result from the inability of our customers to make required payments. This estimate requires significant judgment related to the lessees ability to fulfill their obligations under the leases. If a customer is insolvent or files for bankruptcy protection and fails to make contractual payments beyond any allowance, we may recognize additional bad debt expense in future periods equal to the net outstanding balances, which include amounts recognized as straight-line revenue not realizable until future periods.

In connection with property acquisitions qualifying as business combinations, we may acquire leases with rental rates above or below the market rental rates. Such differences are recorded as an intangible lease asset or liability and amortized to “Rental revenues” over the reasonably assured term of the related leases. The unamortized balances of these assets and liabilities associated with the early termination of leases are fully amortized to their respective revenue line items in our Consolidated Statements of Operations over the shorter of the expected life of such assets and liabilities or the remaining lease term.

Capitalization of Costs

We capitalize costs directly related to the development, pre-development, redevelopment or improvement of our investment in real estate, referred to as capital projects and other activities included within this paragraph. Costs associated with our capital projects are capitalized as incurred. If the project is abandoned, these costs are expensed during the period in which the project is abandoned. Costs considered for capitalization include, but are not limited to, construction costs, interest, real estate taxes and insurance, if appropriate. We capitalize indirect costs such as personnel, office, and administrative expenses that are directly related to our development projects based on an estimate of the time spent on the construction and development activities. These costs are capitalized only during the period in which activities necessary to ready an asset for its intended use are in progress and such costs are incremental and identifiable to a specific activity to get the asset ready for its intended use. We determine when the capitalization period begins and ends through communication with project and other managers responsible for the tracking and oversight of individual projects. In the event that the activities to ready the asset for its intended use are suspended, the capitalization period will cease until such activities are resumed. In addition, we capitalize initial direct costs incurred for successful origination of new leases. Costs incurred for maintaining and repairing our properties, which do not extend their useful lives, are expensed as incurred.

Interest is capitalized based on actual capital expenditures from the period when development or redevelopment commences until the asset is ready for its intended use, at the weighted average borrowing rates in effect during the period. We also capitalize interest on our qualifying investments in unconsolidated joint ventures based on the average capital invested in a venture during the period when the venture has activities in progress necessary to commence its planned principal operations, at our weighted average borrowing rate during

 

46


Table of Contents

the period. A “qualifying investment” is an investment in an unconsolidated joint venture provided that our investee’s activities include the use of funds to acquire qualifying assets, such as development or predevelopment activities, and planned principal operations have not commenced.

Investment in Properties

We record the assets, liabilities and noncontrolling interests associated with property acquisitions which qualify as business combinations at their respective acquisition date fair values which are derived using a market, income or replacement cost approach, or a combination thereof. Acquisition related costs associated with business combinations are expensed as incurred. As defined by GAAP, a business is an integrated set of activities and assets that is capable of being conducted and managed for the purpose of providing a return in the form of dividends, lower costs or other economic benefits directly to investors or other owners, members or participants. We generally do not consider acquisitions of land or unoccupied buildings to be business combinations. Rather, these transactions are treated as asset acquisitions and recorded at cost.

The fair value of identifiable tangible assets such as land, building, building and land improvements and tenant improvements is determined on an “as-if-vacant” basis which requires significant judgment by management. Management considers estimates such as the replacement cost of such assets, appraisals, property condition reports, comparable market rental data and other related information in determining the fair value of the tangible assets. The recorded fair value of intangible lease assets or liabilities includes the value associated with leasing commissions, legal and other costs, as well as the estimated period necessary to lease such property and lease commencement. An intangible asset or liability resulting from in-place leases that are above or below the market rental rates are valued based upon management’s estimates of prevailing market rates for similar leases. Intangible lease assets or liabilities are amortized over the reasonably assured lease term of the remaining in-place leases as an adjustment to “Rental revenues” or “Real estate related depreciation and amortization” depending on the nature of the intangible. The difference between the fair value and the face value of debt assumed in connection with an acquisition is recorded as a premium or discount and amortized to “Interest expense” over the life of the debt assumed. The valuation of assumed liabilities is based on our estimate of the current market rates for similar liabilities in effect at the acquisition date.

We have certain properties which we have acquired or removed from service with the intention to redevelop the property. Buildings under redevelopment require significant construction activities prior to being placed back into service. We generally do not depreciate properties classified as redevelopment until the date that the redevelopment properties are ready for their intended use.

Real estate, including land, building, building and land improvements, and tenant improvements, leasing costs and intangible lease assets and liabilities are stated at historical cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization, unless circumstances indicate that the cost cannot be recovered, in which case, the carrying value of the property is reduced to estimated fair value. Our estimate of the useful life of our assets is evaluated upon acquisition and when circumstances indicate a change in the useful life, which requires significant judgment regarding the economic obsolescence of tangible and intangible assets.

Impairment of Properties

Investments in properties classified as held for use are carried at cost and evaluated for impairment at least annually and whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amounts of these assets may not be recoverable. As we selectively dispose of non-strategic assets and redeploy the proceeds into higher growth assets, our intended hold period may change due to our intention to sell or otherwise dispose of an asset. As a result, we would assess whether that asset is impaired. Depending on the carrying value of the property at that time and the amount that we estimate we would receive on disposal, we may record an impairment loss. Other indicators include the point at which we deem a building to be held for sale or when a building remains vacant significantly longer than expected.

 

47


Table of Contents

For investments in properties that we intend to hold long-term, the recoverability is based on estimated future undiscounted cash flows. If the asset carrying value is not recoverable on an undiscounted cash flow basis, the amount of impairment is measured as the difference between the carrying value and the fair value of the asset and is reflected in “Impairment losses” on the Consolidated Statements of Operations. The determination of fair value of real estate assets to be held for use is derived using the discounted cash flow method and involves a number of management assumptions relating to future economic events that could materially affect the determination of the ultimate value, and therefore, the carrying amounts of our real estate. Such assumptions are management’s estimates and include, but are not limited to, projected vacancy rates, rental rates, property operating expenses and capital expenditures. The capitalization rate is also a significant driving factor in determining the property valuation and requires management’s judgment of factors such as market knowledge, market supply and demand factors, historical experience, lease terms, customer’s financial strength, economy, demographics, environment, property location, visibility, age, physical condition and expected return requirements, among other things. The aforementioned factors are taken as a whole by management in determining the valuation of investment property. The valuation is sensitive to the actual results of many of these uncertain factors, either individually or taken as a whole. Should the actual results differ from management’s estimates, the valuation could be negatively affected and may result in additional impairments recorded in the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Investments in properties classified as held for sale are recorded at the lower of their carrying amount or fair value (typically estimated based on the contracted sales price) less costs to sell. Impairment of assets held for sale is a component of “Income from discontinued operations” in the Consolidated Statements of Operations and is further detailed in “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements Note 15 – Discontinued Operations and Assets Held for Sale.”

Impairment of Investments in and Advances to Unconsolidated Joint Ventures

We evaluate investments in and advances to unconsolidated joint ventures for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that there may be an other-than-temporary decline in value. To do so, we calculate the estimated fair value of the investment using a market, income or replacement cost approach, or combination thereof. The amount of impairment recognized, if any, would be the excess of the investment’s carrying amount over its estimated fair value. We consider various factors to determine if a decline in the value of the investment is other-than-temporary, which include but are not limited to, the age of the venture, our intent and ability to retain our investment in the entity, the financial condition and long-term prospects of the entity, expected term of the investment and the relationships with the other joint venture partners and its lenders. If we believe that the decline in the fair value is temporary, no impairment is recorded. The aforementioned factors are taken as a whole by management in determining the valuation of our investment. Should the actual results differ from management’s estimates, the valuation could be negatively affected and may result in additional impairments in the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Results of Operations

Summary of the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the year ended December 31, 2012

As of December 31, 2013, we owned interests in, managed or had under development approximately 75.5 million square feet of properties leased to approximately 900 customers, including 12.3 million square feet of unconsolidated properties on behalf of four institutional capital management joint venture partners and we consolidated 395 operating properties, two redevelopment properties, two development properties and one property which was held for sale. As of December 31, 2012, we consolidated 399 operating properties, four redevelopment properties, three development properties and three properties which were held for sale.

Comparison of the year ended December 31, 2013 to the year ended December 31, 2012

The following table illustrates the changes in rental revenues, rental expenses and real estate taxes, property net operating income, other revenue and other income (loss) and other expenses for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the year ended December 31, 2012. Our same store portfolio includes all

 

48


Table of Contents

operating properties that we owned for the entirety of both the current and prior year reporting periods for which the operations had been stabilized. We generally consider buildings stabilized when occupancy reaches 90%. Non-same store operating properties include properties not meeting the same-store criteria and exclude development and redevelopment properties. The same store portfolio for the periods presented totaled 321 operating properties and was comprised of 48.6 million square feet. A discussion of these changes follows the table (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
          Percent
Change
 
     2013     2012     $ Change    

Rental Revenues

        

Same store, excluding revenues related to early lease terminations

   $ 233,191      $ 226,927      $ 6,264        2.8

Non-same store operating properties

     51,073        9,175        41,898        456.7

Development and redevelopment

     652        185        467        252.4

Revenues related to early lease terminations

     1,302        552        750        135.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total rental revenues

     286,218        236,839        49,379        20.8
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Rental Expenses and Real Estate Taxes

        

Same store

     67,010        63,908        3,102        4.9

Non-same store operating properties

     12,784        2,249        10,535        468.4

Development and redevelopment

     231        233        (2     -0.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total rental expenses and real estate taxes

     80,025        66,390        13,635        20.5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property Net Operating Income(1)

        

Same store, excluding revenues related to early lease terminations

     166,181        163,019        3,162        1.9

Non-same store operating properties

     38,289        6,926        31,363        452.8

Development and redevelopment

     421        (48     469        977.1

Revenues related to early lease terminations

     1,302        552        750        135.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total property net operating income

     206,193        170,449        35,744        21.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other Revenue and Other Income (Loss)

        

Development profit

     268        307        (39     -12.7

Institutional capital management and other fees

     2,787        4,059        (1,272     -31.3

Equity in earnings of unconsolidated joint ventures, net

     2,405        1,087        1,318        121.3

Interest and other income

     274        85        189        222.4

Casualty and involuntary conversion gain

     296        1,174        (878     -74.8
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other revenue and other income

     6,030        6,712        (682     -10.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other Expenses

        

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

     130,002        109,993        20,009        18.2

Interest expense

     63,394        69,274        (5,880     -8.5

General and administrative

     28,010        25,763        2,247        8.7

Income tax expense and other taxes

     68        671        (603     -89.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other expenses

     221,474        205,701        15,773        7.7
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from discontinued operations

     26,723        11,800        14,923        126.5

Net (income) loss attributable to noncontrolling interests

     (589     272        (861     -316.5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 16,883      $ (16,468   $ 33,351        202.5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)  For a discussion as to why we view property net operating income to be an appropriate supplemental performance measure and a reconciliation of our property net operating income to our reported “Loss from Continuing Operations,” see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data.”

 

49


Table of Contents

Rental Revenues and Leasing Activity

Rental revenues, which are comprised of base rent, straight-line rent, amortization of above and below market rent intangibles, tenant recovery income, other rental revenues and early lease termination fees, increased $49.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012, primarily due to the following changes:

 

    $43.1 million increase in our non-same store rental revenues including development and redevelopment properties, primarily as a result of an increase in the number of properties and an increase in average occupancy year over year. Since December 31, 2012, we acquired 38 operating properties, six properties for development and completed development of five properties.

 

    $6.3 million increase in total revenue in our same store portfolio due primarily to the following:

 

    $6.7 million increase in base rent primarily resulting from increased rental rates and a 100 basis point increase in average occupancy year over year;

 

    $3.2 million increase in operating expense recoveries related to a higher average occupancy; and

 

    $1.3 million increase in other rental revenues primarily related to increases in amortization of below market rent and other rents; which was partially offset by

 

    $5.0 million decrease in straight-line rental revenue as a result of fewer rent concessions.

The following table illustrates the components of our consolidated rental revenues for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
        
     2013      2012      $ Change  

Base rent

   $ 212,045       $ 176,798       $ 35,247   

Straight-line rent

     5,335         6,254         (919

Amortization of above and below market rent intangibles

     1,581         826         755   

Tenant recovery income

     63,829         51,695         12,134   

Other rental income

     2,126         714         1,412   

Revenues related to early lease terminations

     1,302         552         750   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total rental revenues

   $ 286,218       $ 236,839       $ 49,379   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table provides a summary of our leasing activity for the year ended December 31, 2013:

 

     Number of
Leases
Signed
     Square Feet
Signed(1)
     Net Effective
Rent Per
Square
Foot(2)
     GAAP
Basis
Rent
Growth(3)
    Weighted
Average
Lease
Term(4)
     Turnover
Costs Per
Square
Foot(5)
     Weighted
Average
Retention(6)
 
            (in thousands)                   (in months)                

Year to date 2013

     299         13,836       $ 4.37         6.60     53       $ 1.77        72.0

 

(1)  Excludes month to month leases.
(2)  Net effective rent is the average base rent calculated in accordance with GAAP, over the term of the lease.
(3)  GAAP basis rent growth is an annual ratio of the change in net effective rent (including straight-line rent adjustments as required by GAAP) compared to the net effective rent of the comparable lease. Leases where there were no prior comparable leases, due to extended downtime, or materially different lease structures and short-term lease of less than 12 months, are excluded.
(4)  The lease term is in months. Assumes no exercise of lease renewal options, if any.

 

50


Table of Contents
(5)  Turnover costs are comprised of the costs incurred or capitalized for improvements of vacant and renewal spaces, as well as the commissions paid and costs capitalized for leasing transactions. Turnover costs per square foot represent the total turnover costs expected to be incurred on the leases signed during the period and does not reflect actual expenditures for the period.
(6)  Represents the percentage of customers renewing their respective leases weighted by average square feet.

During the year ended December 31, 2013, we signed 102 leases with free rent, which were for 5.8 million square feet of property with total concessions of $6.6 million.

Rental Expenses and Real Estate Taxes

Rental expenses and real estate taxes increased $13.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012, primarily due to:

 

    $10.5 million increase in rental expenses and real estate taxes related to the properties acquired and development and redevelopment properties placed into operation during the period ended December 31, 2013; and

 

    $3.1 million increase in rental expenses and real estate taxes year over year in our same store portfolio, which was primarily due to increases in property taxes, snow removal, management fees and bad debt expense.

Other Revenue and Other Income (Loss)

Total other revenue and other income (loss) decreased $0.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 as compared to the same period in 2012, primarily due to:

 

    $1.3 million decrease in institutional capital management fees as a result of a decrease in assets under management due to the sale of properties from our unconsolidated joint ventures; and

 

    $0.9 million decrease in casualty gains related to amounts received from insurance companies during 2012 for casualty events at certain properties; partially offset by

 

    $1.3 million increase in equity in earnings of unconsolidated joint ventures primarily as a result of an increase in occupancy in three of our joint ventures.

Other Expenses

Other expenses increased $15.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 as compared to the same period in 2012, primarily as a result of:

 

    $20.0 million increase in depreciation and amortization expense, resulting from real estate acquisitions and capital additions; and

 

    $2.2 million increase in general and administrative expenses primarily related to higher acquisition costs and personnel costs, partially offset by an increase in capitalized overhead as a result of increased development, leasing and other capital activities; partially offset by

 

    $5.9 million decrease in interest expense as a result of the $175.0 million term loan paid down in March 2013, lower borrowings on our revolving line of credit, hedging ineffectiveness of $0.7 million during 2012 and an increase in capitalized interest in 2013 related to increased development activities.

Income from Discontinued Operations

Income from discontinued operations increased $14.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 as compared to the same period in 2012. This increase is primarily related to the gain on dispositions totaling $33.6 million partially offset by impairment charges of $13.3 million recorded on sales of properties during 2013, as

 

51


Table of Contents

compared to gain on dispositions totaling $13.4 million partially offset by impairment charges of $11.4 million recorded on sales of properties during 2012. Additionally, the increase was offset by lower operating and other income from properties sold or held for sale in 2013 compared to 2012.

Summary of the year ended December 31, 2012 compared to the year ended December 31, 2011

As of December 31, 2012, we consolidated 399 operating properties, four redevelopment properties, three development properties and three properties which were held for sale. As of December 31, 2011, we consolidated 408 operating properties and one redevelopment property.

 

52


Table of Contents

Comparison of the year ended December 31, 2012 to the year ended December 31, 2011

The following table illustrates the changes in rental revenues, rental expenses and real estate taxes, property net operating income, other revenue and other income (loss) and other expenses for the year ended December 31, 2012 compared to the year ended December 31, 2011. Our same store portfolio includes all operating properties that we owned for the entirety of both the current and prior year reporting periods for which the operations had been stabilized. We generally consider buildings stabilized when occupancy reaches 90%. The same store portfolio for the periods presented totaled 288 buildings comprised of approximately 44.6 million square feet. A discussion of these changes follows the table (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
    $ Change     Percent
Change
 
     2012     2011      

Rental Revenues

        

Same store, excluding revenues related to early lease terminations

   $ 203,850      $ 199,023      $ 4,827        2.4

Non-same store operating properties

     32,252        11,899        20,353        171.0

Development and redevelopment

     185        —          185        100.0

Revenues related to early lease terminations

     552        614        (62     -10.1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total rental revenues

     236,839        211,536        25,303        12.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Rental Expenses and Real Estate Taxes

        

Same store

     57,486        57,344        142        0.2

Non-same store operating properties

     8,672        3,882        4,790        123.4

Development and redevelopment

     232        141        91        64.5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total rental expenses and real estate taxes

     66,390        61,367        5,023        8.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property Net Operating Income(1)

        

Same store, excluding revenues related to early lease terminations

     146,364        141,679        4,685        3.3

Non-same store operating properties

     23,580        8,017        15,563        194.1

Development and redevelopment

     (47     (141     94        66.7

Revenues related to early lease terminations

     552        614        (62     -10.1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total property net operating income

     170,449        150,169        20,280        13.5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other Revenue and Other Income (Loss)

        

Development profit

     307        —          307        100.0

Institutional capital management and other fees

     4,059        4,291        (232     -5.4

Equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated joint ventures, net

     1,087        (2,556     3,643        142.5

Interest and other income (expense)

     85        (93     178        191.4

Casualty and involuntary conversion gain

     1,174        —          1,174        100.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other revenue and other income

     6,712        1,642        5,070        308.8
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other Expenses

        

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

     109,993        103,333        6,660        6.4

Interest expense

     69,274        63,645        5,629        8.8

General and administrative

     25,763        25,251        512        2.0

Impairment losses on investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

     —          1,953        (1,953     -100.0

Income tax expense and other taxes

     671        132        539        408.3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other expenses

     205,701        194,314        11,387        5.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from discontinued operations

     11,800        13,660        (1,860     -13.6

Net loss attributable to noncontrolling interests

     272        958        (686     -71.6
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ (16,468   $ (27,885   $ 11,417        40.9
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)  For a discussion as to why we view property net operating income to be an appropriate supplemental performance measure and a reconciliation of our property net operating income to our reported “Loss from Continuing Operations,” see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data”

 

53


Table of Contents

Rental Revenues

Rental revenues, which are comprised of base rent, straight-line rent, amortization of above and below market rent intangibles, tenant recovery income, early lease termination fees and other rental revenues, increased $25.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2012 compared to the same period in 2011, primarily due to the following changes:

 

    $20.5 million increase in our non-same store rental revenues including development and redevelopment properties, primarily as a result of an increase in the number of properties and an increase in average occupancy year over year. Since December 31, 2011, we acquired 29 operating properties, four redevelopment properties and completed development or redevelopment of three properties.

 

    $4.8 million increase in total revenue in our same store portfolio due primarily to the following:

 

    $4.8 million increase in base rent primarily resulting from increased rental rates and a 140 basis point increase in average occupancy year over year; and

 

    $3.5 million increase in operating expense recoveries related to a higher average occupancy; which was partially offset by

 

    $3.2 million decrease in straight-line rental revenue as a result of fewer rent concessions; and

 

    $0.2 million decrease in early lease termination fees.

The following table illustrates the components of our consolidated rental revenues for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011 (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
        
     2012      2011      $ Change  

Base rent

   $ 176,798       $ 157,885       $ 18,913   

Straight-line rent

     6,254         8,301         (2,047

Amortization of above and below market rent intangibles

     826         387         439   

Tenant recovery income

     51,695         43,579         8,116   

Other rental income

     714         770         (56

Revenues related to early lease terminations

     552         614         (62
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total rental revenues

   $ 236,839       $ 211,536       $ 25,303   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table provides a summary of our leasing activity for the year ended December 31, 2012:

 

     Number of
Leases
Signed
     Square Feet
Signed(1)
     Net
Effective
Rent Per
Square
Foot(2)
     GAAP
Basis
Rent
Growth(3)
    Weighted
Average
Lease
Term(4)
     Turnover
Costs Per
Square
Foot(5)
     Weighted
Average
Retention(6)
 
            (in thousands)                   (in months)                

Year to date 2012

     305         15,492       $ 3.81        4.60     56       $ 1.83        73.4

 

(1)  Excludes month to month leases.
(2)  Net effective rent is the average base rent calculated in accordance with GAAP, over the term of the lease.
(3)  GAAP basis rent growth is an annual ratio of the change in net effective rent (including straight-line rent adjustments as required by GAAP) compared to the net effective rent of the comparable lease. Leases where there were no prior comparable leases, due to extended downtime, or materially different lease structures and short-term lease of less than 12 months, are excluded.
(4) 

The lease term is in months. Assumes no exercise of lease renewal options, if any.

 

54


Table of Contents
(5)  Turnover costs are comprised of the costs incurred or capitalized for improvements of vacant and renewal spaces, as well as the commissions paid and costs capitalized for leasing transactions. Turnover costs per square foot represent the total turnover costs expected to be incurred on the leases signed during the period and does not reflect actual expenditures for the period.
(6)  Represents the percentage of customers renewing their respective leases weighted by average square feet.

Rental Expenses and Real Estate Taxes

Rental expenses and real estate taxes increased $5.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2012 compared to the same period in 2011, primarily due to a $4.9 million increase in rental expenses and real estate taxes related to the properties acquired and development and redevelopment properties placed into operation during the period.

Other Revenue and Other Income (Loss)

Total other revenue and other income (loss) increased $5.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to the same period in 2011, primarily due to:

 

    $3.6 million increase in equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated joint ventures primarily as a result of an increase in occupancy in two of our joint ventures, as well as gains recognized on the sale of two properties in our joint ventures; and

 

    $1.2 million increase in casualty gains related to amounts received from insurance companies subsequent to December 31, 2012 for casualty events at certain properties.

Other Expenses

Other expenses increased $11.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to the same period in 2011, primarily as a result of:

 

    $6.7 million increase in real estate depreciation and amortization expense resulting from real estate acquisitions and capital additions;

 

    $5.6 million increase in interest expense primarily related to higher average borrowings and $0.7 million related to hedge ineffectiveness recognized during the year ended December 31, 2012 related to our settled hedge liability (see “Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements Note 6—Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities” for further detail related to the hedge activity); and

 

    $0.5 million increase in general and administrative expenses, primarily related to an increase in acquisition costs for the increased number of properties acquired during 2012; which were partially offset by

 

    $2.0 million decrease in impairment losses on unconsolidated joint ventures related to an impairment recorded in 2011 on a property sold in an unconsolidated joint venture.

Income from Discontinued Operations

Income from discontinued operations decreased $1.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared the same period in 2011. This change is primarily the result of a casualty gain recorded in 2011 on a property subsequently sold as well as higher net gains on properties sold in 2011.

Segment Summary for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

Our segments are based on our internal reporting of operating results used to assess performance based on our properties’ geographical markets. Our markets are aggregated into three reportable regions or segments, East, Central and West, which are based on the geographical locations of our properties (see “—Business and Properties” for a listing of our properties by market broken into our reportable segments). We consider rental

 

55


Table of Contents

revenues and property net operating income aggregated by segment to be the appropriate way to analyze performance. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior year results to conform to the current presentation related to discontinued operations. The following segment disclosures exclude the results from discontinued operations (see “Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 15 – Discontinued Operations and Assets Held for Sale” for additional information):

 

                                Year Ended
December 31,
 
     As of December 31,     
     Number of
buildings
     Square
feet
     Occupancy at
period end
    Segment
assets(1)
     Rental
revenues(2)
     Property net
operating
income (3)
 

EAST:

                

2013

     132         23,163         90.3   $ 1,026,416       $ 95,682       $ 69,853   

2012

     117         19,651         86.0   $ 875,845       $ 82,909       $ 60,666   

2011

     110         18,970         89.0   $ 936,305       $ 79,920       $ 58,212   

CENTRAL:

                

2013

     166         26,699         92.2   $ 1,034,814       $ 111,017       $ 76,327   

2012

     151         23,663         90.8   $ 1,107,561       $ 90,037       $ 61,800   

2011

     137         20,367         90.7   $ 1,021,956       $ 76,376       $ 50,660   

WEST:

                

2013

     101         13,088         93.6   $ 1,018,246       $ 79,519       $ 60,013   

2012

     90         11,456         97.2   $ 863,003       $ 63,893       $ 47,983   

2011

     78         10,042         91.3   $ 669,591       $ 55,240       $ 41,297   

 

(1)  Segment assets include all assets comprising operating properties included in a segment, less non-segment cash and cash equivalents, other non-segment assets, and assets held for sale. The prior year segment assets are not restated for current year discontinued operations.
(2)  Segment rental revenues include operating properties and development properties. Revenues from properties which were held for sale or sold are included in discontinued operations and are not included in these results.
(3)  For a discussion as to why we view property net operating income to be an appropriate supplemental performance measure and a reconciliation of our property net operating income to our reported “Loss from Continuing Operations,” see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data.”

The following table reflects our total assets, net of accumulated depreciation and amortization, by segment (in thousands):

 

     December 31,      December 31,      December 31,  
     2013      2012      2011  

Segments:

        

East assets

   $ 1,026,416       $ 875,845       $ 936,305   

Central assets

     1,034,814         1,107,561         1,021,956   

West assets

     1,018,246         863,003         669,591   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total segment net assets

     3,079,476         2,846,409         2,627,852   

Non-segment assets:

        

Non-segment cash and cash equivalents

     25,671         8,653         11,624   

Other non-segment assets(1)

     152,620         149,285         153,822   

Assets held for sale

     8,196         52,852         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 3,265,963       $ 3,057,199       $ 2,793,298   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)  Other non-segment assets primarily consists of investments in and advances to unconsolidated joint ventures, deferred loan costs, other receivables and other assets.

 

56


Table of Contents

East Segment

 

    East Segment assets increased by approximately $150.6 million in 2013 due to the acquisition of 13 properties and completion of development of two operating properties since December 31, 2012.

 

    East Segment assets decreased by approximately $60.5 million in 2012 due to the disposition of 20 properties, partially offset by the acquisition of seven properties and the completion of the development of two properties since December 31, 2011.

 

    East Segment property NOI, after reclassification for discontinued operations, increased approximately $9.2 million, for the year ended December 31, 2013 as compared to the same period in 2012 primarily as a result of:

 

    $12.8 million increase in rental revenues, of which $6.7 million is attributed to property acquisitions and $6.1 million is attributed to increased occupancy and higher rental revenues at existing properties; which was partially offset by

 

    $3.6 million increase in operating expenses primarily comprised of increased property taxes, property insurance and maintenance.

 

    East Segment property NOI, after reclassification for discontinued operations, increased approximately $2.5 million, for the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to the same period in 2011 primarily as a result of:

 

    $3.0 million increase in rental revenues, of which $0.9 million is attributed to property acquisitions and $2.1 million is attributed to increased occupancy and higher rental revenues at existing properties; which was partially offset by

 

    $0.5 million increase in operating expenses primarily comprised of increased property taxes, property insurance and maintenance primarily due to property acquisitions.

Central Segment

 

    Central Segment assets decreased by approximately $72.7 million in 2013 due to the disposition of 47 properties, including the disposition of our entire portfolio in Mexico consisting of 15 properties, partially offset by the acquisition of 14 properties and completion of development of one property since December 31, 2012.

 

    Central Segment assets increased by approximately $85.6 million in 2012 due to the acquisition of 12 properties and completion of development of one property, partially offset by the disposition of 16 properties since December 31, 2011.

 

    Central Segment property NOI, after reclassification for discontinued operations, increased approximately $14.5 million, for the year ended December 31, 2013 as compared to the same period in 2012 primarily as a result of:

 

    $21.0 million increase in rental revenues, of which $3.7 million is attributed to property acquisitions and $17.3 million is attributed to an increase in occupancy and higher rental revenues at existing properties; which was partially offset by

 

    $6.5 million increase in operating expenses primarily comprised of increased property taxes, property insurance primarily due to property acquisitions and an increase in bad debt related to a tenant default.

 

57


Table of Contents
    Central Segment property NOI, after reclassification for discontinued operations, increased approximately $11.1 million, for the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to the same period in 2011 primarily as a result of:

 

    $13.7 million increase in rental revenues, of which $3.7 million is attributed to property acquisitions and $10.0 million is attributed to an increase in occupancy and higher rental revenues at existing properties; which was partially offset by

 

    $2.6 million increase in operating expenses primarily comprised of increased property taxes and property insurance primarily due to property acquisitions.

West Segment

 

    West Segment assets increased by approximately $155.2 million in 2013 due to the acquisition of 11 properties and completion of development of one property, partially offset by the disposition of one property since December 31, 2012.

 

    West Segment assets increased by approximately $193.4 million in 2012 due to the acquisition of 12 properties since December 31, 2011.

 

    West Segment property NOI, after reclassification for discontinued operations, increased approximately $12.0 million, for the year ended December 31, 2013 as compared to the same period in 2012 primarily as a result of:

 

    $15.6 million increase in rental revenues, of which $2.9 million is attributed to property acquisitions and $12.7 million which is attributed to an increase in occupancy and higher rental revenues at existing properties; which was partially offset by

 

    $3.6 million increase in operating expenses primarily comprised of increased property taxes and property insurance.

 

    West Segment property NOI, after reclassification for discontinued operations, increased approximately $6.7 million, for the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to the same period in 2011 primarily as a result of:

 

    $8.7 million increase in rental revenues, of which $2.2 million is attributed to property acquisitions and $6.5 million is attributed to an increase in occupancy and higher rental revenues at existing properties; which was partially offset by

 

    $2.0 million increase in operating expenses primarily comprised of increased property taxes and property insurance.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Overview

We currently expect that our principal sources of working capital and funding for potential capital requirements for expansions and renovation of properties, developments, acquisitions, and debt service and distributions to shareholders will include:

 

    Cash flows from operations;

 

    Proceeds from dispositions;

 

    Borrowings under our senior unsecured revolving credit facility;

 

    Other forms of secured or unsecured financings;

 

    Offerings of common stock or other securities;

 

    Current cash balances; and

 

    Distributions from institutional capital management and other joint ventures.

 

58


Table of Contents

Our sources of capital will be used to meet our liquidity requirements and capital commitments, including operating activities, debt service obligations, equityholder distributions, capital expenditures at our properties, development funding requirements and future acquisitions. We expect to utilize the same sources of capital to meet our short-term and long-term liquidity requirements.

Cash Flows

Year ended December 31, 2013 compared to year ended December 31, 2012

“Cash and cash equivalents” were $32.2 million and $12.7 million as of December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012, respectively.

The table below summarizes our cash flow activity for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
       
     2013     2012     Change  

Net cash provided by operating activities

   $ 152,893      $ 118,956      $ 33,937   

Net cash used in investing activities

   $ (301,058   $ (299,138   $ (1,920

Net cash provided by financing activities

   $ 167,695      $ 180,044      $ (12,349

Net cash provided by operating activities increased $33.9 million primarily due to an increase in property net operating income, as a result of an increase in occupancy and rental rates (see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Results of Operations—Rental Revenues and Leasing Activity” for further details), and an increase in accounts payable, accrued expenses and other liabilities, and a decrease in straight-line rent due to fewer rent concessions.

Net cash used in investing activities increased $1.9 million primarily due to an increase in real estate acquisitions of $42.7 million, a $20.7 million decrease in distributions of investments in unconsolidated joint ventures resulting from the sale of three properties in our unconsolidated joint ventures in 2012 and an increase of cash outflows related to capital expenditures of $56.8 million as reflected in the table below. These activities were partially offset by an increase in dispositions of $104.5 million and a decrease in investments in unconsolidated joint ventures of $16.7 million.

 

59


Table of Contents

Going forward, we will pursue the acquisition of buildings and land and consider selective development of new buildings in markets where we perceive that demand and market rental rates will provide attractive financial returns. The amount of cash used related to acquisitions and development and redevelopment investments will vary from period to period based on a number of factors, including, among others, current and anticipated future market conditions impacting the desirability of investments, leasing results with respect to our existing development and redevelopment projects and our ability to locate attractive opportunities. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Summary of Significant Transactions During 2013—Development Activities” for further details regarding projected investment of our current development activities as well as cumulative costs incurred during the year ended December 31, 2013. Our total capital expenditures for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 were comprised of the following (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
       
     2013     2012     $ Change  

Development

   $ 107,950      $ 46,701      $ 61,249   

Redevelopment

     5,948        3,319        2,629   

Due diligence and other

     9,209        4,782        4,427   

Other capital improvements

     4,024        5,710        (1,686

Building and land improvements

     12,394        12,619        (225

Tenant improvements and leasing costs

     26,219        31,388        (5,169
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capital expenditures and development activities

     165,744        104,519        61,225   

Accruals and other adjustments

     (12,822     (8,424     (4,398
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total cash paid for capital expenditures and development activities

   $ 152,922      $ 96,095      $ 56,827   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

We capitalize costs directly related to the development, predevelopment, redevelopment or improvement of our investments in real estate. Building and land improvements comprise capital expenditures related to maintaining our consolidated operating activities. Due diligence capital improvements relate to acquired operating properties and are generally incurred within 12 months of the acquisition date.

We capitalize indirect costs such as personnel, office and administrative expenses that are directly related to our development, redevelopment projects and successful origination of new leases based on an estimate of the time spent on the development and leasing activities. These capitalized costs for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 were $7.8 million, $6.3 million and $5.0 million, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 total interest expense capitalized was $8.3 million, $4.3 million and $2.7 million, respectively.

Net cash provided by financing activities decreased $12.3 million primarily due to a decrease of $125.2 million in net proceeds from debt activity. During 2013, our senior unsecured revolving credit facility’s repayments exceeded our proceeds from borrowings by $71.0 million while in 2012 our proceeds from borrowings exceeded our repayments by $110.0 million. Proceeds from senior unsecured notes exceeded repayments of senior unsecured notes by $97.4 million and $90.0 million, respectively, during 2013 and 2012. Principal payments on mortgage notes exceeded proceeds from mortgage notes by $24.2 million and $72.7 million, respectively, during 2013 and 2012.

Additionally, net cash provided by financing activities decreased due to an increase of $11.4 million in our distributions paid to OP Unitholders and noncontrolling interests. These changes were partially offset by an increase of $87.3 million for the issuance of OP Units in exchange for contributions from the REIT, a $33.6 million payment made to settle our cash flow hedge in 2012 and a $1.8 million decrease in cash outflow relating to redemptions of OP Units.

 

60


Table of Contents

Year ended December 31, 2012 compared to year ended December 31, 2011

“Cash and cash equivalents” were $12.7 million and $12.8 million as of December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011, respectively.

The table below summarizes our cash flow activity for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011 (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
       
     2012     2011     Change  

Net cash provided by operating activities

   $ 118,956      $ 106,482      $ 12,474   

Net cash used in investing activities

   $ (299,138   $ (177,823   $ (121,315

Net cash provided by financing activities

   $ 180,044      $ 66,845      $ 113,199   

Net cash provided by operating activities increased $12.5 million primarily due to an increase in property net operating income, partially offset by an increase in net cash payments related to changes in operating assets and liabilities compared to the year ended December 31, 2011.

Net cash used in investing activities increased $121.3 million due to an increase in cash flows related to acquisitions of $159.1 million and an increase of cash outflows related to capital expenditures, as reflected in the table below, of $20.5 million, partially offset by a $47.3 million increase in proceeds from dispositions and a $9.9 million increase in distributions of our investments in unconsolidated joint ventures.

Our total capital expenditures for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011 were comprised of the following (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
        
     2012     2011      $ Change  

Development

   $ 46,701      $ 11,676       $ 35,025   

Redevelopment

     3,319        6,430         (3,111

Due diligence and other

     4,782        1,264         3,518   

Other capital improvements

     5,710        —           5,710   

Building and land improvements

     12,619        11,601         1,018   

Tenant improvements and leasing costs

     31,388        39,256         (7,868
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total capital expenditures and development activities

     104,519        70,227         34,292   

Accruals and other adjustments

     (8,424     5,324         (13,748
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total cash paid for capital expenditures and development activities

   $ 96,095      $ 75,551       $ 20,544   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities increased $113.2 million primarily due to an increase of $92.2 million in net proceeds from debt activity. During 2012, our senior unsecured revolving credit facility’s proceeds from borrowings exceeded our repayments by $110.0 million while in 2011 our repayments exceeded our proceeds from borrowings by $51.0 million. Proceeds from senior unsecured notes exceeded repayments of senior unsecured notes by $90.0 million and $200.0 million, respectively, during 2012 and 2011. Principal payments on mortgage notes exceeded proceeds from mortgage notes by $72.7 million and $113.9 million, respectively, during 2012 and 2011.

Additionally, net cash provided by financing activities increased due to an increase of $59.7 million for the issuance of OP Units in exchange for contributions from the REIT, partially offset by a $33.6 million payment made to settle our cash flow hedge in 2012, an increase of $3.3 million in our distributions paid to OP Unitholders and noncontrolling interests, and a $2.9 million increase in cash outflow relating to redemptions of OP Units.

 

61


Table of Contents

OP Units

Limited partners have the right to require DCTOP to redeem all or a portion of the OP Units held by the limited partner at a redemption price equal to and in the form of the Cash Amount (as defined in DCTOP’s partnership agreement), provided that such OP Units have been outstanding for at least one year. DCT may, in its sole discretion, purchase the OP Units by paying to the limited partner either the Cash Amount or the REIT Shares Amount (generally one share of DCT’s common stock for each OP Unit), as defined in DCTOP’s partnership agreement.

During the year ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, 3.1 million and 6.2 million OP Units were redeemed for approximately $1.5 million and $3.3 million in cash and approximately 2.9 million and 5.7 million shares of DCT common stock, respectively. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012 the aggregate redemption value of the then-outstanding OP Units held by limited partners was approximately $125.9 million and $129.6 million, respectively, based on the $7.13 and $6.49 per share closing price of DCT’s common stock on December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

On May 29, 2013, DCT registered a third continuous equity offering program, to replace its continuous equity offering program previously registered on November 20, 2012. Pursuant to this offering, DCT may sell up to 20 million shares of common stock from time-to-time through May 29, 2016 in “at-the-market” offerings or certain other transactions. During the year ended December 31, 2013, approximately 13.8 million shares were issued through the second and third continuous equity offering programs at an average price of $7.37 per share for proceeds of $100.4 million, net of offering expenses. As of December 31, 2013, 16.6 million shares remain available to be issued under the current offering.

On August 13, 2013, DCT issued 23.0 million shares of common stock in a public offering at a price of $7.20 per share for proceeds of $158.2 million, net of offering expenses, used for acquisitions, development activities, repayment of amounts under our senior unsecured revolving credit facility and other general purposes. The proceeds from the sale of shares were contributed to DCTOP in exchange for an equal number of OP Units in DCTOP.

Distributions

During the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, the general partner declared distributions to OP Unit holders totaling approximately $92.1 million and $80.2 million, respectively, including distributions to noncontrolling interest holders. Existing cash balances, cash provided from operations and borrowings under our credit facility were used for distributions paid during 2013 and 2012.

The payment of quarterly distributions is determined by DCT’s board of directors and may be adjusted at its discretion at any time. During February 2014, DCT’s board of directors declared a quarterly cash distribution of $0.07 per OP Unit, payable on April 16, 2014 to OP Unitholders of record as of April 4, 2014.

Outstanding Indebtedness

As of December 31, 2013, our outstanding indebtedness of approximately $1.5 billion consisted of mortgage notes, senior unsecured notes and a senior unsecured revolving credit facility, excluding $44.4 million representing our proportionate share of debt associated with unconsolidated joint ventures. As of December 31, 2012, our outstanding indebtedness consisted of mortgage notes and senior unsecured notes and totaled approximately $1.5 billion, excluding $45.0 million representing our proportionate share of debt associated with unconsolidated joint ventures.

As of December 31, 2013, the gross book value of our consolidated properties was approximately $3.7 billion and the gross book value of all properties securing our mortgage debt was approximately $0.7 billion. As

 

62


Table of Contents

of December 31, 2012, the total gross book value of our consolidated properties was approximately $3.4 billion and the gross book value of all properties securing our mortgage debt was approximately $0.7 billion. Our debt has various covenants with which we were in compliance as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

Our debt instruments require monthly, quarterly or semiannual payments of interest and many require monthly or quarterly repayments of principal. Currently, cash flows from our operations are sufficient to satisfy these debt service requirements and we anticipate that cash flows from operations will continue to be sufficient to satisfy our debt service excluding principal maturities, which we plan to fund from refinancing and/or new debt.

All of our senior unsecured notes contain certain cross-default provisions which may be triggered in the event that any material indebtedness is in default. These cross-default provisions may require us to repay such senior unsecured debt. We are not in default and do not have any unsecured debt maturities through December 31, 2014.

We have certain non-recourse, secured loans which are cross-collateralized by multiple properties. In the event of a default, we may then be required to repay such indebtedness, together with applicable prepayment charges, to avoid foreclosure on all cross-collateralized properties within the applicable pool. We generally have broad substitution rights that afford an operating property the opportunity to replace encumbered properties with replacement properties. We are not in default and do not have any cross-collateralized debt maturing through December 31, 2014.

In the event of default or foreclosure, or if we are unable to refinance our indebtedness at maturity or meet our payment obligations, the amount of our distributable cash flows and our financial condition would be adversely affected.

Financing Strategy

Our charter and our bylaws do not limit the amount of debt we incur, however, we intend to operate so that our financial metrics are generally consistent with our publicly held investment grade REIT peers. The metrics we consider most significant include leverage, fixed charge coverage and net debt to earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization. We are also subject to certain covenants which may limit our outstanding indebtedness.

Debt Issuances

During June of 2013, we issued two secured mortgage notes with principal balances of $1.0 million and $6.2 million which mature in June 2023. The notes bear interest at a variable rate, however we have fixed the rate at 4.72% using two variable for floating rate swaps (See Note 6 – Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities for further detail). The notes require monthly payments of principal and interest.

During October 2013, we issued $275.0 million aggregate principal amount of 4.50% senior notes due 2023 at 99.038% of face value in a private placement for net proceeds of approximately $269.6 million after offering costs.

Debt Retirement

During March and April 2013, we retired mortgage notes totaling $11.0 million previously scheduled to mature in April and June of 2013, using proceeds from the Company’s senior unsecured revolving credit facility and proceeds from our equity offerings.

 

63


Table of Contents

During October 2013, in connection with the issuance of $275.0 million in aggregate principal amount of 10-year senior unsecured notes at 99.038% of face value, we primarily used the net proceeds to repay a $15.9 million mortgage note that was scheduled to mature in October 2013, a $50.0 million senior unsecured note that was scheduled to mature in January of 2014 and our $175.0 million senior unsecured term note that was scheduled to mature in February 2015.

Line of Credit

As of December 31, 2013, we had $39.0 million outstanding and $261.0 million available under our senior unsecured revolving credit facility. As of December 31, 2012 we had $110.0 million outstanding and $190.0 million available under the senior unsecured revolving credit facility.

2013 Debt Refinancing

During February 2013, we entered into an amendment with our syndicated bank group whereby we extended and increased our existing $175.0 million senior unsecured term loan to $225.0 million for a period of five years, extended our existing $300.0 million senior unsecured line of credit for a period of four years and received a commitment for an additional $175.0 million senior unsecured term loan with a term of two years. We closed on the additional $175.0 million in March 2013, which was used to refinance a scheduled June 2013 maturity of $175.0 million of other senior unsecured debt.

Interest rate swap

During June 2013 certain of our consolidated investments entered into two pay-fixed, receive-floating interest rate swaps to hedge the variability of future cash flows attributable to changes in the 1 month LIBOR rates. The first pay-fixed, receive-floating swap has a notional amount of $6.2 million, an effective date of June 2013 and a maturity date of June 2023. The second pay-fixed, receive-floating swap has a notional amount of $1.0 million, an effective date of June 2013 and a maturity date of June 2023. These interest rates swaps effectively fix the interest rate on the related debt instruments at 4.72%. As of December 31, 2012, we did not have any hedges in place.

Debt Maturities

The following table sets forth the scheduled maturities of our debt and regularly scheduled principal amortization, excluding unamortized premiums, as of December 31, 2013 (in thousands):

 

Year

   Senior
Unsecured
Notes
     Mortgage
Notes
     Senior Unsecured
Revolving

Credit Facility
     Total  

2014

   $ —         $ 10,927       $ —         $ 10,927   

2015

     40,000         49,982         —           89,982   

2016

     99,000         61,184         —           160,184   

2017

     51,000         11,768         39,000         101,768   

2018

     306,500         6,412         —           312,912   

Thereafter

     628,500         145,448         —           773,948   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,125,000       $ 285,721       $ 39,000       $ 1,449,721   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

64


Table of Contents

Contractual Obligations

The following table reflects our contractual obligations as of December 31, 2013, specifically our obligations under long-term debt agreements and operating and ground lease agreements (in thousands):

 

     Payments due by Period  

Contractual Obligations (1)

  

Total

    

2014

    

2015-2016

    

2017-2018

    

Thereafter

 

Scheduled long-term debt maturities, including interest(2)

   $ 1,850,893       $ 77,355       $ 638,252       $ 240,373       $ 894,913   

Operating lease commitments

     2,713         941         1,608         164         —     

Ground lease commitments(3)

     12,968         509         1,123         1,102         10,234   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,866,574       $ 78,805       $ 640,983       $ 241,639       $ 905,147   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)  From time-to-time in the normal course of our business, we enter into various contracts with third-parties that may obligate us to make payments, such as maintenance agreements at our properties. Such contracts, in the aggregate, do not represent material obligations, are typically short-term and cancellable within 90 days and are not included in the table above. Excluded from the total are our estimated construction costs to complete development projects of approximately $87.5 million, none of which is legally committed until work is completed
(2)  Variable interest rate payments are estimated based on the LIBOR rate at December 31, 2013.
(3)  Three of our buildings comprising 0.7 million square feet reside on 38 acres of land which is leased from an airport authority.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, we had no off-balance sheet arrangements, other than those disclosed under contractual obligations, that have or are reasonably likely to have a current or future effect on our financial condition, changes in financial condition, revenues or expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources that is material to investors, other than items discussed herein.

As of December 31, 2013, there are no lines of credit or side agreements related to, or between, our unconsolidated joint ventures and us, and there are no other derivative financial instruments between our unconsolidated joint ventures and us. In addition, we believe we have no material exposure to financial guarantees.

 

65


Table of Contents

As of December 31, 2013, our proportionate share of the total construction loans of our unconsolidated development joint ventures, including undrawn amounts, was $36.8 million all of which is scheduled to mature by the end of 2017. Our proportionate share of the total construction loans of our unconsolidated development joint ventures includes 50% of the construction loans associated with the SCLA joint venture which are non-recourse to the venture partners. We may elect to fund additional capital to a joint venture through equity contributions (generally on a basis proportionate to our ownership interests), advances or partner loans, although such fundings are not required contractually or otherwise. As of December 31, 2013, our proportionate share of non-recourse debt associated with unconsolidated joint ventures is $44.4 million. The maturities of our proportionate share of the non-recourse debt are summarized in the table below (in thousands):

 

Year

   DCT’s Proportionate
Share of Secured
Non-Recourse Debt
in Unconsolidated
Joint Ventures
 

2014

   $ 4,513   

2015

     2,223   

2016

     830   

2017

     36,805   

2018

     —     

Thereafter

     —     
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 44,371   
  

 

 

 

 

66


Table of Contents

QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

Market risk is the exposure to losses resulting from changes in market prices such as interest rates, foreign currency exchange rates and rental rates. Our future earnings and cash flows are dependent upon prevailing market rates. Accordingly, we manage our market risk by matching projected cash inflows from operating, investing and financing activities with projected cash outflows for debt service, acquisitions, capital expenditures, distributions to stockholders and OP unitholders, and other cash requirements. The majority of our outstanding debt has fixed interest rates, which minimizes the risk of fluctuating interest rates.

Interest Rate Risk

Our exposure to market risk includes interest rate fluctuations in connection with our senior unsecured revolving credit facility and other variable rate borrowings and forecasted fixed rate debt issuances, including refinancing of existing fixed rate debt. Interest rate risk may result from many factors, including governmental monetary and tax policies, domestic and international economic and political considerations and other factors that are beyond our control. To manage interest rate risk for variable rate debt and issuances of fixed rate debt, in the past we have primarily used treasury locks and forward-starting swaps as part of our cash flow hedging strategy. These derivatives are designed to mitigate the risk of future interest rate increases by providing a fixed interest rate for a limited, pre-determined period of time. We do not use derivatives for trading or speculative purposes and only enter into contracts with major financial institutions based on their credit rating and other factors.

During June 2013 certain of our consolidated investments entered into two pay-fixed, receive-floating interest rate swaps to hedge the variability of future cash flows attributable to changes in the 1 month LIBOR rates. The first pay-fixed, receive-floating swap has a notional amount of $6.2 million, an effective date of June 2013 and a maturity date of June 2023. The second pay-fixed, receive-floating swap has a notional amount of $1.0 million, an effective date of June 2013 and a maturity date of June 2023. These interest rates swaps effectively fix the interest rate on the related debt instruments at 4.72%. As of December 31, 2012, we did not have any hedges in place.

Our variable rate debt is subject to risk based upon prevailing market interest rates. As of December 31, 2013, we had approximately $264.0 million of variable rate debt outstanding indexed to LIBOR rates. If the LIBOR rates relevant to our variable rate debt were to increase 10%, we estimate that our interest expense during the year ended December 31, 2013 would increase by approximately $0.1 million based on our average outstanding floating-rate debt during the year ended December 31, 2013. Additionally, if weighted average interest rates on our fixed rate debt were to have increased by 100 basis points due to refinancing, interest expense would have increased by approximately $11.1 million during the year ended December 31, 2013.

As of December 31, 2013, the estimated fair value of our debt was approximately $1.5 billion based on our estimate of the then-current market interest rates.

 

67


Table of Contents

BUSINESS AND PROPERTIES

Business Overview

Our portfolio primarily consists of high-quality, bulk distribution warehouses and light industrial properties. The properties we target for acquisition or development are generally characterized by convenient access to major transportation arteries, proximity to densely populated markets and quality design standards that allow our customers’ efficient and flexible use of the buildings. In the future, we intend to continue focusing on properties that exhibit these characteristics in select U.S. markets where we believe we can achieve favorable returns and leverage our local expertise. We seek to maximize growth in earnings and shareholder value within the context of overall economic conditions, primarily through increasing rents and operating income at existing properties and acquiring and developing high-quality properties in major distribution markets. In addition, we will recycle our capital by disposing of non-strategic, lower growth assets and reinvesting the proceeds into newly acquired or developed assets where we believe the returns will be more favorable over time.

As of December 31, 2013, we owned interests in approximately 75.5 million square feet of properties leased to approximately 900 customers, including:

 

    62.1 million square feet comprising 396 consolidated operating properties, including 0.2 million square feet comprising one consolidated building classified as held for sale, which were 93.3% occupied;

 

    12.3 million square feet comprising 38 unconsolidated properties which were 94.1% occupied and operated on behalf of four institutional capital management partners;

 

    0.2 million square feet comprising two consolidated properties under redevelopment; and

 

    0.9 million square feet comprising two consolidated buildings which are shell-complete and in lease-up and eight land sites under construction.

As of December 31, 2013, our total consolidated portfolio consisted of 400 properties with an average size of 158,000 square feet and an average age of 21 years.

During the year ended December 31, 2013, we acquired 38 buildings. These properties were acquired for a total purchase price of $359.5 million.

During the year ended December 31, 2013, we sold 51 operating properties to third-parties for gross proceeds of approximately $265.8 million. We recognized gains of approximately $33.6 million on the disposition of 36 operating properties and recognized an impairment loss of approximately $13.3 million on the disposition of a portfolio of 15 properties in Dallas.

We have a broadly diversified customer base. As of December 31, 2013, our consolidated properties had leases with approximately 900 customers with no single customer accounting for more than 2.3% of the total annualized base rent of our properties. Our ten largest customers occupy approximately 10.0% of our consolidated properties based on square footage and account for approximately 12.1% of the annualized base rent of these properties. We believe that our broad national presence in the top U.S. distribution markets provides geographic diversity and is attractive to users of distribution space which allows us to build strong relationships with our customers. Furthermore, we are actively engaged in meeting our customers’ expansion and relocation requirements.

The principal executive offices of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP, DCT Industrial Trust Inc., and the subsidiary guarantors are located at 518 Seventeenth Street, Suite 800, Denver, Colorado 80202; our telephone number is (303) 597-2400. We also maintain regional offices in Atlanta, Georgia; Baltimore, Maryland; Chicago, Illinois; Cincinnati, Ohio; Dallas, Texas; Houston, Texas; Paramus, New Jersey; Newport Beach, California; Emeryville, California; Orlando, Florida; and Seattle, Washington. Our website address is www.dctindustrial.com.

 

68


Table of Contents

Business Strategy

Our primary business objectives are to maximize long-term growth in Funds From Operations, or FFO per unit (see definition in “Selected Consolidated Financial Data”), the net asset value of our portfolio and total unitholder return. The strategies we intend to execute to achieve these objectives include:

 

    Maximizing Cash Flows From Existing Properties. We intend to maximize the cash flows from our existing properties by active leasing and management, maintaining strong customer relationships, controlling operating expenses and physically maintaining the quality of our properties. Renewing tenants, leasing space and effectively managing expenses are critical to achieving our objectives and are a primary focus of our local real estate teams.

 

    Profitably Acquiring Properties. We seek to acquire properties that meet our asset, location and financial criteria at prices and potential returns which we believe are attractive. We have selected certain markets and sub-markets where we focus our efforts on identifying buildings to acquire.

 

    Selectively Pursuing New Development. To meet current tenant demand, we continue to develop new assets in select markets where rents and vacancy levels demonstrate the need for new construction. During 2013, we acquired five land parcels for future development totaling approximately 128.6 acres. Also during 2013, we stabilized six development buildings totaling 1.6 million square feet and have seven buildings under construction, which are partially leased, totaling approximately 2.7 million square feet. As of December 31, 2013, we also had one build-to-suit for sale building under contract. The buildings under construction, as well as the build-to-suit for sale building, are all projected to be completed in 2014.

 

    Recycling Capital. We intend to selectively dispose of non-strategic assets and redeploy the proceeds into higher growth acquisition and development opportunities. In 2013, we sold $265.8 million of non-strategic assets for deployment into higher growth assets. This includes the divestiture of the entire portfolio located in Mexico.

 

    Conservatively Managing Our Balance Sheet. We plan to maintain financial metrics, including leverage and coverage ratios on a basis consistent with our investment grade ratings. In addition, we believe that a conservatively managed balance sheet provides for a competitive long-term cost of capital.

Our Competitive Strengths

We believe that we distinguish ourselves from other owners, operators, acquirers and developers of industrial properties through the following competitive strengths:

 

    High-Quality Industrial Property Portfolio. Our portfolio of industrial properties primarily consists of high-quality bulk distribution facilities in high volume leasing markets specifically designed to meet the warehousing needs of local, regional and national companies. The majority of our properties are specifically designed for use by major distribution users and are readily divisible to take advantage of re-tenanting opportunities. We believe that our concentration of high-quality bulk distribution properties provides us with a competitive advantage in attracting and retaining distribution users across the markets in which we operate.

 

    Experienced and Committed Management Team. Our executive management team collectively has an average of nearly 28 years commercial real estate experience and 17 years of industrial real estate experience. Additionally, our executive management team has extensive public company operating experience.

 

    Strong Operating Platform. We have a team of 86 experienced transaction and property management professionals working in 12 regional offices to maximize market opportunities through local expertise, presence and relationships. We believe successfully meeting the needs of our customers and anticipating and responding to market opportunities will result in achieving superior returns from our properties as well as through the sourcing of new acquisitions and development opportunities.

 

69


Table of Contents
    Proven Acquisition and Disposition Capabilities. We have extensive experience in acquiring industrial real estate, including both smaller transactions as well as larger portfolio acquisitions. Our local market teams are an important advantage in sourcing potential marketed as well as off-market transactions. The average size of our acquisitions since 2010 was $14.0 million, demonstrating our ability to access a significant pipeline of smaller acquisitions. Further, consistent with our capital recycling strategy, we have disposed of a cumulative $1.4 billion of real estate investments since inception.

 

    Extensive Development and Redevelopment Expertise. Our local market teams have significant experience in all facets of value-add activities including development and redevelopment capabilities. We believe our local teams’ knowledge of our focus markets and their relationships with key market participants, including land owners, users and brokers, combined with the technical expertise required to successfully execute on complex transactions, provides us with an excellent platform to create value while appropriately managing risk.

 

    Strong Industry Relationships. We believe that our extensive network of industry relationships with the brokerage and investor communities will allow us to execute successfully our acquisition, development and capital recycling strategies. These relationships augment our ability to source acquisitions in off-market transactions outside of competitive marketing processes, capitalize on development opportunities and capture repeat business and transaction activity. Our strong relationships with local and nationally focused brokers aids in attracting and retaining customers.

 

    Capital Structure. Our capital structure provides us with sufficient financial flexibility and capacity to fund future growth. In addition to successfully raising $258.6 million in net proceeds from equity offerings in 2013, the Company received investment grade ratings from Moody’s Investors Service and Standard & Poor’s Rating Services and issued $275.0 million (aggregate principal amount) of 10-year senior unsecured notes at 99.038% of face value for net proceeds of approximately $269.6 million after expenses. The notes have a fixed interest rate of 4.5%. As of December 31, 2013 we had $261.0 million available under our senior unsecured revolving credit facility and 334 of our consolidated operating properties with a gross book value of $2.8 billion were unencumbered.

Operating Segments

Our operating results used to assess performance are aggregated into three reportable segments, East, Central and West, which are based on the geographical locations organized into markets by where our management and operating teams conduct and monitor business. We consider rental revenues and property net operating income aggregated by segment to be the appropriate way to analyze performance. See additional information in “—Properties” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 14—Segment Information.”

Competition

The market for the leasing of industrial real estate is highly competitive. We experience competition for customers from other existing assets in proximity to our buildings as well as from proposed new developments. Institutional investors, other REITs and local real estate operators generally own such properties; however no single competitor or small group of competitors is dominant in our current markets. However, as a result of competition, we may have to provide free rental periods, incur charges for tenant improvements or offer other inducements, all of which may have an adverse impact on our results of operations.

The market for the acquisition of industrial real estate is also very competitive. We compete for real property investments with other REITs and institutional investors such as pension funds and their advisors, private real estate investment funds, insurance company investment accounts, private investment companies, individuals and other entities engaged in real estate investment activities, some of which have greater financial resources than we do.

 

70


Table of Contents

Environmental Matters

We are exposed to various environmental risks that may result in unanticipated losses and affect our operating results and financial condition. Either the previous owners or we subjected a majority of the properties we have acquired, including land, to environmental reviews. While some of these assessments have led to further investigation and sampling, none of the environmental assessments has revealed an environmental liability that we believe would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations. See further additional information in “Risk Factors.”

Employees

As of December 31, 2013, we had 136 full-time employees.

Properties

Geographic Distribution

The following table describes the geographic diversification of our consolidated properties as of December 31, 2013:

 

Markets

  Number of
Buildings
    Percent
Owned(1)
    Square Feet     Occupancy
Percentage(2)
    Annualized
Base Rent(3)(6)
    Percent of
Total
Annualized
Base Rent
 
                (in thousands)           (in thousands)        

CONSOLIDATED OPERATING:

           

Atlanta

    41       100.0     6,592       92.0   $ 19,496       8.4

Baltimore/Washington D.C.

    19       100.0     2,236       88.9     11,607       5.0

Charlotte

    1       100.0     472       100.0     1,604       0.7

Memphis

    8       100.0     3,712       83.4     8,006       3.5

Miami

    10       100.0     1,362       99.0     9,393       4.1

Nashville

    4       100.0     2,064       96.5     5,304       2.3

New Jersey

    14       100.0     1,926       94.4     9,718       4.2

Orlando

    20       100.0     1,864       83.1     6,169       2.7

Pennsylvania

    14       100.0     2,828       91.0     8,929       3.9
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

East Segment Subtotal

    131       100.0     23,056       90.7     80,226       34.8
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Chicago

    34       100.0     6,742        95.4     22,005       9.5

Cincinnati

    31       100.0     3,782       93.8     12,040       5.2

Columbus

    12       100.0     3,480       87.0     7,590       3.3

Dallas

    34       100.0     5,160       97.9     16,670       7.2

Houston

    43       100.0     3,256       99.1     18,969       8.2

Indianapolis

    7       100.0     2,299       96.4     7,499       3.2

Louisville

    3       100.0     1,109       100.0     3,595       1.6
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Central Segment Subtotal

    164       100.0     25,828        95.3     88,368       38.2
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Denver

    2       100.0     278       96.5     1,259       0.5

Northern California

    27       100.0     3,171       93.1     16,502       7.1

Phoenix

    17       100.0     2,025       93.1     7,727       3.3

Seattle

    12       100.0     1,599       94.4     7,827       3.4

Southern California

    42       92.9     5,939       94.8     28,352       12.2
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

West Segment Subtotal

    100       96.8     13,012       94.1     61,667       26.5
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total/weighted average – operating properties

    395       99.3     61,896        93.3     230,261       99.5
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

71


Table of Contents

Markets

  Number of
Buildings
    Percent
Owned(1)
    Square Feet     Occupancy
Percentage(2)
    Annualized
Base Rent(3)(6)
    Percent of
Total
Annualized
Base Rent
 
                (in thousands)           (in thousands)        

REDEVELOPMENT PROPERTIES:

           

New Jersey

    1       100.0     107       0.0     —          0.0

Phoenix

    1       100.0     76       0.0     —          0.0
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total/weighted average – redevelopment properties

    2       100.0     183       0.0     —          0.0
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

DEVELOPMENT PROPERTIES:

           

Chicago

    1       100.0     604       0.0     —          0.0

Houston

    1       100.0     267        0.0     —          0.0
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total/weighted average – development properties

    2       100.0     871        0.0     —          0.0
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

HELD FOR SALE PROPERTIES:

           

Chicago

    1       100.0     222       100.0     1,102       0.5
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total/weighted average – held for sale

    1       100.0     222       100.0     1,102       0.5
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total/weighted average – consolidated properties

    400       99.3     63,172       91.8   $ 231,363 (4)      100.0
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(See footnote definitions on next page)

 

72


Table of Contents

The following table describes the geographic diversification of our investments in unconsolidated properties as of December 31, 2013:

 

Markets

  Number of
Buildings
    Percent
Owned(1)
    Square Feet     Occupancy
Percentage(2)
    Annualized
Base Rent(3)
    Percent of Total
Annualized Base Rent
 
                (in thousands)           (in thousands)        

UNCONSOLIDATED OPERATING PROPERTIES:

           

IDI (Chicago, Nashville, Savannah)

    3        50.0     1,423        53.0   $ 1,631        4.1

Southern California Logistics Airport(5)

    6        50.0     2,160        99.6     7,871        20.0
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total/weighted average – unconsolidated operating properties

    9        50.0     3,583        81.1     9,502        24.1
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

OPERATING PROPERTIES IN CO-INVESTMENT VENTURES:

           

Atlanta

    1        3.6     491       100.0     1,753       4.4

Chicago

    2        20.0     1,033       100.0     3,238        8.2

Cincinnati

    3        13.6     892       100.0     2,977       7.5

Columbus

    2        5.7     451       100.0     1,356       3.4

Dallas

    3        15.3     1,186       100.0     3,622        9.1

Denver

    5        20.0     772       95.9     3,654        9.2

Indianapolis

    1        11.4     475       96.2     1,915       4.8

Louisville

    4        10.0     736       100.0     1,411        3.6

Minneapolis

    3        3.6     472       100.0     2,187       5.5

Nashville

    2        20.0     1,020       100.0     2,750        7.0

Orlando

    2        20.0     696       100.0     3,265       8.2

Pennsylvania

    1        11.4     502       100.0     1,990       5.0
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total/weighted average—co-investment operating properties

    29        14.3     8,726       99.4     30,118        75.9
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total/weighted average— unconsolidated properties

    38        24.7     12,309        94.1   $ 39,620        100.0
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)  Percent owned is based on ownership weighted by square footage, if applicable.
(2)  Based on leases commenced as of December 31, 2013.
(3)  Annualized base rent is calculated as monthly contractual base rent (cash basis) per the terms of the lease in effect, as of December 31, 2013, multiplied by 12.
(4)  Excludes total annualized base rent associated with tenants currently in free rent periods of $9.2 million based on the first month’s cash base rent.
(5)  Although we contributed 100% of the initial cash equity capital required by the venture, after return of certain preferential distributions on capital invested, profits and losses are generally split 50/50.
(6)  Excludes total annualized base rent of $1.7 million from one non-industrial property acquired for future development.

 

73


Table of Contents

Lease Expirations

Our industrial properties are typically leased to customers for terms ranging from 3 to 10 years with a weighted average remaining term of approximately 3.3 years as of December 31, 2013. Following is a schedule of expiring leases for our consolidated properties by square feet and by annualized minimum base rent as of December 31, 2013, assuming no exercise of lease renewal:

 

Year

  Number of Leases
Expiring
    Square Feet
Related to
Expiring Leases
    Percentage of
Total
Square Feet
    Annualized Base
Rent of Expiring
Leases(1)
    Percentage of
Total Annualized
Base Rent
 
          (in thousands)           (in thousands)        

2014(2)

    178        8,440        14.6   $ 35,217        13.4

2015

    162        10,199        17.6     42,062        16.0

2016

    200        10,110        17.4     44,166        16.9

2017

    143        8,223        14.2     34,223        13.1

2018

    107        6,621        11.4     30,394        11.6

Thereafter

    157        14,392        24.8     75,932        29.0
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total occupied

    947        57,985        100.0   $ 261,994        100.0
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Available or leased but not occupied

      5,187         
   

 

 

       

Total consolidated properties

      63,172         
   

 

 

       

 

(1)  Includes contractual rent changes.
(2)  Includes leases that are on month-to-month terms.

Customer Diversification

As of December 31, 2013, there were no customers that occupied more than 2.3% of our properties based on annualized base rent. The following table reflects our ten largest customers, based on annualized base rent as of December 31, 2013. These ten customers occupy a combined 6.3 million square feet or 10.0% of our consolidated properties.

 

Customer

   Percentage of
Annualized Base Rent
 

Schenker, Inc.

     2.3

Deutsche Post World Net (DHL & Excel)

     1.5

The Clorox Company

     1.3

United Stationers Supply Company

     1.1

The Glidden Company

     1.1

YRC, LLC

     1.1

Bridgestone Corporation

     1.0

Ozburn-Hessey Logistics, L.L.C

     0.9

Genco I, Inc.

     0.9

Iron Mountain

     0.9
  

 

 

 

Total

     12.1
  

 

 

 

Although base rent is supported by long-term lease contracts, customers who file bankruptcy generally have the legal right to reject any or all of their leases. In the event that a customer with a significant number of leases in our properties files bankruptcy and cancels its leases, we could experience a reduction in our revenues and an increase in allowance for doubtful accounts receivable.

We continuously monitor the financial condition of our customers. We communicate often with those customers who have been late on payments or filed bankruptcy. We are not currently aware of any significant financial difficulties of any tenants that would individually cause a material reduction in our revenues, and no customer represents more than 5% of our annual base rent.

 

74


Table of Contents

Industry Diversification

The table below illustrates the diversification of our consolidated portfolio by the industry classification of our customers based upon their NAICS code as of December 31, 2013 (dollar amounts in thousands):

 

     Number of
Leases
     Annualized
Base Rent(1)
     Percentage of
Total
Annualized
Base Rent
    Occupied
Square Feet
     Percentage of
Total Occupied
Square Feet
 
                         (in thousands)         

Manufacturing

     250       $ 71,230         30.8     17,138         29.6

Wholesale Trade

     229         48,733         21.1     12,741         22.0

Transportation and Warehousing

     156         45,548         19.7     12,726         21.9

Retail Trade

     92         22,992         10.0     6,667         11.5

Administrative Support and Waste Management Services

     43         9,268         4.0     2,337         4.0

Professional, Scientific and Technical Services

     55         10,754         4.6     1,955         3.3

Media and Information

     16         3,963         1.7     567         1.0

Rental Companies

     15         3,498         1.5     917         1.6

Health Care and Social Assistance

     11         4,168         1.8     629         1.1

Other

     80         11,209         4.8     2,308         4.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     947       $ 231,363         100.0     57,985         100.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)  Annualized base rent is calculated as monthly contractual base rent (cash basis) per the terms of the lease in effect, as of December 31, 2013, multiplied by 12.

Indebtedness

As of December 31, 2013, 63 of our 400 consolidated properties, with a combined gross book value of $674.2 million were encumbered by mortgage indebtedness totaling $285.7 million (excluding net premiums). See “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 5—Outstanding Indebtedness” and the accompanying Schedule III beginning on page F-45 for additional information.

 

75


Table of Contents

DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS

This section reflects information with respect to the directors and executive officers of DCT. Because DCTOP is managed by DCT, and DCT conducts substantially all of its operations through DCTOP, DCTOP refers to DCT’s executive officers as its executive officers, and although as a partnership DCTOP does not have a board of directors, it refers to DCT’s Board of Directors as its Board of Directors.

Board of Directors

Below is information with respect to our Directors.

Thomas G. Wattles. Director since 2003

Mr. Wattles, age 62, is a cofounder of the Company and has been our Executive Chairman since 2003. Mr. Wattles also served as our Chief Investment Officer from March 2003 to September 2005. Mr. Wattles was a principal of both Dividend Capital Group LLC and Black Creek Capital, LLC, each a Denver-based real estate investment firm, from February 2003 until June 2008. From March 1997 to May 1998, Mr. Wattles served as Chairman of ProLogis, and served as Co-Chairman and Chief Investment Officer from November 1993 to March 1997. Mr. Wattles was a Managing Director of Security Capital Group Incorporated and served in various capacities including Chief Investment Officer from January 1991 to December 2002. Mr. Wattles is currently a director of (i) Regency Centers Corporation, chairing its investment committee and serving on its audit committee; and (ii) Columbia Property Trust, serving on its audit and operations committees. Mr. Wattles holds a Bachelor’s degree and an M.B.A. degree from Stanford University.

Philip L. Hawkins. Director since 2006

Mr. Hawkins, age 58, has been our Chief Executive Officer since October 2006. Mr. Hawkins was the President, Chief Operating Officer and a director of CarrAmerica Realty Corporation, where he had been employed from 1996 until July 2006. CarrAmerica was a public REIT focused on the acquisition, development, ownership and operation of office properties in select markets across the United States and was acquired by a fund managed by The Blackstone Group in July 2006. Prior to joining CarrAmerica, Mr. Hawkins spent approximately 13 years with LaSalle Partners (now Jones Lang LaSalle), a real estate services company where he was a director and held various positions involving real estate investment, development, leasing and management. Mr. Hawkins serves as a director of Corporate Office Properties Trust, a publicly traded office REIT that focuses primarily on serving the specialized requirements of U.S. government agencies and defense contractors. He is a member of the National Association of Real Estate Investment Trusts (NAREIT) and the Urban Land Institute. He is a trustee of Hamilton College and served as a director of SBA Communications Corporation, a publicly traded wireless tower owner and operator, from August 2004 to May 2009. He holds an M.B.A. from the University of Chicago Graduate School of Business and a Bachelor of Arts degree from Hamilton College.

Marilyn A. Alexander. Director since 2011

Ms. Alexander, age 62, has over thirty years of experience in a range of industries, including real estate, hospitality and management consulting. Ms. Alexander has been a consultant since 2003, currently serving as principal of Alexander & Friedman LLC, a management consulting company that she founded. She previously served in executive roles in finance, brand management, marketing and revenue management at The Walt Disney Company and Marriott Corporation. Since 2008, she has served as a director of Tutor Perini Corporation, a publicly traded leading civil and building construction company offering diversified general contracting and design/build services to private clients and public agencies in the U.S. and abroad. She is also currently a director of Torchmark Corporation. From November 2004 until its sale in February 2007, Ms. Alexander served as a trustee of Equity Office Properties Trust. Ms. Alexander also served as a director of New Century Financial

 

76


Table of Contents

Corporation, a formerly publicly traded REIT, from May 2005 to April 2007. She also formerly was a trustee of PIMCO Variable Insurance Trust, PIMCO Commercial Securities Trust, Inc. and PIMCO Strategic Global Government Fund, Inc. from October 2006 to August 2007. Ms. Alexander earned a Bachelor’s degree at Georgetown University in Philosophy and an MBA at the Wharton Graduate School of the University of Pennsylvania; she is a licensed CPA in the Commonwealth of Virginia.

Thomas F. August. Director since 2006

Mr. August, age 65, has served as President and Chief Executive Officer of Equity Office Properties Trust since July 2010 and served from October 2009 to July 2010 as its Chairman. Equity Office Properties Trust is currently a private company controlled by The Blackstone Group and is one of the largest owners and managers of office properties in the United States. From February 2008 to August 2009 he served as the Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of Behringer Harvard REIT I, Inc., and from May 2009 through August 2009 he also served as Chief Executive Officer of Behringer Harvard REIT I, Inc. He served as a trustee of Brandywine Realty Trust, a publicly traded REIT, from January 2006 through February 2008. From October 1999 to January 2006, Mr. August had served as President, Chief Executive Officer and a trustee of Prentiss Properties Trust. Prior to that time, he was President and Chief Operating Officer of Prentiss since Prentiss’ initial public offering in October 1996. From 1992 to 1996, Mr. August served as President and Chief Operating Officer of a Prentiss affiliate, Prentiss Properties Limited, Inc. From 1987 to 1992, Mr. August served as Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Prentiss’ predecessor company. From 1985 to 1987, Mr. August served in executive capacities with Cadillac Fairview Urban Development, Inc. Prior to joining Cadillac Fairview Urban Development in 1985, Mr. August was Senior Vice President of Finance for Oxford Properties, Inc., in Denver, Colorado, an affiliate of a privately-held Canadian real estate firm. Previously, he was a Vice President of Citibank, responsible for real estate lending activities in the Midwest. Mr. August has more than 40 years of experience as a senior executive in the real estate industry, including prior experience as the chief executive officer of a publicly traded REIT. Mr. August holds a Bachelor’s degree from Brandeis University and an M.B.A. degree from Boston University.

John S. Gates, Jr. Director since 2006

Mr. Gates, age 60, has served since August 2010 as the Chairman of the Board of the Regional Transportation Authority of Metropolitan Chicago which is responsible for all passenger transit operations in the metropolitan Chicago area. Mr. Gates has also served since January 1, 2005 as the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of PortaeCo, a private investment and asset management company. In 1984, Mr. Gates co-founded CenterPoint Properties Trust and served as Co-Chairman and Chief Executive Officer for 22 years. During that period, CenterPoint became one of the largest private property owners in the Metropolitan Chicago Region and the nation’s first publicly traded industrial property REIT. In March 2006, CenterPoint was acquired by the California Public Employees Retirement System and Jones Lang LaSalle for approximately $3.5 billion. In 1979, Mr. Gates joined CB Richard Ellis, and in 1981 co-founded the Chicago office of Jones Lang Wootton (now Jones Lang LaSalle), a global commercial property investment firm. Mr. Gates is a director of The Davis Funds and numerous not-for- profit institutions. Mr. Gates has more than 30 years of experience in the industrial real estate industry. Mr. Gates graduated from Trinity College with a Bachelor’s degree in Economics.

Raymond B. Greer. Director since 2010

Mr. Greer, age 51, has over thirty years of logistics and transportation experience. Mr. Greer has served since February 2011 as the President of BNSF Logistics, LLC, which is an international third party logistics provider and a wholly-owned subsidiary of Burlington Northern Santa Fe, LLC, a Berkshire Hathaway company. From March 2005 to January 2010, Mr. Greer served as President and Chief Executive Officer of Greatwide Logistics Services, a non-asset based logistics and transportation services company. Greatwide and its senior lenders filed a Chapter 11 bankruptcy filing in October 2008 to restructure Greatwide’s debt and permit a purchase of the business. From December 2002 to March 2005, Mr. Greer served as President and Chief Executive Officer for

 

77


Table of Contents

Newgistics, Inc., a reverse logistics company. Mr. Greer served as President of Global Network Solutions and Services for i2 Technologies, Inc., a supply chain management software and services company, from February 2002 to November 2002. Mr. Greer has also held senior management positions for Ryder and FedEx Corporation. From June 2005 to April 2007, Mr. Greer served as a director of Kitty Hawk, Inc., a publicly traded air cargo company. Mr. Greer received a Bachelor of Science in Mathematics from the University of Utah and an Executive Masters in Information Systems & Telecommunications from Christian Brothers University.

Tripp H. Hardin. Director since 2002

Mr. Hardin, age 52, is Senior Vice President of Investments with CBRE, Inc., which is the world’s largest real estate services firm. Prior to joining CBRE in 2002, Mr. Hardin was a principal of Trammell Crow Krombach Partners and was associated with them or their predecessor company since 1986. He has over 28 years of experience in the commercial real estate industry, focusing primarily on the sale and leasing of industrial and office properties. He also has extensive experience in real estate investment and build-to-suit transactions. Mr. Hardin graduated from Stanford University with a Bachelor of Science degree in Industrial Engineering.

John C. O’Keeffe. Director since 2002

Mr. O’Keeffe, age 54, has been active in the construction industry since 1983 and has been associated with Wm. Blanchard Co., a construction management firm located in Springfield, NJ, since 1987. He has served in a variety of capacities at the firm, including estimating, contract negotiation and contract management, contractor management, project management and for the past 10 years, in an executive capacity, managing a variety of large scale healthcare projects. Presently, Mr. O’Keeffe serves as Vice President, Construction Operations for Wm. Blanchard Co. Mr. O’Keeffe graduated from Denison University with a Bachelor of Arts degree.

Bruce L. Warwick. Director since 2005

Mr. Warwick, age 75, is Vice Chairman of Related Companies, a private real estate development firm. Mr. Warwick oversees the development of various real estate development projects, including the development of Hudson Yards, a 12 million square foot mixed-use project on the west side of Manhattan. He joined Related Companies in 1998 as President of Columbus Centre Developer LLC, the division of Related Companies charged with the development and construction of Time Warner Center in New York City. Prior to joining Related Companies in 1998, Mr. Warwick served as Vice Chairman of The Galbreath Company, overseeing development and management in the East Region. He has been in the development and construction business for over 45 years, developing properties in both Puerto Rico and in the Northeast United States. He received a Bachelor of Arts degree from Colgate University.

Executive Officers

Below is information with respect to our executive officers.

Jeffrey F. Phelan, age 53, has been President of our company since January 2013. Mr. Phelan previously served as National President of Development and Managing Director, West Region, from March 2010 until January 2013. Prior to joining our company, from November 2006 through March 2010, Mr. Phelan was a principal of Phelan Development Company, a privately held real estate company that Mr. Phelan founded in November 2006, headquartered in Southern California that developed and managed industrial, office and retail properties. Prior to founding Phelan Development, Mr. Phelan was a partner at Panattoni Development Company from 1994 to 2006 where he founded their operations in Southern California and developed over 20 million square feet of commercial real estate. Panattoni Development Company is a development company specializing in industrial, office and retail projects. Mr. Phelan received a Bachelor’s degree in Business Administration with a concentration in Real Estate from California State University.

 

78


Table of Contents

Teresa L. Corral, age 50, has been our company’s Executive Vice President of Investments and Portfolio Management since May 2011. Ms. Corral oversees our company’s investment and disposition process as well as portfolio management of our balance sheet and joint venture assets. Prior to this role, Ms. Corral served as our company’s Senior Vice President of Institutional Capital Management and Dispositions since 2006. Ms. Corral brings more than 26 years of experience in acquisitions, due diligence, and underwriting institutional and privately-held real estate to our company. Prior to joining our company in 2003, Ms. Corral served in various positions with Clayton, Williams, and Sherwood Inc., a private investment firm. She also worked for various affiliates of Clayton, Williams, and Sherwood Inc., including CWS Communities Trust, a private REIT. Ms. Corral received her Bachelor’s degree in Business Administration and Economics from St. Mary’s College of California.

Neil P. Doyle, age 44 has been our company’s Managing Director, Central Region, since April 2012. He is responsible for all property operations, investments and development in the Central Region. Prior to joining our company in 2012, Mr. Doyle served in various positions at CenterPoint Properties Trust since 1997. Most recently, from February 2007 through June 2011, he served as Executive Vice President of Infrastructure and Transportation at CenterPoint Properties Trust with responsibility for the sourcing and execution of logistics-based industrial parks in key U.S. intermodal and port markets. Prior to this role, Mr. Doyle served as Senior Vice-President of Development at CenterPoint from July 2005 through January 2007. Mr. Doyle holds a Bachelor of Science degree in Civil Engineering from Marquette University.

Matthew T. Murphy, age 49, has been Chief Financial Officer of our company since September 2011. Mr. Murphy has been with our company or an affiliate since 2003, previously serving as interim Chief Financial Officer, Executive Vice President and Treasurer. Mr. Murphy has served as Treasurer of our company since October 2006 and, from May 2003 through October 2006, served as the Controller of Dividend Capital Advisors LLC, which was our external advisor at the time. From February 1998 until joining our former external advisor in May 2003, Mr. Murphy was a Vice President and Controller of Pritzker Residential, LLC, a privately-owned, fully-integrated multi-family real estate investment company. Prior to joining Pritzker, Mr. Murphy served in various positions with Security Capital Group and its affiliates, including Archstone-Smith Trust and ProLogis. Prior to joining Security Capital Group, in 1992, Mr. Murphy was a staff accountant with Coopers and Lybrand. Mr. Murphy served as a director of Versus Capital Multi-Manager Real Estate Income Fund LLC from July 2012 through August 2013. Mr. Murphy holds a Bachelor’s degree in Accounting from Colorado State University.

Charla Rios, age 52, has been our company’s Executive Vice President of Property Management since June 2011. Ms. Rios is responsible for planning, directing and managing our property management activities and leading our company’s property management teams. Ms. Rios brings over 25 years of property management experience to our company. Prior to joining our company in 2011, Ms. Rios served as First Vice President and West Regional Property Manager of Prologis, Inc. for 16 years. Before joining Prologis, Inc., Ms. Rios was a Senior Property Manager with Trammell Crow Company in Phoenix, managing a portfolio for Pension Fund Advisors and institutional owners.

Michael J. Ruen, age 47, has been a Managing Director of our company since early 2007 and prior to that a Senior Vice President of our company since 2005. From February 2004 through October 2006, Mr. Ruen was an employee of Dividend Capital Advisors LLC, which was our external advisor at the time. Since the latter part of 2008, Mr. Ruen has overseen the Eastern Region of our company, responsible for all property operations, investments and development in that region. Prior to that time, Mr. Ruen was responsible for capital deployment in the Eastern United States and development. Prior to joining our former advisor in February 2004, he was employed for nine years in various positions with ProLogis. Before leaving ProLogis, Mr. Ruen had been a First Vice President and Market Officer with responsibility over development, acquisition and portfolio operations for the state of Tennessee. Prior to that, he had similar responsibilities for Denver, Birmingham and Chattanooga after managing the leasing and marketing activities for Atlanta. Prior to joining ProLogis, Mr. Ruen was with CB Richard Ellis-Atlanta and was responsible for various institutional account activities including general brokerage. He received his Bachelor of Sciences degree from the University of Alabama and an M.B.A. from Georgia State University.

 

79


Table of Contents

John G. Spiegleman, age 46, has been Executive Vice President and General Counsel of our company since May 2011. Mr. Spiegleman is responsible for all legal, risk management and compliance matters. Mr. Spiegleman brings more than 21 years of experience to our company. Prior to joining our company in 2011, Mr. Spiegleman served as a Senior Vice President and Assistant General Counsel of Aimco from January 2006 to April 2011. While at Aimco, Mr. Spiegleman managed the legal aspects for all its transactions. Prior to joining Aimco, Mr. Spiegleman was Senior Vice President of Miller Global Properties for seven years. While at Miller Global, a privately-held company that owns, develops, and operates office and hotel properties throughout the world, Mr. Spiegleman served in legal and business roles. Mr. Spiegleman received his Juris Doctor from the University of Colorado, School of Law and his Bachelor’s degree in Economics from Denison University.

 

80


Table of Contents

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

Compensation Discussion and Analysis

We provide what we believe is a competitive total compensation package to our executive management team through a combination of base salary, annual cash incentive bonuses, long-term equity incentive compensation and broad-based benefits programs. This Compensation Discussion and Analysis explains our compensation objectives, policies and practices with respect to our Chief Executive Officer, our Chief Financial Officer and the other three most highly-compensated executive officers as of the end of 2013 as determined in accordance with applicable SEC rules (collectively referred to as our named executive officers or, in this “Compensation Discussion and Analysis” section, our executives). Our named executive officers are as follows: Philip L. Hawkins, Chief Executive Officer; Thomas G. Wattles, Executive Chairman of the Board; Jeffrey F. Phelan, President; Matthew T. Murphy, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer; and Michael J. Ruen, Managing Director, East Region.

Objectives of Our Executive Compensation Programs

Our compensation programs for our executives are designed to achieve the following objectives:

 

    Attract and retain top contributors to ensure that we have high caliber executives;

 

    Create and maintain a performance-driven organization, by providing upside compensation opportunity for outstanding performance and downside compensation risk in the event of performance below expectations;

 

    Align the interests of our executives and stockholders by motivating executives to increase stockholder value along with the achievement of other key corporate goals and objectives and rewarding executives when stockholder value increases;

 

    Encourage teamwork and cooperation while recognizing individual contributions by linking variable compensation to company and individual performance based on position responsibilities and ability to influence financial and organizational results;

 

    Provide flexibility and allow for discretion in applying our compensation principles in order to appropriately reflect individual circumstances as well as changing business conditions and priorities;

 

    Motivate our executives to manage our business to meet and appropriately balance our short- and long-term objectives, and reward them for meeting these objectives; and

 

    Reinforce our entrepreneurial culture.

Peer Group Data

During 2012 and 2013, the compensation committee assessed and affirmed the independence of Frederic W. Cook & Co., Inc., or F.W. Cook, a nationally recognized consulting firm, and engaged it to be the compensation committee’s independent executive compensation consultant and to conduct a competitive review of our executive compensation program. As part of F.W. Cook’s engagement, the compensation committee directed F.W. Cook to, among other things, compare our executive compensation with competitive market compensation data for two different peer groups: an asset-based peer group consisting of seven public REITs with an industrial asset class focus; and a size-based REIT peer group consisting of 14 public REITs similar in size (as defined by equity market capitalization and enterprise value) to our company, but in varying asset classes. These two peer

 

81


Table of Contents

groups, which were developed by F.W. Cook in consultation with our management and subsequently approved by the compensation committee, were comprised of the following companies:

 

Asset-Based Peers

  

Size-Based Peers

Duke Realty Corporation    American Campus Communities, Inc.
EastGroup Properties, Inc.    Colonial Properties Trust
First Industrial Realty Trust, Inc.    Diamondrock Hospitality Company
First Potomac Realty Trust    EastGroup Properties, Inc.
Liberty Property Trust    Equity One, Inc.
PS Business Parks, Inc.    Extra Space Storage Inc.
STAG Industrial, Inc.    Healthcare Realty Trust Incorporated
   LaSalle Hotel Properties
   Lexington Realty Trust
   Medical Properties Trust, Inc.
   Post Properties, Inc.
   PS Business Parks, Inc.
   Sovran Self Storage, Inc.
   Sunstone Hotel Investors, Inc.

The peer group data presented included information regarding base salary, actual and target bonus amounts, total annual compensation, long-term equity and cash incentives and total compensation. F.W. Cook also presented the same categories of information for all industrial REITs and all REITs with an enterprise value between $1.0 billion and $3.0 billion that were included in the 2011 NAREIT Compensation and Benefits Survey. For each of these categories of information, F.W. Cook presented information comparing our compensation to the compensation paid by the companies in these peer groups at the 25th, 50th and 75th percentiles for comparable positions.

For purposes of 2013 compensation, the compensation committee used this competitive market compensation data to gain a greater understanding of market practices in connection with establishing base salaries, target annual cash incentive bonus amounts and target values for annual grants of long-term equity incentive compensation, all of which were established in early 2013. The compensation committee did not target a single percentile or range of percentiles to be used consistently for all of our executives, but rather used this information in connection with a number of factors, including, among others, the individual experience and skills of, and expected contributions from, our executives, the difficulty that we would have in replacing each of our executives and current economic conditions.

Our Executive Compensation Programs

Our executive compensation primarily consists of base salary, annual cash incentive bonuses, long-term equity incentive compensation and broad-based benefits programs. Additionally, with the exception of Mr. Wattles, we have employment agreements with each of our executives that provide for payments and other benefits in connection with a termination of employment in certain circumstances or a change-in-control. Overall, we designed our executive compensation programs to achieve the objectives described above. In particular, consistent with the emphasis we place on maintaining a performance-driven organization and aligning the interests of our executives and stockholders, long-term equity incentive compensation constitutes a significant portion of our total executive compensation. We also structured our annual cash incentive bonuses and annual grants of long-term equity incentive compensation to be based on our actual performance compared to predetermined performance goals. In determining the mix of the different elements of executive compensation, we considered the mix being offered by comparable companies. We generally structured the mix of base salary, target annual cash incentive bonuses and target long-term equity incentive compensation to approximate the average mix for our peers, except that we placed a greater emphasis on long-term equity incentive compensation.

 

82


Table of Contents

For 2013, we generally kept the mix of the different elements of executive compensation consistent with the mix that we have had in prior years recognizing that each year, depending on actual performance during the year, the amount of cash incentive bonuses paid and long-term equity incentive compensation granted relative to base salary will fluctuate.

Each of the primary elements of our executive compensation is discussed in detail below, including a description of the particular element and how it fits into our overall executive compensation and a discussion of the amounts of compensation paid to our executives for 2013 under each of these elements. In the descriptions below, we highlight particular compensation objectives that are addressed by specific elements of our executive compensation program; however, it should be noted that we have designed our compensation programs to complement each other and collectively serve all of our executive compensation objectives described above. Accordingly, whether or not specifically mentioned below, we believe that, as a part of our overall executive compensation, each element, to a greater or lesser extent, serves each of our objectives.

At our 2013 annual meeting, a non-binding, advisory resolution approving the compensation paid to our named executive officers, as disclosed in our proxy statement for the 2013 annual meeting, including the Compensation Discussion and Analysis, compensation tables and narrative discussions, was approved by our stockholders, with more than 99% of the votes cast having been voted in favor of the proposal to approve such resolution. The compensation committee has considered the results of this vote and, as a result of the high percentage of votes cast in favor of this proposal, the compensation committee viewed these results as an indication of stockholders’ overall satisfaction with the manner in which we compensated our named executive officers in 2012. Accordingly, based in part on the results of this vote, the compensation committee generally has maintained the structure of our executive compensation programs that had been described in our proxy statement for the 2013 annual meeting.

2013 Total Annual Compensation

The following table sets forth the amounts of base salary, annual cash incentive bonus and annual long-term equity incentive compensation (based on the value approved) awarded by the compensation committee for each of our executives for 2013.

 

Name

   Base Salary      Annual Bonus      Annual
Equity(1)
     Total  

Philip L. Hawkins

   $ 600,000       $ 768,000       $ 1,369,000       $ 2,737,000   

Thomas G. Wattles

     260,000         162,000         364,000         786,000   

Jeffrey F. Phelan

     400,000         412,000         557,000         1,369,000   

Matthew T. Murphy

     300,000         325,000         450,000         1,075,000   

Michael J. Ruen

     260,000         214,000         489,000         963,000   

 

(1) Annual equity represents the value of the annual long-term equity incentive compensation approved by the compensation committee. All of the annual equity grants were made in the form of restricted stock or LTIP units, at the election of the executive. We valued the annual grants at $7.36 per share or unit, which was the closing stock price of our common stock on February 4, 2014, the date the awards were approved. With the exception of Mr. Wattles, each of these annual equity awards vests over four years with 25% vesting on each of the first four anniversaries of January 1, 2014, subject to continued employment with us through such date. Mr. Wattles’ equity award vests over four years with 25% vesting on each of the first four anniversaries of January 1, 2014, however, vesting is not subject to continued employment with us through such date.

The foregoing table more accurately reflects the decisions of the compensation committee with respect to our executive officers’ compensation than the Summary Compensation Table below. This primarily results from the fact that, in order to link our annual long-term equity incentive compensation to our annual performance, the compensation committee typically grants our annual long-term equity incentive compensation for a particular

 

83


Table of Contents

year in January or February of the following year. Due to the rules governing the presentation of the Summary Compensation Table, we are required to present these grants as compensation for the year in which they were granted (as opposed to the year for which they were granted). As a result, for example, the “Stock Awards” granted in February 2013 for 2012 performance are required to be reported as 2013 compensation in the Summary Compensation Table. In addition, the foregoing table does not include the equity award granted to Mr. Phelan in connection with his promotion to President effective as of January 1, 2013, as this was a one-time award in connection with his promotion.

A detailed discussion of the base salary, annual cash incentive bonus and annual long-term equity incentive compensation paid or awarded to our executives for 2013 is contained below.

Base Salary

We pay our executives a base salary, which we review and determine annually, subject to the commitments we have made to our executives in their employment agreements. We believe that a competitive base salary is a necessary element of any compensation program that is designed to attract and retain talented and experienced executives. We also believe that attractive base salaries can motivate and reward executives for their overall performance. Although base salaries are established in part based on the individual experience, skills and expected contributions during the coming year of our executives and our executives’ performance during the prior year, we do not view base salaries as primarily serving our objective of paying for performance.

The following table sets forth the annual base salaries for our executives for 2013 and 2012:

 

Named Executive Officer

   2013 Base
Salary
     2012 Base
Salary
     Percentage Change  

Philip L. Hawkins

   $ 600,000       $ 600,000         —     

Thomas G. Wattles

   $ 260,000       $ 260,000         —     

Jeffrey F. Phelan

   $ 400,000       $ 260,000         54

Matthew T. Murphy

   $ 300,000       $ 275,000         9

Michael J. Ruen

   $ 260,000       $ 260,000         —     

During 2013, we maintained base salaries at 2012 levels for Messrs. Hawkins, Wattles and Ruen. Effective January 2013, in connection with Mr. Phelan’s promotion to President, we increased his base salary to the amount set forth in the table above. The increase in base salary for each of Messrs. Phelan and Murphy was based on a number of factors including the compensation committee’s most recent review of competitive market compensation data and the base salaries of our other executive officers. Overall, base salaries for 2013 were based on the compensation committee’s review of competitive market compensation data and its conclusion that, in most cases, the amount of the base salaries for our executives remain competitive.

In setting base salary, we also took into account the commitments that we have made to our executives in their employment agreements. Under the employment agreements that were in effect for 2013, minimum annual base salaries for these executives for 2013 were established based on the annual base salaries at the time the agreements were entered into as follows: Mr. Hawkins’ minimum base salary was $600,000 per year; Mr. Phelan’s minimum base salary was $400,000 per year; Mr. Murphy’s minimum base salary was $275,000 per year; and Mr. Ruen’s minimum base salary was $260,000 per year. Annual base salary for each of Messrs. Hawkins, Phelan and Ruen for 2013 equaled the minimum base salaries in these employment agreements. We have not entered into an employment agreement with Mr. Wattles.

Annual Cash Incentive Bonuses

Our executives are eligible to receive annual cash incentive bonuses each year primarily based upon their performance. Our annual cash incentive bonuses are intended to reward our executives with currently paid compensation based on annual performance.

 

84


Table of Contents

2013 Target Bonuses

Similar to base salary, the employment agreements that we entered into with our executives provide for minimum target annual cash incentive bonuses. These agreements provided for the following minimum target annual cash incentive bonuses for 2013: Mr. Hawkins—100% of base salary; Mr. Phelan—$300,000; Mr. Murphy—$250,000; and Mr. Ruen—$200,000. The commitments in these employment agreements related to minimum target annual cash incentive bonuses, and we have discretion to establish the criteria that must be met for the annual cash incentive bonuses to be paid and may grant annual cash incentive bonuses in amounts above or below the target level based on our assessment of performance.

In February 2013, we established target annual cash incentive bonuses for each of our executives. Similar to base salary, except for Mr. Phelan, we maintained the levels of our executives’ target annual cash incentive bonuses for 2013 at 2012 levels. In connection with Mr. Phelan’s promotion to President, we increased his minimum target. Mr. Phelan’s increased target was based on a number of factors including the compensation committee’s most recent review of competitive market compensation data and the targets established for our other executive officers. For 2013, our decisions regarding the amount of the target annual cash incentive bonuses were also based on the compensation committee’s analysis of competitive market compensation data and its conclusion that the amount of the target annual cash incentive bonuses for our executives did not need to increase in order to remain competitive.

The following table sets forth the target annual cash incentive bonuses for each of our executives for 2013 and 2012:

 

Named Executive Officer

   2013 Target Bonus      2012 Target Bonus      Percentage Change  

Philip L. Hawkins

   $ 600,000       $ 600,000         —     

Thomas G. Wattles

   $ 200,000       $ 200,000         —     

Jeffrey F. Phelan

   $ 300,000       $ 200,000         50

Matthew T. Murphy

   $ 250,000       $ 250,000         —     

Michael J. Ruen

   $ 200,000       $ 200,000         —     

2013 Bonus Objectives

For 2013, consistent with 2012, a substantial majority of each executive’s target annual cash incentive bonus was linked in a formulaic manner to the achievement of specific, objectively measurable goals, with the remainder based on each executive’s achievement of more subjective goals, subject, in each case, to the compensation committee’s ability to exercise negative discretion to award executives annual bonuses that are less than what would have been earned based on the formulaic application of the predetermined objectives.

The table set forth below describes the objectives that we established for each of our executives and the percentage of that executive’s annual cash incentive bonus that was linked to the achievement of each objective.

 

Objectives

   Hawkins     Wattles     Phelan     Murphy     Ruen  

Total net operating income

     30.0     —          15.0     30.0     15.0

Regional net operating income

     —          —          15.0     —          25.0

Total capital deployment

     25.0     30.0     30.0     25.0     20.0

Regional/national capital deployment

     —          70.0     20.0     —          20.0

Asset sales/equity raises

     25.0     —          —          25.0     —     

Individual/Subjective

     20.0     —          20.0     20.0     20.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     100     100     100     100     100

We selected these specific objectives because (i) net operating income is one of the most significant financial measures that we report to investors and use to evaluate our ongoing performance, (ii) the deployment

 

85


Table of Contents

of capital through the completion of acquisitions and commencement of development projects, consistent with our investment criteria, during 2013 was one of our key strategic goals for the year and (iii) our assets sales and equity raises were expected to provide an important source of funding to be used to meet our capital deployment goals.

For each of these objectives, in February 2013, we established five different levels of performance pursuant to which executives could earn from 0-200% of the target amount of the portion of the annual cash incentive bonus attributable to that objective. The table below sets forth the goals established at each of these performance levels, actual performance for 2013 and the percentage of target earned for each objective.

 

Objectives

   Min.
(0%)
    Thresh.
(50%)
    Target
(100%)
    High
(150%)
    Max.
(200%)
    Actual     Earned % (4)  

Total net operating income (% of budget)(1)

     84     92     100     108     116     100.6     103.7

Regional net operating income (% of budget)(1)

              

West region (Phelan)

     84     92     100     108     116     99.8     98.7

East region (Ruen)

     84     92     100     108     116     98.4     90.2

Total capital deployment(2)

   $ 120      $ 220      $ 370      $ 520      $ 620      $ 535.4        157.7

Regional/National capital deployment(2)

              

West Region (Phelan)

   $ 110      $ 150      $ 190      $ 230      $ 270      $ 252.8        178.5

East Region (Ruen)

   $ 30      $ 40      $ 75      $ 110      $ 145      $ 61.9        82.6

National (Wattles)

   $ 0      $ 50      $ 100      $ 150      $ 200      $ 48.0        48.0

Assets sales/equity raises(3)

   $ 120      $ 220      $ 370      $ 520      $ 620      $ 470.9        133.6

 

(1) Represents net operating income, excluding new acquisitions and adjusted for dispositions. Regional net operating income for Messrs. Phelan and Ruen relates to net operating income, excluding new acquisitions and adjusted for dispositions, for properties in each executive’s region.
(2) Capital deployment is based on the unlevered investment in acquisitions closed during 2013 plus total projected capital committed to development and value-add projects started in 2013, excluding capital deployed for two properties acquired in a portfolio that are intended to be held short-term. Regional capital deployment for Messrs. Phelan and Ruen is based on acquisitions sourced in each executive’s region, excluding deals primarily sourced by Mr. Wattles, plus total projected capital committed to development and value-add projects started in each executive’s region in 2013. National capital deployment for Mr. Wattles is based on acquisitions sourced through Mr. Wattles with support from our acquisition teams, excluding widely marketed properties.
(3) Represent total capital raised through asset sales, excluding the sale of assets previously held through DCT Fund I, and the issuance of our equity through public offerings.
(4) To the extent performance fell between two of the established levels of performance, the percentage earned was determined based on linear interpolation between the percentages that would have been earned for the established levels of performance.

In addition, in February 2013, the compensation committee established the following objectives for each of our executives for use, together with our actual funds from operations, which we refer to as FFO, as adjusted, for 2013 as compared to a target of $0.42 per diluted share that approximately represented the midpoint of our initial guidance for 2013 of $0.40-$0.45 per diluted share, in determining the individual/subjective component of the annual cash incentive bonuses for our executives to the extent applicable:

 

Named Executive Officer

  

Objectives

Philip L. Hawkins   

Objectives relating to debt financing and dividend coverage

Jeffrey F. Phelan   

Objectives relating to transitioning into the role of President and development activities

Mathew T. Murphy   

Objectives relating to capital expenditures, debt financing and dividend coverage

Michael J. Ruen   

Objectives relating to development activities and overseeing the East Region

 

86


Table of Contents

With respect to the individual/subjective component of the annual cash incentive bonuses, the compensation committee determined that each of these executives had exceeded target performance. Based on an evaluation of the foregoing objectives, including that our FFO, as adjusted, of $0.45 per diluted share exceeded our target of $0.42 per diluted share, the compensation committee determined that the executives had earned the following percentages of their target amounts with respect to the individual/subjective component of the annual cash incentive bonuses: Mr. Hawkins—120%; Mr. Phelan—120%; Mr. Murphy—130%; and Mr. Ruen—105%.

2013 Bonus Amounts

The compensation committee determined 2013 annual cash incentive bonuses for each of the executives based on the percentage earned for each objective, the executive’s pre-established percentage weighting for each objective and the executive’s target amount, all as set forth above. The amounts earned with respect to the objectives relating net operating income, capital deployment, asset sales and equity raises, which represented from 80%-100% of the overall bonus opportunity, were determined in a formulaic manner based on actual performance as compared to the goals established in February 2013. The remainder, relating to the individual/subjective component, was determined based on the compensation committee’s evaluation of the performance of each of our executives against the objectives established for that executive, including FFO, as described above. The following are the target and actual annual cash incentive bonuses for each of our executives for 2013 and the percentages of the target annual cash incentive bonuses that were paid:

 

Named Executive Officer

   2013 Target Bonus      2013 Actual Bonus      Percentage Payout  

Philip L. Hawkins

   $ 600,000       $ 768,000         128

Thomas G. Wattles

   $ 200,000       $ 162,000         81

Jeffrey F. Phelan

   $ 300,000       $ 412,000         137

Matthew T. Murphy

   $ 250,000       $ 325,000         130

Michael J. Ruen

   $ 200,000       $ 214,000         107

Long-Term Equity Incentive Compensation

We grant long-term equity incentive awards to executives as part of our total compensation package. During 2013, the primary component of our long-term equity incentive awards was an annual grant program.

Annual Grant Program

Under the annual grant program, our executives are eligible to receive annual grants of long-term equity incentive compensation. Our annual grant program is intended to reward our executives with long-term compensation for annual performance. The primary objectives of this program are to incent our executives to achieve annual performance goals, further align the interests of our executives with our stockholders over the longer term and serve as a retention tool for our executives. We determine our annual grants based on a dollar value, and pay all of the annual grants in the form of restricted stock or LTIP units. Historically, we have used restricted stock or LTIP units for all or the majority of our long-term equity incentive compensation because we believe that these full value awards provide the best alignment with our stockholders by fully reflecting the total return we provide to our stockholders, including dividends or other distributions as well as potential future increases or decreases in our stock price.

Similar to annual cash incentive bonuses, the employment agreements that we entered into with our executives provide for minimum target values for our annual grants. The terms of their respective employment agreements provided for the following minimum target values for annual grants for 2013: Mr. Hawkins—$1,150,000; Mr. Phelan—$450,000; Mr. Murphy—$250,000; and Mr. Ruen—$450,000. The commitments in these employment agreements related to minimum target values; however, we have discretion to establish the criteria that must be met for the annual grants to be awarded and may grant awards with actual values above or below the target level based on our assessment of performance in order to fully motivate and reward our executives. These employment agreements also specify that the vesting of these awards must occur in equal annual installments over no more than five years.

 

87


Table of Contents

In February 2013, we established target values for the annual grants for each of our executives. Except for Mr. Murphy, we maintained the levels of the target values for the annual grants for 2013 for our executives at 2012 levels. The increase in target value for Mr. Murphy was based on a number of factors including the compensation committee’s most recent review of competitive market compensation data and the base salaries of our other executive officers. Overall, our decisions regarding the amount of the target values was also based on the compensation committee’s analysis of competitive market compensation data and its conclusion that, generally, the amount of the target values for annual grants for our executives did not need to increase in order to remain competitive.

The following table sets forth the target values of the annual grants for each of our executives for 2013 and 2012:

 

Named Executive Officer

   2013 Target Value      2012 Target Value      Percentage Change  

Philip L. Hawkins

   $ 1,150,000       $ 1,150,000         —     

Thomas G. Wattles

   $ 450,000       $ 450,000         —     

Jeffrey F. Phelan

   $ 450,000       $ 450,000         —     

Mathew T. Murphy

   $ 375,000       $ 250,000         50

Michael J. Ruen

   $ 450,000       $ 450,000         —     

With the exception of Mr. Wattles, half of the actual values of the annual equity awards granted to each of our executives were determined using the same overall percentage payouts relative to the targets that were used to determine the annual cash incentive bonuses, except that the amounts that could be earned ranged from 50% to 150% of the target amount for each of our executives. The remaining half of the actual values of the annual equity awards granted to each of our executives, with the exception of Mr. Wattles, were based on our total stockholder return as compared to the median total stockholder return of a selected peer group, which we refer to as the “median TSR.” The peer group consisted of Duke Realty Corporation, EastGroup Properties, Inc., First Industrial Realty Trust, Inc., Liberty Property Trust, STAG Industrial, Inc. and the SNL US REIT Industrial Index. The amounts that could be earned ranged from 50% to 150% of the target and reaching the median TSR would result in a payout equal to 100% of target. For 2013, the median TSR was 12.40% as compared to our total stockholder return of 14.21%, and as a result the compensation committee awarded a payout equal to 110.0% of target. For Mr. Wattles, all of his annual equity award granted to him was determined using the same objectives and percentage weightings that were used to determine Mr. Wattles’ annual cash incentive bonus. In each case, the equity awards were subject to the compensation committee’s ability to exercise negative discretion to award our executives equity awards that were less than what would have been earned based on the formulaic application of the predetermined objectives. Accordingly, the following are the target and actual values of the annual equity awards for each of our executives for 2013 and the percentages of the target value that were awarded:

 

Named Executive Officer

   2013 Target Value      2013 Actual Value      Percentage Payout  

Philip L. Hawkins

   $ 1,150,000       $ 1,369,000         119

Thomas G. Wattles

   $ 450,000       $ 364,000         81

Jeffrey F. Phelan

   $ 450,000       $ 557,000         124

Matthew T. Murphy

   $ 375,000       $ 450,000         120

Michael J. Ruen

   $ 450,000       $ 489,000         109

For each of our executives, the annual grant was made in the form of restricted stock or LTIP units, at the election of the executive. For purposes of determining the annual grants, we valued restricted stock and LTIP units based on $7.36 per share or unit, which was the closing stock price of our common stock on February 4, 2014, the date the awards were approved. With the exception of Mr. Wattles, each of these annual equity awards vests over four years with 25% vesting on January 1, 2015 and 25% on each January 1st thereafter, subject to continued employment with us through such date. Mr. Wattles’ equity award vests over four years with 25% vesting on January 1, 2015 and 25% on each January 1st thereafter, however, vesting is not subject to continued employment with us through such date.

 

88


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the terms of the equity awards actually made to our executives in 2014 with respect to 2013:

 

Named Executive Officer

   LTIP Units
(# of units)
 

Philip L. Hawkins

     186,006   

Thomas G. Wattles

     49,457   

Jeffrey F. Phelan

     75,680   

Matthew T. Murphy

     61,142   

Michael J. Ruen

     66,441   

Promotional/New Hire Grants

In addition to annual grants of long-term equity incentive compensation, in 2013, the compensation committee also awarded Mr. Phelan a one-time equity award, with a value of $400,000, in connection with his promotion to President on January 1, 2013. The amount of the award was based on a number of factors including the compensation committee’s most recent review of competitive market compensation data, the amount considered appropriate by the compensation committee to reflect Mr. Phelan’s increased responsibilities and similar awards granted to other executive officers in the past in connection with their hiring or promotion. This grant was made in the form of restricted stock or LTIP units, at the election of Mr. Phelan. For purposes of determining the number of shares or units, we valued restricted stock and LTIP units based on $6.49 per share or unit, which was the closing stock price of our common stock on December 31, 2012. The equity awards vests over five years with 25% vesting on December 31, 2015, an additional 25% vesting on December 31, 2016 and the remaining 50% vesting on December 31, 2017, in each case subject to continued employment with us through such date.

LTIP Units

In 2006, we established a program under our Second Amended and Restated 2006 Long-Term Incentive Plan, or the 2006 Plan, for the grant of other equity-based awards, valued by reference to shares of our common stock, consisting of equity interests in DCTOP which we refer to as “long-term incentive units” or “LTIP units.” LTIP units are a separate class of units of limited partnership interest in DCTOP. LTIP units, which can be granted either as free-standing awards or together with other awards under the 2006 Plan are valued by reference to the value of our common stock, and may be subject to such conditions and restrictions as the compensation committee may determine, including continued employment or service, computation of financial metrics and/or achievement of pre-established performance goals and objectives. If applicable conditions and/or restrictions are not attained, participants will forfeit their LTIP units. Generally, LTIP unit awards, whether vested or unvested, entitle the holder to receive distributions from DCTOP that are equivalent to the dividends and distributions that would be made with respect to the number of shares of our common stock underlying the LTIP unit award, though receipt of such distributions may be delayed or made contingent on vesting.

LTIP units are structured as “profits interests” for U.S. federal income tax purposes, and we do not expect the grant, vesting or conversion of LTIP units into common units to produce a tax deduction for us. As profits interests, LTIP units initially will not have full parity, on a per-unit basis, with common units with respect to liquidating distributions. Upon the occurrence of specified events, LTIP units can over time achieve full parity with common units and therefore accrete to an economic value for the participant equivalent to common units. This accretion to parity is driven, in part, by partnership tax rules and is based on the book capital account associated with LTIP units for tax purposes. Generally, the book capital account associated with LTIP units when they are initially issued is zero, while the book capital account associated with common units is equal on a per unit basis to the price per share of our common stock. Economic parity is reached when the book capital account of the LTIP units has grown, through special allocations of unrealized or realized gain, to be equal to that of an equal number of common units. Events that allow such special allocations under the partnership agreement and

 

89


Table of Contents

applicable federal tax regulations include: (1) our issuance of common stock, (2) the issuance by DCTOP of common or other partnership units, (3) our repurchases of significant amounts of common stock for cash, and (4) the redemption by DCTOP of common units for cash, in each case so long as the price of our common stock at the time is higher than the price on the date on which the LTIP units were initially issued. If such parity is achieved, LTIP units may be converted, subject to the satisfaction of applicable vesting conditions, on a one-for-one basis into common units, which in turn are redeemable by the holder for cash or, at our election, shares of our common stock on a one-for-one basis. However, there are circumstances under which LTIP units will not achieve parity with common units, and until such parity is reached, the value that a participant in the program could realize for a given number of LTIP units will be less than the value of an equal number of shares of our common stock and may be zero. Ordinarily, we anticipate that each LTIP unit awarded will be equivalent to an award of one share of common stock reserved under our 2006 Plan, thereby reducing the number of shares of common stock available for subsequent awards of stock options, shares of restricted stock, phantom shares, dividend equivalent rights and other equity-based awards on a one-for-one basis. However, the compensation committee has the authority to determine the number of shares of common stock underlying an award of LTIP units in light of all applicable circumstances, including performance-based vesting conditions, operating partnership “capital account allocations,” to the extent set forth in the limited partnership agreement for DCTOP, the Internal Revenue Code or applicable regulations, value accretion factors or conversion ratios.

LTIP units are designed to offer executives the same long-term incentive as shares of restricted stock, while allowing them to enjoy the more favorable U.S. federal income tax treatment available for “profits interests.” More specifically, one key disadvantage of restricted stock is that executives are generally taxed on the full market value of a grant at the time of vesting, even if they choose to hold the stock. As a result, executives often need to sell a portion of their vested shares upon vesting to pay taxes on their restricted stock awards from prior years, which may limit an executive’s ability to increase his or her equity ownership over the long term. Conversely, an executive would generally be taxed only when he or she chooses to liquidate his or her LTIP units. Therefore, an executive who wishes to hold his or her equity awards for the long term can do so in a more tax-efficient manner with LTIP units. In light of the trade-offs between increased tax efficiency and incremental economic risk involved in LTIP units as compared to restricted stock, it is generally our policy to allow eligible executives a choice between restricted stock and LTIP units on a one-for-one basis for their equity-based incentive compensation awards. We believe that the use of LTIP units (1) enhances our equity-based compensation package overall, (2) advances the goal of promoting long-term equity ownership by executives, (3) has no adverse impact on dilution as compared to restricted stock, and (4) further aligns the interests of our executives with the interests of our stockholders. We also believe that these benefits outweigh the loss of the U.S. federal income tax business-expense deduction from the issuance of LTIP units, as compared to restricted stock.

Stock Ownership Guidelines

In order to complement our long-term equity incentive compensation program and further align the interests of our executives with those of our stockholders, our board of directors adopted stock ownership guidelines that apply to our executives. See “Executive and Director Compensation—Director and Officer Stock Ownership Guidelines” below for a summary of these guidelines.

Equity Award Grant Policy

Since 2007, we have maintained an equity award grant policy in order to formalize our approach regarding the timing and pricing of equity awards made to the executives and all other employees. Under our current equity award grant policy, generally, equity awards will only be made to existing employees on an annual basis or in connection with a promotion or other extraordinary event. The amount of annual awards will be determined at a pre-scheduled meeting of the compensation committee that is expected to be held in January or February of each year. Shares of restricted stock, LTIP units or other full-value awards granted as part of the annual awards will be denominated in dollars and will be priced based on the closing price of our common stock on the date of the meeting at which they were approved. Stock options, if granted as part of the annual awards, will either be

 

90


Table of Contents

denominated in shares or dollars, will have an exercise price per share equal to the closing price of our common stock on the date of the meeting at which they were approved and, if denominated in dollars, will be for the number of shares determined using the formula approved by the compensation committee at the time of the grants. Promotional or extraordinary grants will be granted and priced on the later of the date on which the promotion or other extraordinary event occurs or the date on which the grant is approved.

Tax Treatment

We generally take into account the tax treatment of the compensation of our executives, including the expected tax treatment to our executives and whether we will be able to deduct the amount of any compensation paid as a result of limitations under Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code or otherwise. To the extent consistent with our other compensation objectives, we attempt to preserve the deductibility of the compensation that we pay to our executives. However, in order to appropriately compensate our executives and maintain the flexibility we desire in our bonus programs, we are prepared to exceed the $1 million limit under Section 162(m) for compensation to our executives. Additionally, we use LTIP units or offer to executives the choice of LTIP units (as described above under “—Our Executive Compensation Programs—Long-Term Equity Incentive Compensation—LTIP Units”) which may be more advantageous to executives from a tax perspective than other types of full-value awards, such as shares of restricted stock, but result in the loss of a tax deduction for us.

Employment Agreements

We have employment agreements with Messrs. Hawkins, Murphy, Phelan and Ruen. We entered into employment agreements with Messrs. Hawkins, Murphy and Ruen in October 2012, which superseded their previous employment agreements with us. In December 2012, we entered into an employment agreement with Mr. Phelan in connection with his appointment as President, which took effect on January 1, 2013. We do not have an employment agreement with Mr. Wattles.

For Messrs. Hawkins, Murphy and Ruen, their employment agreements, among other things, provide for severance payments generally equal to a multiple of salary and bonus plus acceleration of all time-based vesting on equity awards and continuation of coverage under our group health plan for a period of time in the event of a termination of employment by us without cause or by an executive for good reason. In return, each of these executives has agreed to non-compete, non-solicitation, non-interference and confidentiality provisions.

Commensurate with his new title as President, under his new employment agreement Mr. Phelan’s salary was increased from $260,000 to $400,000, his annual target cash bonus was increased from at least $200,000 to at least $300,000 and he was given a one-time equity grant of $400,000. Otherwise the terms of Mr. Phelan’s new employment agreement are substantially the same as his previous employment agreement. Both under Mr. Phelan’s new employment agreement and his employment agreement in place during 2012, in the event of a termination of employment by us without cause or by Mr. Phelan for good reason, the employment agreements, among other things, permit Mr. Phelan to offer to enter into a one-year consulting agreement with us on pre-negotiated terms, including non-compete, non-solicitation and confidentiality provisions that apply during the term. We then have the option to either enter into the agreement and, among other things, pay the pre-negotiated compensation to Mr. Phelan during the term or refuse Mr. Phelan’s offer and provide him with severance payments generally equal to a multiple of salary and bonus plus acceleration of all time-based vesting on equity awards and continuation of coverage under our group health plan for a period of time. For Mr. Phelan, in the event that the termination occurs within 12 months after a change-in-control, we have agreed to provide him with severance payments regardless of whether he has offered to enter into the consulting agreement. The new agreement also provides for acceleration of all time-based vesting on equity awards upon the occurrence of a change-in-control regardless of whether Mr. Phelan’s employment is terminated.

For each of our executives with whom we have entered into an employment agreement, we believe that because the severance level and/or terms of any continuing consulting agreement are negotiated up front, it makes it easier for us to terminate these executives without the need for protracted negotiations over severance.

 

91


Table of Contents

We also believe that providing pre-negotiated severance benefits for all of our executives in the event they are terminated without cause or terminate their employment for good reason following a change-in-control helps to further align the interests of our executives and our stockholders in the event of a potentially attractive proposed change-in-control transaction following which one or more of our executives may be expected to be terminated. See “Executive and Director Compensation—Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change-in-Control” for a summary of the employment agreements.

Broad-Based Benefits

All full-time employees, including our executives, may participate in our health and welfare benefit programs, including medical, dental and vision care coverage, disability insurance and life insurance, and our 401(k) plan. We do not provide any other benefits or perquisites to our executives.

Anti-Hedging and Anti-Pledging Policy

None of our executives have engaged in any hedging transactions with respect to our stock or pledged any of his shares of our stock. In 2013, we established formal anti-hedging policies that generally prohibits all of our executive officers and directors, including our executives, from engaging in any hedging transactions. Exceptions to this anti-hedging policy can only be made with the prior approval of the audit committee. We also have an anti-pledging policy that generally prohibits all of our executive officers and directors, including our executives, from pledging any shares of our stock. Exceptions to this policy can only be made with the prior approval of our compliance officer.

Executive Compensation Process

Information regarding our processes and procedures for considering and determining the compensation of our executives, including the role of any executive officers, is described below under “Executive and Director Compensation—Executive and Director Compensation Process.”

Summary of Executive Compensation

The following table sets forth certain information with respect to compensation paid for 2013, 2012 and 2011 to each of our named executive officers.

 

92


Table of Contents

SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE

 

Name and

Principal Position

  Year     Salary($)     Bonus($)     Stock
Awards
($)(1)
    Option
Awards
($)(1)
    Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation
($)(2)
    All Other
Compensation
($)
    Total ($)  

Philip L. Hawkins

Chief Executive Officer

    2013      $ 600,000      $ —        $ 1,397,709      $ —        $ 768,000      $ —        $ 2,765,709   
    2012        600,000        —          1,357,315        —          900,982        —          2,858,297   
    2011        600,000        —          754,334        195,758        740,000        —          2,290,092   

Thomas G. Wattles

Executive Chairman of the Board

   
 
2013
2012
  
  
   
 
260,000
260,000
  
  
   
 
—  
—  
  
  
   
 
571,995
375,427
  
  
   

 

—  

—  

  

  

   
 
162,000
268,531
  
  
   
 
—  
—  
  
  
   
 
993,995
903,958
  
  

Jeffrey F. Phelan

President

    2013        400,000        —          869,793        —          412,000        —          1,681,793   
    2012        260,000        —          532,339        —          248,153        —          1,040,492   
    2011        260,000        —          269,403        69,914        245,000        —          844,317   

Matthew T. Murphy

Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer

    2013        300,000        —          304,742        —          325,000        —          929,742   
    2012        275,000        —          300,342        —          377,284        —          952,626   
    2011        228,958        —          388,458        25,969        313,000        —          956,385   

Michael J. Ruen

Managing Director, East Region

    2013        260,000        —          477,367        —          214,000        —          951,367   
    2012        260,000        —          532,339        —          235,012        —          1,027,351   
    2011        260,000        —          277,103        71,911        245,000        —          854,014   

 

(1) Except as otherwise noted, amounts for 2011, 2012 and 2013 are based on the aggregate grant date fair value of stock awards and option awards granted in the fiscal years ended December 31, 2011, 2012 and 2013 respectively, in accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board Accounting Standards Codification Topic 718, Compensation—Stock Compensation, or ASC Topic 718, disregarding the estimate of forfeitures. The assumptions we used for calculating the grant date fair values are set forth in note 11 to our consolidated financial statements included in our annual report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013.
(2) For 2011, 2012 and 2013, the amounts set forth in the “Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation” column set forth the amounts earned by each of the named executive officers pursuant to our 2011, 2012 and 2013 annual cash incentive bonus program. See “—Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Annual Cash Incentive Bonuses” for a detailed description of our 2013 annual cash incentive bonus program.

 

93


Table of Contents

Grants of Plan-Based Awards

The following table sets forth certain information with respect to grants of plan-based awards for the year ended December 31, 2013 to our named executive officers.

2013 GRANTS OF PLAN-BASED AWARDS

 

Name

   Grant Date      Estimated Possible Payouts Under
Non-Equity Incentive Plan Awards(1)
     All Other Stock
Awards:
Number of
Shares of Stock
or Units (#)(2)
     Grant Date
Fair Value of
Stock and
Option Awards
($)
 
      Threshold ($)      Target ($)      Maximum ($)        

Philip L. Hawkins

     02/06/13         N/A       $ 600,000       $ 1,200,000         —         $ —     
     02/06/13         —           —           —           207,068         1,397,709   

Thomas G. Wattles

     02/06/13         N/A         200,000         400,000         —           —     
     02/06/13         —           —           —           84,740         571,995   

Jeffrey F. Phelan

     02/06/13         N/A         300,000         600,000         —           —     
     02/06/13         —           —           —           72,795         869,793   

Matthew T. Murphy

     02/06/13         N/A         250,000         500,000         —           —     
     02/06/13         —           —           —           45,147         304,742   

Michael J. Ruen

     02/06/13         N/A         200,000         400,000         —           —     
     02/06/13         —           —           —           70,721         477,367   

 

(1) Represents the payouts to our named executive officers that were possible pursuant to the portion of our 2013 annual cash incentive bonus program that was based on the achievement of performance goals relating to net operating income, acquisitions and commencement of development projects and asset sales and equity raises, which represented 80-100% of the total possible payouts to our named executive officers under the program. For each of the goals, five different levels of performance were established pursuant to which executives could earn from 0-200% of the target amount of the portion of the annual cash incentive bonus attributable to that objective.

Accordingly, the “Threshold ($)” subcolumn is not applicable. Up to 20% of the remaining total possible payouts to our named executive officers under our 2013 annual cash incentive bonus program was determined based on the achievement of goals based on the compensation committee’s evaluation of performance against such objectives established for the given executive. The actual amounts paid pursuant to the 2013 annual cash incentive bonus program are set forth in the Summary Compensation Table above in the “Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation” column. See “—Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Annual Cash Incentive Bonuses” for a detailed description of our annual cash incentive bonus program.

 

(2) All awards were grants of LTIP units and were made under the 2006 Plan. The total number of LTIP units granted were based on the dollar value of the awards approved on February 6, 2013 and the closing price of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange on February 6, 2013.

Discussion of Summary Compensation and Grants of Plan-Based Awards Tables

Our executive compensation policies and practices, pursuant to which the compensation set forth in the Summary Compensation Table and the 2013 Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table was paid or awarded, are described above under “—Compensation Discussion and Analysis.” A summary of certain material terms of our compensation plans and arrangements is set forth below.

In 2013, we granted equity awards to our named executive officers under the 2006 Plan, as described in the 2013 Grants of Plan-Based Awards table. Each stock option granted has a term of ten-years from its grant date. Generally, to the extent vested, each stock option is exercisable during the term of the option while the grantee maintains a service relationship with us and for a period of three months thereafter, unless such termination is upon death or disability, in which case the grantee or his or her heir(s) may continue to exercise the stock option for a period of one year thereafter. With the exception of Mr. Wattles, each of the equity awards granted in 2013

 

94


Table of Contents

vests over four years with 25% vesting on January 1, 2014 and 25% on each January 1st thereafter based on continued employment; provided that vesting of each is also subject to acceleration in connection with a change-in-control as described below under “—Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change-in-Control.” Mr. Wattles’ equity award vests over four years with 25% vesting on January 1, 2014 and 25% on each January 1st thereafter, however, vesting is not subject to continued employment with us through such date. Generally, we pay distributions and dividends to holders of all LTIP units and shares of restricted stock, whether vested or not, at the same rate per share as the dividends per share paid to our common stockholders. The terms of the LTIP units are described above under “—Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Long-Term Equity Incentive Compensation—LTIP Units.”

The terms of employment agreements and change-in-control agreements that we have entered into with our executives are described below under “—Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change-in-Control.”

Outstanding Equity Awards

The following table sets forth certain information with respect to outstanding equity awards at December 31, 2013, with respect to our named executive officers.

OUTSTANDING EQUITY AWARDS AT FISCAL YEAR-END 2013

 

     Option Awards      Stock Awards  

Name

   Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options (#)
Exercisable
     Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options (#)
Unexercisable
    Option
Exercise Price
($)
     Option
Expiration
Date
     Number of
Shares or Units
of Stock That
Have Not
Vested (#)
    Market Value
of Shares or
Units of Stock
That Have Not
Vested ($)(1)
 

Philip L. Hawkins

     200,698         —        $ 11.46         01/11/2017        
     359,375         —          8.64         02/11/2018        
     75,000         —          3.41         02/10/2019        
     111,691         37,230 (2)      4.56         02/11/2020        
     59,036         59,036 (3)      5.55         02/03/2021        
                45,395 (4)    $ 323,666   
                70,630 (5)      503,592   
                188,167 (6)      1,341,631   
                207,068 (7)      1,476,395   

Thomas G. Wattles

     273,438         —          8.64         2/11/2018        
     350,000         —          3.41         2/10/2019        
                52,046 (6)      371,088   
                84,740 (7)      604,196   

Jeffrey F. Phelan

     —           21,084 (3)      5.55         02/03/2021        
                61,633 (10)      439,443   
                143,403 (9)      1,022,463   
                25,225 (5)      179,854   
                73,799 (6)      526,187   
                72,795 (7)      519,028   

Matthew T. Murphy

     8,726         —          11.46         01/11/2017        
     31,250         —          8.64         02/11/2018        
     32,000         —          3.41         02/10/2019        
     12,086         4,029 (2)      4.56         02/11/2020        
     7,832         7,831 (3)      5.55         02/03/2021        
                4,913 (4)      35,030   
                9,369 (5)      66,801   
                41,637 (6)      296,872   
                45,147 (7)      321,898   
                61,100 (8)      435,643   

 

95


Table of Contents
     Option Awards      Stock Awards  

Name

   Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options (#)
Exercisable
     Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options (#)
Unexercisable
    Option
Exercise Price
($)
     Option
Expiration
Date
     Number of
Shares or Units
of Stock That
Have Not
Vested (#)
    Market Value
of Shares or
Units of Stock
That Have Not
Vested ($)(1)
 

Michael J. Ruen

     47,993         —          11.46         01/11/2017        
     140,625         —          8.64         02/11/2018        
     110,000         —          3.41         02/10/2019        
     43,705         14,568 (2)      4.56         02/11/2020        
     21,687         21,686 (3)      5.55         02/03/2021        
                17,764 (4)      126,657   
                25,946 (5)      184,995   
                73,799 (6)      526,187   
                70,721 (7)      504,241   

 

(1) Based on a price of $7.13 per share/unit, which was the closing price on the New York Stock Exchange of one share of our common stock on December 31, 2013. Assumes that the value of LTIP units on a per unit basis is equal to the per share value of our common stock.
(2) Represents the unvested portion of stock options to purchase the following number of shares of common stock, which were granted on February 11, 2010 under the 2006 Plan: Mr. Hawkins—148,921 shares; Mr. Murphy—16,115 shares; and Mr. Ruen—58,273 shares. The total number of shares originally subject to the stock options were subject to vesting over four years with 25% vesting on January 1, 2011, and 25% on January 1 of each of the following three years based on continued employment.
(3) Represents the unvested portion of stock options to purchase the following number of shares of common stock, which were granted on February 3, 2011 under the 2006 Plan: Mr. Hawkins—118,072 shares; Mr. Phelan—42,169 shares; Mr. Murphy—15,663 shares; and Mr. Ruen—43,373 shares. The total number of shares originally subject to the stock options were subject to vesting over four years with 25% vesting on January 1, 2012, and 25% on January 1 of each of the following three years based on continued employment.
(4) Represents the unvested portion of the following equity awards that were granted on February 25, 2010 under the 2006 Plan: Mr. Hawkins—181,579 LTIP units; Mr. Murphy—19,649 LTIP units; and Mr. Ruen—71,053 LTIP units. The total number of LTIP units originally granted were subject to vesting over four years with 25% vesting on January 1, 2011, and 25% on January 1 of each of the following three years based on continued employment.
(5) Represents the unvested portion of the following equity awards that were granted on February 3, 2011 under the 2006 Plan: Mr. Hawkins—141,261 LTIP units; Mr. Phelan—50,450 LTIP units; Mr. Murphy—18,739 LTIP units; and Mr. Ruen—51,892 LTIP units. The total number of LTIP units originally granted were subject to vesting over four years with 25% vesting on January 1, 2012, and 25% on January 1 of each of the following three years based on continued employment.
(6) Represents the unvested portion of the following equity awards that were granted on February 23, 2012 under the 2006 Plan: Mr. Hawkins—250,890 LTIP units; Mr. Wattles—69,395; Mr. Phelan—98,399 LTIP units; Mr. Murphy—55,516 LTIP units; and Mr. Ruen—98,399 LTIP units. With the exception of Mr. Wattles, the total number of LTIP units originally granted were subject to vesting over four years with 25% vesting on January 1, 2013, and 25% on January 1 of each of the following three years based on continued employment. Mr. Wattles’ equity award vests over four years with 25% vesting on each of the first four anniversaries of January 1, 2013, however, vesting is not subject to continued employment with us through such date.
(7)

Represents the unvested portion of the following equity awards that were granted on February 21, 2013 under the 2006 Plan: Mr. Hawkins—207,068 LTIP units; Mr. Wattles—84,740; Mr. Phelan—72,795 LTIP units; Mr. Murphy—45,147 LTIP units; and Mr. Ruen—70,721 LTIP units. With the exception of Mr. Wattles, the total number of LTIP units originally granted were subject to vesting over four years with 25% vesting on January 1, 2014, and 25% on January 1 of each of the following three years based on

 

96


Table of Contents
  continued employment. Mr. Wattles’ equity award vests over four years with 25% vesting on each of the first four anniversaries of January 1, 2014, however, vesting is not subject to continued employment with us through such date.
(8) Represents the unvested portion of 61,100 LTIP units granted on September 30, 2011 that vest 25% on September 18, 2014, 25% on September 18, 2015, and 50% on September 18, 2016 based on continued employment.
(9) Represents the unvested portion of 191,204 LTIP units granted on March 31, 2010 that vest 25% on March 30, 2013, 25% on March 30, 2014, and 50% on March 30, 2015 based on continued employment.
(10) Represents 61,633 LTIP units granted on January 1, 2013 that vest 25% on December 31, 2015, 25% on December 31, 2016, and 50% on December 31, 2017 based on continued employment.

Option Exercises and Stock Vested

The following table sets forth the aggregate number of options to purchase shares of our common stock exercised by our named executive officers in 2013 and the aggregate number of shares of common stock and LTIP units that vested in 2013. The value realized on exercise is the product of (1) the closing price on the New York Stock Exchange of a share of common stock on the date of exercise minus the exercise price, multiplied by (2) the number of shares of common stock underlying exercised options. The value realized on vesting is the product of (1) the closing price on the New York Stock Exchange of a share of common stock on the vesting date (or, if there were no reported sales on such date, the most recent previous date on which there were reported sales), multiplied by (2) the number of shares/LTIP units vesting.

2013 OPTION EXERCISES AND STOCK VESTED

 

     Option Awards      Stock Awards  

Name

   Number of
Shares Acquired
on Exercise

(#)
     Value Realized
on Exercise

($)
     Number of
Shares Acquired
on Vesting

(#)
     Value Realized
on Vesting

($)
 

Philip L. Hawkins

     —         $ —           244,007       $ 1,619,819   

Thomas G. Wattles

     —           —           17,349         112,595   

Jeffrey F. Phelan

     21,085         39,429         122,736         864,198   

Matthew T. Murphy

     —           —           56,460         384,532   

Michael J. Ruen

     —           —           109,188         732,773   

Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change-in-Control

The following is a description of the material terms of our employment agreements with our named executive officers.

Philip L. Hawkins

On October 9, 2012, we entered into an employment agreement with Mr. Hawkins under which he serves as our Chief Executive Officer and a director. Mr. Hawkins’ employment agreement has a three year term and provides for an annual salary of at least $600,000, annual cash bonuses with a target cash bonus of at least 100% of Mr. Hawkins’ annual salary for the applicable fiscal year and annual equity awards with a target value of at least $1,150,000; provided that the amount of the actual cash bonuses paid and the value of the actual equity awards granted will be made by us, in our sole discretion, based on such factors relating to the performance of Mr. Hawkins or DCT Industrial Trust as we deem relevant and, in each case, may be more or less than the target amount. Generally, if Mr. Hawkins is terminated for any reason, under the employment agreement he will be subject to the following continuing obligations after termination: (1) noncompetition with us for one year (unless

 

97


Table of Contents

employment is terminated (i) upon or after termination of the term of employment or (ii) by us without cause or Mr. Hawkins for good reason in connection with or within 18 months after a change-in-control, in which case the noncompetition provision will not extend beyond termination of employment); (2) nonsolicitation and non-hiring of our employees for one year; (3) non-interference with our business for one year; (4) nondisparagement of us for one year; and (5) cooperation with us in connection with future claims or investigations. The employment agreement also provides for the following payments and benefits to Mr. Hawkins in connection with the termination of his employment with us or if we experience a change-in-control:

 

    Change-in-control without termination. Upon a change-in-control while Mr. Hawkins is employed by us that occurs during or after the expiration of the term of employment under the agreement, all of Mr. Hawkins’ outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest upon a change-in-control; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. 

 

    Termination without cause or for good reason. If Mr. Hawkins’ employment is terminated by us without cause or by Mr. Hawkins for good reason during the term of employment or within 18 months after a change-in-control that occurs during the term of employment or thereafter, Mr. Hawkins will receive (1) annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment, (2) a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (i) two times (or, in the event of a termination within 18 months after a change-in-control, three times) annual salary plus (ii) two times (or, in the event of a termination within 18 months after a change-in-control, three times) the greater of the target cash bonus for the year of termination or the average of actual cash bonuses for the two years preceding the year of termination and (3) a pro-rata cash bonus for the year in which Mr. Hawkins’ employment was terminated based on the target annual cash bonus. Mr. Hawkins will also continue to receive his medical and welfare benefits for two years, and all of his outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. Mr. Hawkins’ receipt of these payments and benefits (other than the annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment) in connection with a termination without cause or for good reason is subject to his execution of a general release of claims with us.

 

    Termination upon death or disability. If Mr. Hawkins’ employment is terminated by us upon Mr. Hawkins’ death or disability, Mr. Hawkins will receive (1) annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment and (2) a pro-rata cash bonus for the year in which Mr. Hawkins’ employment was terminated based on the target annual cash bonus. In addition, all of Mr. Hawkins’ outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. Mr. Hawkins’ receipt of these payments and benefits (other than the annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment) in connection with a termination upon disability is subject to his execution of a general release of claims with us.

If any payments and benefits to be paid or provided to Mr. Hawkins, whether pursuant to the terms of the employment agreement or otherwise, would be subject to “golden parachute” excise taxes under the Internal Revenue Code, Mr. Hawkins’ payments and benefits under his employment agreement will be reduced to the extent necessary to avoid such excise taxes, but only if such a reduction of pay or benefits would result in a greater after-tax benefit to Mr. Hawkins.

Matthew T. Murphy

On October 9, 2012, we entered into an employment agreement with Mr. Murphy under which he serves as our Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer. Mr. Murphy’s agreement has a three year term and provides for an annual salary of at least $275,000, annual cash bonuses with a target cash bonus of $250,000, annual equity

 

98


Table of Contents

awards with a target value of at least $250,000; provided that the amount of the actual cash bonuses paid and the value of the actual annual equity awards granted will be made by us, in our sole discretion, based on such factors relating to the performance of Mr. Murphy or DCT Industrial Trust as we deem relevant and, in each case, may be more or less than the target amount. Generally, if Mr. Murphy is terminated for any reason, under the employment agreement he will be subject to the following continuing obligations after termination: (1) noncompetition with us for one year (unless employment is terminated (i) upon or after termination of the term of employment or (ii) by the Company without cause or Mr. Murphy for good reason in connection with or within 12 months after a change-in-control, in which case the noncompetition provision will not extend beyond termination of employment); (2) nonsolicitation and non-hiring of our employees for one year; (3) non-interference with our business for one year; (4) nondisparagement of us for one year; and (5) cooperation with us in connection with future claims or investigations. The employment agreement also provides for the following payments and benefits to Mr. Murphy in connection with the termination of his employment with us or if we experience a change-in-control:

 

    Change-in-control without termination. Upon a change-in-control while Mr. Murphy is employed by us that occurs during or after the expiration of the term of employment under the agreement, all of Mr. Murphy’s outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. 

 

    Termination without cause or for good reason. If Mr. Murphy’s employment is terminated by us without cause or by Mr. Murphy for good reason during the term of employment or within 12 months of a change-in-control that occurs during the term of employment or thereafter, Mr. Murphy will receive (1) annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment, (2) a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (i) one times (or, in the event of a termination within 12 months after a change-in-control, two times) annual salary plus (ii) one times (or, in the event of a termination within 12 months after a change-in-control, two times) the greater of the target cash bonus for the year of termination or the average of actual cash bonuses for the two years preceding the year of termination and (3) a pro-rata cash bonus for the year in which Mr. Murphy’s employment was terminated based on the target annual cash bonus. Mr. Murphy will also continue to receive his medical and welfare benefits for two years, and all of his outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. Mr. Murphy’s receipt of these payments and benefits (other than the annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment) in connection with a termination without cause or for good reason is subject to his execution of a general release of claims with us.

 

    Termination upon death or disability. If Mr. Murphy’s employment is terminated by us upon Mr. Murphy’s death or disability, Mr. Murphy will receive (1) annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment and (2) a pro-rata cash bonus for the year in which Mr. Murphy’s employment was terminated based on the target annual cash bonus. In addition, all of Mr. Murphy’s outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. Mr. Murphy’s receipt of these payments and benefits (other than the annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment) in connection with a termination upon disability is subject to his execution of a general release of claims with us.

If any payments and benefits to be paid or provided to Mr. Murphy, whether pursuant to the terms of the employment agreement or otherwise, would be subject to “golden parachute” excise taxes under the Internal Revenue Code, Mr. Murphy’s payments and benefits under his employment agreement will be reduced to the extent necessary to avoid such excise taxes, but only if such a reduction of pay or benefits would result in a greater after-tax benefit to Mr. Murphy.

 

99


Table of Contents

Jeffrey F. Phelan

On December 4, 2012, we entered into an employment agreement, effective January 1, 2013, with Mr. Phelan under which he serves as our President. Mr. Phelan’s agreement has a three year term and provides for an annual salary of at least $400,000, annual cash bonuses with a target cash bonus of at least $300,000 and annual equity awards with a target value of at least $450,000; provided that the amount of the actual cash bonuses paid and the value of the actual equity awards granted will be made by us, in our sole discretion, based on such factors relating to the performance of Mr. Phelan or DCT Industrial Trust as we deem relevant and, in each case, may be more or less than the target amount. Generally, if Mr. Phelan is terminated for any reason, under the employment agreement he will be subject to the following continuing obligations after termination: (1) nonsolicitation of our employees for one year; (2) nondisparagement of us for one year; and (3) cooperation with us in connection with future claims or investigations. The employment agreement also provides for the following payments and benefits to Mr. Phelan in connection with the termination of his employment with us or if we experience a change-in-control:

 

    Change-in-control without termination. Upon a change-in-control while Mr. Phelan is employed by us that occurs during or after the expiration of the term of employment under the agreement, all of Mr. Phelan’s outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest upon a change-in-control; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. 

 

    Termination without cause or for good reason. If Mr. Phelan’s employment is terminated by us without cause or by Mr. Phelan for good reason during the term of employment or within 12 months after a change-in-control that occurs during the term of employment or thereafter (a “Qualified Termination”), Mr. Phelan will receive (1) annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment, and (2) a pro-rata cash bonus for the year in which Mr. Phelan’s employment was terminated based on the target annual cash bonus.

Additionally, upon a Qualified Termination, Mr. Phelan may offer to enter into a one-year consulting agreement with us on pre-negotiated terms (the “Consulting Agreement”). Under the Consulting Agreement, Mr. Phelan would agree to consult with us for up to 10 hours per month and would be subject to non-competition provisions during the term. In exchange, we would (1) pay Mr. Phelan an annual fee equal to 5% of his “full-time consulting rate,” which equals the sum of (i) his annual salary prior to the termination of his employment plus (ii) the greater of his target cash bonus for the year of the termination of his employment or the average of actual cash bonuses for the two years preceding the year of the termination of his employment, (2) provide Mr. Phelan with continued medical and welfare benefits for 18 months and (3) permit Mr. Phelan to continue vesting in his equity awards subject to time-based vesting. In addition, if Mr. Phelan fully performed under the Consulting Agreement, then at the end of the term, he would be entitled to (1) a bonus equal to the sum of (i) his full-time consulting rate plus (ii) an amount equal to the cost to us of providing Mr. Phelan six months of coverage under the group health plans based on the rates paid by us immediately prior to the termination of his employment and (2) full acceleration of time-based vesting on all of his outstanding unvested equity awards.

If we reject Mr. Phelan’s offer to enter into the Consulting Agreement or, regardless of whether Mr. Phelan offered to enter into the Consulting Agreement, if the Qualified Termination occurred within 12 months after a change-in-control, then Mr. Phelan will also receive (1) a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (i) one times (or, in the event of a termination within 12 months after a change-in-control, two times) annual salary plus (ii) one times (or, in the event of a termination within 12 months after a change-in-control, two times) the greater of the target cash bonus for the year of termination or the average of actual cash bonuses for the two years preceding the year of termination and (2) a cash payment equal to the cost to us of providing Mr. Phelan six months of coverage under the group health plans based on the rates paid by us immediately prior to the termination. Mr. Phelan will also continue to receive his medical and welfare benefits for 18 months, and all of his outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such

 

100


Table of Contents

awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. Mr. Phelan’s receipt of these payments and benefits (other than the annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment) in connection with a termination without cause or for good reason is subject to his execution of a general release of claims with us.

 

    Termination upon death or disability. If Mr. Phelan’s employment is terminated by us upon Mr. Phelan’s death or disability, Mr. Phelan will receive (1) annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment and (2) a pro-rata cash bonus for the year in which Mr. Phelan’s employment was terminated based on the target annual cash bonus. In addition, all of Mr. Phelan’s outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. Mr. Phelan’s receipt of these payments and benefits (other than the annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment) in connection with a termination upon disability is subject to his execution of a general release of claims with us.

If any payments and benefits to be paid or provided to Mr. Phelan, whether pursuant to the terms of the employment agreement or otherwise, would be subject to “golden parachute” excise taxes under the Internal Revenue Code, Mr. Phelan’s payments and benefits under his employment agreement will be reduced to the extent necessary to avoid such excise taxes, but only if such a reduction of pay or benefits would result in a greater after-tax benefit to Mr. Phelan.

Michael J. Ruen

On October 9, 2012, we entered into an employment agreement with Mr. Ruen under which he serves as our Managing Director, East Region. The employment agreement with Mr. Ruen was amended in October, 2011 to extend its term through October 9, 2012. Mr. Ruen’s agreement provides for an annual salary of at least $260,000, annual cash bonuses with a target cash bonus of at least $200,000 and annual equity awards with a target value of at least $450,000; provided that the amount of the actual cash bonuses paid and the value of the actual equity awards granted will be made by us, in our sole discretion, based on such factors relating to the performance of Mr. Ruen or DCT Industrial Trust as we deem relevant and, in each case, may be more or less than the target amount. Generally, if Mr. Ruen is terminated for any reason, under the employment agreement he will be subject to the following continuing obligations after termination: (1) noncompetition with us for one year, or, if employment is terminated by us without cause or Mr. Ruen for good reason, six months, (unless employment is terminated (i) upon or after termination of the term of employment or (ii) by us without cause or Mr. Ruen for good reason in connection with or within 18 months after a change-in-control, in which case the noncompetition provision will not extend beyond termination of employment); (2) nonsolicitation and non-hiring of our employees for one year; (3) non-interference with our business for one year; (4) nondisparagement of us for one year; and (5) cooperation with us in connection with future claims or investigations. The employment agreement also provides for the following payments and benefits to Mr. Ruen in connection with the termination of his employment with us or if we experience a change-in-control:

 

    Change-in-control without termination. Upon a change-in-control while Mr. Ruen is employed by us that occurs during or after the expiration of the term of employment under the agreement, all of Mr. Ruen’s outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest upon a change-in-control; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. 

 

   

Termination without cause or for good reason. If Mr. Ruen’s employment is terminated by us without cause or by Mr. Ruen for good reason during the term of employment or within 12 months after a change-in-control that occurs during the term of employment or thereafter, Mr. Ruen will receive (1) annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment, (2) a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (i) one times (or, in the event

 

101


Table of Contents
 

of a termination within 12 months after a change-in-control, two times) annual salary plus (ii) one times (or, in the event of a termination within 12 months after a change-in-control, two times) the greater of the target cash bonus for the year of termination or the average of actual cash bonuses for the two years preceding the year of termination and (3) a pro-rata cash bonus for the year in which Mr. Ruen’s employment was terminated based on the target annual cash bonus. Mr. Ruen will also continue to receive his medical and welfare benefits for two years and all of his outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. Mr. Ruen’s receipt of these payments and benefits (other than the annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment) in connection with a termination without cause or for good reason is subject to his execution of a general release of claims with us.

 

    Termination upon death or disability. If Mr. Ruen’s employment is terminated by us upon Mr. Ruen’s death or disability, Mr. Ruen will receive (1) annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment and (2) a pro-rata cash bonus for the year in which Mr. Ruen’s employment was terminated based on the target annual cash bonus. In addition, all of Mr. Ruen’s outstanding unvested equity awards subject to time-based vesting conditions will fully vest; provided that any performance-based vesting conditions applicable to such awards will continue to apply in accordance with their terms. Mr. Ruen’s receipt of these payments and benefits (other than the annual salary, cash bonus and other benefits earned and accrued under the agreement prior to the termination of employment) in connection with a termination upon disability is subject to his execution of a general release of claims with us.

If any payments and benefits to be paid or provided to Mr. Ruen, whether pursuant to the terms of the employment agreement or otherwise, would be subject to “golden parachute” excise taxes under the Internal Revenue Code, Mr. Ruen’s payments and benefits under his employment agreement will be reduced to the extent necessary to avoid such excise taxes, but only if such a reduction of pay or benefits would result in a greater after-tax benefit to Mr. Ruen.

The terms cause, good reason and change-in-control are specifically defined in the agreements of Mr. Hawkins, Mr. Murphy, Mr. Phelan, and Mr. Ruen.

We do not have an employment, change-in-control, or severance agreement with Mr. Wattles. However, pursuant to the terms of our LTIP unit award agreements, all of the LTIP units issued pursuant to such agreements are subject to automatic and immediate vesting in the event of a change-in-control or upon death or disability. Additionally, pursuant to the terms of our stock option award agreements, all unexercisable stock options held by our continuing executives will automatically become exercisable in the event of a change-in-control prior to a termination of service of the executive.

 

102


Table of Contents

The following tables set forth the amounts that would have been paid to our continuing named executive officers in the event of a termination by us without cause or by the executive for good reason other than in connection with a change-in-control; upon death or disability; upon a change-in-control without termination and upon a termination by us without cause or by the executive for good reason in connection with a change-in-control occurring, in each case, as of December 31, 2013:

Philip L. Hawkins

 

Payments Upon Termination

   Without
Cause/For
Good Reason
     Death/
Disability
     Change-in-
Control (No
Termination)
     Change-in-
Control
(Termination
Without
Cause/For
Good Reason)
 

Bonus

   $ 600,000       $ 600,000       $ —         $ 600,000   

Cash Severance

     2,840,982         —           —           4,261,473   

Restricted Stock & LTIP Units Vesting(1)

     3,645,284         3,645,284         3,645,284         3,645,284   

Stock Option Vesting(2)

     188,958         188,958         188,958         188,958   

Benefits Continuation(3)

     24,857         —           —           24,857   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total(5)

   $ 7,300,081       $ 4,434,242       $ 3,834,242       $ 8,720,572   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Thomas G. Wattles

 

Payments Upon Termination

   Without
Cause/For
Good Reason
     Death/
Disability
     Change-in-
Control (No
Termination)
     Change-in-
Control
(Termination
Without
Cause/For
Good Reason)
 

Bonus

   $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —     

Cash Severance

     —           —           —           —     

Restricted Stock & LTIP Units Vesting(1)

     —           975,284         975,284         975,284   

Stock Option Vesting(2)

     —           —           —           —     

Benefits Continuation(3)

     —           —           —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total(5)

   $ —         $ 975,284       $ 975,284       $ 975,284   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Jeffrey F. Phelan

 

Payments Upon Termination

   Without
Cause/For
Good
Reason(4)
     Death/
Disability
     Change-in-
Control (No
Termination)
     Change-in-
Control
(Termination
Without
Cause/For
Good Reason)
 

Bonus

   $ 300,000       $ 300,000       $ —         $ 300,000   

Cash Severance

     700,000         —           —           1,400,000   

Restricted Stock & LTIP Units Vesting(1)

     2,686,975         2,686,975         2,686,975         2,686,975   

Stock Option Vesting(2)

     33,313         33,313         33,313         33,313   

Benefits Continuation(3)

     24,857         —           —           24,857   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total(5)

   $ 3,745,145       $ 3,020,288       $ 2,720,288       $ 4,445,145   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

103


Table of Contents

Matthew T. Murphy

 

Payments Upon Termination

   Without
Cause/For
Good Reason
     Death/
Disability
     Change-in-
Control (No
Termination)
     Change-in-
Control
(Termination
Without
Cause/For
Good Reason)
 

Bonus

   $ 250,000       $ 250,000       $ —         $ 250,000   

Cash Severance

     645,142         —           —           1,290,284   

Restricted Stock & LTIP Units Vesting(1)

     1,156,244         1,156,244         1,156,244         1,156,244   

Stock Option Vesting(2)

     22,728         22,728         22,728         22,728   

Benefits Continuation(3)

     24,857         —           —           24,857   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total(5)

   $ 2,098,971       $ 1,428,972       $ 1,178,972       $ 2,744,113   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Michael J. Ruen

 

Payments Upon Termination

   Without
Cause/For
Good Reason
     Death/
Disability
     Change-in-
Control (No
Termination)
     Change-in-
Control
(Termination
Without
Cause/For
Good Reason)
 

Bonus

   $ 200,000       $ 200,000       $ —         $ 200,000   

Cash Severance

     500,006         —           —           1,000,012   

Restricted Stock & LTIP Units Vesting(1)

     1,342,080         1,342,080         1,342,080         1,342,080   

Stock Option Vesting(2)

     71,704         71,704         71,704         71,704   

Benefits Continuation(3)

     24,857         —           —           24,857   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total(5)

   $ 2,138,647       $ 1,613,784       $ 1,413,784       $ 2,638,653   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

 

(1) For all executives, except Mr. Wattles, outstanding equity awards fully vest upon a change-in-control, the executive’s termination upon death or disability or termination by us without cause or by the executive for good reason (assuming, with respect to Mr. Phelan, that he offers to enter into the Consulting Agreement with us and we reject his offer). For Mr. Wattles, outstanding equity awards fully vest upon a change in control. As of December 31, 2013, Messrs. Hawkins, Wattles, Murphy, Phelan, and Ruen held unvested restricted common stock and unvested LTIP units as follows: Mr. Hawkins—511,260 LTIP units; Mr. Wattles—136,786 LTIP units; Mr. Phelan—376,855 LTIP units; Mr. Murphy—162,166 LTIP units; and Mr. Ruen—188,230 LTIP units. For purposes of the tables above, the value of the equity awards that vest are based on the value of unvested awards set forth in the “Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End 2013” table above.
(2) All of the executives’ outstanding stock options fully vest upon a change-in-control, the executive’s termination upon death or disability or termination by us without cause or by the executive for good reason (assuming, with respect to Mr. Phelan, that he offers to enter into the Consulting Agreement with us and we reject his offer). Information regarding unvested stock options held by our named executive officers as of December 31, 2013 is contained in the “Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End 2013” table above.
(3) Benefits continuation amounts are based on the actual expense for financial reporting purposes for the year ended December 31, 2013 for covering an employee under each of our group health plans for the entire year, assuming that the employee elected family coverage under each of these plans, less the minimum contribution required by employees participating in these plans. Mr. Phelan’s amount includes a lump sum payment equal to the cost to us of providing Mr. Phelan six months of coverage under the group health plans.
(4) Assumes Mr. Phelan offers to enter into the Consulting Agreement with us and we reject his offer.

 

104


Table of Contents
(5) In the event that any payments and benefits to be paid or provided to the executive would be subject to “golden parachute” excise taxes under the Internal Revenue Code, the executive’s payments and benefits will be reduced to the extent necessary to avoid such excise taxes, but only if such a reduction of pay or benefits would result in a greater after-tax benefit to the executive.

The amounts described above do not include payments and benefits to the extent they have been earned prior to the termination of employment or are provided on a non-discriminatory basis to salaried employees upon termination of employment. These include:

 

    Accrued salary and vacation pay;

 

    Distribution of plan balances under our 401(k) plan;

 

    Life insurance proceeds in the event of death; and

 

    Disability insurance payouts in the event of disability.

Compensation Risks

We reviewed our compensation policies and practices for employees to determine whether they encourage unnecessary or excessive risk-taking. Due to the greater emphasis placed on incentive compensation at higher levels of our organization, and the fact that these individuals are more likely to make decisions that impact corporate performance and could have a material adverse effect on us, the review focused primarily on our executive compensation policies and practices. Based on this review, we concluded that risks arising from our policies and practices for compensating employees are not reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on us. Our conclusion was based primarily on the following findings:

 

    vesting schedules for LTIP units and restricted stock cause management to have a significant amount of unvested awards at any given time;

 

    our executive compensation program has a significant focus on long-term equity compensation;

 

    the goals for our equity incentive program are aligned with long-term performance objectives/metrics, reflect a balanced mix of individual and company goals aligned with our strategic objectives, are both quantitative and qualitative and provide a comprehensive framework for assessing performance;

 

    incentive compensation opportunities are capped and therefore do not incentivize employees to maximize short-term performance at the expense of long-term performance;

 

    our compensation levels and opportunities are in keeping with appropriate competitive practice; and

 

    our executives and directors are expected to maintain an ownership interest in the Company, which aligns their interests with those of shareholders.

 

105


Table of Contents

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

For purposes of this section titled “Transactions with Related Persons,” the terms “we” and “our” refer to DCT Industrial Trust Inc. together with its consolidated subsidiaries.

Transactions with Jeffrey F. Phelan

In December 2010, we entered into two agreements whereby we acquired from third parties ownership interests of approximately 44.8% and 52.6% in two bulk industrial buildings located in Ontario, California, totaling 0.5 million square feet. Entities indirectly owned by Mr. Phelan and his wife had existing ownership interests in these buildings of approximately 21.3% and 25.0%, respectively, and acquired from third parties additional ownership interests in these buildings of approximately 19.1% and 22.4%, respectively, pursuant to these two agreements. We purchased our interests in these buildings for approximately $11.6 million (plus the assumption of our pro rata share of approximately $9.4 million of indebtedness encumbering one of the properties). Following the transaction, we owned each of these buildings as tenants-in-common with entities indirectly owned by Mr. Phelan and his wife and are entitled to earn returns on these buildings in accordance with our respective ownership interests. We control the operation and management of these buildings. In connection with this transaction, we also provided approximately $1.0 million of secured debt financing for the second building that we acquired at an interest rate of 5.75% and a maturity date of January 1, 2012; which maturity date had been extended on a month-to-month basis. The loan obligation was split among us and the entities indirectly owned by Mr. Phelan and his wife based on respective ownership interests. The full principal balance was repaid June 6, 2013. From January 1, 2013 through the repayment date, $26,236 in interest was paid on the loan.

In January 2011, we formed a joint venture, DCT Palmiowa LLC, with Iowa Investments, LLC, a company indirectly owned by Mr. Phelan and his wife. The joint venture acquired two bulk industrial buildings, totaling approximately 0.2 million square feet, located in Riverside, California from entities indirectly owned by Mr. Phelan and his wife for approximately $11.7 million. These entities indirectly owned by Mr. Phelan and his wife had acquired the two bulk industrial buildings shortly before the sale to DCT Palmiowa LLC in order to facilitate the transaction. Pursuant to the operating agreement for the joint venture, we contributed approximately 52.6% of the initial equity capital and Iowa Investments, LLC contributed the remainder, and all distributions will be made pro rata based on the parties’ capital contributions. In connection with this transaction, we also provided DCT Palmiowa LLC with an approximately $7.6 million secured loan at an interest rate of 5.75% and a maturity date of January 1, 2012; which maturity date had been extended on a month-to-month basis. The full principal balance was repaid June 6, 2013. From January 1, 2013 through the repayment date, $190,240 in interest was paid on the loan.

Transactions with Related Person Approval Policy

Our corporate governance guidelines set forth in writing our transactions with related person approval policy. According to this policy, each related person transaction must be reviewed and approved in advance by the audit committee or, for contributions, acquisitions, and dispositions of real property, the investment committee; provided that if we enter into a transaction without recognizing that it constitutes a related person transaction, this approval requirement can be satisfied if the transaction is subsequently ratified by the audit committee or investment committee, as applicable. Our transactions with related person approval policy under our corporate governance guidelines covers all transactions with related parties required to be disclosed in the proxy statement under SEC rules and all other related person transactions in which the amount involved exceeds $60,000.

Our code of business conduct and ethics sets forth in writing the standards, policies and procedures that the Company follows in situations where there is a possibility of a conflict of interest. Each employee, officer or director is expected to avoid any situation in which his or her personal interests conflict, or have the appearance

 

106


Table of Contents

of conflicting, with those of the Company. All employees, officers and directors must promptly and fully disclose the occurrence of any situation that may amount to such conflict of interest, including the existence of a personal direct or indirect financial interest in a transaction, to our general counsel. Non-employee directors are expected to make appropriate disclosures to our board and recuse themselves from board decisions with respect to transactions involving the Company to which they are an interested party. A waiver with respect to any transaction involving a director or officer that may violate our code of business conduct and ethics may be made only by the board of directors or by the nominating and corporate governance committee and must be promptly disclosed to our stockholders in accordance with all applicable laws and regulations. Our code of business conduct and ethics may or may not cover all transactions with related parties required to be disclosed in the proxy statement under SEC rules.

 

107


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF NOTES

As used in this “Description of notes,” references to the “Partnership,” we,” “our,” or “us” refer solely to DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP and not to any of our subsidiaries, and references to the “Company” refer solely to DCT Industrial Trust Inc. and not to any of its subsidiaries, unless the context otherwise requires. The notes will initially be guaranteed by the Partnership’s wholly owned subsidiaries that guarantee borrowings under our revolving credit facility (collectively, the “Subsidiary Guarantors”) and by the Company (together with the Subsidiary Guarantors, the “Guarantors”).

The Partnership issued the private notes and will issue the notes under an indenture among itself, the Guarantors and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee, dated October 9, 2013. See “Notice to investors.” The indenture complies with the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended (the “Trust Indenture Act”). The terms of the notes include those stated in the indenture and those made part of the indenture by reference to the Trust Indenture Act.

The following description is a summary of the key provisions of the notes and the indenture, does not purport to be complete and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by reference to, the actual terms and provisions of the notes and the indenture, which are filed as exhibits to the registration statement to which this prospectus forms a part and which are incorporated herein by reference. We will provide copies of these documents to you upon request. Capitalized terms used but not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings given to them in the notes, the indenture or the registration rights agreement, as applicable.

The registered holder of a note will be treated as the owner of it for all purposes. Only registered holders will have rights under the indenture.

General

The notes will be issued only in fully registered, book-entry form, in denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof, except under the limited circumstances described below under “—Book-entry, delivery and form.” The registered holder of a note will be treated as its owner for all purposes.

If any interest payment date, stated maturity date or redemption date is not a business day, the payment otherwise required to be made on such date will be made on the next business day without any additional payment as a result of such delay. The term “business day” means, with respect to any note, any day, other than a Saturday, Sunday or any other day on which banking institutions in New York, New York are authorized or obligated by law or executive order to close. All payments will be made in U.S. dollars.

The notes will be fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the Guarantors on a senior unsecured basis. See “—Guarantees” below.

The terms of the notes provide that we are permitted to reduce interest payments and payments upon a redemption of notes otherwise payable to a holder for any amounts we are required to withhold by law. For example, non-United States holders of the notes may, under some circumstances, be subject to U.S. federal withholding tax with respect to payments of interest on the notes. We will set-off any such withholding tax that we are required to pay against payments of interest payable on the notes and payments upon a redemption of notes.

Ranking

The notes and the guarantees will be our and the Guarantors’ senior unsecured obligations and will rank equally in right of payment with all of such entities’ existing and future senior indebtedness. The notes and the guarantees, however, will be effectively subordinated to all of our and the Guarantors’ existing and future secured indebtedness (to the extent of the value of the collateral securing such indebtedness). The notes and the

 

108


Table of Contents

guarantees will also be structurally subordinated to all existing and future indebtedness and other obligations, including preferred stock, of our subsidiaries that do not guarantee the notes (the “Non-Guarantor Subsidiaries”). As of December 31, 2013, we and the Guarantors had approximately $1.5 billion of indebtedness ($291.0 million of which was secured indebtedness), and our consolidated subsidiaries that will not guarantee the notes had $256.5 million of indebtedness and $25.0 million of other liabilities, all of which would have been structurally senior to the notes, and had $528.2 million of assets, representing 16.2% of the Company’s and its consolidated subsidiaries’ consolidated total assets.

Except as described under “—Certain covenants” and “—Merger, consolidation or sale,” the indenture governing the notes will not prohibit us or the Company or any of our subsidiaries from incurring secured or unsecured indebtedness in the future, nor will the indenture afford holders of the notes protection in the event of (1) a recapitalization transaction or other highly leveraged or similar transaction involving us or the Company, (2) a change of control of us or the Company or (3) a merger, consolidation, reorganization, restructuring or transfer or lease of substantially all of our or the Company’s assets or similar transaction that may adversely affect the holders of the notes. We may, in the future, enter into certain transactions such as the sale of all or substantially all of our assets or a merger or consolidation that may increase the amount of our indebtedness or substantially change our assets, which may have an adverse effect on our ability to service our indebtedness, including the notes. See “Risk factors—Risks related to the offering—Despite our substantial indebtedness, we may still incur significantly more debt, which could exacerbate any or all of the risks related to our indebtedness, including our ability to pay the principal of or interest on the notes.”

Additional notes

The notes will initially be limited to an aggregate principal amount of $275.0 million. We may from time to time, without notice to or consent of existing noteholders, create and issue additional notes having the same terms and conditions as the notes offered by this prospectus in all respects, except for the issue date and, under certain circumstances, the issue price, interest accrued prior to the issue date and first payment of interest thereon. Additional notes issued in this manner will be consolidated with and will form a single series with the previously outstanding notes, provided, however, that such additional notes may not be fungible with the previously outstanding notes for U.S. federal income tax purposes, in which case the additional notes would have a different CUSIP number than the notes offered hereby.

Interest

Interest on the notes will accrue at the rate of 4.500% per year from and including October 9, 2013 or the most recent interest payment date to which interest has been paid or provided for, and will be payable semi-annually in arrears on April 15 and October 15 of each year, beginning April 15, 2014. The interest so payable will be paid to each holder in whose name a note is registered at the close of business on the April 1 or October 1 (whether or not a business day) immediately preceding the applicable interest payment date. Interest on the notes will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months.

If any interest payment, maturity or redemption date falls on a day that is not a business day, the required payment shall be made on the next business day as if it were made on the date such payment was due and no interest shall accrue on the amount so payable from and after such interest payment, maturity or redemption date, as the case may be, to such next business day. If we redeem the notes in accordance with the terms of the indenture, we will pay accrued and unpaid interest and premium, if any, to the holder that surrenders the note for redemption. If a redemption falls after a record date and on or prior to the corresponding interest payment date, however, we will pay the full amount of accrued and unpaid interest and premium, if any, due on such interest payment date to the holder of record at the close of business on the corresponding record date (instead of the holder surrendering its notes for redemption).

 

109


Table of Contents

Maturity

The notes will mature on October 15, 2023 and will be paid against presentation and surrender thereof at the corporate trust office of the trustee unless earlier redeemed by us at our option as described under “—Redemption of the notes at the option of the Partnership” below. The notes will not be entitled to the benefits of, or be subject to, any sinking fund.

Redemption of the notes at the option of the Partnership

We may redeem the notes at our option and in our sole discretion, at any time or from time to time prior to 90 days prior to the maturity date in whole or in part, at a redemption price equal to the greater of:

 

    100% of the principal amount of the notes being redeemed; or

 

    the sum of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments of principal and interest thereon (not including any portion of such payments of interest accrued as of the redemption date) discounted to the redemption date on a semi-annual basis (assuming a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) at the Adjusted Treasury Rate (as defined below) plus 30 basis points,

plus, in each case, accrued and unpaid interest thereon to, but not including, the applicable redemption date; provided, however, that if the redemption date falls after a record date and on or prior to the corresponding interest payment date, we will pay the full amount of accrued and unpaid interest, if any (plus additional interest, if applicable), on such interest payment date to the holder of record at the close of business on the corresponding record date (instead of the holder surrendering its notes for redemption).

Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the notes are redeemed on or after 90 days prior to the maturity date, the redemption price will be equal to 100% of the principal amount of the notes being redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon to, but not including, the applicable redemption date.

As used herein:

“Adjusted Treasury Rate” means, with respect to any redemption date, the rate per year equal to the semi-annual equivalent yield to maturity (computed on the third business day immediately preceding the redemption date) of the Comparable Treasury Issue, assuming a price for the Comparable Treasury Issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) equal to the Comparable Treasury Price for such redemption date.

“Comparable Treasury Issue” means the United States Treasury security selected by the Quotation Agent as having an actual or interpolated maturity comparable to the remaining term of the notes to be redeemed that would be utilized, at the time of selection and in accordance with customary financial practice, in pricing new issues of corporate debt securities of comparable maturity to the remaining term of such notes.

“Comparable Treasury Price” means, with respect to any redemption date, (1) the bid price for the Comparable Treasury Issue (expressed as a percentage of its principal amount) at 4:00 P.M. on the third business day preceding such redemption date, as set forth on “Reuters Page 500” (or such other page as may replace Reuters Page 500), or (2) if such page (or any successor page) is not displayed or does not contain such bid prices at such time (a) the average of the Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations obtained by the trustee for such redemption date, after excluding the highest and lowest of four such Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations, or (b) if the trustee is unable to obtain at least four such Reference Treasury Dealers Quotations, the average of all Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations obtained by the trustee.

“Quotation Agent” means an independent investment banking institution of national standing appointed by the Partnership from time to time.

 

110


Table of Contents

“Reference Treasury Dealer” means, as determined by us, either (1) J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Citibank Global Markets Inc. (or an affiliate or successor of any of the foregoing that is a Primary Treasury Dealer), a Primary Treasury Dealer selected by Wells Fargo Securities LLC or its successor and one other primary U.S. government securities dealer (a “Primary Treasury Dealer”) appointed by us or (2) one Primary Treasury Dealer appointed by us and three other Primary Treasury Dealers selected by the Quotation Agent; provided, however, that if any of the foregoing shall cease to be a Primary Treasury Dealer, we will substitute therefor another Primary Treasury Dealer.

“Reference Treasury Dealer Quotations” means, with respect to each Reference Treasury Dealer and any redemption date, the average, as determined by us, of the bid and asked prices for the Comparable Treasury Issue (expressed in each case as a percentage of its principal amount) quoted in writing to the trustee by such Reference Treasury Dealer at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the third business day preceding such redemption date.

Notice of any redemption will be mailed at least 30 days but not more than 60 days before the redemption date to each holder of the notes to be redeemed. Unless we default in payment of the redemption price, on and after the redemption date, interest will cease to accrue on the notes or portions thereof called for redemption.

If we decide to redeem the notes in part, the trustee will select the notes to be redeemed (in principal amounts of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof) on a pro rata basis or such other method it deems fair and appropriate or is required by the depository for the notes.

In the event of any redemption of notes in part, we will not be required to:

 

    issue or register the transfer or exchange of any note during a period beginning at the opening of business 15 days before the mailing of a notice of redemption of the notes selected for redemption and ending at the close of business on the day of such mailing; or

 

    register the transfer or exchange of any note so selected for redemption, in whole or in part, except the unredeemed portion of any Note being redeemed in part.

If the paying agent holds funds sufficient to pay the redemption price of the notes on the redemption date, then on and after such date:

 

    such notes will cease to be outstanding;

 

    interest on such notes will cease to accrue; and

 

    all rights of holders of such notes will terminate except the right to receive the redemption price.

Such will be the case whether or not book-entry transfer of the notes in book-entry form is made and whether or not notes in certificated form, together with the necessary endorsements, are delivered to the paying agent.

We will not redeem the notes on any date if the principal amount of the notes has been accelerated, and such an acceleration has not been rescinded or cured on or prior to such date.

Certain covenants

Limitation on total outstanding debt. The notes will provide that the Partnership will not, and will not permit any Subsidiary to, incur any Debt (including, without limitation, Acquired Debt) if, immediately after giving effect to the incurrence of such Debt and the application of the proceeds from such Debt on a pro forma basis, the aggregate principal amount of all of its and its Subsidiaries’ outstanding Debt (determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP) is greater than 60% of the sum of the following (without duplication): (1) Total Assets of the Partnership and its Subsidiaries as of the last day of the then most recently ended fiscal quarter for

 

111


Table of Contents

which financial statements are available and (2) the aggregate purchase price of any real estate assets or mortgages receivable acquired, and the aggregate amount of any securities offering proceeds received (to the extent such proceeds were not used to acquire real estate assets or mortgages receivable or used to reduce Debt), by the Partnership or any Subsidiary since the end of such fiscal quarter, including the proceeds obtained from the incurrence of such additional Debt.

Secured debt test. The notes will provide that the Partnership will not, and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to, incur any Debt (including, without limitation, Acquired Debt) secured by any Lien on any of its or any of its Subsidiaries’ property or assets, whether owned on the date of the indenture or subsequently acquired, if, immediately after giving effect to the incurrence of such Debt and the application of the proceeds from such Debt on a pro forma basis, the aggregate principal amount of all of its and its Subsidiaries’ outstanding Debt (determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP) which is secured by a Lien on any of the Partnership’s or any of its Subsidiaries’ property or assets is greater than 40% of the sum of the following (without duplication): (1) Total Assets of the Partnership and its Subsidiaries as of the last day of the then most recently ended fiscal quarter for which financial statements are available; and (2) the aggregate purchase price of any real estate assets or mortgages receivable acquired, and the aggregate amount of any securities offering proceeds received (to the extent such proceeds were not used to acquire real estate assets or mortgages receivable or used to reduce Debt), by the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries since the end of such fiscal quarter, including the proceeds obtained from the incurrence of such additional Debt.

Debt service test. The notes also will provide that the Partnership will not, and will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to, incur any Debt (including without limitation Acquired Debt) if the ratio of Consolidated Income Available for Debt Service to Annual Debt Service Charge for the period consisting of the four consecutive fiscal quarters most recently ended prior to the date on which such additional Debt is to be incurred shall have been less than 1.5:1 on a pro forma basis after giving effect to the incurrence of such Debt and the application of the proceeds from such Debt (determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP), and calculated on the following assumptions: (1) such Debt and any other Debt (including, without limitation, Acquired Debt) incurred by the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries since the first day of such four-quarter period had been incurred, and the application of the proceeds from such Debt (including to repay or retire other Debt) had occurred, on the first day of such period; (2) the repayment or retirement of any other Debt of the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries since the first day of such four-quarter period had occurred on the first day of such period (except that, in making this computation, the amount of Debt under any revolving credit facility, line of credit or similar facility will be computed based upon the average daily balance of such Debt during such period); and (3) in the case of any acquisition or disposition by the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries since the first day of such four-quarter period, whether by merger, stock purchase or sale or asset purchase or sale or otherwise, such acquisition or disposition had occurred as of the first day of such period with the appropriate adjustments with respect to such acquisition or disposition being included in such pro forma calculation.

If the Debt giving rise to the need to make the calculation described above or any other Debt incurred after the first day of the relevant four-quarter period bears interest at a floating rate, then, for purposes of calculating the Annual Debt Service Charge, the interest rate on such Debt will be computed on a pro forma basis by applying the average daily rate which would have been in effect during the entire four-quarter period to the greater of the amount of such Debt outstanding at the end of such period or the average amount of such Debt outstanding during such period.

For purposes of the foregoing, Debt will be deemed to be incurred by the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries whenever the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries shall create, assume, guarantee or otherwise become liable in respect thereof.

Maintenance of total unencumbered assets. The notes will provide that the Partnership will not have at any time Total Unencumbered Assets of less than 150% of the aggregate principal amount of all of its and its subsidiaries’ outstanding Unsecured Debt determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP.

 

112


Table of Contents

Existence. Except as permitted under “—Merger, consolidation or sale,” the Partnership will do or cause to be done all things necessary to preserve and keep in full force and effect its existence, rights (charter and statutory) and franchises, and the Company will do or cause to be done all things necessary to preserve and keep in full force and effect its existence, rights (charter and statutory) and franchises. However, neither the Partnership nor the Company will be required to preserve any right or franchise if the Partnership’s or the Company’s board of directors (or any duly authorized committee of that board of directors), as the case may be, determines that the preservation of the right or franchise is no longer desirable in the conduct of the Partnership’s or the Company’s business, as the case may be.

Maintenance of properties. The notes will provide that the Partnership will cause all of its properties used or useful in the conduct of its business or the business of any of its Subsidiaries to be maintained and kept in good condition, repair and working order, normal wear and tear, casualty and condemnation excepted, and supplied with all necessary equipment and cause all necessary repairs, renewals, replacements, betterments and improvements to be made, all as in our judgment may be necessary in order for the Partnership to at all times properly and advantageously conduct its business carried on in connection with such properties. The Partnership and the Company will not be prevented from (1) removing permanently any property that has been condemned or suffered a casualty loss, if it is in our best interests, (2) discontinuing maintenance or operation of any property if, in the Company’s reasonable judgment, such removal is in the best interest of the Company and is not disadvantageous in any material respect to the holders of the notes, or (3) selling or otherwise disposing for value its properties in the ordinary course of business consistent with the terms of the indenture.

Insurance. The notes will provide that the Partnership will, and will cause each of its Subsidiaries to, keep in force upon all of its and each of its Subsidiaries’ properties and operations insurance policies carried with responsible companies in such amounts and covering all such risks as is customary in the industry in which the Partnership and its Subsidiaries do business in accordance with prevailing market conditions and availability.

Payment of taxes and other claims. The notes will provide that the Partnership and the Company will each pay or discharge or cause to be paid or discharged before it becomes delinquent:

 

    all material taxes, assessments and governmental charges levied or imposed on each of them or any of their respective Subsidiaries or on their respective or any such Subsidiary’s income, profits or property; and

 

    all material lawful claims for labor, materials and supplies that, if unpaid, might by law become a Lien upon their respective property or the property of any of their respective Subsidiaries. However, neither the Partnership nor the Company will be required to pay or discharge or cause to be paid or discharged any tax, assessment, charge or claim the amount, applicability or validity of which is being contested in good faith.

Provision of financial information. The notes will provide that:

 

   

Whether or not the Partnership is subject to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act and for so long as any notes are outstanding, the Partnership will furnish to the trustee (1) all quarterly and annual reports that would be required to be filed with the SEC on Forms 10-Q and 10-K if the Partnership was required to file such reports and (2) all current reports that would be required to be filed with the SEC on Form 8-K if the Partnership was required to file such reports, in each case within 15 days after the Partnership files such reports with the SEC or would be required to file such reports with the SEC pursuant to the applicable rules and regulations of the SEC, whichever is earlier. Reports, information and documents filed with the SEC via the EDGAR system will be deemed to be delivered to the trustee as of the time of such filing via EDGAR for purposes of this covenant; provided, however, that the trustee shall have no obligation whatsoever to determine whether or not such information, documents or reports have been filed via EDGAR. Delivery of such reports, information and documents to the trustee is for informational purposes only and the trustee’s receipt of such shall not constitute constructive notice of any information contained therein or determinable from information contained

 

113


Table of Contents
 

therein, including its compliance with any of its covenants relating to the notes (as to which the trustee is entitled to rely exclusively on an officer’s certificate). Notwithstanding the foregoing, if permitted by the SEC, the Partnership may satisfy its obligation to furnish the reports described above by furnishing such reports filed by the Company.

 

    If so required by Rule 144A, the Partnership and the Company will promptly furnish to the holders, beneficial owners and prospective purchasers of the notes, upon their request, the information required to be delivered pursuant to Rule 144A(d)(4) to facilitate the resale of the notes pursuant to Rule 144A.

Guarantees

The Guarantors will jointly and severally guarantee our obligations under the notes, including the due and punctual payment of principal of and premium, if any, and interest on the notes, whether at stated maturity, by declaration of acceleration, call for redemption or otherwise. The obligations of each Guarantor under its guarantee will be limited to the amount necessary to prevent such guarantee from constituting a fraudulent transfer or conveyance under applicable law. See “Risk factors—Risks related to the offering—Federal and state statutes allow courts, under specific circumstances, to void guarantees and require holders of notes to return payments received from guarantors.”

Each Guarantee will be a continuing guarantee and will inure to the benefit of and be enforceable by the trustee, the holders of the notes and their successors, transferees and assigns.

A Guarantor will be automatically and unconditionally released from its obligations under the indenture and the related guarantee:

 

  (a) in the case of a Subsidiary Guarantor, upon the sale or other disposition of the Subsidiary Guarantor;

 

  (b) in the case of a Subsidiary Guarantor, upon the sale or disposition of all or substantially all the assets of the Subsidiary Guarantor;

 

  (c) upon the liquidation or dissolution of such Guarantor; provided no Default or Event of Default shall occur as a result thereof;

 

  (d) if we exercise our legal defeasance option or our covenant defeasance option as described under “—Defeasance” or if our obligations under the indenture are discharged in accordance with the terms of the indenture as described under “Satisfaction and discharge”; or

 

  (e) if a Guarantor ceases to guarantee the obligations of the Partnership under any indebtedness for money borrowed of the Partnership in an amount greater than $5.0 million.

provided, however, that in the case of clauses (a) and (b) above, (1) such sale or other disposition is made to a person other than the Company or any of its Subsidiaries and (2) such sale or disposition is otherwise permitted by the indenture.

If at any time after the issuance of the notes, including following any release of a Subsidiary Guarantor from its guarantee under the indenture, a Subsidiary of the Partnership (including any future Subsidiary) guarantees our indebtedness for money borrowed in an amount greater than $5.0 million, the Partnership will cause such Subsidiary to guarantee the notes by simultaneously executing and delivering a supplemental indenture in accordance with the indenture. At our request, and upon delivery to the trustee of an officer’s certificate and an opinion of counsel, each stating that all conditions precedent under the indenture relating to such release have been complied with, the trustee will execute any documents reasonably requested by us evidencing such release.

 

114


Table of Contents

Merger, consolidation or sale

The indenture provides that the Partnership or the Company may consolidate with, or sell, lease or convey all or substantially all of our or its assets to, or merge with or into, any other entity, provided that the following conditions are met:

 

    the Partnership or the Company, as the case may be, shall be the continuing entity, or the successor entity (if other than the Partnership or the Company, as the case may be) formed by or resulting from any consolidation or merger or which shall have received the transfer of assets shall be domiciled in the United States, any state thereof or the District of Columbia and shall expressly assume payment of the principal of and interest on all of the notes and the due and punctual performance and observance of all of the covenants and conditions in the indenture and in the notes or the guarantees endorsed on the notes, as the case may be;

 

    immediately after giving effect to the transaction, no Event of Default under the indenture, and no event which, after notice or the lapse of time, or both, would become an Event of Default, shall have occurred and be continuing; and

 

    an officer’s certificate and legal opinion covering these conditions shall be delivered to the trustee.

In the event of any transaction described in and complying with the conditions listed in the immediately preceding paragraphs in which the Partnership and/or the Company are not the continuing entity, the successor person formed or remaining shall succeed, and be substituted for, and may exercise every right and power of ours, and the Partnership and/or the Company shall be discharged from our respective obligations under the notes, the guarantee, the indenture and the registration rights agreement.

Events of default

The indenture provides that the following events are “Events of Default” with respect to the notes:

 

    default for 30 days in the payment of any installment of interest under the notes;

 

    default in the payment of the principal amount or redemption price due with respect to the notes, when the same becomes due and payable; provided, however, that a valid extension of the maturity of the notes in accordance with the terms of the indenture shall not constitute a default in the payment of principal;

 

    any guarantee by a Guarantor (excluding, in the case of a Subsidiary Guarantor, a Subsidiary Guarantor that by itself or considered together with other Subsidiary Guarantors whose guarantees cease to be in full force or effect would not also be a Significant Subsidiary) ceases for any reason to be, or is asserted in writing by us or such Guarantor not to be, in full force and effect and enforceable in accordance with its terms except to the extent contemplated by the indenture and any such guarantee;

 

    the Partnership’s failure to comply with any of our other agreements in the notes or the indenture upon receipt by the Partnership of notice of such default by the trustee or by holders of not less than 25% in aggregate principal amount of the notes then outstanding and the Partnership’s failure to cure (or obtain a waiver of) such default within 60 days after it receives such notice;

 

    failure to pay any recourse indebtedness for money borrowed by the Partnership, the Company or any Significant Subsidiary in an outstanding principal amount in excess of $50.0 million at final maturity or upon acceleration after the expiration of any applicable grace period, which recourse indebtedness is not discharged, or such default in payment or acceleration is not cured or rescinded, within 30 days after written notice to the Partnership or the Company from the trustee (or to the Partnership and the trustee from holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the outstanding notes);

 

   

certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization, court appointment of a receiver, liquidator or trustee of the Partnership, the Company or any of their respective Significant Subsidiaries or any substantial part of their respective property, or commencement of an involuntary case or other

 

115


Table of Contents
 

proceeding against the Partnership, the Company or any Significant Subsidiary seeking liquidation, reorganization or other relief with respect to the Partnership, the Company or any Significant Subsidiary or its debts under any bankruptcy, insolvency or other similar law (which involuntary case or other proceeding remains undismissed and unstayed for 30 days).

If an Event of Default under the indenture with respect to the notes occurs and is continuing (other than an Event of Default specified in the last bullet above with respect to us, which shall result in an automatic acceleration), then in every case the trustee or the holders of not less than 25% in principal amount of the outstanding notes may declare the principal amount of all of the notes to be due and payable immediately by written notice thereof to us and the Company (and to the trustee if given by the holders). However, at any time after the declaration of acceleration with respect to the notes has been made, but before a judgment or decree for payment of the money due has been obtained by the trustee, the holders of not less than a majority in principal amount of outstanding notes may waive all defaults or Events of Default and rescind and annul such declaration and its consequences if all Events of Default, other than the non-payment of accelerated principal of (or specified portion thereof) or interest on the notes, have been cured or waived as provided in the indenture.

The indenture also provides that the holders of not less than a majority in principal amount of the outstanding notes may waive any past default with respect to the notes and its consequences, except a default:

 

    in the payment of the principal of or interest on the notes, unless such default has been cured and we or the Company shall have deposited with the trustee all required payments of the principal of and interest on the notes; or

 

    in respect of a covenant or provision contained in the indenture that cannot be modified or amended without the consent of the holder of each outstanding note affected thereby.

The trustee will be required to give notice to the holders of the notes of a default under the indenture unless the default has been cured or waived within 90 days; provided, however, that the trustee may withhold notice to the holders of the notes of any default with respect to the notes (except a default in the payment of the principal of or interest on the notes) if specified responsible officers of the trustee consider the withholding to be in the interest of the holders.

The indenture provides that no holders of the notes may institute any proceedings, judicial or otherwise, with respect to the indenture or for any remedy thereunder, except in the case of failure of the trustee, for 90 days, to act after it has received a written request to institute proceedings in respect of an Event of Default from the holders of not less than 25% in principal amount of the outstanding Notes, as well as an offer of reasonable indemnity. This provision will not prevent, however, any holder of the notes from instituting suit for the enforcement of payment of the principal of and interest on the notes at the respective due dates thereof.

Subject to provisions in the indenture relating to its duties in case of default, the trustee is under no obligation to exercise any of its rights or powers under the indenture at the request or direction of any holders of the notes then outstanding under the indenture, unless the holders shall have offered to the trustee reasonable security or indemnity. The holders of not less than a majority in principal amount of the outstanding notes (or of all notes then outstanding under the indenture, as the case may be) shall have the right to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the trustee, or of exercising any trust or power conferred upon the trustee. However, the trustee may refuse to follow any direction which is in conflict with any law or the indenture, or which may be unduly prejudicial to the holders of the notes not joining therein.

Within 120 days after the close of each fiscal year of the Partnership, the Partnership must deliver a certificate of an officer certifying to the trustee whether or not the officer has knowledge of any default under the indenture and, if so, specifying each default and the nature and status thereof.

 

116


Table of Contents

Defeasance

The Partnership may, at its option and at any time, elect to have its obligations and the obligations of each Guarantor discharged with respect to the outstanding notes and guarantees (“Legal Defeasance”). Legal Defeasance means that the Partnership and the Guarantors shall be deemed to have paid and discharged the entire indebtedness represented by the outstanding notes and guarantees, and to have satisfied all other obligations under such notes, the guarantees and the indenture, except as to:

 

    the rights of holders of outstanding notes to receive payments in respect of the principal of, or interest or premium and additional interest, if any, on, such notes when such payments are due from the trust funds referred to below;

 

    the Partnership’s obligations with respect to such notes concerning exchange and registration of transfer of notes, mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen notes, issuing temporary notes, and the maintenance of an office or agency for payment and money for security payments held in trust;

 

    the rights, powers, trust, duties, and immunities of the trustee, and the Partnership’s and the Guarantors’ obligations in connection therewith; and

 

    the Legal Defeasance provisions of the indenture.

In addition, the Partnership may, at its option and at any time, elect to have its obligations and the obligations of the Guarantors released with respect to certain covenants under the indenture, including certain covenants listed under “—Certain covenants” above, as described in the indenture (“Covenant Defeasance”), and thereafter any omission to comply with such obligations shall not constitute a default or an Event of Default. In the event Covenant Defeasance occurs, certain Events of Default (not including non-payment, bankruptcy, receivership, rehabilitation and insolvency events) will no longer apply. Except as specified herein, however, the remainder of the indenture and such notes and guarantees will be unaffected by the occurrence of Covenant Defeasance, and the notes will continue to be deemed “outstanding” for all other purposes under the indenture other than for the purposes of any direction, waiver, consent or declaration or act of holders (and the consequences of any thereof) in connection with any of the defeased covenants.

In order to exercise either Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance:

 

    the Partnership must irrevocably deposit with the trustee, in trust, for the benefit of the holders, cash in U.S. dollars, non-callable government securities, or a combination thereof, in such amounts as will be sufficient, in the opinion of a nationally recognized investment bank, appraisal firm, or firm of independent public accountants, to pay the principal of, premium and additional interest, if any, and interest on, the outstanding notes on the stated date for payment thereof or on the redemption date of the notes, as the case may be, and the Partnership must specify whether the notes are being defeased to such stated date for payment or to a particular redemption date;

 

    in the case of Legal Defeasance, the Partnership must deliver to the trustee an opinion of counsel confirming that:

 

    the Partnership has received from, or there has been published by the IRS a ruling, or

 

    since the date of the indenture, there has been a change in the applicable U.S. federal income tax law,

in either case to the effect that, and based thereon such opinion of counsel shall confirm that, the holders of the outstanding notes will not recognize income, gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes as a result of such Legal Defeasance and will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on the same amounts, in the same manner and at the same times as would have been the case if such Legal Defeasance had not occurred;

 

   

in the case of Covenant Defeasance, the Partnership must deliver to the trustee an opinion of counsel confirming that the holders of the outstanding notes will not recognize income, gain or loss for U.S.

 

117


Table of Contents
 

federal income tax purposes as a result of such Covenant Defeasance and will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on the same amounts, in the same manner and at the same times as would have been the case if such Covenant Defeasance had not occurred;

 

    no default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing on the date of such deposit (other than a default or Event of Default resulting from the borrowing of funds to be applied to such deposit (and any similar concurrent deposit relating to other indebtedness being defeased, discharged or replaced), and the granting of liens to secure such borrowings);

 

    such Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance shall not result in a breach or violation of, or constitute a default under, any material agreement or instrument (other than the indenture and the agreements governing any other indebtedness being defeased, discharged or replaced) to which the Partnership, the Company or any Subsidiary Guarantor is a party or by which any of them is bound;

 

    the Partnership must deliver to the trustee an officer’s certificate stating that the deposit was not made by the Partnership or a Guarantor with the intent of preferring the holders of the notes over their other creditors with the intent of defeating, hindering, delaying or defrauding any of their creditors or others; and

 

    the Partnership must deliver to the trustee an officer’s certificate and an opinion of counsel, each stating that all conditions precedent relating to the Legal Defeasance or the Covenant Defeasance have been complied with.

Satisfaction and discharge

The indenture will be discharged and will cease to be of further effect (except as to surviving rights or registration of transfer or exchange of the notes, as expressly provided for in the indenture) as to all outstanding notes when:

 

    either:

 

    all the notes theretofore authenticated and delivered (except lost, stolen or destroyed notes which have been replaced or paid and notes for whose payment money has theretofore been deposited in trust and thereafter repaid to us) have been delivered to the trustee for cancellation; or

 

    all notes not theretofore delivered to the trustee for cancellation (1) have become due and payable or will become due and payable at their stated maturity within one year or (2) are to be called for redemption on a redemption date within one year under arrangements reasonably satisfactory to the trustee for the giving of notice of redemption by the trustee in the name, and at the expense, of the Partnership, and the Guarantors, in the case of clause (1) or (2) above, have irrevocably deposited or caused to be irrevocably deposited with the trustee or the paying agent (other than us or any of our affiliates), as applicable, as trust funds in trust cash in an amount sufficient to pay and discharge the entire indebtedness on such notes not theretofore delivered to the trustee for cancellation, for principal and interest to the date of such deposit (in the case of notes which have become due and payable) or to the maturity date or redemption date, as the case may be; provided, however, that there shall not exist, on the date of such deposit, a default or Event of Default; provided, further, that such deposit shall not result in a breach or violation of, or constitute a default under, the indenture or any other material agreement or instrument to which the Partnership is a party or to which any Guarantor is bound;

 

    the Partnership has paid or caused to be paid all other sums payable under the indenture by the Partnership; and

 

    the Partnership has delivered to the trustee an officer’s certificate and an opinion of counsel, each stating that all conditions precedent provided for in the indenture relating to the satisfaction and discharge of the indenture have been complied with.

 

118


Table of Contents

Modification, waiver and meetings

Modifications and amendments of, and supplements to, the indenture (other than certain modifications, supplements and amendments for administrative purposes or for the benefit of note holders, in each case as further described below) will be permitted to be made only with the consent of the holders of not less than a majority in principal amount of all outstanding notes; provided, however, that no modification or amendment may, without the consent of the holder of each note affected thereby:

 

    change the stated maturity of the principal of or any installment of interest on the notes issued under such indenture, reduce the principal amount of, or the rate or amount of interest on, or any premium payable on redemption of, the notes, or adversely affect any right of repayment of the holder of the notes, change the place of payment, or the coin or currency, for payment of principal of or interest on any note or impair the right to institute suit for the enforcement of any payment on or with respect to the notes;

 

    reduce the above-stated percentage of outstanding notes necessary to modify or amend the indenture, to waive compliance with certain provisions thereof or certain defaults and consequences thereunder or to reduce the quorum or change voting requirements set forth in the indenture;

 

    modify or affect in any manner adverse to the holders the terms and conditions of our obligations in respect of the payment of principal and interest;

 

    modify or affect in any manner adverse to the holders of the notes the terms and conditions of the guarantees of any Guarantor in respect of the notes; or

 

    modify any of the foregoing provisions or any of the provisions relating to the waiver of certain past defaults or certain covenants, except to increase the required percentage to effect the action or to provide that certain other provisions may not be modified or waived without the consent of the holders of the notes.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, modifications and amendments of the indenture will be permitted to be made by the Partnership, the Guarantors and the trustee without the consent of any holder of the notes for any of the following purposes:

 

    to evidence a successor to us as obligor or any of the Guarantors as guarantor under the indenture;

 

    to add to our covenants or those of the Company or our or its respective Subsidiaries, including the Subsidiary Guarantors, for the benefit of the holders of the notes or to surrender any right or power conferred upon us, the Company or our or its respective Subsidiaries, including the Subsidiary Guarantors, in the indenture;

 

    to add Events of Default for the benefit of the holders of the notes;

 

    to amend or supplement any provisions of the indenture; provided, that no amendment or supplement shall materially adversely affect the interests of the holders of any notes then outstanding;

 

    to secure the notes;

 

    to provide for the acceptance of appointment by a successor trustee or facilitate the administration of the trusts under the indenture by more than one trustee;

 

    to provide for rights of holders of the notes if any consolidation, merger or sale of all or substantially all of our property or assets occurs;

 

    to cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency in the indenture; provided, that the action shall not adversely affect the interests of holders of the notes in any material respect;

 

    to provide for the issuance of additional notes in accordance with the limitations set forth in the indenture;

 

119


Table of Contents
    to supplement any of the provisions of the indenture to the extent necessary to permit or facilitate defeasance and discharge of any series of the notes; provided, that the action shall not adversely affect the interests of the holders of the notes in any material respect;

 

    make any amendment to the provisions of the indenture relating to the transfer and legending of notes; provided, however, that such amendment does not materially and adversely affect the rights of holders to transfer notes;

 

    comply with any requirement of the SEC in order to effect or maintain the qualification of the indenture under the Trust Indenture Act;

 

    to conform the text of the indenture, any guarantee or the notes to any provision of this “Description of notes,” as supplemented by the related term sheet, to the extent that such provision in this “Description of notes” was intended to be a verbatim recitation of a provision of the indenture, such guarantee or the notes; or

 

    to add additional guarantors for the benefit of holders of the notes.

In addition, without the consent of any holder of the notes, the Company, or a subsidiary thereof, may directly assume the due and punctual payment of the principal of, any premium and interest on all the notes and the performance of every covenant of the indenture on our part to be performed or observed. Upon any assumption, the Company or such subsidiary shall succeed us, and be substituted for and may exercise every right and power of ours, under the indenture with the same effect as if the Company or such subsidiary had been the issuer of the notes, and the Partnership shall be released from all obligations and covenants with respect to the notes. No assumption shall be permitted unless the Company has delivered to the trustee (1) an officer’s certificate and an opinion of counsel, stating, among other things, that the guarantees and all other covenants of the Company in the indenture remain in full force and effect and (2) an opinion of counsel that the holders of the notes shall have no materially adverse U.S. federal tax consequences as a result of the assumption, and that, if any notes are then listed on the New York Stock Exchange, that the notes shall not be delisted as a result of the assumption.

In determining whether the holders of the requisite principal amount of outstanding notes have given any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent or waiver thereunder or whether a quorum is present at a meeting of holders of the notes, the indenture provides that notes owned by us, the Company, any Subsidiary Guarantor or any of our or their respective subsidiaries or affiliates shall be disregarded.

The indenture contains provisions for convening meetings of the holders of the notes. A meeting will be permitted to be called at any time by the trustee, and also, upon request, by us, the Company or the holders of at least 10% in principal amount of the outstanding notes, in any case upon notice given as provided in the indenture. Except for any consent that must be given by the holder of each note affected by certain modifications and amendments of the indenture, any resolution presented at a meeting or adjourned meeting duly reconvened at which a quorum is present will be permitted to be adopted by the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding notes; provided, however, that, except as referred to above, any resolution with respect to any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action that may be made, given or taken by the holders of a specified percentage, which is less than a majority, in principal amount of the outstanding notes may be adopted at a meeting or adjourned meeting duly reconvened at which a quorum is present by the affirmative vote of the holders of the specified percentage in principal amount of the outstanding notes. Any resolution passed or decision taken at any meeting of holders of the notes duly held in accordance with the indenture will be binding on all holders of the notes. The quorum at any meeting called to adopt a resolution, and at any adjourned meeting duly reconvened, will be holders holding or representing a majority in principal amount of the outstanding notes; provided, however, that if any action is to be taken at the meeting with respect to a consent or waiver which may be given by the holders of not less than a specified percentage in principal amount of the outstanding notes, holders holding or representing the specified percentage in principal amount of the outstanding notes will constitute a quorum.

 

120


Table of Contents

Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions, any action to be taken at a meeting of holders of the notes with respect to any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action that the indenture expressly provides may be made, given or taken by the holders of a specified percentage which is less than a majority in principal amount of the outstanding notes may be taken at a meeting at which a quorum is present by the affirmative vote of holders of the specified percentage in principal amount of the outstanding notes.

Trustee

U.S. Bank National Association will initially act as the trustee, registrar, exchange agent and paying agent for the notes, subject to replacement at the Partnership’s option as provided in the indenture.

If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the trustee will be required to use the degree of care and skill of a prudent man in the conduct of its own affairs. The trustee will become obligated to exercise any of its powers under the indenture at the request of any of the holders of the required percentage under the indenture of holders of the notes only after those holders have offered the trustee indemnity reasonably satisfactory to it.

U.S. Bank National Association is one of our creditors. As a result, it is subject to limitations on its rights to obtain payment of claims or to realize on some property received for any such claim, as security or otherwise. The trustee is permitted to engage in other transactions with the Partnership. If, however, it acquires any conflicting interest, it must eliminate that conflict or resign.

No personal liability of directors, officers, employees and shareholders

No past, present or future director, officer, employee, incorporator, shareholder or limited partner of the Partnership or any Guarantor, as such, will have any liability for any of our obligations or those of any Guarantor under the notes, the indenture, or any guarantee or for any claim based on, in respect of, or by reason of, such obligations or their creation. Each holder of notes by accepting a note waives and releases all such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for issuance of the notes. The waiver may not be effective to waive liabilities under the federal securities laws.

Book-entry, delivery and form

Except as set forth below, the notes will be issued in registered, global form in minimum denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof (the “Global Notes”).

Except as set forth below, the Global Notes may be transferred, in whole and not in part, only to another nominee of DTC or to a successor of DTC or its nominee. Beneficial interests in the Global Notes may not be exchanged for definitive notes in registered certificated form (“Certificated Notes”) except in the limited circumstances described below. See “—Exchange of global notes for certificated notes.” Except in the limited circumstances described below, owners of beneficial interests in the Global Notes will not be entitled to receive physical delivery of notes in certificated form.

Depository procedures

The following description of the operations and procedures of DTC is provided solely as a matter of convenience. These operations and procedures are solely within the control of DTC and is subject to change by them. We take no responsibility for these operations and procedures and urge investors to contact the system or their participants directly to discuss these matters.

DTC has advised us that DTC is a limited-purpose trust company created to hold securities for its participating organizations (collectively, the “Participants”) and to facilitate the clearance and settlement of transactions in those securities between the Participants through electronic bookentry changes in accounts of its

 

121


Table of Contents

Participants. The Participants include securities brokers and dealers, banks, trust companies, clearing corporations and certain other organizations. Access to DTC’s system is also available to other entities such as banks, brokers, dealers and trust companies that clear through or maintain a custodial relationship with a Participant, either directly or indirectly (collectively, the “Indirect Participants”). Persons who are not Participants may beneficially own securities held by or on behalf of DTC only through the Participants or the Indirect Participants. The ownership interests in, and transfers of ownership interests in, each security held by or on behalf of DTC are recorded on the records of the Participants and Indirect Participants.

DTC has also advised us that, pursuant to procedures established by it:

 

  (1) upon deposit of the Global Notes, DTC will credit the accounts of the Participants with portions of the principal amount of the Global Notes; and

 

  (2) ownership of these interests in the Global Notes will be shown on, and the transfer of ownership of these interests will be effected only through, records maintained by DTC (with respect to the Participants) or by the Participants and the Indirect Participants (with respect to other owners of beneficial interest in the Global Notes).

Investors in the Global Notes who are Participants may hold their interests therein directly through DTC. Investors in the Global Notes who are not Participants may hold their interests therein indirectly through organizations (including Euroclear and Clearstream) which are Participants. The laws of some states require that certain persons take physical delivery in definitive form of securities that they own. Consequently, the ability to transfer beneficial interests in a Global Note to such persons will be limited to that extent. Because DTC can act only on behalf of the Participants, which in turn act on behalf of the Indirect Participants, the ability of a person having beneficial interests in a Global Note to pledge such interests to persons that do not participate in the DTC system, or otherwise take actions in respect of such interests, may be affected by the lack of a physical certificate evidencing such interests.

Except as described below, owners of interests in the Global Notes will not have notes registered in their names, will not receive physical delivery of notes in certificated form and will not be considered the registered owners or “holders” thereof under the indenture governing the notes for any purpose.

Payments in respect of the principal of, and interest and premium, if any, on, a Global Note registered in the name of DTC or its nominee will be payable to DTC in its capacity as the registered holder under the indenture governing the notes. Under the terms of the indenture, we and the trustee will treat the persons in whose names the notes, including the Global Notes, are registered as the owners of the notes for the purpose of receiving payments and for all other purposes. Consequently, neither we, the Company, the trustee nor any agent of us or the trustee has or will have any responsibility or liability for:

 

  (1) any aspect of DTC’s records or any Participant’s or Indirect Participant’s records relating to or payments made on account of beneficial ownership interest in the Global Notes or for maintaining, supervising or reviewing any of DTC’s records or any Participant’s or Indirect Participant’s records relating to the beneficial ownership interests in the Global Notes; or

 

  (2) any other matter relating to the actions and practices of DTC or any of its Participants or Indirect Participants.

DTC has advised us that its current practice, upon receipt of any payment in respect of securities such as the notes (including principal and interest), is to credit the accounts of the relevant Participants with the payment on the payment date unless DTC has reason to believe that it will not receive payment on such payment date. Each relevant Participant is credited with an amount proportionate to its beneficial ownership of an interest in the principal amount of the relevant security as shown on the records of DTC. Payments by the Participants and the Indirect Participants to the beneficial owners of Notes will be governed by standing instructions and customary practices and will be the responsibility of the Participants or the Indirect Participants and will not be the

 

122


Table of Contents

responsibility of DTC, the trustee or us. Neither we nor the trustee will be liable for any delay by DTC or any of the Participants or the Indirect Participants in identifying the beneficial owners of the notes, and we and the trustee may conclusively rely on and will be protected in relying on instructions from DTC or its nominee for all purposes.

DTC has advised us that it will take any action permitted to be taken by a holder of notes only at the direction of one or more Participants to whose account DTC has credited the interests in the Global Notes and only in respect of such portion of the aggregate principal amount at maturity of the notes as to which such Participant or Participants has or have given such direction. However, if there is an Event of Default under the notes, DTC reserves the right to exchange the Global Notes for legended notes in certificated form, and to distribute such notes to its Participants.

Exchange of global notes for certificated notes

A Global Note is exchangeable for a Certificated Note if:

 

    DTC (a) notifies us that it is unwilling or unable to continue as depository for the Global Notes or (b) has ceased to be a clearing agency registered under the Exchange Act and, in either case, we fail to appoint a successor depository;

 

    we, at our option, notify the trustee in writing that we elect to cause the issuance of Certificated Notes; or

 

    upon request from DTC if there has occurred and is continuing a default of Event of Default with respect to the notes.

In addition, beneficial interests in a Global Note may be exchanged for Certificated Notes upon prior written notice given to the trustee by or on behalf of DTC in accordance with the indenture. In all cases, Certificated Notes delivered in exchange for any Global Note or beneficial interests in a Global Note will be registered in the names, and issued in any approved denominations, requested by or on behalf of the depository (in accordance with its customary procedures).

Exchange of certificated notes for global notes

Certificated Notes may be exchanged for beneficial interests in any Global Notes.

Same day settlement and payment

We will make payments in respect of the notes represented by the Global Notes (including principal, premium, if any, and interest) by wire transfer of immediately available funds to the accounts specified by DTC or its nominee. We will make all payments of principal, interest and premium, if any, with respect to Certificated Notes by wire transfer of immediately available funds to the accounts specified by the holders of the Certificated Notes or, if no such account is specified, by mailing a check to each such holder’s registered address. The notes represented by the Global Notes are expected to trade in DTC’s Same-Day Funds Settlement System, and any permitted secondary market trading activity in such Notes will, therefore, be required by DTC to be settled in immediately available funds. We expect that secondary trading in any Certificated Notes will also be settled in immediately available funds.

Notices

Except as otherwise provided in the indenture, notices to holders of the notes will be given by mail to the addresses of holders of the notes as they appear in the note register; provided that notices given to holders holding notes in book-entry form may be given through the facilities of DTC or any successor depository.

 

123


Table of Contents

Governing law

The indenture, the notes and the guarantees will be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the law of the State of New York.

Definitions

As used in the indenture, the following terms have the respective meanings specified below:

“Acquired Debt” means Debt of a person:

 

    existing at the time such person is merged or consolidated with or into the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries or becomes a Subsidiary of ours; or

 

    assumed by the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries in connection with the acquisition of assets from such person.

Acquired Debt shall be deemed to be incurred on the date the acquired person is merged or consolidated with or into us or any of our Subsidiaries or becomes a Subsidiary of ours or the date of the related acquisition, as the case may be.

“Annual Debt Service Charge” means, for any period, the interest expense of the Partnership and its Subsidiaries for such period, determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP, including, without duplication (1) all amortization of debt discount and premium; (2) all accrued interest; (3) all capitalized interest; and (4) the interest component of capitalized lease obligations, but excluding (i) interest reserves funded from the proceeds of any loan, (ii) amortization of deferred financing costs, (iii) prepayment penalties, (iv) swap ineffectiveness charges and (v) any expense resulting from the discounting of any indebtedness in connection with the application of purchase accounting in connection with any acquisition.

“Consolidated Income Available for Debt Service” for any period means Consolidated Net Income of the Partnership and its Subsidiaries for such period, plus amounts which have been deducted and minus amounts which have been added for, without duplication:

 

    interest expense on Debt;

 

    provision for taxes;

 

    amortization of debt discount, premium and deferred financing costs;

 

    the income or expense attributable to transactions involving derivative instruments that do not qualify for hedge accounting in accordance with GAAP;

 

    losses and gains on sales or other dispositions of properties and other investments, property valuation losses and impairment charges;

 

    depreciation and amortization;

 

    gains or losses on early extinguishment of debt;

 

    all prepayment penalties and all costs or fees incurred in connection with any debt financing or amendment thereto, acquisition, disposition, recapitalization or similar transaction (regardless of whether such transaction is completed);

 

    the effect of any non-recurring or other unusual non-cash items; and

 

    amortization of deferred charges.

all determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP. Consolidated Income Available for Debt Service will be adjusted, without duplication, to give pro forma effect in the case of any assets having been placed in service or removed from service from the beginning of the period to the date of determination, to

 

124


Table of Contents

include or exclude, as the case may be, any Consolidated Income Available for Debt Service earned or eliminated as a result of the placement of the assets in service or removal of the assets from service as if the placement of the assets in service or removal of the assets from service occurred at the beginning of the period.

“Consolidated Net Income” for any period means the amount of net income (or loss) of the Partnership and its Subsidiaries for such period, excluding, without duplication:

 

    extraordinary items; and

 

    the portion of net income (but not losses) of the Partnership and its Subsidiaries allocable to noncontrolling interests in unconsolidated persons to the extent that cash dividends or distributions have not actually been received by the Partnership or one of its subsidiaries, all determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP.

“Debt” means, with respect to any person, any indebtedness of such person, whether or not contingent, in respect of (without duplication):

 

  (i) indebtedness for borrowed money evidenced by bonds, notes, debentures or similar instruments;

 

  (ii) indebtedness secured by any Lien on any property or asset owned by such person, but only to the extent of the lesser of (a) the amount of indebtedness so secured and (b) the fair market value (determined in good faith by us) of the property subject to such Lien;

 

  (iii) reimbursement obligations in connection with any letters of credit actually issued (other than letters of credit issued to provide credit enhancement or support with respect to other of such person’s or such person’s Subsidiaries’ indebtedness otherwise reflected as Debt under this definition) or unconditional obligations to pay the deferred and unpaid purchase price of property, which purchase price is due more than six months after the date of placing such property in service or taking delivery and title thereto, except any such purchase price that constitutes an accrued expense or trade payable; or

 

  (iv) any lease of property by such person as lessee which is required to be reflected on such person’s balance sheet as a capitalized lease in accordance with GAAP,

in the case of items of indebtedness under (i) through (iii) above to the extent that any such items (other than letters of credit) would appear as liabilities on such person’s balance sheet in accordance with GAAP; provided, however, that the term “Debt” will (1) include, to the extent not otherwise included, any obligation of such person to be liable for, or to pay, as obligor, guarantor or otherwise (other than for purposes of collection in the ordinary course of business) Debt of the types referred to above of another person other than obligations to be liable for the Debt of another person solely as a result of non-recourse carveouts (it being understood that Debt shall be deemed to be incurred by such person whenever such person shall create, assume, guarantee or otherwise become liable in respect thereof) and (2) exclude any such indebtedness (or obligation referenced in clause (1) above) that has been the subject of an “in substance” defeasance in accordance with GAAP and Intercompany Debt that is subordinate in right of payment to the notes (or an obligation to be liable for, or to pay, Intercompany Debt that is subordinate in right of payment to the notes referenced in clause (1) above).

“GAAP” means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America in effect as of the issue date, including those set forth in the opinions and pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements and pronouncements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board or in such other statements by such other entity as approved by a significant segment of the accounting profession.

“Intercompany Debt” means, as of any date, indebtedness and liabilities for borrowed money, secured or unsecured, to which the only parties are the Partnership, the Company or any Subsidiary of either of them as of that date.

 

125


Table of Contents

“Lien” means a mortgage, deed of trust, deed to secure Debt, pledge, security interest, assignment for collateral purposes, deposit arrangement, or other security agreement, excluding any right of setoff but including, without limitation, any conditional sale or other title retention agreement, any financing lease having substantially the same economic effect as any of the foregoing, and any other like agreement granting or conveying a security interest.

“Significant Subsidiary” means any Subsidiary or group of Subsidiaries that meets either of the following conditions: (1) the Company and its other Subsidiaries’ investments in and advances to the Subsidiary exceed 10% of the Company’s and its Subsidiaries’ total assets consolidated (determined in accordance with GAAP) as of the end of the most recent fiscal quarter for which an annual or quarterly report has been furnished to holders of the notes or filed with the SEC; or (2) the Company and its other Subsidiaries’ proportionate share of the total assets (after intercompany eliminations) of the subsidiary exceeds 10% of the Company’s and its Subsidiaries’ total assets consolidated (determined in accordance with GAAP) as of the end of the most recent fiscal quarter for which an annual or quarterly report has been furnished to holders of the notes or filed with the SEC.

“Subsidiary” means a corporation, partnership association, joint venture, trust, limited liability company or other business entity which is required to be consolidated with the Partnership in accordance with GAAP.

“Total Assets” means the sum of, without duplication:

 

    Undepreciated Real Estate Assets; and

 

    all other assets (excluding accounts receivable and non-real estate intangible assets) of the Partnership and its Subsidiaries, all determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP.

“Total Unencumbered Assets” means, as of any date, the sum of, without duplication:

 

    Undepreciated Real Estate Assets that are not subject to a Lien securing Debt; and

 

    all other assets (excluding accounts receivable and non-real estate intangible assets) of the Partnership and its Subsidiaries that are not subject to a Lien securing Debt,

all determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP; provided, however, that, in determining Total Unencumbered Assets as a percentage of outstanding Unsecured Debt for purposes of the covenant set forth above in “Certain covenants—Maintenance of total unencumbered assets,” all investments by the Partnership and its Subsidiaries in unconsolidated joint ventures, unconsolidated limited partnerships, unconsolidated limited liability companies and other unconsolidated entities shall be excluded from Total Unencumbered Assets to the extent that such investments would have otherwise been included.

“Undepreciated Real Estate Assets” means, as of any date, the cost (original acquisition cost plus capital improvements) of real estate assets and related intangibles of the Partnership and its Subsidiaries on such date, before depreciation and amortization, all determined on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP.

“Unsecured Debt” means Debt of the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries which is not secured by a Lien on any property or assets of the Partnership or any of its Subsidiaries.

 

126


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF THE PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT OF

DCT INDUSTRIAL OPERATING PARTNERSHIP

General

DCT has qualified, and intends to continue to qualify, as a REIT for U.S. federal income tax purposes. We are structured as an umbrella partnership REIT, or UPREIT, under which substantially all of our current and future business is, and will be, conducted through DCTOP, which was formed under Delaware law on April 24, 2002 to acquire, own and lease properties on our behalf of DCT. This UPREIT structure generally enables us to acquire real property in exchange for OP units in DCTOP from owners who desire to defer taxable gain that would otherwise normally be recognized by them upon the disposition of their property or the transfer of their property to us in exchange for DCT’s common stock or cash. These owners may also desire to achieve diversity in their investment and other benefits afforded to owners of stock in a REIT. For purposes of satisfying the Asset and Income Tests for qualification as a REIT for U.S. federal income tax purposes (see “U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences”), the REIT’s proportionate share of the assets and income of DCTOP will be deemed to be assets and income of the REIT.

The property owner’s goals are accomplished because the owner may contribute property to DCTOP in exchange for OP units on a tax deferred basis. Further, DCTOP is structured to make distributions with respect to OP units which are equivalent to the dividend distributions made to DCT’s stockholders. Finally, a limited partner in DCTOP may later redeem his, her or its OP units for shares of DCT’s common stock (in a taxable transaction) or cash and achieve liquidity for his, her or its investment.

We intend to hold substantially all of our assets in DCTOP or in subsidiary entities in which DCTOP owns an interest, and we intend to make future acquisitions of real properties using the UPREIT structure. DCT is the sole general partner of DCTOP. As the sole general partner of DCTOP, DCT has the exclusive power to manage and conduct the business of DCTOP. We also own a substantial majority of the OP units of DCTOP.

The following is a summary of certain provisions of the amended and restated limited partnership agreement of DCTOP. This summary is not complete and is qualified by the specific language in the partnership agreement. You should refer to the actual partnership agreement, a copy of which we have filed as an exhibit to the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part, for more detail.

Capital Contributions

In connection with this offering and future offerings of DCT’s common stock, we will transfer substantially all of the net offering proceeds to DCTOP in exchange for OP units. However, we will be deemed to have made capital contributions in the amount of the gross offering proceeds, and DCTOP will be deemed to have simultaneously paid the underwriting discounts and commissions and other costs associated with the offering.

If DCTOP requires additional funds at any time in excess of capital contributions made by us, we may borrow funds from a financial institution or other lender and lend such funds to DCTOP on the same terms and conditions as are applicable to our borrowing of such funds. In addition, we are authorized to cause DCTOP to issue partnership interests for less than fair market value if we conclude in good faith that such issuance is in the best interest of DCTOP and our company.

Fiduciary Duties

DCT’s directors and officers have duties under applicable Maryland law to manage DCT in a manner consistent with the best interests of its stockholders. At the same time, DCT, as the general partner of DCTOP, has fiduciary duties under applicable Delaware law to manage DCTOP in a manner beneficial to DCTOP and its partners. DCT’s duties to DCTOP and its limited partners, therefore, may come into conflict with the duties of

 

127


Table of Contents

DCT’s directors and officers to DCT’s stockholders. When deciding whether to cause DCTOP to take or decline to take any actions, DCT, as the general partner, will be under no obligation to give priority to the separate interest of (i) the limited partners in DCTOP (including, without limitation, the tax interests of our limited partners except as provided in a separate written agreement) or (ii) DCT’s stockholders.

Operations

The partnership agreement requires that DCTOP be operated in a manner that will enable DCT to (1) satisfy the requirements for being classified as a REIT for U.S. federal income tax purposes, unless DCT otherwise cease s to qualify as a REIT, (2) avoid any federal income or excise tax liability, and (3) ensure that DCTOP will not be classified as a “publicly traded partnership” for purposes of Section 7704 of the Code, which classification could result in DCTOP being taxed as a corporation, rather than as a partnership.

Redemption Rights

The limited partners of DCTOP (other than our company) generally have the right to cause DCTOP to redeem all or a portion of their OP units for cash or, at our sole discretion, shares of DCT’s common stock, or a combination of both. If we elect to redeem OP units for shares of DCT’s common stock, we will generally deliver one share of DCT’s common stock for each OP unit redeemed. If we elect to redeem OP units for cash, we will generally deliver cash to be paid in an amount equal to, for each redeemed OP unit, the average of the daily market price for the ten consecutive trading days immediately preceding the date we receive a notice of redemption by a limited partner. In connection with the exercise of these redemption rights, a limited partner must make certain representations, including that the delivery of shares of DCT’s common stock upon redemption would not result in such limited partner owning shares in excess of DCT’s ownership limits in its charter.

Subject to the foregoing, limited partners may exercise their redemption rights at any time after one year following the date of issuance of their OP units; provided, however, that a limited partner may not deliver more than two redemption notices each calendar year and may not exercise a redemption right for less than 1,000 OP units, unless the limited partner holds less than 1,000 OP units, in which case it must exercise its redemption right for all of its OP units.

Transferability of Interests

We may not (1) voluntarily withdraw as the general partner of DCTOP, (2) engage in any merger, consolidation or other business combination, or (3) transfer our general partnership interest in DCTOP (except to a wholly-owned subsidiary), unless the transaction in which such withdrawal, business combination or transfer occurs results in the limited partners receiving or having the right to receive an amount of cash, securities or other property equal in value to the amount they would have received if they had exercised their redemption rights immediately prior to such transaction or unless, in the case of a merger or other business combination, the successor entity contributes substantially all of its assets to DCTOP in return for an interest in DCTOP and agrees to assume all obligations of the general partner of DCTOP. We may also enter into a business combination or we may transfer our general partnership interest upon the receipt of the consent of a majority-in-interest of the limited partners of DCTOP. With certain exceptions, the limited partners may not transfer their interests in DCTOP, in whole or in part, without our written consent as general partner.

The partnership agreement generally provides that DCTOP will distribute cash flows from operations and net sales proceeds from disposition of assets to the partners of DCTOP in accordance with their relative percentage interests, on at least a quarterly basis, in amounts determined by us as general partner.

Similarly, the partnership agreement of DCTOP provides that income of DCTOP from operations and income of DCTOP from disposition of assets normally will be allocated to the partners of DCTOP in accordance with their relative percentage interests such that a holder of one OP unit will be allocated income for each taxable

 

128


Table of Contents

year in an amount equal to the amount of taxable income allocated to us in respect of a holder of one share of our common stock, subject to compliance with the provisions of Sections 704(b) and 704(c) of the Code and corresponding Treasury Regulations. Losses, if any, will generally be allocated among the partners in accordance with their respective percentage interests in DCTOP. Upon the liquidation of DCTOP, after payment of debts and obligations, any remaining assets of DCTOP will be distributed in accordance with the distribution provisions of the partnership agreement to the extent of each partner’s positive capital account balance.

In addition to the administrative and operating costs and expenses incurred by DCTOP in acquiring and operating real properties, DCTOP will pay all administrative costs and expenses of our company, and such expenses will be treated as expenses of DCTOP. Such expenses will include, without limitation:

 

    All expenses relating to maintaining our corporate existence;

 

    All expenses relating to the public offering and registration of our securities;

 

    All expenses associated with the preparation and filing of any periodic reports by us under federal, state or local laws or regulations;

 

    All expenses associated with our compliance with applicable laws, rules and regulations; and

 

    All our other operating or administrative costs incurred in the ordinary course of its business on behalf of DCTOP.

LTIP Units

In connection with the Internalization, we established a new class of limited partnership interest in DCTOP, which we refer to as LTIP units. The LTIP units are structured as “profits interests” for U.S. federal income tax purposes, and we intend them to be a form of equity compensation that we can use. LTIP units are designed to offer their recipients the same long-term incentive as shares of restricted stock, while allowing them to enjoy the more favorable U.S. federal income tax treatment available for “profits interests.” See “Executive Compensation—Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Long-term Equity Incentive Compensation—LTIP Units” for a more complete description of the LTIP units.

Tax-Matters Partner

DCT is the tax-matters partner of DCTOP, and, as such, DCT has authority to make tax elections under the Code on behalf of DCTOP.

Term

DCTOP will continue in full force and effect until December 31, 2032, or until sooner dissolved in accordance with its terms or as otherwise provided by law.

Amendment

The partnership agreement may not be amended without our consent as general partner. As general partner, we may, without the consent of the limited partners, amend the partnership agreement in any respect or merge or consolidate DCTOP with or into any other partnership or business entity in certain transactions pursuant to the partnership agreement; provided, however, that the following amendments and any other merger or consolidation of DCTOP shall require the consent of limited partners holding more than 50% of the ownership interests of all limited partners:

 

  (a) certain amendments affecting the operation of the redemption rights for OP units, or the mechanism for converting OP units into shares of our common stock, in a manner adverse to the limited partners;

 

129


Table of Contents
  (b) any amendment that would adversely affect the rights of the limited partners to receive the distributions payable to them under the partnership agreement, other than with respect to the issuance of additional OP units pursuant to certain provisions of the partnership agreement;

 

  (c) any amendment that would alter DCTOP’s allocations of profit and loss to the limited partners, other than with respect to the issuance of additional OP units pursuant to certain provisions of the partnership agreement; or

 

  (d) any amendment that would impose on the limited partners any obligation to make additional capital contributions to DCTOP.

 

130


Table of Contents

U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

Pursuant to U.S. Internal Revenue Service Circular 230, we hereby inform you that the discussion set forth herein with respect to U.S. federal tax issues was not intended or written to be used, and such discussion cannot be used, by any taxpayer for the purpose of avoiding any penalties that may be imposed on the taxpayer under the U.S. Internal Revenue Code. The following discussion was written to support the transactions or matters addressed in this prospectus. Each taxpayer should seek advice based on the taxpayer’s particular circumstances from an independent tax advisor.

General

The following is a summary of certain United States federal income tax considerations relating to the exchange of private notes for exchange notes pursuant to this prospectus and the holding and disposition of exchange notes. The statements made in this section of the offering memorandum are based upon current provisions of the Internal Revenue Code and Treasury Regulations promulgated thereunder, as currently applicable, currently published administrative positions of the Internal Revenue Service and judicial decisions, all of which are subject to change, either prospectively or retroactively. We cannot assure you that any changes will not modify the statements made herein. This summary does not address all possible tax considerations that may be material to a holder of private notes or exchange notes and does not constitute legal or tax advice. Moreover, this summary does not deal with all tax aspects that might be relevant to you, as a potential holder of exchange notes, in light of your personal circumstances, nor does it deal with particular types of holders that are subject to special treatment under the federal income tax laws, such as insurance companies, tax-exempt organizations, financial institutions or broker dealers, a regulated investment company, foreign corporations or persons who are not citizens or residents of the United States except as provided below, or others who are subject to special treatment under the Internal Revenue Code. This summary assumes that the private notes and the exchange notes are held as capital assets, which generally means as property held for investment. It applies only if the private notes were acquired in the initial offering at the offering price. If the private notes were purchased at a price other than the offering price, the amortizable bond premium or market discount rules may apply which are not described in this prospectus. Holders should consult their own tax advisors regarding these possibilities.

The term “U.S. Holder” means any beneficial owner of the private notes or exchange notes, other than an entity treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes, that for United States federal income tax purposes, is

 

    a citizen or resident of the United States;

 

    a corporation (including an entity treated as a corporation for United States federal income tax purposes) created or organized under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or the District of Columbia;

 

    an estate, the income of which is subject to United States federal income taxation regardless of its source; or

 

    any trust if (1) a United States court is able to exercise primary supervision over the administration of such trust and one or more United States persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust or (2) it has a valid election in place to be treated as a United States person.

The term “Non-U.S. Holder” shall refer to a beneficial owner of the private notes or exchange notes, other than an entity treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes, that is not a U.S. Holder.

If a partnership (including for this purpose any entity treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes) is a beneficial owner of a private note or exchange note, the treatment of a partner in the partnership will generally depend upon the status of the partner and upon the activities of the partnership. A holder of a private note or exchange note that is a partnership, and partners in such partnership, should consult their tax advisors about the U.S. federal income tax consequences of exchanging, holding and disposing of the private notes and exchange notes.

 

131


Table of Contents

This discussion is not intended to be, and should not be construed as, tax advice. We urge you, as a holder of private notes or exchange notes, to consult your tax advisor regarding the specific tax consequences to you of an exchange of private notes for exchange notes, and of your ownership and sale of exchange notes, including the federal, state, local, foreign and other tax consequences of such exchange, ownership, and sale and of potential changes in applicable tax laws.

Exchange offer

The exchange of private notes for exchange notes in the exchange offer pursuant to this prospectus will not be a taxable event for U.S. federal income tax purposes and you will have the same tax basis and holding period in the exchange notes as you had in the private notes. Furthermore, any market discount or bond premium associated with your private notes will be treated as market discount or bond premium, as applicable, with respect to your exchange notes for which you exchange the applicable private notes.

Taxation of U.S. holders.

Interest

Stated interest on the exchange notes generally will be included in the income of a U.S. Holder as ordinary income at the time such interest is received or accrued, in accordance with the U.S. Holder’s regular method of tax accounting.

Disposition of the exchange notes

Upon the sale, exchange, redemption, repurchase, retirement or other disposition of a note, a U.S. Holder generally will recognize capital gain or loss equal to the difference between (i) the amount of cash proceeds and the fair market value of any property received on the disposition (except to the extent such amount is attributable to accrued but unpaid stated interest, which is taxable as ordinary income if not previously included in such holder’s income) and (ii) such U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis in the note. A U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis in an exchange note generally will equal the cost of the private note transferred to DCTOP in exchange for such exchange note and decreased by the amount of any payments other than qualified stated interest payments.

Capital gain or loss recognized upon the disposition of an exchange note will be a long-term capital gain or loss if the exchange note was held for more than one year (including the period during which the private notes were held). Long-term capital gains to individual U.S. Holders are generally subject to preferential tax rates. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.

Medicare tax

A U.S. Holder that is an individual will be subject to a 3.8% tax on the lesser of (1) such U.S. holder’s “net investment income” for the relevant taxable year and (2) the excess of such U.S. Holder’s modified gross income for the taxable year over a certain threshold. U.S. Holders that are estates or certain trusts that do not fall into a special class of trusts that is exempt from such tax are subject to the 3.8% tax on the lesser of (A) their undistributed net investment income or (B) the excess of their adjusted gross income for the taxable year over a certain threshold. Net investment income generally would include interest on the notes and net gain from the disposition of the notes. If you are a U.S. Holder that is an individual, estate or trust, you are urged to consult your tax advisors regarding the applicability of the Medicare tax to your income and gains in respect of your ownership of the notes.

 

132


Table of Contents

Information reporting and backup withholding

We will report to U.S. Holders and to the IRS the amount of stated interest payments and payments of the proceeds from the sale, exchange, redemption, repurchase, retirement or other disposition of an exchange note made to a U.S. Holder, and the amount we withhold, if any. Under the backup withholding rules, a U.S. Holder may be subject to backup withholding at a current rate of up to 28% with respect to distributions unless the holder:

 

    is a corporation or comes within certain exempt categories and, when required, demonstrates that fact, or

 

    provides a taxpayer identification number, certifies as to no loss of exemption from backup withholding, and otherwise complies with the applicable requirements of the backup withholding rules.

A U.S. holder who does not provide us with its correct taxpayer identification number also may be subject to penalties imposed by the IRS. Any amount paid as backup withholding will be creditable against the U.S. holder’s income tax liability if the required information is furnished to the IRS in a timely manner. For a discussion of the backup withholding rules as applied to non-U.S. Holders, see “Taxation of Non-U.S. holders.”

Taxation of non-U.S. holders

The rules governing the U.S. federal income taxation of a Non-U.S. Holder are complex and no attempt will be made herein to provide more than a summary of such rules. Non-U.S. Holders should consult their tax advisors to determine the effect of U.S. federal, state, local and foreign tax laws, as well as tax treaties, with regard to their ownership of the exchange notes.

Interest

A Non-U.S. Holder will be exempt from U.S. federal income and withholding taxes on payments of interest on the exchange notes so long as such payments are not effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United States by the Non-U.S. Holder (and, if required by an applicable income tax treaty, is not attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment), unless such Non-U.S. Holder is (i) a direct or indirect 10% or greater partner (as defined in section 871(h)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code) in DCTOP, (ii) a controlled foreign corporation related to DCTOP, or (iii) a bank extending credit pursuant to a loan agreement entered into in the ordinary course of its trade or business.

In order for a Non-U.S. Holder that is an individual or corporation (or entity treated as such for U.S. federal income tax purposes) to qualify for the exemption from taxation on interest, the “withholding agent” (generally, the last U.S. payor or a non-U.S. payor who is a qualified intermediary or withholding foreign partnership) must have received a statement (generally made on IRS Form W-8BEN) from the individual or corporation that: (i) is signed under penalties of perjury by the beneficial owner of the exchange note, (ii) certifies that such owner is not a U.S. Holder and (iii) provides the beneficial owner’s name and address. A Non-U.S. Holder that is not an individual or corporation (or an entity treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes) holding an exchange note on its own behalf may have substantially increased reporting requirements and should consult its tax advisor.

If a Non-U.S. Holder cannot satisfy the requirements described above, payments of interest will be subject to the 30% U.S. federal withholding tax, unless the Non-U.S. Holder provides us with a properly executed (1) IRS Form W-8BEN (or other applicable form) claiming an exemption from or reduction in withholding under the benefit of an applicable income tax treaty or (2) IRS Form W-8ECI (or other applicable form) stating that interest paid on the exchange notes is not subject to withholding tax because it is effectively connected with the Non-U.S. Holder’s conduct of a trade or business in the United States.

 

133


Table of Contents

If a Non-U.S. Holder is engaged in a trade or business in the United States and interest on the exchange notes is effectively connected with the conduct of that trade or business, the Non-U.S. Holder will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on that interest on a net income basis in the same general manner as if the Non-U.S. Holder were a U.S. Holder unless an applicable income tax treaty provides otherwise.

In addition, if a Non-U.S. Holder is a foreign corporation, it may be subject to a branch profits tax equal to 30% (or lesser rate under an applicable income tax treaty) of its earnings and profits, subject to adjustments, that are effectively connected with its conduct of a trade or business in the United States.

Disposition of the exchange notes

Any gain realized on the sale, redemption, exchange, retirement, repurchase or other taxable disposition of the exchange notes by a Non-U.S. Holder (except to the extent such amount is attributable to accrued but unpaid stated interest, which would be taxable as described above) will be exempt from U.S. federal income and withholding taxes unless: (i) the gain is effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United States by the Non-U.S. Holder, or (ii) if the Non-U.S. Holder is and an individual, the Non-U.S. Holder is present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year and certain other requirements are met.

If a Non-U.S. Holder is described in (i) above, it will be subject to tax on the net gain derived from the sale, exchange, retirement, redemption or other taxable disposition in the same general manner as if the Non-U.S. Holder were a U.S. Holder, unless an applicable income tax treaty provides otherwise. In addition, if a Non-U.S. Holder is a foreign corporation that falls under (i) above, it may be subject to the branch profits tax equal to 30% (or lesser rate as may be specified under an applicable income tax treaty) on its earnings and profits, subject to adjustments, that are effectively connected with its conduct of a trade or business in the United States. If a Non-U.S. Holder is an individual described in (ii) above, such holder will be subject to a flat 30% tax (subject to reductions under an applicable income tax treaty) on the gain derived from the sale, exchange, retirement, redemption or other taxable disposition, which may be offset by U.S. source capital losses, even though such holder is not considered a resident of the United States.

Information reporting and backup withholding

Information reporting requirements and backup withholding generally will not apply to payments on the exchange notes to a Non-U.S. Holder if the statement described in “Taxation of Non-U.S. Holders—Interest” is duly provided by such holder, provided that the withholding agent does not have actual knowledge that the holder is a U.S. person. Information reporting requirements and backup withholding will not apply to any payment of the proceeds of the sale of an exchange note effected outside the United States by a foreign office of a “broker” (as defined in applicable Treasury Regulations), unless such broker (i) is a U.S. person, (ii) derives 50% or more of its gross income for certain periods from the conduct of a trade or business in the United States, (iii) is a controlled foreign corporation within the meaning of the Internal Revenue Code or (iv) is a U.S. branch of a foreign bank or a foreign insurance company. Payment of the proceeds of any such sale effected outside the United States by a foreign office of any broker that is described in (i), (ii) or (iii) of the preceding sentence will not be subject to backup withholding, but will be subject to the information reporting requirements unless such broker has documentary evidence in its records that the beneficial owner is a Non-U.S. Holder and certain other conditions are met, or the beneficial owner otherwise establishes an exemption. Payment of the proceeds of any such sale to or through the U.S. office of a broker is subject to information reporting and backup withholding requirements, unless the beneficial owner of the exchange note provides the statement described in “Taxation of Non-U.S. Holders—Interest” or otherwise establishes an exemption. Any amount withheld from a payment to a holder of an exchange note under the backup withholding rules is allowable as a credit against such holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability (which might entitle such holder to a refund), provided that such holder furnishes the required information to the IRS.

 

134


Table of Contents

PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

Each broker-dealer that receives exchange notes for its own account pursuant to the exchange offer must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of the exchange notes. Broker-dealers may use this prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, in connection with the resale of exchange notes received in exchange for private notes where the broker-dealer acquired the private notes as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities. We have agreed that for a period of up to one year after the date that this registration statement is declared effective by the SEC, we will make this prospectus, as amended or supplemented, available to any broker-dealer that requests it for use in connection with any such resale.

We will not receive any proceeds from any sale of exchange notes by broker-dealers or any other persons. Broker-dealers may sell exchange notes received by broker-dealers for their own account pursuant to the exchange offer from time to time in one or more transactions in the over-the-counter market, in negotiated transactions, through the writing of options on the exchange notes or a combination of such methods of resale, at market prices prevailing at the time of resale, at prices related to the prevailing market prices or negotiated prices. Broker-dealers may resell exchange notes directly to purchasers or to or through brokers or dealers who may receive compensation in the form of commissions or concessions from any broker-dealer and/or the purchasers of the exchange notes. Any broker-dealer that resells exchange notes that were received by it for its own account pursuant to the exchange offer and any broker or dealer that participates in a distribution of the exchange notes may be deemed to be “underwriters” within the meaning of the Securities Act and any profit on any resale of exchange notes and any commissions or concessions received by any such persons may be deemed to be underwriting compensation under the Securities Act. By acknowledging that it will deliver and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an “underwriter” within the meaning of the Securities Act.

We have agreed to pay all expenses incident to our performance of, or compliance with, the registration rights agreement and will indemnify the holders of the notes (including any broker-dealers) against liabilities under the Securities Act.

By its acceptance of the exchange offer, any broker-dealer that receives exchange notes pursuant to the exchange offer agrees to notify us before using the prospectus in connection with the sale or transfer of exchange notes. The broker-dealer further acknowledges and agrees that, upon receipt of notice from us of the happening of any event which makes any statement in the prospectus untrue in any material respect or which requires the making of any changes in the prospectus to make the statements in the prospectus not misleading or which may impose upon us disclosure obligations that may have a material adverse effect on us, which notice we agree to deliver promptly to the broker-dealer, the broker-dealer will suspend use of the prospectus until we have notified the broker-dealer that delivery of the prospectus may resume and have furnished copies of any amendment or supplement to the prospectus to the broker-dealer.

 

135


Table of Contents

LEGAL MATTERS

Certain legal matters will be passed upon for us by Goodwin Procter LLP, Boston, Massachusetts.

EXPERTS

The consolidated financial statements and schedule of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP at December 31, 2013 and 2012, and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2013, appearing in this Prospectus and Registration Statement have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their report thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

The consolidated financial statements of DCT Industrial Trust Inc. appearing in its Annual Report (Form 10-K) for the year ended December 31, 2013 (including the schedule appearing therein), and the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013 have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their reports thereon, included therein, and incorporated herein by reference. Such consolidated financial statements are incorporated herein by reference in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

 

136


Table of Contents

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

This prospectus is part of a Registration Statement on Form S-4 that we have filed with the SEC under the Securities Act. This prospectus does not contain all of the information set forth in the Registration Statement. For further information about us and the notes, you should refer to the Registration Statement. This prospectus summarizes material provisions of contracts and other documents to which we refer you. Since this prospectus may not contain all of the information that you may find important, you should review the full text of these documents. We have filed these documents as exhibits to our Registration Statement.

DCT files and DCTOP will file annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other information with the SEC. You may read and copy any document DCT files or DCTOP will file with the SEC at the SEC’s public reference rooms at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the public reference rooms. The SEC also maintains a website that contains reports, proxy and information statements, and other information regarding registrants that file electronically with the SEC (http://www.sec.gov). You can inspect reports and other information DCT files or DCTOP will file at the offices of the New York Stock Exchange, Inc., 20 Broad Street, New York, New York 10005. In addition, DCT maintains a website that contains information about DCT and DCTOP at http://www.dctindustrial.com. Information on or accessible through our website is not a part of and is not incorporated by reference into this prospectus.

You should rely only upon the information incorporated by reference or provided in this prospectus. If information in incorporated documents conflicts with information in this prospectus, you should rely on the most recent information. We have not authorized anyone to provide you with different information. You should not assume that the information in this prospectus is accurate as of any date other than the date of this prospectus.

INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE

The Securities and Exchange Commission allows DCT to “incorporate by reference” into this prospectus the information DCT files with the Commission, which means that DCT can disclose important information to you by referring you to those documents. Information incorporated by reference is an important part of this prospectus. Later information filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission will update and supersede this information. DCT incorporates by reference the documents listed below and any future filings DCT makes with the SEC under Sections 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act until this offering is completed:

 

    DCT’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013.

To the extent that any information contained in any current report on Form 8-K, or any exhibit thereto, was furnished to, rather than filed with, the SEC, such information or exhibit is specifically not incorporated by reference in this prospectus.

You may request a copy of these filings, at no cost, by contacting Investor Relations, DCT Industrial Trust Inc., 518 17th Street, Suite 800, Denver, Colorado 80202, by telephone at 303-597-2400, by facsimile at 303-228-2201, or by e-mail at investorrelations@dctindustrial.com, or by visiting our website at www.dctindustrial.com. The information contained on our website is not part of this prospectus. Our reference to our website is intended to be an inactive textual reference only.

 

137


Table of Contents

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

DCT INDUSTRIAL OPERATING PARTNERSHIP LP

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     F-2   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2013 and 2012

     F-3   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

     F-4   

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the Years Ended December  31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

     F-5   

Consolidated Statements of Capital for the Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

     F-6   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011

     F-7   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-8   

Schedule III—Real Estate and Accumulated Depreciation

     F-55   

 

F-1


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The Partners of

DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP and subsidiaries:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP and subsidiaries (the “Partnership”) as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), changes in capital, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2013. Our audits also included the financial statement schedule listed in the accompanying Index to Financial Statements. These consolidated financial statements and schedule are the responsibility of the Partnership’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements and schedule based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. We were not engaged to perform an audit of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP and subsidiaries at December 31, 2013 and 2012, and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2013, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles. Also, in our opinion, the related financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP

Denver, Colorado

April 10, 2014

 

F-2


Table of Contents

DCT INDUSTRIAL OPERATING PARTNERSHIP LP AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(in thousands, except unit information)

 

     December 31,
2013
    December 31,
2012
 

ASSETS

    

Land

   $ 883,804      $ 780,235   

Buildings and improvements

     2,615,879        2,481,206   

Intangible lease assets

     82,758        78,467   

Construction in progress

     88,610        45,619   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total investment in properties

     3,671,051        3,385,527   

Less accumulated depreciation and amortization

     (654,097     (605,888
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investment in properties

     3,016,954        2,779,639   

Investments in and advances to unconsolidated joint ventures

     124,923        130,974   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investment in real estate

     3,141,877        2,910,613   

Cash and cash equivalents

     32,226        12,696   

Restricted cash

     12,621        10,076   

Deferred loan costs, net

     10,251        6,838   

Straight-line rent and other receivables, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $2,178 and $1,251, respectively

     46,247        51,179   

Other assets, net

     14,545        12,945   

Assets held for sale

     8,196        52,852   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 3,265,963      $ 3,057,199   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND CAPITAL

    

Liabilities:

    

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

   $ 63,281      $ 57,501   

Distributions payable

     23,792        21,129   

Tenant prepaids and security deposits

     28,542        24,395   

Other liabilities

     10,122        7,213   

Intangible lease liability, net

     20,389        20,148   

Line of credit

     39,000        110,000   

Senior unsecured notes

     1,122,407        1,025,000   

Mortgage notes

     290,960        317,314   

Liabilities related to assets held for sale

     278        940   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     1,598,771        1,583,640   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Partners’ Capital:

    

General Partner:

    

OP Units, 3,379,271 and 3,002,870 issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012, respectively

     16,872        14,996   

Limited Partners:

    

OP Units, 334,547,822 and 297,284,179 issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012, respectively

     1,670,362        1,484,637   

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     (32,077     (37,242
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total partners’ capital

     1,655,157        1,462,391   

Noncontrolling interests

     12,035        11,168   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capital

     1,667,192        1,473,559   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and capital

   $ 3,265,963      $ 3,057,199   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-3


Table of Contents

DCT INDUSTRIAL OPERATING PARTNERSHIP LP AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Operations

(in thousands, except per unit data)

 

     For the Year Ended December 31,  
     2013     2012     2011  

REVENUES:

      

Rental revenues

   $ 286,218      $ 236,839      $ 211,536   

Institutional capital management and other fees

     2,787        4,059        4,291   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

     289,005        240,898        215,827   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

OPERATING EXPENSES:

      

Rental expenses

     35,977        30,298        28,931   

Real estate taxes

     44,048        36,092        32,436   

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

     130,002        109,993        103,333   

General and administrative

     28,010        25,763        25,251   

Casualty and involuntary conversion gain

     (296     (1,174     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

     237,741        200,972        189,951   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income

     51,264        39,926        25,876   

OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):

      

Development profit

     268        307        —     

Equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated joint ventures, net

     2,405        1,087        (2,556

Impairment losses on investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

     —          —          (1,953

Interest expense

     (63,394     (69,274     (63,645

Interest and other income (expense)

     274        85        (93

Income tax expense and other taxes

     (68     (671     (132
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from continuing operations

     (9,251     (28,540     (42,503

Income from discontinued operations

     26,723        11,800        13,660   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consolidated net income (loss) of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP

     17,472        (16,740     (28,843

Net (income) loss attributable to noncontrolling interests

     (589     272        958   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

     16,883        (16,468     (27,885
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Distributed and undistributed earnings allocated to participating securities

     (692     (524     (443
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 16,191      $ (16,992   $ (28,328
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

EARNINGS PER OP UNIT – BASIC AND DILUTED:

      

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (0.03   $ (0.10   $ (0.16

Income from discontinued operations

     0.08        0.04        0.05   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 0.05      $ (0.06   $ (0.11
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

WEIGHTED AVERAGE OP UNITS OUTSTANDING:

      

Basic and diluted

     317,848        278,189        267,901   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-4


Table of Contents

DCT INDUSTRIAL OPERATING PARTNERSHIP LP AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

(in thousands)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2013     2012     2011  

Consolidated net income (loss) of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP

   $ 17,472      $ (16,740   $ (28,843

Other comprehensive income (loss):

      

Net derivative gain (loss) on cash flow hedging instruments

     675        (6,776     (16,508

Net reclassification adjustment on cash flow hedging instruments

     4,490        2,098        970   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss)

     5,165        (4,678     (15,538
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

     22,637        (21,418     (44,381

Comprehensive (income) loss attributable to noncontrolling interests

     (589     272        958   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 22,048      $ (21,146   $ (43,423
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-5


Table of Contents

DCT INDUSTRIAL OPERATING PARTNERSHIP LP AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Capital

(in thousands)

 

          General Partner     Limited Partners     Accumulated
Other

Comprehensive
Loss
    Non-
controlling
Interests
 
          OP Units     OP Units      
    Total Capital     Units     Amount     Units     Amount      

Balance at December 31, 2010

  $ 1,400,838       2,483     $ 14,085        245,801     $ 1,394,416      $ (17,026   $ 9,363  

Net loss

    (28,843     —          (279     —          (27,606     —          (958

Other comprehensive loss

    (15,538     —          —          —          —          (15,538  

Issuance of OP Units, net of selling costs

    111,588       —          —          21,850       111,588       —          —     

Issuance of OP Units, share-based compensation plans

    (88     —          —          868       (88     —          —     

Amortization of share-based compensation

    4,552       —          —          —          4,552       —          —     

Distributions to OP Unitholders and noncontrolling interests

    (76,848     —          (763     —          (75,490     —          (595

Capital contributions

    4,918       —          —          1,002       4,918       —          —     

Capital contributions from noncontrolling interests

    4,632       —          —          —          —          —          4,632  

Purchase of noncontrolling interests, net

    (725     —          —          —          (191     —          (534

Conversion and redemption of limited partner OP Units

    (371     —          —          (76     (371     —          —     

Conversion of limited partner OP Units to OP Units of general partner

    —          236        1,205        (236     (1,205     —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2011

  $ 1,404,115       2,719     $ 14,248        269,209     $ 1,410,523      $ (32,564   $ 11,908  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

    (16,740     —          (165     —          (16,303     —          (272

Other comprehensive loss

    (4,678     —          —          —          —          (4,678     —     

Issuance of OP Units, net of selling costs

    171,328       —          —          28,447       171,328       —          —     

Issuance of OP Units, share-based compensation plans

    (288     —          —          485       (288     —          —     

Amortization of share-based compensation

    4,311       —          —          —          4,311       —          —     

Distributions to OP Unitholders and noncontrolling interests

    (80,231     —          (800     —          (79,216     —          (215

Capital contributions from noncontrolling interests

    30       —          —          —          —          —          30  

Purchase of noncontrolling interests, net

    (995     —          —          —          (712     —          (283

Conversion and redemption of limited partner OP Units

    (3,293     —          —          (573     (3,293     —          —     

Conversion of limited partner OP Units to OP Units of general partner

    —          284        1,713        (284     (1,713     —       
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2012

  $ 1,473,559       3,003     $ 14,996        297,284     $ 1,484,637      $ (37,242   $ 11,168  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

    17,472       —          169        —          16,714        —          589  

Other comprehensive income

    5,165       —          —          —          —          5,165        —     

Issuance of OP Units, net of selling costs

    258,575       —          —          36,817       258,575       —          —     

Issuance of OP Units, share-based compensation plans

    (65     —          —          1,032       (65     —          —     

Amortization of share-based compensation

    5,108       —          —          —          5,108       —          —     

Distributions to OP Unitholders and noncontrolling interests

    (92,070     —          (910     —          (90,133     —          (1,027

Capital contributions from noncontrolling interests

    1,073       —          —          —          —          —          1,073  

Purchase and other allocations of noncontrolling interests

    (125     —          —          —          (357     —          232  

Conversion and redemption of limited partner OP Units

    (1,500     —          —          (209     (1,500     —          —     

Conversion of limited partner OP Units to OP Units of general partner

    —          376        2,617        (376     (2,617     —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2013

  $ 1,667,192       3,379     $ 16,872        334,548     $ 1,670,362      $ (32,077   $ 12,035   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-6


Table of Contents

DCT INDUSTRIAL OPERATING PARTNERSHIP LP AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(in thousands)

 

    Year Ended  
    December 31,  
    2013     2012     2011  

OPERATING ACTIVITIES:

     

Consolidated net income (loss) of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP

  $ 17,472      $  (16,740   $  (28,843

Adjustments to reconcile consolidated net income (loss) of DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP to net cash provided by operating activities:

     

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

    137,120        126,687        128,989   

Gain on dispositions of real estate interests

    (33,619     (13,383     (12,030

Distributions of earnings from unconsolidated joint ventures

    8,801        4,808        3,267   

Equity in (earnings) loss of unconsolidated joint ventures, net

    (2,405     (1,087     2,556   

Casualty and involuntary conversion gain

    (296     (1,624     (1,298

Impairment losses

    13,279        11,422        10,160   

Share-based compensation

    4,004        3,584        4,068   

Straight-line rent

    (5,525     (5,962     (9,526

Other

    6,294        6,213        3,731   

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

     

Other receivables and other assets

    417        1,767        (1,197

Accounts payable, accrued expenses and other liabilities

    7,351        3,271        6,605   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

    152,893        118,956        106,482   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

INVESTING ACTIVITIES:

     

Real estate acquisitions

    (402,723     (360,002     (200,909

Capital expenditures and development activities

    (152,922     (96,095     (75,551

Proceeds from dispositions of real estate investments

    258,224        153,747        106,455   

Investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

    (2,756     (19,417     (21,991

Proceeds from casualties and involuntary conversion

    8,268        681        3,813   

Distributions of investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

    2,175        22,877        12,941   

Other investing activities

    (11,324     (929     (2,581
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

    (301,058     (299,138     (177,823
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FINANCING ACTIVITIES:

     

Proceeds from senior unsecured revolving line of credit

    426,000        450,000        260,500   

Repayments of senior unsecured revolving line of credit

    (497,000     (340,000     (311,500

Proceeds from senior unsecured notes

    497,355        90,000        400,000   

Repayments of senior unsecured notes

    (400,000     —          (200,000

Proceeds from mortgage notes

    16,498        —          20,000   

Principal payments on mortgage notes

    (40,744     (72,672     (133,898

Settlement of cash flow hedge

    —          (33,550     —     

Proceeds from the issuance of OP Units in exchange for contributions from the REIT, net

    258,575        171,267        111,583   

OP Unit redemptions

    (1,500     (3,293     (371

Distributions paid on OP Units

    (88,380     (77,946     (74,654

Distributions paid to noncontrolling interests

    (1,027     (31     (18

Contributions from noncontrolling interests

    723        30        231   

Other financing activity

    (2,805     (3,761     (5,028
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

    167,695        180,044        66,845   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

NET CHANGE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

    19,530        (138     (4,496

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, beginning of period

    12,696        12,834        17,330   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, end of period

  $ 32,226      $ 12,696      $ 12,834   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental Disclosures of Cash Flow Information

     

Cash paid for interest, net of capitalized interest

  $ 57,177      $ 64,795      $ 58,461   

Supplemental Disclosures of Non-Cash Activities

     

Retirement of fully depreciated and amortized assets

  $ 29,899      $ 51,817      $ 42,149   

Assumption of mortgage notes in connection with real estate acquired

  $ —        $ 73,253      $ 7,653   

Contributions of real estate from noncontrolling interests

  $ 350      $ —        $ 4,401   

Issuance of OP Units in connection with real estate acquisition

  $ —        $ —        $ 4,918   

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F-7


Table of Contents

DCT INDUSTRIAL OPERATING PARTNERSHIP LP AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Note 1—Organization

DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP and subsidiaries (collectively, the “Operating Partnership,” “we,” “our” or “us”) is engaged in the business of owning, operating, acquiring and developing high-quality bulk distribution and light industrial properties in high volume distribution markets in the United States (“U.S.”). The Operating Partnership was formed on April 24, 2002 and is managed by DCT Industrial Trust Inc. (“DCT Industrial Trust” or “DCT”), our sole general partner who conducts all of its operations through the Operating Partnership.

The general partner has elected to be treated as a Real Estate Investment Trust (REIT) for U.S. federal income tax purposes. The general partner and the Operating Partnership (collectively, the “Company”) are an internally managed REIT with an “UPREIT” structure whereby the general partner does not hold any independent assets or conduct any business operations apart from its investment in the Operating Partnership.

As of December 31, 2013, DCT owned approximately 94.8% of the outstanding common partnership interests (referred to as “OP Units”) in the Operating Partnership.

As of December 31, 2013, we owned interests in approximately 75.5 million square feet of properties leased to approximately 900 customers, including:

 

    61.9 million square feet comprising 395 consolidated properties owned in our operating portfolio which were 93.3% occupied;

 

    12.3 million square feet comprising 38 unconsolidated properties which were 94.1% occupied and operated on behalf of four institutional capital management partners;

 

    0.2 million square feet comprising two consolidated properties under redevelopment;

 

    0.9 million square feet comprising two consolidated buildings in development; and

 

    0.2 million square feet comprising one building held for sale.

We also have seven consolidated buildings under construction, several projects in predevelopment and one build-to-suit project under contract for sale. See Note 3—Investment in Properties for further detail.

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Basis of Presentation and Principles of Consolidation

The accompanying Consolidated Financial Statements include the financial position, results of operations and cash flows of the Operating Partnership, its wholly-owned qualified REIT subsidiaries and taxable REIT subsidiaries and its consolidated joint ventures, in which it has a controlling interest. Third-party equity interests in consolidated joint ventures are reflected as noncontrolling interests in the Consolidated Financial Statements. We also have noncontrolling partnership interests in unconsolidated institutional capital management and other joint ventures, which are accounted for under the equity method. All significant intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated in consolidation.

All square feet, acres, occupancy, number of properties, number of customers and total projected investment disclosed in the notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements are unaudited.

We hold interests in both consolidated and unconsolidated joint ventures. All joint ventures over which we have financial and operating control, and variable interest entities (“VIEs”) in which we have determined that we are the primary beneficiary, are included in the Consolidated Financial Statements. We use the equity method of

 

F-8


Table of Contents

accounting for joint ventures over which we do not have a controlling interest or where we do not exercise significant control over major operating and management decisions but where we exercise significant influence and include our share of earnings or losses of these joint ventures in our consolidated results of operations.

We analyze our joint ventures in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) to determine whether they are VIEs and, if so, whether we are the primary beneficiary. Our judgment with respect to our level of influence or control over an entity and whether we are the primary beneficiary of a VIE involves consideration of various factors including the form of our ownership interest, our representation on the entity’s board of directors, the size of our investment (including loans) and our ability to participate in major decisions. Our ability to correctly assess our influence or control over an entity affects the presentation of these investments in the Consolidated Financial Statements and, consequently, our financial position and results of operations.

Use of Estimates

The preparation of the Consolidated Financial Statements in accordance with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the Consolidated Financial Statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Capitalization of Costs

We capitalize costs directly related to the development, pre-development, redevelopment or improvement of our investment in real estate, referred to as capital projects and other activities included within this paragraph. Costs associated with our capital projects are capitalized as incurred. If the project is abandoned, these costs are expensed during the period in which the project is abandoned. Costs considered for capitalization include, but are not limited to, construction costs, interest, real estate taxes and insurance, if appropriate. We capitalize indirect costs such as personnel, office and administrative expenses that are directly related to our development projects based on an estimate of the time spent on the construction and development activities. These costs are capitalized only during the period in which activities necessary to ready an asset for its intended use are in progress and such costs are incremental and identifiable to a specific activity to get the asset ready for its intended use. We determine when the capitalization period begins and ends through communication with project and other managers responsible for the tracking and oversight of individual projects. In the event that the activities to ready the asset for its intended use are suspended, the capitalization period will cease until such activities are resumed. In addition, we capitalize initial direct costs incurred for successful origination of new leases. Costs incurred for maintaining and repairing our properties, which do not extend their useful lives, are expensed as incurred.

Interest is capitalized based on actual capital expenditures from the period when development or redevelopment commences until the asset is ready for its intended use, at the weighted average borrowing rate during the period. We also capitalize interest on our qualifying investments in unconsolidated joint ventures based on the average capital invested in a venture during the period when the venture has activities in progress necessary to commence its planned principal operations, at our weighted average borrowing rate during the period. A “qualifying investment” is an investment in an unconsolidated joint venture provided that our investee’s activities include the use of funds to acquire qualifying assets, such as development or predevelopment activities, and planned principal operations have not commenced.

Discontinued Operations

We classify certain properties and related assets and liabilities as held for sale when certain criteria are met. At such time, the respective assets and liabilities are presented separately on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. We include liabilities related to assets held for sale that will be transferred in the transaction in “Liabilities related to assets held for sale.” Assets held for sale are reported at the lower of carrying value or estimated fair value less

 

F-9


Table of Contents

estimated costs to sell. The operating results of such properties are presented in “Income from discontinued operations” in current periods and all comparable periods presented. Depreciation is not recorded on properties held for sale; however, depreciation expense recorded prior to classification as held for sale is included in “Income from discontinued operations.” Gains on sales of real estate assets are recognized if the specific transaction terms and any continuing involvement in the form of management or financial assistance meet the various sale recognition criteria as defined by GAAP. If the criteria are not met, we defer the gain until such time that the criteria for sale recognition have been met. Net gains on sales and any impairment losses associated with assets held for sale are presented in “Income from discontinued operations” when recognized.

Fair Value

GAAP establishes a framework for measuring fair value and requires disclosures about fair value measurements. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in an orderly transaction between market participants. The guidance establishes a hierarchy for inputs used in measuring fair value based on observable and unobservable inputs by requiring that the most observable inputs be used when available. Observable inputs are based on market data obtained from independent sources. Unobservable inputs are inputs that reflect our assumptions of pricing the asset or liability based on the best information available in the circumstances. The hierarchy is broken down into three levels as follows:

Level 1: Inputs that reflect unadjusted quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in active markets;

Level 2: Inputs include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active or inactive markets or that are observable either directly or indirectly for the asset or liability; and

Level 3: Unobservable inputs are typically based on management’s own assumptions, as there is little, if any, related observable market activity.

Assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to their fair value measurement. Our assessment of the significance of a particular input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires judgment, and considers factors specific to the asset or liability.

Investment in Properties

We record the assets, liabilities and noncontrolling interests associated with property acquisitions which qualify as business combinations at their respective acquisition date fair values which are derived using a market, income or replacement cost approach, or combination thereof. Acquisition related costs associated with business combinations are expensed as incurred. As defined by GAAP, a business is an integrated set of activities and assets that is capable of being conducted and managed for the purpose of providing a return in the form of dividends, lower costs or other economic benefits directly to investors or other owners, members or participants. We do not consider acquisitions of land or unoccupied buildings to be business combinations. Rather, these transactions are treated as asset acquisitions and recorded at cost.

The fair value of identifiable tangible assets such as land, building, building and land improvements and tenant improvements is determined on an “as-if-vacant” basis. Management considers Level 3 inputs such as the replacement cost of such assets, appraisals, property condition reports, market data and other related information in determining the fair value of the tangible assets. The difference between the fair value and the face value of debt assumed in connection with an acquisition is recorded as a premium or discount and amortized to “Interest expense” over the life of the debt assumed. The valuation of assumed liabilities is based on the current market rate for similar liabilities. The recorded fair value of intangible lease assets includes Level 3 inputs and represents the value associated with in-place leases which include leasing commissions, legal and other costs, as well as an intangible asset or liability resulting from in-place leases being above or below the market rental rates over the lease term on the date of the acquisition. Intangible lease assets or liabilities are amortized over the reasonably assured lease term of the remaining in-place leases as an adjustment to “Rental revenues” or “Real estate related depreciation and amortization” depending on the nature of the intangible.

 

F-10


Table of Contents

We have certain properties which we have acquired or removed from service with the intention to redevelop the property. Buildings under redevelopment require significant construction activities prior to being placed back into service. We generally do not depreciate properties classified as redevelopment until the date that the redevelopment properties are ready for their intended use.

Real estate, including land, building, building and land improvements, tenant improvements, leasing costs and intangible lease assets and liabilities are stated at historical cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization, unless circumstances indicate that the cost cannot be recovered, in which case, the carrying value of the property is reduced to its estimated fair value.

Depreciation and Useful Lives of Real Estate Assets

Depreciation and amortization are computed on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful lives of the related assets or liabilities. Our ability to assess the useful lives of our real estate assets accurately is critical to the determination of the appropriate amount of depreciation and amortization expense recorded and the carrying values of the underlying assets. Any change to the estimated depreciable lives of these assets would have an impact on the depreciation and amortization expense we recognize.

The following table reflects the standard depreciable lives generally used to compute depreciation and amortization. However, such depreciable lives may be different based on the estimated useful life of such assets or liabilities. The carrying value of assets sold or retired and the related accumulated depreciation and/or amortization is derecognized and the resulting gain or loss, if any, is recorded during the period in which such sale or retirement occurs.

 

Description

  

Expected Useful Life

Land    Not depreciated
Building    20 – 40 years
Building and land improvements    5 – 20 years
Tenant improvements    Shorter of lease term or useful life
Leasing costs    Lease term
Other intangible lease assets    Average term of leases for property
Above/below market rent assets/liabilities    Reasonably assured lease term

Depreciation is not recorded on real estate assets currently held for sale, in pre-development, or being developed or redeveloped until the building is substantially completed and ready for its intended use, not later than one year from cessation of major construction activity.

Impairment of Properties

Investments in properties classified as held for use are carried at cost and evaluated for impairment at least annually and whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amounts of these assets may not be recoverable. Examples of such changes in circumstances include the point at which we deem a building to be held for sale, our intended hold period changes, or when a building remains vacant significantly longer than expected. For investments in properties that we intend to hold long-term, the recoverability is based on estimated future undiscounted cash flows. If the asset carrying value is not supported on an undiscounted cash flow basis, the amount of impairment is measured as the difference between the carrying value and the fair value of the asset and is reflected in “Impairment losses” on the Consolidated Statements of Operations. The determination of fair value of real estate assets to be held for use is derived using the discounted cash flow method and involves a number of management assumptions relating to future economic events that could materially affect the determination of the ultimate value, and therefore, the carrying amounts of our real estate. Such assumptions are Level 3 inputs and include, but are not limited to, projected vacancy rates, rental rates, property operating expenses and capital expenditures. The capitalization rate is also a significant driving factor in determining the

 

F-11


Table of Contents

property valuation and requires management’s judgment of factors such as market knowledge, historical experience, lease terms, customer financial strength, economy, demographics, environment, property location, visibility, age, physical condition and expected return requirements, among other things. The aforementioned factors are taken as a whole by management in determining the valuation of investment property. The valuation is sensitive to the actual results of any of these uncertain factors, either individually or taken as a whole. Should the actual results differ from management’s estimates, the valuation could be negatively affected and may result in additional impairments recorded in the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Investments in properties classified as held for sale are measured at the lower of their carrying amount or fair value (typically estimated based on the contractual sales price, a Level 2 input) less costs to sell. Impairment of assets held for sale is a component of “Income from discontinued operations” in the Consolidated Statements of Operations and is further detailed in Note 15 – Discontinued Operations and Assets Held for Sale.

Investments in and Advances to Unconsolidated Joint Ventures

We account for our investments in and advances to unconsolidated joint ventures under the equity method because we exercise significant influence over, but do not control, these entities. Under the equity method, these investments (including advances to joint ventures) are initially recorded at cost and are subsequently adjusted to reflect our proportionate share of net earnings or losses of each of the joint ventures, distributions received, contributions made and certain other adjustments, as appropriate. Such investments are included in “Investments in and advances to unconsolidated joint ventures” in our Consolidated Balance Sheets. Distributions from these investments that are related to earnings from operations are included as operating activities and distributions that are related to capital transactions are included as investing activities in our Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows.

Investment properties that are contributed to unconsolidated joint ventures are not considered discontinued operations due to our continuing involvement through maintaining an ownership interest in these investment properties and continuing to act as manager of the assets. We recognize any gains from the contribution of investment properties into an unconsolidated joint venture if the recognition criteria have been met and the cash received is not required to be reinvested. Such gains are recognized to the extent of the outside ownership interest in the joint venture in our Consolidated Statements of Operations under the heading of “Gain on dispositions of real estate interests.” Any gain related to the remaining proceeds reduces our basis in the investment in the unconsolidated joint venture, and is recognized into earnings over the weighted average life of the related property’s real estate assets. We recognize our proportionate share of the ongoing earnings or losses of each unconsolidated joint venture in “Equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated joint ventures, net” in our Consolidated Statements of Operations.

Impairment of Investments in and Advances to Unconsolidated Joint Ventures

We evaluate our investments in unconsolidated entities for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that there may be an other-than-temporary decline in value. To do so, we calculate the estimated fair value of the investment using a market, income or replacement cost approach, or combination thereof. The amount of impairment recognized, if any, would be the excess of the investment’s carrying amount over its estimated fair value. We consider various factors to determine if a decline in the value of the investment is other-than-temporary. These factors are Level 2 and 3 inputs and include but are not limited to, age of the venture, our intent and ability to retain our investment in the entity, the financial condition and long-term prospects of the entity, expected term of the investment and the relationships with the other joint venture partners and its lenders. If we believe that the decline in the fair value is temporary, no impairment is recorded. The aforementioned factors are taken as a whole by management in determining the valuation of our investment. Should the actual results differ from management’s estimates, the valuation could be negatively affected and may result in a negative impact on the Consolidated Financial Statements. See Note 4—Investments in and Advances to Unconsolidated Joint Ventures for additional information.

 

F-12


Table of Contents

Cash and Cash Equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents include cash held in financial institutions and other highly liquid short-term investments with original maturities of three months or less. We have not realized any losses in our cash and cash equivalents and believe that these short-term instruments are not exposed to any significant credit risk.

Restricted Cash

Restricted cash consists of escrow deposits held by lenders for real estate taxes, insurance and capital replacement reserves, security deposits and amounts held by intermediary agents to be used for tax-deferred, like-kind exchange transactions. As of December 31, 2013, approximately $8.8 million of restricted cash was included in “Investing Activities” in our Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows related to tax deferred, like-kind exchange transactions.

Deferred Loan Costs

Deferred loan costs include fees and costs incurred to obtain long-term financing. These fees and costs are amortized to “Interest expense” over the terms of the related loans. Accumulated amortization of deferred loan costs was approximately $6.3 million and $4.5 million as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Unamortized deferred loan costs are fully amortized when debt is retired before the maturity. Our interest expense for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 includes approximately $2.7 million, $2.1 million and $2.1 million for the amortization of loan costs, respectively, including amounts related to discontinued operations.

Straight-line Rent and Other Receivables

Straight-line rent and other receivables include all straight-line rent and current accounts receivable, net of allowances. We maintain an allowance for estimated losses that may result from the inability of our customers to make required payments. If a customer fails to make contractual payments beyond any allowance, we may recognize additional bad debt expense in future periods equal to the net outstanding balances. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, our allowance for doubtful accounts was approximately $2.2 million and $1.3 million, respectively.

Debt

Debt consists of fixed and variable rate secured mortgage notes, senior unsecured notes and a senior unsecured revolving credit facility. Discounts and premiums to the principal amounts are included in the carrying value of debt and amortized to “Interest expense” over the remaining life of the underlying debt. The aggregate premium balance, net of accumulated amortization, was approximately $2.6 million and $7.3 million as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

We may use interest rate swaps to manage certain interest rate risk. We record derivatives at fair value which are presented on a gross basis in “Other assets, net” or “Other liabilities” in our Consolidated Balance Sheets. The valuation of these instruments is determined using widely accepted valuation techniques including discounted cash flow analysis on the expected cash flows of each derivative. This analysis reflects the contractual terms of the derivatives, including the period to maturity, and uses observable market-based inputs, including interest rate curves. The fair values of interest rate swaps are determined using the market standard methodology of netting the discounted future fixed cash payments and the discounted expected variable cash receipts. The variable cash receipts are based on an expectation of future interest rates (forward curves) derived from observable market interest rate curves. We incorporate credit valuation adjustments to appropriately reflect both our own nonperformance risk and the respective counterparty’s nonperformance risk in the fair value measurements. In

 

F-13


Table of Contents

adjusting the fair value of our derivative contracts for the effect of nonperformance risk, we have considered the impact of netting and any applicable credit enhancements, such as collateral postings, thresholds, mutual puts and guarantees.

Although we have determined that the majority of the inputs used to value our derivatives fall within Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy, the credit valuation adjustments associated with our derivatives utilize Level 3 inputs, such as estimates of current credit spreads to evaluate the likelihood of default by us and our counterparties.

For derivatives designated as “cash flow” hedges, the effective portion of the changes in the fair value of the derivative is initially reported in “Accumulated other comprehensive loss” in our Consolidated Balance Sheets (i.e., not included in earnings) and subsequently reclassified into earnings when the hedged transaction affects earnings or the hedging relationship is no longer effective at which time the ineffective portion of the derivative’s change in fair value is recognized directly into earnings. We assess the effectiveness of each hedging relationship whenever financial statements are issued or earnings are reported and at least every three months. We do not use derivatives for trading or speculative purposes.

Comprehensive Income (Loss)

We report comprehensive income or loss in our Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss). Amounts reported in “Accumulated other comprehensive loss” related to settled hedging transactions will be amortized to “Interest expense” as the hedged forecasted transactions occur. Any ineffectiveness related to our hedging transactions is reported in our Consolidated Statements of Operations. See Note 6 – Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities for additional information.

Revenue Recognition

We record rental revenues on a straight-line basis under which contractual rent increases are recognized evenly over the lease term. Certain properties have leases that provide for tenant occupancy during periods where no rent is due or where minimum rent payments change during the term of the lease. Accordingly, we record receivables from tenants that we expect to collect over the remaining lease term rather than currently, which are recorded as a straight-line rent receivable. When we acquire a property, the terms of existing leases are considered to commence as of the acquisition date for the purposes of this calculation. The total increase to “Rental revenues” due to straight-line rent adjustments was approximately $5.3 million, $6.3 million and $8.3 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011.

Tenant recovery income includes payments and amounts due from tenants pursuant to their leases for real estate taxes, insurance and other recoverable property operating expenses and is recognized as “Rental revenues” during the same period the related expenses are incurred. Tenant recovery income recognized as “Rental revenues” was approximately $63.8 million, $51.7 million and $43.6 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011.

In connection with property acquisitions qualifying as business combinations, we may acquire leases with rental rates above or below the market rental rates. Such differences are recorded as an intangible lease asset or liability and amortized to “Rental revenues” over the reasonably assured term of the related leases. The unamortized balances of these assets and liabilities associated with the early termination of leases are fully amortized to their respective revenue line items in our Consolidated Statements of Operations on a straight-line basis over the estimated remaining contractual lease term. The total net impact to “Rental revenues” due to the amortization of above and below market rents was an increase of approximately $1.6 million, an increase of approximately $0.8 million and an increase of approximately $0.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

 

F-14


Table of Contents

Future minimum base rental payment, i.e., cash received for monthly contractual rent, due to us from our customers under the terms of non-cancelable operating leases in effect as of December 31, 2013 were as follows (in thousands):

 

Year Ended December 31,

   Amount  

2014

   $ 226,868   

2015

     199,725   

2016

     159,027   

2017

     124,002   

2018

     91,148   

Thereafter

     285,230   
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,086,000   
  

 

 

 

The schedule does not reflect future rental revenues from the potential renewal or replacement of existing and future leases and excludes tenant recovery income. Additionally, leases where the tenant can terminate the lease with short-term notice are not included.

Early lease termination fees are recorded in “Rental revenues” on a straight-line basis over the estimated remaining contractual lease term or upon collection if collectability is not assured. During the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, early lease termination fees were $1.3 million, $0.6 million and $0.6 million, respectively.

We earn revenues from asset management fees, acquisition fees, property management fees and fees for other services pursuant to joint venture and other agreements. These are included in our Consolidated Statements of Operations in “Institutional capital management and other fees.” We recognize revenues from asset management fees, acquisition fees, property management fees and fees for other services when the related fees are earned and are realized or realizable.

We develop certain properties for specific buyers, called build-to-suit projects. We make certain judgments based on the specific terms of each project as to the amount and timing of recognition of profits from the project. Projects are generally accounted for using the percentage of completion method or full accrual method. Profits under the percentage of completion method are based on our estimates of the percentage of completion of individual contracts, commencing when the work performed under the contracts reaches a point where the final costs can be estimated with reasonable accuracy. The percentage of completion estimates are based on a comparison of the contract expenditures incurred to the estimated final costs. Changes in job performance, job conditions and estimated profitability may result in revisions to the costs and income and are recognized in the period in which the revisions are determined. If the sale recognition criteria for using the percentage of completion or full accrual methods are not met, we apply another recognition method provided by GAAP, such as the installment or cost recovery methods. The profit recognized from these projects is reported net of estimated taxes, when applicable, and is included in “Development profit” in our Consolidated Statements of Operations.

Share-Based Compensation

Share-based compensation awards are measured at fair value on the grant date and amortized to compensation expense on a straight-line basis over the service period during which the awards fully vest. Such expense is included in “General and administrative” expense in our Consolidated Statements of Operations. Options are valued using the Black-Scholes option pricing model, which relies on assumptions we make related to the expected term of the options, volatility, dividend yield and risk-free interest rate.

 

F-15


Table of Contents

Income and Other Taxes

The Operating Partnership is not required to pay federal and state income tax. Instead, our taxable income is allocated to our partners, who include such amounts on their federal and state income tax returns.

Our general partner has elected to be taxed as a REIT, as defined under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”). Certain of our operations (property management, asset ownership or management, sales of certain assets, etc.) may be conducted through taxable REIT subsidiaries, which are subsidiaries of the operating partnership and each of which we refer to as a TRS. A TRS is a C-corporation for which a REIT and its subsidiary C-corporation have jointly elected for the C-corporation to be a taxable REIT subsidiary of the REIT and therefore is subject to U.S. federal corporate income tax.

Generally, a REIT will not be subject to U.S. federal income taxes on net income that is distributed to the Company’s stockholders if the Company distributes at least 90% of the REIT’s taxable income. REITs are also subject to a number of other organizational and operational requirements. If the Company fails to qualify as a REIT in any taxable year, its taxable income will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at regular corporate rates (including any applicable alternative minimum tax). Even if the Company qualifies as a REIT, it may be subject to certain U.S. federal, state and local and non-U.S. income taxes. The Company will also be required to pay a 100% tax on non-arm’s length transactions between it and its taxable REIT subsidiary and on any net income from gain on property that was held for sale to customers in the ordinary course of business.

For our taxable REIT subsidiaries, deferred income taxes result from temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for U.S federal income tax purposes, as well as interest and loss carryforwards, and are measured using current enacted tax rates and laws that are expected to be in effect when the differences reverse. We reduce deferred tax assets by recording a valuation allowance when we determine based on available evidence it is more likely than not that the assets will not be realized.

We recognize penalties and interest accrued related to unrecognized tax benefits, if any, as income tax expense. To the extent interest and penalties are not assessed with respect to uncertain tax positions, amounts accrued will be reduced and reflected as a reduction of the overall income tax expense. We had no interest expense or penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 or 2011.

We recognize tax benefits of uncertain tax positions only if it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained, based solely on its technical merits, with the taxing authority having full knowledge of all relevant information. The measurement of a tax benefit for an uncertain tax position that meets the “more likely than not” threshold is based on a cumulative probability model under which the largest amount of tax benefit recognized is the amount with a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement with the taxing authority having full knowledge of all the relevant information. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, there were no unrecognized tax benefits. We do not anticipate a significant change to the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits within the next 12 months. Our federal income tax returns and income tax returns for various state and local jurisdictions are subject to examination by the Internal Revenue Service for the year ended December 31, 2009 and subsequent years.

New Accounting Standards

During the second quarter of 2011, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-04, Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRS, which generally aligns the principles for fair value measurements and the related disclosure requirements under US GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”). This standard requires new disclosures, with a particular focus on Level 3 measurements, including quantitative information about the significant unobservable inputs used for all Level 3 measurements, qualitative discussion

 

F-16


Table of Contents

about the sensitivity of recurring Level 3 measurements to changes in the unobservable inputs disclosed, including the interrelationship between inputs, and a description of the company’s valuation processes. This standard also requires disclosure of any transfers between Levels 1 and 2 of the fair value hierarchy, information about when the current use of a non-financial asset measured at fair value differs from its highest and best use, and the hierarchy classification for items whose fair value is not recorded on the balance sheet but is disclosed in the notes. This standard was effective for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. In conjunction with the adoption of this standard, we made an accounting policy election to measure the credit risk of our derivative financial instruments that are subject to master netting agreements on a net basis by counterparty portfolio. We adopted this standard effective January 1, 2012.

Also during the second quarter of 2011, the FASB issued an accounting standards update that eliminates the option to present components of other comprehensive income (“OCI”) in the statement of changes in equity, and requires the presentation of components of net income and OCI either in a single continuous statement or in two separate but consecutive statements. This standard requires retrospective application and was effective for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. We adopted this standard on January 1, 2012 and have presented the components of net income and other comprehensive income in two separate but consecutive statements.

In February 2013, the FASB issued an accounting standard update that requires disclosure of the effect of significant reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income on the respective line items in net income if the amount is required under GAAP to be reclassified in its entirety to net income. Additionally, the update requires disclosure of changes in each component of OCI. The disclosure requirements were retroactively effective for us on January 1, 2013. As this guidance only requires expanded disclosure, the adoption did not have any impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements.

Note 3—Investment in Properties

Our consolidated investment in properties consist of operating properties, redevelopment properties, properties under development, properties in pre-development and land held for future development or other purposes. The historical cost of our investment in properties was (in thousands):

 

     December 31,     December 31,  
     2013     2012  

Operating properties

   $ 3,442,442      $ 3,209,024   

Properties under redevelopment

     12,194        14,699   

Properties under development

     142,903        80,008   

Properties in pre-development including land held

     73,512        81,796   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Investment in Properties

     3,671,051        3,385,527   

Less accumulated depreciation and amortization

     (654,097     (605,888
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Investment in Properties

   $ 3,016,954      $ 2,779,639   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-17


Table of Contents

Acquisition Activity

2013 Acquisition Activity

During the year ended December 31, 2013, we acquired 38 buildings totaling 7.1 million square feet for a total purchase price of $359.5 million, excluding our existing ownership of 3.6% in the seven properties previously held by TRT-DCT Venture I (see Note 4 – Investments in and Advances to Unconsolidated Joint Ventures for further detail). The table below represents a summary of our acquisitions during 2013:

 

     Market    Number of
Buildings
     Square Feet  

East Operating Segment:

   Atlanta      4         684,000   
   Pennsylvania      5         1,275,000   
   Charlotte      1         472,000   
   Miami      1         211,000   
   New Jersey      2         308,000   

Central Operating Segment:

   Chicago      9         2,209,000   
   Dallas      4         506,000   
   Houston      1         88,000   

West Operating Segment:

   Northern California      2         439,000   
   Phoenix      3         308,000   
   Seattle      1         39,000   
   Southern California      5         583,000   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
   Total      38         7,122,000   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

2012 Acquisition Activity

During the year ended December 31, 2012, we acquired 32 buildings totaling 6.2 million square feet for a total purchase price of approximately $338.4 million, excluding our existing ownership of 20% in the six properties previously held by DCT Fund I (see Note 4 – Investments in and Advances to Unconsolidated Joint Ventures for further detail related to the buyout of our joint venture partner’s interest). The table below represents a summary of our acquisitions during 2012:

 

     Market    Number of
Buildings
     Square Feet  

East Operating Segment:

   Atlanta      2         735,000   
   Pennsylvania      1         100,000   
   Memphis      1         1,039,000   
   Miami      1         50,000   
   New Jersey      2         194,000   

Central Operating Segment:

   Chicago      6         1,034,000   
   Dallas      2         1,090,000   
   Houston      5         522,000   

West Operating Segment:

   Northern California      1         337,000   
   Phoenix      1         76,000   
   Seattle      2         136,000   
   Southern California      8         862,000   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
   Total      32         6,175,000   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-18


Table of Contents

Development Activity

2013 Development Activity

During 2013, we continued to expand our development activities. The table below represents a summary of our consolidated development activity as of December 31, 2013:

 

Project

  Market     Acres     Number
of
Buildings
    Square Feet     Percent
Owned
    Cumulative
Costs at
12/31/2013
    Projected
Investment
    Completion
Date(1)
    Percent
Leased
 
                      (in thousands)           (in thousands)     (in thousands)              

Development Activities

                 

Projects in Lease Up

                 

DCT Airtex Industrial Center

    Houston        13        1        267        100   $ 12,161      $ 14,983        Q4-2013        100

DCT 55

    Chicago        33        1        604        100     26,218        28,318        Q4-2012        66
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total

      46        2        871        100   $ 38,379      $ 43,301          77
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Under Construction

                 

DCT Beltway Tanner Business Center

    Houston        11        1        133       100   $ 10,201      $ 15,153        Q1-2014        0

8th & Vineyard B

    So. California        4        1        99       91     5,243        6,197        Q1-2014        0

DCT Summer South Distribution Center

    Seattle        9        1        188       100     9,194        13,060        Q1-2014        0

DCT White River Corporate Center Phase I

    Seattle        30        1        649       100     23,051        42,433        Q2-2014        0

Slover Logistics Center II

    So. California        28        1        610       100     24,241        37,496        Q1-2014        100

DCT Auburn 44

    Seattle        3        1        49       100     3,341        4,547        Q1-2014        100

DCT Rialto Logistics Center

    So. California        42        1        928       100     21,480        59,523        Q3-2014        0
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total

      127        7        2,656       100   $ 96,751      $ 178,409          25
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

Build-to-Suit for Sale

                 

8th & Vineyard A

    So. California        6        1        130        91   $ 7,773      $ 8,703        Q1-2014        N/A   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total

      6        1        130        91   $ 7,773      $ 8,703       
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total Development Activities

      179        10        3,657        99   $ 142,903      $ 230,413          38
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

(1)  The completion date represents the date of building shell completion or estimated date of shell completion.

2013 Development Profits

Construction was completed during the second quarter of 2013 on the Dulles Summit build-to-suit project. We recognized development profits, net of tax of approximately $0.3 million and $0.3 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 related to the development of the Dulles Summit build-to-suit project. As of December 31, 2013, we had one build-to-suit for sale project, 8th and Vineyard A, under contract. Due to the terms of the contract, timing of payments and the sale recognition criteria of GAAP, no profit was recognized in 2013. The construction and sale were completed in January 2014, at which time the development profit was recognized.

2013 Development Acquisitions

During the year ended December 31, 2013, we acquired five land parcels for future development which total approximately 128.6 acres located in the Southern California, Seattle, Miami and Houston markets. The land parcels were acquired for a total purchase price of $40.5 million.

2012 Development Acquisitions

During the year ended December 31, 2012, we acquired seven land parcels for future development which totaled approximately 216.4 acres located in the Chicago, Southern California, Seattle, Atlanta and Houston markets and

 

F-19


Table of Contents

one shell-complete building totaling approximately 0.3 million square feet in Houston. The land parcels and shell-complete building were acquired from unrelated third-parties for a total purchase price of $72.1 million.

Disposition Activity

2013 Disposition Activity

During the year ended December 31, 2013, we sold 51 operating properties, totaling 6.8 million square feet, to third-parties for gross proceeds of approximately $265.8 million. We recognized gains of approximately $33.6 million on the disposition of 36 operating properties and recognized an impairment loss of approximately $13.3 million on the disposition of a portfolio of 15 properties in Dallas. All gains and impairment associated with these sales are reflected in “Income from discontinued operations” in the Consolidated Financial Statements. The table below represents a summary of our dispositions during 2013:

 

     Market    Number of
Buildings
     Square Feet  

East Operating Segment:

   Atlanta      1         578,000   
   Memphis      2         1,439,000   

Central Operating Segment:

   Mexico      15         1,653,000   
   Cincinnati      1         710,000   
   Dallas      17         640,000   
   San Antonio      13         1,177,000   
   Louisville      1         221,000   

West Operating Segment:

   Northern California      1         396,000   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
   Total      51         6,814,000   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

2012 Disposition Activity

During the year ended December 31, 2012, we sold 36 operating properties, totaling 4.1 million square feet, to third-parties for combined gross proceeds of approximately $155.0 million. We recognized gains of approximately $13.4 million on the disposition of 23 operating properties and recognized an impairment loss of approximately $11.4 million on the disposition of a portfolio of 13 properties in Atlanta. All gains and impairment associated with these sales are reflected in “Income from discontinued operations” in the Consolidated Financial Statements. The table below represents a summary of our dispositions during 2012:

 

     Market    Number of
Buildings
     Square Feet  

East Operating Segment:

   Atlanta      16         840,000   
   Charlotte      1         80,000   
   Memphis      2         1,106,000   
   New Jersey      1         138,000   

Central Operating Segment:

   Columbus      2         821,000   
   Dallas      1         85,000   
   Houston      13         1,005,000   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
   Total      36         4,075,000   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Intangible Lease Assets and Liabilities

Aggregate amortization expense for intangible lease assets recognized in connection with property acquisitions (excluding assets and liabilities related to above and below market rents; see Note 2 - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies for additional information) was approximately $11.8 million, $9.6 million and $10.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

 

F-20


Table of Contents

Our intangible lease assets and liabilities included the following as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 (in thousands):

 

     December 31, 2013      December 31, 2012  
     Gross     Accumulated
Amortization
    Net     Weighted
Average
Remaining Life
(in Years)
     Gross     Accumulated
Amortization
    Net  

Other intangible lease assets

   $ 77,383      $ (27,668   $ 49,715        4       $ 71,846      $ (26,181   $ 45,665   

Above market rent

   $ 5,375      $ (1,761   $ 3,614        2       $ 6,621      $ (4,348   $ 2,273   

Below market rent

   $ (26,562   $ 6,173      $ (20,389     9       $ (27,590   $ 7,442      $ (20,148

The following table describes the estimated net amortization of such intangible assets and liabilities and the net impact to rental revenues due to the amortization of above and below market rents for the next five years and thereafter (in thousands):

 

For the Period Ended December 31,

   Estimated Net
Amortization of
Lease Intangible Assets
     Estimated Net Increase
to Rental Revenues Related to
Above and
Below Market Rents
 

2014

   $ 12,284       $ 1,686   

2015

     9,671         1,507   

2016

     7,290         1,065   

2017

     5,451         840   

2018

     3,544         480   

Thereafter

     11,475         11,197   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 49,715       $ 16,775   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Casualty and Involuntary Conversion Events

During 2013, we recognized a gain of approximately $0.3 million as a result of a settlement pursuant to eminent domain proceedings.

During 2012 and 2011, a series of storms caused damage to some of our properties which were covered by insurance for all losses, subject to our deductibles. The recoveries received for damages were in excess of the sum of our incurred losses for cleanup costs and the net book value written off for the damaged property. After all contingencies relating to the casualties were resolved, we recorded casualty gains of approximately $1.6 million and $1.3 million, during the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively, including amounts related to discontinued operations.

 

F-21


Table of Contents

Note 4—Investments in and Advances to Unconsolidated Joint Ventures

We enter into joint ventures primarily for purposes of operating and developing industrial real estate. The following describes our unconsolidated joint ventures as of December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 

     As of December 31, 2013      Investments in and
Advances to as of
 

Unconsolidated Joint Ventures

   Ownership
Percentage
    Number of
Buildings
     December 31,
2013
     December 31,
2012
 

Institutional Joint Ventures:

          

DCT/SPF Industrial Operating LLC(2)

     20.0     13       $ 41,253       $ 42,571   

TRT-DCT Venture I(1) (3) (5)

     3.6     7         823         558   

TRT-DCT Venture II(5)

     11.4     5         1,847         1,990   

TRT-DCT Venture III(2)

     10.0     4         1,197         1,225   
    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Institutional Joint Ventures

       29         45,120         46,344   

Other:

          

Stirling Capital Investments (SCLA)(4)

     50.0     6         47,978         53,840   

IDI/DCT, LLC

     50.0     3         27,735         27,736   

IDI/DCT Buford, LLC (land only)

     75.0     —           4,090         3,054   
    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Other

       9         79,803         84,630   
    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

       38       $ 124,923       $ 130,974   
    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)  As of December 31, 2012 the venture owned 14 properties. During May 2013, we purchased the remaining 96.4% interest in seven properties from TRT-DCT Venture I for additional consideration of $82.8 million. Additionally, we sold one of the properties during 2013 and the remaining six properties were consolidated as of December 31, 2013.
(2)  During 2012, our unconsolidated joint venture completed dispositions of two properties in the Cincinnati and Louisville markets where our share of gross proceeds was approximately $3.7 million. We recognized gains of $1.0 million, inclusive of a previously deferred gain of approximately $0.3 million, in “Equity in earnings (loss) in unconsolidated joint ventures” in our Consolidated Statement of Operations during the year ended December 31, 2012.
(3)  During the first quarter of 2012, our joint venture partner contributed one property into the TRT-DCT Venture I. As a result of this activity, we made a capital contribution totaling $0.2 million, which resulted in an equity ownership of 3.6%.
(4)  Although we contributed 100% of the initial cash equity capital required by the venture, our partners retain certain participation rights in the venture’s available cash flows.
(5)  In January 2014, the TRT-DCT Ventures I and II disposed of all their properties, generating net proceeds of approximately $6.6 million to the Operating Partnership.

Institutional Capital Management Joint Ventures

DCT/SPF Industrial Operating LLC

During 2007, we entered into a joint venture agreement with Industrial Acquisition LLC (“JP Morgan”), an entity advised by JPMorgan Asset Management, to form DCT/SPF Industrial Operating LLC (“JP Morgan Venture”) that owns and operates industrial properties located in the U.S. Our actual ownership percentage may vary depending on amounts of capital contributed and the timing of contributions and distributions. As of December 31, 2013 our ownership interest was 20.0%. As a result of our contribution of properties into the JP Morgan Venture in 2007, we have deferred gains of $2.6 million as of December 31, 2013, which will be recognized through earnings over the weighted average life of the related properties, or upon disposition of the properties to a third-party.

 

F-22


Table of Contents

TRT-DCT Industrial Joint Ventures I, II and III

We entered into a joint venture with Dividend Capital Diversified Property Fund (“DCDPF”), formerly known as Dividend Capital Total Realty Trust Inc., to form TRT-DCT Venture I on September 1, 2006. Our ownership percentage may vary depending on amounts of capital contributed and the timing of contributions and distributions. As of December 31, 2013 our ownership interest was 3.6%. As noted above, subsequent to December 31, 2013 the venture disposed of its seven properties.

We formed a joint venture with DCDPF, TRT-DCT Industrial Joint Venture II G.P. (“TRT-DCT Venture II”), on March 27, 2007. Our ownership percentage may vary depending on amounts of capital contributed and the timing of contributions and distributions. As of December 31, 2013 our ownership interest was 11.4%. As a result of our contribution of properties into TRT-DCT Venture II in 2007, we have deferred gains of $0.6 million as of December 31, 2013. As noted above, subsequent to December 31, 2013 the venture disposed of its five properties, resulting in the recognition of the $0.6 million deferred gain.

We formed a joint venture with DCDPF, TRT-DCT Industrial Joint Venture III, G.P. (“TRT-DCT Venture III”), on September 9, 2008. Our ownership percentage may vary depending on amounts of capital contributed and the timing of contributions and distributions. As of December 31, 2013 our ownership interest was 10.0%.

Development Projects in Unconsolidated Joint Ventures

SCLA

During 2006, we entered into a joint venture agreement with Stirling Airports International, LLC, (“Stirling”), an unrelated third-party, to be the master developer of up to 4,350 acres in Victorville, California, part of the Inland Empire submarket in Southern California. The development project is located at the former George Air Force Base which closed in 1992 and is now known as Southern California Logistics Airport (“SCLA”). We refer to this joint venture as the SCLA joint venture. Stirling entered into two master development agreements which gave it certain rights to be the exclusive developer of the SCLA development project through 2019 (including certain extensions) and assigned these rights to the SCLA joint venture upon the closing of the venture. While our exact share of the equity interests in the SCLA joint venture will depend on the amount of capital we contribute and the timing of contributions and distributions, the SCLA joint venture contemplates an equal sharing between us and Stirling of residual profits and cash flows after all priority distributions. As of December 31, 2013, the SCLA joint venture owned six operating buildings comprised of 2.2 million square feet which were 99.6% occupied and an additional 181.4 acres of land available for development.

IDI/DCT, LLC

During 2007, we entered into a joint venture agreement with Industrial Developments International, Inc. (“IDI”), an unrelated third-party developer, to acquire approximately 113 acres of land to develop four distribution buildings comprising approximately 1.9 million square feet in the Savannah, GA, Nashville, TN, Chicago, IL, and Stockton, CA markets. The Operating Partnership has the right of first offer to buy each of the projects and the buildings are operating.

In 2011, the joint venture sold one of its buildings located in Stoughton, CA to a third-party. As a result of the contractual sales price less costs to sell being lower than the carrying amount of the related real estate assets, the joint venture recognized an impairment loss. Our portion of the impairment loss was approximately $2.0 million, which is included in “Impairment losses on investments in unconsolidated joint ventures” in our Consolidated Statement of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2011.

IDI/DCT Buford, LLC

During 2008, we entered into a joint venture agreement with IDI to form IDI/DCT Buford, LLC. This joint venture was funded for the purpose of developing distribution buildings on approximately 47 acres that were contributed to the joint venture by the Operating Partnership.

 

F-23


Table of Contents

Summarized Financial Information

The following table provides unaudited selected combined financial information for unconsolidated joint ventures as of and for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 (in thousands):

 

     2013     2012     2011  

Real estate, net of accumulated depreciation

   $ 528,130      $ 630,478      $ 739,373   

Total assets

   $ 548,833      $ 651,971      $ 765,427   

Notes payable

   $ 191,100      $ 272,948      $ 290,983   

Total liabilities

   $ 202,620      $ 287,046      $ 368,018   

Partners’ capital

   $ 346,213      $ 364,925      $ 397,409   

Rental revenues

   $ 54,363      $ 66,052      $ 62,971   

Operating expenses

   $ 13,677      $ 16,343      $ 16,270   

Depreciation expense

   $ 25,300      $ 33,734      $ 33,769   

Interest expense

   $ (11,686   $ 22,117      $ 20,754   

Net loss

   $ (1,090   $ (3,688   $ (12,767

Our aggregate investment in these partnerships at December 31, 2013 and 2012 of approximately $124.9 million and $131.0 million, respectively, exceeds our share of the underlying equity in the net assets of our joint ventures by approximately $19.0 million and $18.4 million, respectively, primarily due to capitalized interest and other costs incurred in connection with the ventures.

Guarantees

There are no lines of credit or side agreements related to, or between, our unconsolidated joint ventures and us, and there are no derivative financial instruments between our unconsolidated joint ventures and us. In addition, we believe we have no material exposure to financial guarantees.

Note 5—Outstanding Indebtedness

As of December 31, 2013, our outstanding indebtedness of approximately $1.5 billion consisted of mortgage notes, senior unsecured notes and a senior unsecured revolving credit facility, excluding approximately $44.4 million representing our proportionate share of debt associated with unconsolidated joint ventures. As of December 31, 2012, our outstanding indebtedness of $1.5 billion consisted of mortgage notes, senior unsecured notes and a senior unsecured revolving credit facility, excluding approximately $45.0 million representing our proportionate share of debt associated with unconsolidated joint ventures.

As of December 31, 2013, the gross book value of our consolidated properties was approximately $3.7 billion and the gross book value of all properties securing our mortgage debt was approximately $0.7 billion. As of December 31, 2012, the total gross book value of our consolidated properties was approximately $3.4 billion and the gross book value of all properties securing our mortgage debt was approximately $0.7 billion. Our debt has various covenants with which we were in compliance as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

 

F-24


Table of Contents

Our outstanding indebtedness as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 is summarized below (in thousands):

 

     Interest
Rate(1)
           As of December 31,  
       Maturity      2013      2012  

Senior Unsecured Notes:

          

8 year, fixed rate(2)

     5.68     Jan-14       $ —         $ 50,000   

9 year, fixed rate

     5.43     Apr-20         50,000         50,000   

10 year, fixed rate(2)

     5.77     Apr-16         50,000         50,000   

5 year, fixed rate(2)

     6.11     Jun-13         —           175,000   

2 year, variable rate

     1.52     Feb-18         225,000         175,000   

Private Placement 5 year, fixed rate

     5.63     Jun-15         40,000         40,000   

Private Placement 7 year, fixed rate

     6.31     Jun-17         51,000         51,000   

Private Placement 8 year, fixed rate

     6.52     Jun-18         41,500         41,500   

Private Placement 11 year, fixed rate

     6.95     Jun-21         77,500         77,500   

2011 Private Placement 5 year, fixed rate

     4.02     Aug-16         49,000         49,000   

2011 Private Placement 7 year, fixed rate

     4.69     Aug-18         40,000         40,000   

2011 Private Placement 8 year, fixed rate

     4.97     Aug-19         46,000         46,000   

2011 Private Placement 10 year, fixed rate

     5.42     Aug-21         15,000         15,000   

2011 Private Placement 11 year, fixed rate

     5.50     Aug-22         40,000         40,000   

2011 Private Placement 12 year, fixed rate

     5.57     Aug-23         35,000         35,000   

2012 Private Placement 10yr, fixed rate(2)

     4.21     Sept-22         90,000         90,000   

2013 Private Placement 10yr, fixed rate

     4.50     Oct-23         275,000         —     

Mortgage Notes:

          

111 Lake Drive

     5.79     Apr-13         —           4,885   

Binney & Smith Distribution Center

     6.97     Jun-13         —           6,154   

8 year, fixed rate

     4.97     Oct-13         —           16,283   

Shelby 5

     5.69     Dec-13         —           5,651   

1700 Desoto

     6.00     Apr-14         3,264         3,338   

10 year, fixed rate(2)

     5.31     Jan-15         44,566         36,873   

Cargo Ventures

     5.77     Feb-16         52,971         54,040   

116 Lehigh Drive

     6.08     Aug-16         4,453         4,453   

State Highway 225

     6.25     Aug-17         5,893         6,023   

Shelby 4

     7.40     Dec-17         609         739   

Miami Commerce Center

     6.91     Oct-18         2,948         3,455   

Cabot

     6.17     Feb-19         50,357         51,108   

Cabot

     6.11     Feb-20         66,387         67,393   

7425 Pinemont

     6.25     Jul-20         2,488         2,523   

Rollins Road

     4.25     Dec-21         19,021         19,502   

Haven A

     7.29     Oct-22         7,676         8,282   

Shelby 19

     6.72     Nov-22         8,171         8,829   

740 Palmyrita

     4.72     Jun-23         6,155         —     

Haven G

     4.72     Jun-23         965         —     

6th & Rochester

     4.96     Aug-23         3,147         3,394   

Mohawk

     5.75     Aug-25         6,650         7,043   
       

 

 

    

 

 

 

Weighted Avg./Totals(3)

     4.71        1,410,721         1,334,968   

Premiums/Discounts, Net of Amortization

     N/A           2,646         7,346   
       

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Senior Unsecured Notes and Mortgage Notes

     N/A           1,413,367         1,342,314   

Senior Unsecured Revolving Credit Facility

     1.34     Feb-17         39,000         110,000   
       

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Carrying Value of Debt

     N/A         $ 1,452,367       $ 1,452,314   
       

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fixed Rate Debt(3)

     5.32      $ 1,185,721       $ 1,159,968   

Premiums/Discounts, Net of Amortization

     N/A           2,646         7,346   

Variable Rate Debt(3)

     1.49        264,000         285,000   
       

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Carrying Value of Debt

     N/A         $ 1,452,367       $ 1,452,314   
       

 

 

    

 

 

 

(footnotes on following page)

 

F-25


Table of Contents
(1)  Interest rates for fixed rate debt are stated rates. Interest rates for variable rate debt are the interest rate charged as of the last payment in 2013.
(2)  We settled certain derivative instruments related to these notes and the settlement amount of these derivative instruments are amortized to interest expense over the life of the assigned notes.
(3)  Weighted average interest rates are based upon outstanding balances as of December 31, 2013.

Debt Payoffs, Refinancing and Issuance

During February 2013, we entered into an amendment with our syndicated bank group whereby we extended and increased our existing $175.0 million senior unsecured term loan to $225.0 million for a period of five years, extended our existing $300.0 million senior unsecured line of credit for a period of four years and received a commitment for an additional $175.0 million senior unsecured term loan with a term of two years. We closed on the additional $175.0 million in March 2013, which was used to refinance a scheduled June 2013 maturity of $175.0 million of other senior unsecured debt.

During March and April 2013, we retired $11.0 million mortgage notes previously scheduled to mature in April and June of 2013, using proceeds from our senior unsecured revolving credit facility and our equity offerings.

During June 2013, we issued two secured mortgage notes with principal balances of $1.0 million and $6.2 million which mature in June 2023. The notes bear interest at a variable rate; however we have fixed the rate at 4.72% using two interest rate swaps (See Note 6 – Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities for further detail). The notes require monthly payments of principal and interest.

During October 2013, we issued $275.0 million aggregate principal amount of 4.50% senior notes due 2023 at 99.038% of face value in a private placement for net proceeds of approximately $269.6 million after offering costs. We primarily used the net proceeds to repay a $15.9 million mortgage note that was scheduled to mature in October 2013, a $50.0 million senior unsecured note that was scheduled to mature in January of 2014 and our $175.0 million senior unsecured term loan that was scheduled to mature in February 2015.

During the year ended December 31, 2012, we retired mortgage notes totaling approximately $64.7 million previously scheduled to mature in September 2012, October 2012, November 2012, January 2013 and January 2015, using proceeds from the our senior unsecured revolving credit facility and with proceeds from our equity offerings.

In September 2012, we issued $90.0 million of fixed rate, senior unsecured notes through a private placement offering. These senior unsecured notes mature in September 2022 and have a fixed interest rate of 4.21%. The notes require semi-annual interest payments. The proceeds from these notes were used to repay outstanding indebtedness and for general corporate purposes.

Debt Assumptions

During the year ended December 31, 2012, we assumed four mortgage notes with outstanding balances totaling $67.5 million in connection with property acquisitions. The assumed notes bear interest at rates ranging from 5.77% to 6.25% and require monthly payments of principal and interest. The notes mature at various dates from February 2016 to July 2020. We recorded approximately $5.8 million of premiums in connection with the assumption of these notes.

For the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, the amortization of all premiums/discounts resulted in a reduction of interest expense of approximately $2.1 million, $1.0 million and $1.1 million, respectively, including amounts from discontinued operations.

 

F-26


Table of Contents

Line of Credit

As of December 31, 2013, we had $39.0 million outstanding and $261.0 million available under our senior unsecured revolving credit facility. As of December 31, 2012, we had $110.0 million outstanding and $190.0 million available under our senior unsecured revolving credit facility.

Interest Expense and Capitalized Interest

During the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, we incurred interest expense of approximately $71.7 million, $73.7 million and $66.9 million, respectively, including amounts included in discontinued operations. We capitalized approximately $8.3 million, $4.3 million and $2.7 million of interest in 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively, associated with certain development and redevelopment, and other construction activities.

Debt Maturities

The following table sets forth the scheduled maturities of our debt and regularly scheduled principal amortization, excluding unamortized premiums, as of December 31, 2013 (in thousands):

 

Year

   Senior
Unsecured
Notes
     Mortgage
Notes
     Senior Unsecured
Revolving
Credit Facility
     Total  

2014

   $ —         $ 10,927       $ —         $ 10,927   

2015

     40,000         49,982         —           89,982   

2016

     99,000         61,184         —           160,184   

2017

     51,000         11,768         39,000         101,768   

2018

     306,500         6,412         —           312,912   

Thereafter

     628,500         145,448         —           773,948   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,125,000       $ 285,721       $ 39,000       $ 1,449,721   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Guarantee of Debt

DCT has guaranteed the Operating Partnership’s obligations with respect to the senior unsecured notes and the senior unsecured revolving credit facility.

 

F-27


Table of Contents

Note 6—Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the fair values of cash and cash equivalents, restricted cash, accounts receivable and accounts payable approximated their carrying values due to the short-term nature of settlement of these instruments. The fair values of other financial instruments subject to fair value disclosures were determined based on available market information and valuation methodologies we believe to be appropriate estimates for these purposes. Considerable judgment and a high degree of subjectivity are involved in developing these estimates. Our estimates may differ from the actual amounts that we could realize upon disposition. The following table summarizes these financial instruments (in thousands):

 

     Balances as of
December 31, 2013
     Balances as of
December 31, 2012
 
     Carrying
Amounts
     Estimated
Fair Value
     Carrying
Amounts
     Estimated
Fair Value
 

Borrowings(1):

           

Senior unsecured revolving credit facility

   $ 39,000       $ 39,000       $ 110,000       $ 110,000   

Fixed rate debt(2)

   $ 1,188,367       $ 1,263,722       $ 1,167,314       $ 1,306,761   

Variable rate debt

   $ 225,000       $ 226,153       $ 175,000       $ 176,922   

Interest rate contracts:

           

Interest rate swap(3)

   $ 212       $ 212       $ —         $ —     

 

(1)  The fair values of our borrowings were estimated using a discounted cash flow methodology. Credit spreads and market interest rates used to determine the fair value of these instruments are based on unobservable Level 3 inputs which management has determined to be its best estimate of current market values.
(2)  The carrying amount of our fixed rate debt includes premiums and discounts.
(3)  The fair value of our interest rate swap is determined using the market standard methodology of netting the discounted future fixed cash flows and the discounted expected variable cash flows based on an expectation of future interest rates derived from Level 2 observable market interest rate curves. We also incorporate a credit valuation adjustment, which is derived using unobservable Level 3 inputs, to appropriately reflect both our nonperformance risk and the respective counterparty’s nonperformance risk in the fair value measurement.

The following table displays a reconciliation of assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 (in thousands). The table also displays gains and losses due to changes in fair value, including both realized and unrealized, recognized in the Consolidated Statements of Operations for Level 3 liabilities. When assets and liabilities are transferred between levels, we recognize the transfer at the beginning of the period. There were no transfers between levels during the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012.

 

     During the
Year Ended
December 31,
 
     2013      2012  

Level 3 Assets (Liabilities):

     

Interest Rate Swaps:

     

Beginning balance at January 1

   $     —         $ (26,746

Net unrealized income (loss) included in accumulated other comprehensive loss

     123         (6,127

Realized loss recognized in interest expense

     89         (677

Cash paid for settlement of hedge

     —           33,550   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ending balance at December 31

   $ 212       $ —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-28


Table of Contents

Hedging Activities

During June 2013, certain of our consolidated ventures entered into two pay- fixed, receive-floating interest rate swaps to hedge the variability of future cash flows attributable to changes in the 1 month LIBOR rates. The first pay-fixed, receive-floating swap has a notional amount of $6.2 million, an effective date of June 2013 and a maturity date of June 2023. The second pay-fixed, receive-floating swap has a notional amount of $1.0 million, an effective date of June 2013 and a maturity date of June 2023. These interest rates swaps effectively fix the interest rate on the related debt instruments at 4.72%. During July 2012, we settled our forward-starting swap for $33.6 million, which was in place to hedge the variability of cash flows associated with forecasted issuances of debt, contemporaneously with locking rate for $90.0 million of debt which was funded in September 2012.

On a recurring basis, we measure our derivatives at fair value, which was a gross asset of approximately $0.2 million as of December 31, 2013. This amount was included in “Other assets, net” in our Consolidated Balance Sheet. The fair value of our derivatives was determined using Level 2 and 3 inputs. We utilized a third-party derivative valuation expert to assist in the determination of the fair value for each reporting period. The effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives designated and that qualify as cash flow hedges is recorded in “Accumulated other comprehensive loss” and is subsequently reclassified into earnings in the period that the hedged forecasted transaction affects earnings. The ineffective portion of the change in fair value of the derivatives is recognized directly in earnings and is recorded as “Interest expense” in our Consolidated Statements of Operations.

The following table presents the effect of our derivative financial instruments on our accompanying consolidated financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 (in thousands):

 

     For the Year Ended  
     2013     2012     2011  

Derivatives in Cash Flow Hedging Relationships

      

Interest Rate Swaps:

      

Amount of gain (loss) recognized in OCI for effective portion of derivatives

   $ 675      $ (6,776   $ (16,508
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amount of loss reclassified from accumulated OCI for effective portion of derivatives into interest expense and equity earnings of unconsolidated joint ventures

   $ (4,490   $ (2,098   $ (970
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amount of loss recognized in interest expense due to missed forecast (ineffective portion and amount excluded from effectiveness testing)

   $ —        $ 677      $ —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amounts reported in “Accumulated other comprehensive loss” related to derivatives will be amortized to “Interest expense” as interest payments are made on our current debt and anticipated debt issuances. During the next 12 months, we estimate that approximately $4.3 million will be reclassified from “Accumulated other comprehensive loss” to “Interest expense” resulting in an increase in interest expense.

Note 7—Commitments and Contingencies

Legal Matters

We are a party to various legal actions and administrative proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business, some of which may be covered by liability insurance, and none of which we expect to have a material adverse effect on our consolidated financial condition or results of operations.

 

F-29


Table of Contents

Operating Leases

We are obligated under non-cancelable office space, ground and equipment operating leases. Approximate minimum annual rentals under operating leases are as follows (in thousands):

 

Year Ended December 31:

   Operating
Leases
     Ground Leases  

2014

   $ 941       $ 509   

2015

     882         564   

2016

     726         559   

2017

     141         551   

2018

     23         551   

Thereafter

     —           10,234   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 2,713       $ 12,968   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Substantially all of the office space and equipment subject to the operating leases described above are for the use at our corporate and regional offices. Rent expense recognized was approximately $0.9 million, $0.7 million and $1.1 million during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

Note 8—Noncontrolling Interests

Noncontrolling interests are the portion of equity, or net assets, in a subsidiary not attributable, directly or indirectly, to a parent. Our noncontrolling interests primarily represent equity interests held by third-party partners in our consolidated real estate joint ventures. Our noncontrolling interests held by third-party partners in our consolidated joint ventures totaled $12.0 million and $11.2 million as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

The following table illustrates the noncontrolling interests’ share of our consolidated net income (loss) during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
 
     2013     2012      2011  

Noncontrolling interests’ share of (income) loss from continuing operations

   $ (589   $ 272       $ 958   

Noncontrolling interests’ share of (income) loss from discontinued operations

     —          —           —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net (income) loss attributable to noncontrolling interests

   $ (589   $ 272       $ 958   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Note 9—Partners’ Capital

OP Units

As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, DCT owned approximately 94.8% and 93.3%, respectively, of our outstanding OP Units.

DCT holds its interests through both general and limited partner units. The Amended and Restated Limited Partnership Agreement of the Operating Partnership (the “Partnership Agreement”) stipulates that the general partner shall at all times own a minimum of 1.0% of all outstanding OP Units. As a result, each reporting period certain of DCT’s limited partner units are converted to general partner units to satisfy this requirement as illustrated in the Consolidated Statements of Capital. The remaining 5.2% of the common partnership interests in the Operating Partnership were owned by executives of the Company and non-affiliated limited partners.

 

F-30


Table of Contents

Limited partners have the right to require the Company to redeem all or a portion of the OP Units held by the limited partner at a redemption price equal to and in the form of the Cash Amount (as defined in the Partnership Agreement), provided that such OP Units have been outstanding for at least one year. The Company may, in its sole discretion, purchase the OP Units by paying to the limited partner either the Cash Amount or the REIT Shares Amount (generally one share of DCT’s common stock for each OP Unit), as defined in the Partnership Agreement. DCT’s common stock is publicly traded on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) under the ticker symbol “DCT”.

During the year ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, 3.1 million and 6.2 million OP Units were redeemed for approximately $1.5 million and $3.3 million in cash and approximately 2.9 million and 5.7 million shares of DCT common stock, respectively. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012 the aggregate redemption value of the then-outstanding OP Units held by executives of the Company and non-affiliated limited partners was approximately $125.9 million and $129.6 million, respectively, based on the $7.13 and $6.49 per share closing price of DCT’s common stock on December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

On May 29, 2013, the Company registered a third continuous equity offering program, to replace its continuous equity offering program previously registered on November 20, 2012. Pursuant to this offering, DCT may sell up to 20 million shares of common stock from time-to-time through May 29, 2016 in “at-the-market” offerings or certain other transactions. During the year ended December 31, 2013, approximately 13.8 million shares were issued through the second and third continuous equity offering programs at an average price of $7.37 per share for proceeds of $100.4 million, net of offering expenses. During the year ended December 31, 2012, approximately 9.5 million shares were issued through the second continuous equity offering program, at an average price of $6.33 per share for proceeds of $59.2 million, net of offering expenses. The proceeds from the sale of shares were contributed to the Operating Partnership in exchange for an equal number of OP Units in the Operating Partnership and were used for general corporate purposes, including funding acquisitions and repaying debt. As of December 31, 2013, 16.6 million shares remain available to be issued under the current offering.

On August 13, 2013, the Company issued 23.0 million shares of common stock in a public offering at a price of $7.20 per share for proceeds of $158.2 million, net of offering expenses, used for acquisitions, development activities, repayment of amounts under our senior unsecured revolving credit facility and other general purposes. The proceeds from the sale of shares were contributed to the Operating Partnership in exchange for an equal number of OP Units in the Operating Partnership.

On September 12, 2012, Company issued approximately 19.0 million shares of common stock in a public offering at a price of $6.20 per share for proceeds of $112.1 million, net of offering expenses, used for acquisitions and other general corporate purposes. The proceeds from the sale of shares were contributed to the Operating Partnership in exchange for an equal number of OP Units in the Operating Partnership.

Allocations of Net Income and Net Losses to Partners

The Operating Partnership’s net income and loss will generally be allocated to the general partner and the Operating Partnership’s limited partners in accordance with the respective percentage interests in the OP Units issued by the Operating Partnership.

 

F-31


Table of Contents

Distributions

The Partnership Agreement provides that the general partner will determine in its discretion and distribute cash on a quarterly basis, pro rata in accordance with the units outstanding on the distribution record date. The general partner declared the following distributions on the Operating Partnership’s OP Units:

 

Amount Declared During Quarter Ended in 2013:

   Per Unit      Date Paid  

December 31,

   $ 0.07         January 9, 2014   

September 30,

     0.07         October 16, 2013   

June 30,

     0.07         July 17, 2013   

March 31,

     0.07         April 17, 2013   
  

 

 

    

Total 2013

   $ 0.28      
  

 

 

    

Amount Declared During Quarter Ended in 2012:

   Per Unit      Date Paid  

December 31,

   $ 0.07         January 10, 2013   

September 30,

     0.07         October 17, 2012   

June 30,

     0.07         July 18, 2012   

March 31,

     0.07         April 18, 2012   
  

 

 

    

Total 2012

   $ 0.28      
  

 

 

    

Amount Declared During Quarter Ended in 2011:

   Per Unit      Date Paid  

December 31,

   $ 0.07         January 12, 2012   

September 30,

     0.07         October 18, 2011   

June 30,

     0.07         July 19, 2011   

March 31,

     0.07         April 19, 2011   
  

 

 

    

Total 2011

   $ 0.28      
  

 

 

    

Note 10—Earnings per Unit

We use the two-class method of computing earnings per unit which is an earnings allocation formula that determines earnings per unit for OP Units and any participating securities according to distributions declared (whether paid or unpaid) and participation rights in undistributed earnings. Under the two-class method, earnings per unit are computed by dividing the sum of distributed earnings to OP Unitholders and undistributed earnings allocated to OP Unitholders by the weighted average number of units outstanding for the period.

A participating security is defined by GAAP as an unvested share-based payment award containing non-forfeitable rights to distributions and must be included in the computation of earnings per unit pursuant to the two-class method. The Company’s nonvested restricted stock and LTIP Units, as defined in Note 11 – Equity Based Compensation, are considered participating securities as these share-based awards contain non-forfeitable rights to dividends irrespective of whether the awards ultimately vest or expire.

 

F-32


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the computation of our basic and diluted earnings per unit (in thousands except per unit information):

 

     For the Year Ended December 31,  
     2013     2012     2011  

Earnings per OP Unit – Basic and Diluted

      

Numerator

      

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (9,251   $ (28,540   $ (42,503

(Income) loss from continuing operations attributable to noncontrolling interests

     (589     272        958   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from continuing operations attributable to OP Unitholders

     (9,840     (28,268     (41,545

Less: Distributed and undistributed earnings allocated to participating securities

     (692     (524     (443
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Numerator for adjusted loss from continuing operations attributable to OP Unitholders

     (10,532     (28,792     (41,988
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from discontinued operations

     26,723        11,800        13,660   

Noncontrolling interests’ share of income from discontinued operations

     —          —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Numerator for income from discontinued operations attributable to OP Unitholders

     26,723        11,800        13,660   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 16,191      $ (16,992   $ (28,328
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Denominator

      

Weighted average OP Units outstanding – basic and dilutive

     317,848        278,189        267,901   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Earnings per OP Unit – Basic and Diluted

      

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (0.03   $ (0.10   $ (0.16

Income from discontinued operations

     0.08        0.04        0.05   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 0.05      $ (0.06   $ (0.11
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Potentially Dilutive Units

We have excluded from diluted earnings per unit the weighted average common unit equivalents related to approximately 5.8 million, 5.5 million and 5.7 million DCT stock options and phantom shares for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 respectively, because their effect would be anti-dilutive.

Note 11—Equity Based Compensation

For each share of common stock issued by DCT pursuant its equity compensation plan, the Operating Partnership issues a corresponding OP Unit.

Long-Term Incentive Plan

On October 10, 2006, the Company adopted, and the general partner’s stockholders approved, the Long-Term Incentive Plan, as amended. The Company may grant restricted stock, stock options and other equity awards to personnel and directors, as defined in the plan. Subject to adjustment upon certain corporate transactions or events, the total number of shares of DCT’s common stock subject to such awards may not exceed 23.0 million shares and in no event may any optionee receive options for more than 2.0 million shares on an annual basis.

 

F-33


Table of Contents

Phantom Shares

Pursuant to the Long-Term Incentive Plan, as amended, the Company may grant phantom shares to non-employee directors. Phantom shares generally vest upon the first anniversary of the grant date, depending on the grant. Once vested and at the discretion of the grantee, the phantom stock can be converted into either cash or common stock at the option of the Company. Phantom shares are recorded at their fair value on the date of grant and amortized to compensation expense on a straight-line basis over the service period during which term the shares vest.

Restricted Stock

Restricted stock is recorded at fair value on the date of grant and amortized to compensation expense on a straight-line basis over the service period during which term the stock fully vests. Restricted stock generally vests ratably over a period of four to five years, depending on the grant.

LTIP Units

Pursuant to the Long-Term Incentive Plan, as amended, the Company may grant limited partnership interests in the Operating Partnership called LTIP Units. Vested LTIP Units may be redeemed by the Company in cash or DCT common stock, at the discretion of the Company, on a one-for-one basis with common shares, subject to certain restrictions of the Partnership Agreement. LTIP Units receive distributions equally along with common shares. LTIP Units are valued by reference to the value of DCT’s common stock and generally vest ratably over a period of four to five years, depending on the grant. LTIP Unit equity compensation is amortized into expense over the service period during which the units vest.

During the year ended December 31, 2013, 0.7 million LTIP Units were granted to certain senior executives, which vest over a four year period with a total fair value of $4.6 million at the date of grant as determined by a lattice-binomial option-pricing model based on a Monte Carlo simulation using a volatility factor of 52% and a risk-free interest rate of 0.84%.

During the year ended December 31, 2012, 0.7 million LTIP Units were granted to senior executives, which vest over a four or five year period with a total fair value of $3.9 million at the date of grant as determined by a lattice-binomial option-pricing model based on a Monte Carlo simulation using a volatility factor of 72% and risk-free interest rates ranging from 0.82% to 1.04%.

During the year ended December 31, 2011, 0.6 million LTIP Units were granted to senior executives, which vest over a period of four to five years with a total fair value $3.0 million at the date of grant as determined by a lattice-binomial option-pricing model based on a Monte Carlo simulation using volatility factors ranging from 67% to 71% and risk-free interest rates ranging from 0.85% to 2.18%.

Multi-Year Outperformance Program

On January 11, 2011, the Company adopted a multi-year outperformance program, which is a long-term incentive compensation program, and granted awards under the program to certain officers and senior executives.

The awards entitle participants to receive shares of DCT’s common stock with a maximum value of $10 million based on the absolute and relative total return to stockholders during the three-year performance period beginning on December 31, 2009. Half of the awards are based on DCT’s absolute total return to stockholders during the performance period and the other half are based on DCT’s relative total return to stockholders during the performance period compared to the performance of the MSCI US REIT Index during the same period.

Each participant’s award is designated as a specified percentage of the aggregate award value earned during the performance period, and participants are also entitled to a share of any unallocated portion of the aggregate award value. At the end of the performance period, each participant will be issued shares of DCT’s common

 

F-34


Table of Contents

stock with a value equal to that participant’s share of the aggregate award value. Half of the shares of common stock issued will be fully vested upon issuance at the end of the performance period and the remaining half will vest on the first anniversary of that date based on continued employment. The Company may also permit participants to elect to receive their awards in the form of LTIP Units or other equivalent forms of equity in lieu of shares of DCT’s common stock.

During the year ended December 31, 2013, 0.4 million LTIP Units were granted with a grant date fair value of approximately $2.4 million. There were no awards granted under the program during 2012 or 2011.

The following table summarizes the number of awards redeemed and converted to DCT’s common stock on a one for one basis, the fair value at grant date for the awards vested during the period and the number of awards outstanding at period end related to phantom shares, restricted stock and LTIP Units:

 

     Phantom      Restricted         
     Shares      Stock      LTIP Units  

During the year ended December 31, 2013:

        

Common stock issued for vested awards (in thousands)

     20         187         —     

Fair value of awards vested (in millions)

   $ 0.4       $ 1.2       $ 2.1   

Awards outstanding at end of period (in millions)

     0.2         0.6         3.0   

During the year ended December 31, 2012:

        

Common stock issued for vested awards (in thousands)

     14         130         687   

Fair value of awards vested (in millions)

   $ 0.3       $ 0.7       $ 1.2   

Awards outstanding at end of period (in millions)

     0.2         0.5         1.9   

During the year ended December 31, 2011:

        

Common stock issued for vested awards (in thousands)

     46         120         82   

Fair value of awards vested (in millions)

   $     0.3       $ 0.6       $     4.6   

Awards outstanding at end of period (in millions)

     0.1         0.4         1.9   

The following table summarizes additional information concerning unvested phantom shares, restricted stock and LTIP Units (shares in thousands):

 

     Phantom Shares      Restricted Stock      LTIP Units  
                        Weighted            Weighted  
           Weighted            Average            Average  
           Average            Grant            Grant  
           Grant Date            Date Fair            Date Fair  
     Shares     Fair Value      Shares     Value      Shares     Value  

Unvested at December 31, 2010

     54      $ 5.17         386      $ 4.82         1,329      $ 5.91   

Granted

     55        5.71         159        5.54         553        5.41   

Vested

     (54     5.17         (123     5.01         (653     7.03   

Forfeited

     —          —           (74     5.35         (219     5.54   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Unvested at December 31, 2011

     55      $ 5.71         348      $ 4.97         1,010      $ 5.04   

Granted

     71        5.88         285        5.62         723        5.64   

Vested

     (55     5.71         (130     5.06         (237     5.07   

Forfeited

     —          —           (6     5.33         —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Unvested at December 31, 2012

     71      $ 5.88         497      $ 5.32         1,496      $ 5.14   

Granted

     55        7.67         285        7.13         1,065        6.87   

Vested

     (71     5.88         (187     5.02         (791     5.73   

Forfeited

     —          —           (42     6.02         —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Unvested at December 31, 2013

     55      $ 7.67         553      $ 6.30         1,770      $ 6.04   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-35


Table of Contents

Stock Options

The Company may grant stock options to certain employees pursuant to our Long-Term Incentive Plan, as amended. The term of such options is 10 years from the date of grant unless forfeited earlier and the period during which the right to exercise such options fully vests ranges from four to five years from the date of grant. During the year ended December 31, 2013, 33,000 shares of common stock were issued upon the exercise of options to purchase DCT’s common stock by certain employees. There were no options granted during the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012.

During the year ended December 31, 2011, options issued under the Long-Term Incentive Plan, as amended, were valued using the Black-Scholes option pricing model. The table below sets forth the assumptions used in valuing such options:

 

    

2011

Expected term(1)

   5.50 – 6.25 years

Expected volatility

   48.18% – 64.51%

Weighted average volatility

   48.04%

Expected dividend yield

   5.05% – 5.77%

Weighted average dividend yield

   5.02%

Risk-free interest rate

   0.97% – 2.55%

 

(1) The Company uses the simplified method to determine the estimated life of option awards as sufficient historical exercise data is unavailable. Under the simplified method the expected term is calculated as the midpoint between the vesting and the end of the contractual term of the option.

Employee Option Plan

Prior to October 6, 2006, the Company issued stock options under the Employee Option Plan, which was designed to enable the Company, our former advisor and its affiliates to obtain or retain the services of employees (not to include directors) of the Company’s former advisor and its affiliates considered essential to our long-term success and the success of the Company’s former advisor and its affiliates by offering such employees an opportunity to participate in our growth through ownership of our shares. No employee options were granted under this plan subsequent to 2006.

Independent Director Option Plan

Prior to October 6, 2006, the Company granted stock options under the Independent Director Option Plan, which the Company used in an effort to attract and retain qualified independent directors. No options were issued under this plan subsequent to 2006.

Options Summary Table

Options granted under the Long-Term Incentive Plan, as amended, the Employee Option Plan and the Independent Director Option Plan are amortized on a straight-line basis over the service period during which the right to exercise such options fully vests.

 

F-36


Table of Contents

The following table describes the total options outstanding, granted, exercised, expired and forfeited as of and during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, as well as the total options exercisable as of December 31, 2013 (number of options and intrinsic value in thousands):

 

    Independent
Director
Option Plan
    Employee
Option
Plan
    Long-
Term
Incentive
Plan
    Weighted
Average
Option
Price Per
Share
    Weighted
Average
Fair
Value of
Options
Granted
During
the Year
    Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life
(Years)
    Intrinsic
Value
 
             
             
             
             
             
             

Issued and Outstanding as of December 31, 2010

    80        74        3,598      $ 6.65         

Granted

    —          —          441        5.54      $ 1.66       

Exercised

    —          —          (243     3.64          $ 338   

Forfeited and/or expired

    (15     (74     (757     7.57         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Issued and Outstanding as of December 31, 2011

    65        —          3,039      $ 6.48         

Granted

    —          —          —          —        $ —         

Exercised

    —          —          (321     3.49          $ 846   

Forfeited and/or expired

    —          —          (11     8.27         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Issued and Outstanding as of December 31, 2012

    65        —          2,707      $ 6.82         

Granted

    —          —          —          —        $ —         

Exercised

    —          —          (100     4.37          $ 309   

Forfeited and/or expired

    (20     —          (21     9.37         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

Issued and Outstanding as of December 31, 2013

    45        —          2,586      $ 6.87          4.60      $ 3,729   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Exercisable as of December 31, 2013

    45        —          2,339      $ 6.87          4.80      $ 3,261   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity Compensation Expense

The following table summarizes the amount recorded in “General and administrative” expense in our Consolidated Statement of Operations for the amortization of phantom shares, restricted stock, LTIP Units and stock options (in millions):

 

     For the Year Ended December 31,  
         2013             2012             2011      

Phantom Shares

   $ 0.4      $ 0.4      $ 0.3   

Restricted Stock

     1.2        1.0        0.7   

LTIP Units

     3.3        2.5        3.0   

Stock Options

     0.2        0.4        0.6   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Equity Compensation Expense

     5.1        4.3        4.6   

Less Amounts Capitalized

     (1.1     (0.7     (0.5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net Equity Compensation Expense

   $ 4.0      $ 3.6      $ 4.1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-37


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes the remaining unrecognized expense and remaining period over which we expect to amortize the expense as of December 31, 2013 related to phantom shares, restricted stock, LTIP Units and stock options (dollars in millions):

 

     Unrecognized Expense as of      Remaining Period to  
     December 31, 2013      Recognize Expense  

Phantom Shares

   $ 0.1         4 months   

Restricted Stock

   $ 2.6         2.5 years   

LTIP Units

   $ 6.5         2.6 years   

Stock Options

   $ 0.2         1.0 years   

Note 12—Related Party Transactions

8th and Vineyard Consolidated Joint Venture

In May 2010 we entered into the 8th and Vineyard joint venture with Iowa Investments, LLC, an entity owned by one of the Company’s executives, to purchase 19.3 acres of land held for development in Southern California. Pursuant to the joint venture agreement, we will first receive a return of all capital along with a preferred return. Thereafter, Iowa Investments, LLC will receive a return of all capital along with a promoted interest. The land parcel acquired by 8th and Vineyard was purchased from an entity in which the same executive had a minority ownership. The total acquisition price of $4.7 million was determined to be at fair value.

Southern California Consolidated Ventures

We entered into four agreements, two in December 2010 and two in January 2011, whereby we acquired a weighted average ownership interest, based on square feet, of approximately 48.4% in five bulk industrial buildings located in the Southern California market. Entities controlled by one of the Company’s executives have a weighted average ownership in these properties of approximately 43.7%, based on square feet, and the remaining 7.9% is held by a third-party. Each venture partner will earn returns in accordance with their ownership interests. We have controlling rights including management of the operations of the properties and have consolidated the properties in accordance with GAAP. The total acquisition price of $46.3 million was determined to be at fair value.

General Partner

All expenses of the general partner relate to the business and operations of the Operating Partnership and are therefore paid directly or reimbursed by the Operating Partnership. The only transactions between the general partner and the Operating Partnership consist of (i) contributions by the general partner of consideration received from issuances of its capital stock in consideration of the issuance by the Operating Partnership of OP Units to the general partner, (ii) distributions by the Operating Partnership to the general partner with respect to outstanding OP Units held by the general partner and (iii) reimbursements of administrative expenses incurred by the general partner, including legal, accounting and other professional expenses.

Note 13—Income and Other Taxes

DCT Industrial Trust Inc.

The Company operates and expects to continue to operate in a manner to meet all the requirements to qualify for REIT status. The Company made its REIT election under Section 856 of the Code for the taxable year ended December 31, 2003 and has not revoked such election. In order for a former C corporation to elect to be a REIT, it must distribute 100% of its C corporation earnings and profits and agree to be subject to federal tax at the corporate level to the extent of any subsequently recognized built-in gains within a 10 year period. The Company did not have any built-in gains at the time of its conversion to REIT status. As a REIT, the Company generally

 

F-38


Table of Contents

will not be subject to federal income taxation at the corporate level to the extent the Company annually distributes 100% of its REIT taxable income, as defined under the Code, to the Company’s stockholders and satisfies other requirements. To continue to qualify as a REIT for federal tax purposes, the Company must distribute at least 90% of our REIT taxable income annually.

Summary of Current and Deferred Income Taxes

Components of the provision (benefit) for income taxes were as follows (in thousands):

 

     For the Year Ended December 31,  
     2013     2012     2011  

Income tax expense (benefit)

      

Current:

      

Federal

   $ 51      $ 26      $ 64   

State

     813        825        783   

Foreign

     (11     62        22   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current tax expense (benefit)

   $ 853      $ 913      $ 869   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred:

      

Federal

   $ (755   $ (188   $ (638

State

     (41     (9     (88
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax expense (benefit)

   $ (796   $ (197   $ (726
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income tax expense (benefit)

   $ 57      $ 716      $ 143   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Operations classification Continuing operations expense

   $         68      $         671      $       132   

Discontinued operations expense (benefit)

   $  (11)      $ 45      $ 11   

Foreign income taxes are accrued for foreign countries in which the Company operates in accordance with the applicable local laws and regulations, taking into account provisions of applicable double tax treaties. During the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, the Company incurred $(11,000), $62,000 and $22,000 of foreign income tax (benefit) expenses, respectively, resulting from operations in Mexico. As of December 31, 2012, the Company had a $0.6 million value added tax and other tax receivable outstanding.

 

F-39


Table of Contents

Deferred Income Taxes

Deferred income taxes represent the tax effect of temporary differences between the book and tax basis of assets and liabilities. As of December 31, 2013, the Company had recorded a $2.3 million deferred tax asset, net of valuation allowance of $2.3 million, included in the Consolidated Balance Sheets in “Other assets, net”, and a $0.8 million deferred tax liability, included in the Consolidated Balance Sheets in “Other liabilities”, for federal and state income taxes on our taxable REIT subsidiaries. As of December 31, 2012, the Company had recorded a $1.8 million deferred tax asset, net of valuation allowance of $2.5 million, and a $1.2 million deferred tax liability for federal and state income taxes on our taxable REIT subsidiaries. Deferred tax assets (liabilities) were as follows (in thousands):

 

     December 31, 2013  
     2013     2012  

Deferred tax assets:

    

Depreciation and amortization

   $ 1,673      $ 1,399   

Section 163(j) interest limitations

     1,835        1,729   

Unearned income

     560        249   

Net operating loss carryforwards

     511        878   

Other

     (5     70   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets

   $ 4,574      $ 4,325   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Valuation allowance

     (2,274     (2,507
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets, net

   $ 2,300      $ 1,818   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities:

    

Basis difference—investment in properties

   $ (509   $ (513

Basis difference—straight-line rent

     (340     (665
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax liabilities

   $ (849   $ (1,178
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net deferred tax assets

   $ 1,451      $ 640   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP

As a partnership, the allocated share of income of the Operating Partnership is included in the income tax returns of the general and limited partners. Accordingly, no accounting for income taxes is generally required for such income of the Operating Partnership. However, the Operating Partnership owns taxable REIT subsidiaries, which are subject to federal, state and local income taxes at regular corporate rates. See discussion above under DCT Industrial Trust, Inc. for more details of income taxes associated with our taxable REIT subsidiaries.

Note 14—Segment Information

Our segments are based on our internal reporting of operating results used to assess performance based on our properties’ geographical markets. Our markets are aggregated into three reportable regions or segments, East, Central and West, which are based on the geographical locations of our properties. Management considers rental revenues and property net operating income aggregated by segment to be the appropriate way to analyze performance. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior year results to conform to the current presentation, related to discontinued operations. The following segment disclosures exclude the results from discontinued operations (see Note 15—Discontinued Operations and Assets Held for Sale for additional information).

 

F-40


Table of Contents

The following table reflects our total assets, net of accumulated depreciation and amortization, by segment, as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 (in thousands):

 

     December 31,      December 31,  
     2013      2012  

Segments:

     

East assets

   $ 1,026,416       $ 875,845   

Central assets

     1,034,814         1,107,561   

West assets

     1,018,246         863,003   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total segment net assets

     3,079,476         2,846,409   

Non-segment assets:

     

Non-segment cash and cash equivalents

     25,671         8,653   

Other non-segment assets (1)

     152,620         149,285   

Assets held for sale

     8,196         52,852   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 3,265,963       $ 3,057,199   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)  Other non-segment assets primarily consists of investments in and advances to unconsolidated joint ventures, deferred loan costs, other receivables and other assets.

The following table sets forth the rental revenues of our segments in continuing operations and a reconciliation of our segment rental revenues to our reported consolidated total revenues for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
 
     2013      2012      2011  

East

   $ 95,682       $ 82,909       $ 79,920   

Central

     111,017         90,037         76,376   

West

     79,519         63,893         55,240   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Rental revenues

     286,218         236,839         211,536   

Institutional capital management and other fees

     2,787         4,059         4,291   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total revenues

   $ 289,005       $ 240,898       $ 215,827   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-41


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth property net operating income of our segments in continuing operations and a reconciliation of our property NOI to our reported “Loss from continuing operations” for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 (in thousands):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
 
     2013     2012     2011  

East

   $ 69,853      $ 60,666      $ 58,212   

Central

     76,327        61,800        50,660   

West

     60,013        47,983        41,297   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property NOI (1)

     206,193        170,449        150,169   

Institutional capital management and other fees

     2,787        4,059        4,291   

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

     (130,002     (109,993     (103,333

Casualty and involuntary conversion gain

     296        1,174        —     

Development profit

     268        307        —     

General and administrative

     (28,010     (25,763     (25,251

Equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated joint ventures, net

     2,405        1,087        (2,556

Impairment losses on investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

     —          —          (1,953

Interest expense

     (63,394     (69,274     (63,645

Interest and other income (expense)

     274        85        (93

Income tax expense and other taxes

     (68     (671     (132
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (9,251   $ (28,540   $ (42,503
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)  Property net operating income (“property NOI”) is defined as rental revenues, including reimbursements, less rental expenses and real estate taxes, which excludes depreciation, amortization, impairment, general and administrative expenses and interest expense. We consider property NOI to be an appropriate supplemental performance measure because property NOI reflects the operating performance of our properties and excludes certain items that are not considered to be controllable in connection with the management of the property such as depreciation, amortization, impairment, general and administrative expenses, and interest expense. However, property NOI should not be viewed as an alternative measure of our financial performance since it excludes expenses which could materially impact our results of operations. Further, our property NOI may not be comparable to that of other real estate companies, as they may use different methodologies for calculating property NOI. Therefore, we believe net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders, as defined by GAAP, to be the most appropriate measure to evaluate our overall financial performance.

Included in the Central operating segment were assets as of December 31, 2012 of approximately $74.2 attributable to the Mexico operations. During October 2013, we sold our entire portfolio of assets located in Mexico consisting of 15 properties totaling 1.7 million square feet for gross proceeds of $82.7 million.

Note 15—Discontinued Operations and Assets Held for Sale

We report results of operations from real estate assets that meet the definition of a component of an entity and have been sold, or meet the criteria to be classified as held for sale, as discontinued operations. During the year ended December 31, 2013, we sold 51 operating properties to unrelated third-parties. Three of these properties were in the East operating segment, 47 were in the Central operating segment and one was in the West operating segment, together totaling approximately 6.8 million square feet. These sales resulted in gains of approximately $33.6 million and impairment losses totaling approximately $13.3 million. The impairment charge was recorded on a portfolio of 15 properties in Dallas sold in a single transaction as the assets’ carrying value exceeded their

 

F-42


Table of Contents

estimated fair value less costs to sell. The estimated fair value of these properties was based upon the contractual sales price, a Level 2 fair value measurement. We also classified one property in our Central operating segment as held for sale as of December 31, 2013.

During the year ended December 31, 2012, we sold 36 operating properties to unrelated third-parties. Sixteen of these properties were in the Central operating segment and 20 were in the East operating segment, together totaling approximately 4.1 million square feet. These sales resulted in gains of approximately $13.4 million and impairment losses totaling approximately $11.4 million. The impairment charge was recorded on a portfolio of 13 properties in Atlanta as the assets’ carrying value exceeded their estimated fair value less costs to sell. The estimated fair value of these properties was based upon the contractual sales price, a Level 2 fair value measurement.

During the year ended December 31, 2011, we sold 16 operating properties to unrelated third-parties. Six of the properties sold were in the Central operating segment and ten were in the East operating segment, together totaling approximately 2.7 million square feet. These sales resulted in gains of approximately $12.0 million and impairment losses totaling approximately $8.2 million. The impairment charge was recorded on a portfolio of nine properties in Charlotte as the assets’ carrying value exceeded their estimated fair value less costs to sell. The estimated fair value of these properties was based upon the contractual sales price, a Level 2 fair value measurement.

For the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 income from discontinued operations includes the results of operations of these properties prior to the date of sale. We included all results of these discontinued operations in a separate component of income in our Consolidated Statements of Operations under the heading “Income from discontinued operations.” This treatment resulted in certain reclassifications of financial statement amounts for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011. For further details of our policy on discontinued operations, impairment of assets held for sale and related fair value measurements, see Note 2 – Summary of Significant Accounting Policies.

The following is a summary of the components of income from discontinued operations for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 (in thousands):

 

     2013     2012     2011  

Rental revenues

   $ 17,234      $ 34,061      $ 46,743   

Rental expenses and real estate taxes

     (3,538     (7,735     (11,095

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

     (7,118     (16,694     (25,656

General and administrative

     (157     (301     (676
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income

     6,421        9,331        9,316   

Casualty gain

     —          450        1,298   

Interest expense

     —          (129     (609

Interest and other income (expense)

     (49     232        (157

Income tax benefit (expense) and other taxes

     11        (45     (11
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income and other income

     6,383        9,839        9,837   

Gain on dispositions of real estate interests

     33,619        13,383        12,030   

Impairment losses

     (13,279     (11,422     (8,207
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from discontinued operations

   $ 26,723      $ 11,800      $ 13,660   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-43


Table of Contents

Note 16—Quarterly Results (Unaudited)

The following tables present selected unaudited quarterly financial data for each quarter during the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 (in thousands except per unit information). The following disclosures exclude the results from discontinued operations (see Note 15 – Discontinued Operations and Assets Held for Sale for additional information):

 

     For the Quarter Ended     For the Year
Ended
December 31,
2013
 
     March 31,
2013
    June 30,
2013
    September 30,
2013
    December 31,
2013
   

Total revenues

   $ 68,121      $ 70,031      $ 73,730      $ 77,123      $ 289,005   

Total operating expenses

   $ 55,406      $ 59,566      $ 58,480      $ 64,289      $ 237,741   

Operating income

   $ 12,715      $ 10,465      $ 15,250      $ 12,834      $ 51,264   

Income (loss) from continuing operations

   $ (3,430   $ (4,551   $ 1,010      $ (2,280   $ (9,251

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

   $ 5,066      $ 16,218      $ (11,793   $ 17,232      $ 26,723   

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 1,372      $ 11,559      $ (10,870   $ 14,822      $ 16,883   

Earnings per OP Unit—basic:

          

Income (loss) from continuing operations

   $ (0.01   $ (0.01   $ 0.00      $ (0.01   $ (0.03

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     0.01        0.05        (0.03     0.05        0.08   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 0.00      $ 0.04      $ (0.03   $ 0.04      $ 0.05   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Earnings per OP Unit—diluted:

          

Income (loss) from continuing operations

   $ (0.01   $ (0.01   $ 0.00      $ (0.01   $ (0.03

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     0.01        0.05        (0.03     0.05        0.08   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ 0.00      $ 0.04      $ (0.03   $ 0.04      $ 0.05   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic OP Units outstanding

     301,346        310,623        323,388        335,596        317,848   

Diluted OP Units outstanding

     301,346        310,623        324,293        335,596        317,848   

 

     For the Quarter Ended     For the Year
Ended
December 31,
2012
 
     March 31,
2012
    June 30,
2012
    September 30,
2012
    December 31,
2012
   

Total revenues

   $ 57,681      $ 57,856      $ 61,080      $ 64,281      $ 240,898   

Total operating expenses

   $ 48,841      $ 49,265      $ 51,738      $ 51,128      $ 200,972   

Operating income

   $ 8,840      $ 8,591      $ 9,342      $ 13,153      $ 39,926   

Income (loss) from continuing operations

   $ (9,138   $ (8,721   $ (6,704   $ (3,977   $ (28,540

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

   $ 2,308      $ (8,820   $ 14,964      $ 3,348      $ 11,800   

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ (6,629   $ (17,345   $ 8,364      $ (858   $ (16,468

Earnings per OP Unit—basic and diluted:

          

Income (loss) from continuing operations

   $ (0.03   $ (0.03   $ (0.02   $ (0.02   $ (0.10

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

     0.01        (0.03     0.05        0.01        0.04   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to OP Unitholders

   $ (0.02   $ (0.06   $ 0.03      $ (0.01   $ (0.06
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic and diluted OP Units outstanding

     272,098        272,033        275,991        292,503        278,189   

 

F-44


Table of Contents

Note 17—Condensed Consolidating Financial Information

During October 2013, we issued $275.0 million aggregate principal amount of 4.50% senior notes at 99.038% of face value in a private placement. The senior notes are jointly and severally, fully and unconditionally guaranteed by DCT and certain of the Company’s wholly owned subsidiaries.

The following tables present the condensed consolidating financial information for (a) DCT Industrial Trust, Inc. (“Parent” and a guarantor), (b) DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP (“Subsidiary Issuer”), (c) on a combined basis, the guarantor subsidiaries (“Subsidiary Guarantors”), and (d) on a combined basis, the non-guarantor subsidiaries (“Non-Guarantor Subsidiaries”). Additional columns present consolidating adjustments and consolidated totals as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 and for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011. The subsidiary guarantors’ condensed consolidating information as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 and for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 is presented based on the guarantors as of December 31, 2013. Separate financial statements of the Subsidiary Guarantors are not presented because the guarantee by each 100% owned Subsidiary Guarantor is full and unconditional, joint and several. Furthermore, there are no significant legal restrictions on the Parent’s ability to obtain funds from its subsidiaries by dividend or loan.

Investments in consolidated subsidiaries are accounted for using the equity method for purposes of the combined presentation. The consolidating adjustments principally relate to the elimination of investments in consolidated subsidiaries and intercompany balances and transactions.

 

F-45


Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets

December 31, 2013

(in thousands)

 

    Parent     Subsidiary
Issuer
    Subsidiary
Guarantors
    Non-Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Consolidating
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
 

ASSETS

           

Land

  $ —        $ —        $ 728,556      $ 155,248      $ —        $ 883,804   

Buildings and improvements

    —          —          2,192,623        423,256        —          2,615,879   

Intangible lease assets

    —          —          56,429        26,329        —          82,758   

Construction in progress

    —          —          75,235        13,375        —          88,610   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total investment in properties

    —          —          3,052,843        618,208        —          3,671,051   

Less accumulated depreciation and amortization

    —          —          (543,781     (110,316     —          (654,097
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investment in properties

    —          —          2,509,062        507,892        —          3,016,954   

Investments in and advances to unconsolidated joint ventures

    —          124,285        638        —          —          124,923   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investment in real estate

    —          124,285        2,509,700        507,892        —          3,141,877   

Cash and cash equivalents

    —          28,098        —          4,128        —          32,226   

Restricted cash

    —          8,841        340        3,440        —          12,621   

Deferred loan costs, net

    —          9,737        —          514        —          10,251   

Straight-line rent and other receivables, net

    —          82        37,800        8,365        —          46,247   

Other assets, net

    —          3,313        7,343        3,889        —          14,545   

Intercompany receivables, net

    22,472        114,528        —          —          (137,000     —     

Investment in subsidiaries

    1,543,806        2,540,233        11,965        —          (4,096,004     —     

Assets held for sale

    —          —          8,196        —          —          8,196   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

  $ 1,566,278      $ 2,829,117      $ 2,575,344      $ 528,228      $ (4,233,004   $ 3,265,963   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND EQUITY

           

Liabilities:

           

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

  $ —        $ 11,140      $ 36,985      $ 15,156      $ —        $ 63,281   

Intercompany payables, net

    —          —          44,448        92,552        (137,000     —     

Distributions payable

    22,472        1,320        —          —          —          23,792   

Tenant prepaids and security deposits

    —          —          24,289        4,253        —          28,542   

Other liabilities

    —          93        7,177        2,852        —          10,122   

Intangible lease liability, net

    —          —          17,646        2,743        —          20,389   

Line of credit

    —          39,000        —          —          —          39,000   

Senior unsecured notes

    —          1,122,407        —          —          —          1,122,407   

Mortgage notes

    —          —          34,480        256,480        —          290,960   

Liabilities related to assets held for sale

    —          —          278        —          —          278   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

    22,472        1,173,960        165,303        374,036        (137,000     1,598,771   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity:

           

Stockholders’ equity

    1,543,806        1,655,157        2,410,041        154,192        (4,219,390     1,543,806   

Noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          —          123,386        123,386   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

    1,543,806        1,655,157        2,410,041        154,192        (4,096,004     1,667,192   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

  $ 1,566,278      $ 2,829,117      $ 2,575,344      $ 528,228      $ (4,233,004   $ 3,265,963   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-46


Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss)

For the Year Ended December 31, 2013

(in thousands)

 

    Parent     Subsidiary
Issuer
    Subsidiary
Guarantors
    Non-Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Consolidating
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
 

REVENUES:

         

Rental revenues

  $ —        $ —        $ 233,250      $ 52,968      $ —        $ 286,218   

Institutional capital management and other fees

    —          974        —          2,149        (336     2,787   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

    —          974        233,250        55,117        (336     289,005   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

OPERATING EXPENSES:

         

Rental expenses

    —          —          30,760        5,217        —          35,977   

Real estate taxes

    —          —          35,096        8,952        —          44,048   

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

    —          —          104,840        25,162        —          130,002   

General and administrative

    —          26,533        416        1,061        —          28,010   

Casualty and involuntary conversion gain

    —          —          (353     57        —          (296
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

    —          26,533        170,759        40,449        —          237,741   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

    —          (25,559     62,491        14,668        (336     51,264   

OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):

         

Development profit

    —          —          —          268        —          268   

Equity in earnings of unconsolidated joint ventures, net

    —          2,050        20        —          335        2,405   

Interest expense

    —          (47,590     (5,154     (13,318     2,668        (63,394

Interest and other income (expense)

    —          2,679        12        5,762        (8,179     274   

Income tax (benefit) expense and other taxes

    —          (675     853        (246     —          (68
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

    —          (69,095     58,222        7,134        (5,512     (9,251
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from discontinued operations

    —          —          867        20,344        5,512        26,723   

Equity in earnings of consolidated subsidiaries

    15,870        85,978        193        —          (102,041     —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consolidated net income (loss)

    15,870        16,883        59,282        27,478        (102,041     17,472   

Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          —          (1,602     (1,602
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

    15,870        16,883        59,282        27,478        (103,643     15,870   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Distributed and undistributed earnings allocated to participating securities

    —          (692     —          —          —          (692
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

  $ 15,870      $ 16,191      $ 59,282      $ 27,478      $ (103,643   $ 15,178   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  $ 15,870      $ 16,883      $ 59,282      $ 27,478      $ (102,041   $ 17,472   

Other comprehensive income (loss):

         

Net derivative gain on cash flow hedging instruments

    —          552        —          123        —          675   

Net reclassification adjustment on cash flow hedging instruments

    —          4,490        —          —          —          4,490   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income

    —          5,042        —          123        —          5,165   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

    15,870        21,925        59,282        27,601        (102,041     22,637   

Comprehensive income attributable to noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          —          (2,403     (2,403
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

  $ 15,870      $ 21,925      $ 59,282      $ 27,601      $ (104,444   $ 20,234   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-47


Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

For the Year Ended December 31, 2013

(in thousands)

 

    Parent     Subsidiary
Issuer
    Subsidiary
Guarantors
    Non-Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Consolidating
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
 

OPERATING ACTIVITIES:

           

Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities

  $ —        $ (48,411   $ 168,058     $ 33,246     $ —        $ 152,893  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

INVESTING ACTIVITIES:

           

Real estate acquisitions

    —          —          (382,379     (20,344     —          (402,723

Capital expenditures and development activities

    —          —          (137,622     (15,300     —          (152,922

Proceeds from dispositions of real estate investments

    —          —          —          258,224       —          258,224  

Investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

    —          (2,756     —          —          —          (2,756

Proceeds from casualties and involuntary conversion

    —          —          6,370       1,898       —          8,268  

Distributions of investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

    —          2,175       —          —          —          2,175  

Other investing activities

    —          (10,995     7       (336     —          (11,324
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

    —          (11,576     (513,624     224,142       —          (301,058
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FINANCING ACTIVITIES:

           

Proceeds from senior unsecured revolving line of credit

    —          426,000       —          —          —          426,000  

Repayments of senior unsecured revolving line of credit

    —          (497,000     —          —          —          (497,000

Proceeds from senior unsecured notes

    —          497,355       —          —          —          497,355  

Repayments of senior unsecured notes

    —          (400,000     —          —          —          (400,000

Proceeds from mortgage notes

    —          —          9,303       7,195       —          16,498  

Principal payments on mortgage notes

    —          —          (32,440     (8,304     —          (40,744

Proceeds from issuance of common stock and OP Units

    267,453       267,453       —          —          (267,453     267,453  

Offering costs for issuance of common stock and OP Units

    (8,878     (8,878     —          —          8,878       (8,878

Net payments relating to intercompany financing

    (176,144     (113,751     368,606       (254,855     176,144       —     

Redemption of noncontrolling interests

    —          (1,500     —          —          —          (1,500

Dividends to common stockholders

    (82,431     (82,431     —          —          82,431       (82,431

Distributions to noncontrolling interests

    —          (5,949     —          (1,027     —          (6,976

Contributions from noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          723       —          723  

Other financing activity

    —          (4,376     —          1,571       —          (2,805
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

    —          76,923       345,469       (254,697     —          167,695  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net change in cash and cash equivalents

    —          16,936       (97     2,691       —          19,530  

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period

    —          11,162       97       1,437       —          12,696  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of period

  $ —        $ 28,098     $ —        $ 4,128     $ —        $ 32,226  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-48


Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets

December 31, 2012

(in thousands)

 

    Parent     Subsidiary
Issuer
    Subsidiary
Guarantors
    Non-Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Consolidating
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
 

ASSETS

           

Land

  $ —        $ —        $ 592,668     $ 187,567     $ —        $ 780,235  

Buildings and improvements

    —          —          1,880,658       600,996       (448     2,481,206  

Intangible lease assets

    —          —          49,193       29,274       —          78,467  

Construction in progress

    —          —          38,968       7,155       (504     45,619  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total investment in properties

    —          —          2,561,487       824,992       (952     3,385,527  

Less accumulated depreciation and amortization

    —          —          (468,023     (137,865     —          (605,888
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investment in properties

    —          —          2,093,464       687,127       (952     2,779,639  

Investments in and advances to unconsolidated joint ventures

    —          130,356       618       —          —          130,974  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investment in real estate

    —          130,356       2,094,082       687,127       (952     2,910,613  

Cash and cash equivalents

    —          11,162       97       1,437       —          12,696  

Restricted cash

    —          1,674       4,000       4,402       —          10,076  

Deferred loan costs, net

    —          6,344       13       481       —          6,838  

Straight-line rent and other receivables, net

    —          167       37,279       13,733       —          51,179  

Other assets, net

    —          1,519       5,853       5,573       —          12,945  

Intercompany receivables, net

    19,669       108,697       1,148       2,121       (131,635     —     

Investment in subsidiaries

    1,330,016       2,349,512       4,620       —         (3,684,148     —     

Assets held for sale

    —          —          —          52,852       —          52,852  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

  $ 1,349,685     $ 2,609,431     $ 2,147,092     $ 767,726     $ (3,816,735   $ 3,057,199  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND EQUITY

           

Liabilities:

           

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

  $ —        $ 9,436     $ 31,540     $ 16,525     $ —        $ 57,501  

Intercompany payables, net

    —          —          51,829       79,806       (131,635     —     

Distributions payable

    19,669       1,460       —          —          —          21,129  

Tenant prepaids and security deposits

    —          —          17,715       6,680       —          24,395  

Other liabilities

    —          192       3,725       3,296       —          7,213  

Intangible lease liability, net

    —          —          16,506       3,642       —          20,148  

Line of credit

    —          110,000       —          —          —          110,000  

Senior unsecured notes

    —          1,025,000       —          —          —          1,025,000  

Mortgage notes

    —          —          57,711       259,603       —          317,314  

Liabilities related to assets held for sale

    —          —          —          940       —          940  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

    19,669       1,146,088       179,026       370,492       (131,635     1,583,640  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity:

           

Stockholders’ equity

    1,330,016       1,463,343       1,968,066       397,234       (3,829,595     1,329,064  

Noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          —          144,495       144,495  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

    1,330,016       1,463,343       1,968,066       397,234       (3,685,100     1,473,559  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

  $ 1,349,685     $ 2,609,431     $ 2,147,092     $ 767,726     $ (3,816,735   $ 3,057,199  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-49


Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss)

For the Year Ended December 31, 2012

(in thousands)

 

    Parent     Subsidiary
Issuer
    Subsidiary
Guarantors
    Non-Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Consolidating
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
 

REVENUES:

           

Rental revenues

  $ —        $ —        $ 195,726      $ 41,113      $ —        $ 236,839   

Institutional capital management and other fees

    —          2,147        —          2,405        (493     4,059   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

    —          2,147        195,726        43,518        (493     240,898   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

OPERATING EXPENSES:

           

Rental expenses

    —          —          25,689        4,609        —          30,298   

Real estate taxes

    —          —          29,134        6,958        —          36,092   

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

    —          —          89,286        20,707        —          109,993   

General and administrative

    —          23,893        247        1,623        —          25,763   

Casualty and involuntary conversion gain

    —          —          (1,123     (51     —          (1,174
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

    —          23,893        143,233        33,846        —          200,972   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

    —          (21,746     52,493        9,672        (493     39,926   

OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):

           

Development profit

    —          —          —          307       —          307  

Equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated joint ventures, net

    —          622        (28     —          493        1,087   

Interest expense

    —          (52,699     (7,441     (12,777     3,643        (69,274

Interest and other income (expense)

    —          4,186        11        6,776        (10,888     85   

Income tax (benefit) expense and other taxes

    —          (736     161        (96     —          (671
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

    —          (70,373     45,196        3,882        (7,245     (28,540
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from discontinued operations

    —          —          654        4,416        6,730       11,800   

Equity in earnings (loss) of consolidated subsidiaries

    (14,571     54,420        52        —          (39,901     —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consolidated net income (loss)

    (14,571     (15,953     45,902        8,298        (40,416     (16,740

Net loss attributable to noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          —          1,654        1,654   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

    (14,571     (15,953     45,902        8,298        (38,762     (15,086
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Distributed and undistributed earnings allocated to participating securities

    —          (524     —          —          —          (524
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

  $ (14,571   $ (16,477   $ 45,902      $ 8,298      $ (38,762   $ (15,610
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  $ (14,571   $ (15,953   $ 45,902      $ 8,298      $ (40,416   $ (16,740

Other comprehensive income (loss):

           

Net derivative loss on cash flow hedging instruments

    —          (6,776     —          —          —          (6,776

Net reclassification adjustment on cash flow hedging instruments

    —          2,098       —          —          —          2,098  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive loss

    —          (4,678     —          —          —          (4,678
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

    (14,571     (20,631     45,902        8,298        (40,416     (21,418

Comprehensive loss attributable to noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          —          902       902  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

  $ (14,571   $ (20,631   $ 45,902      $ 8,298      $ (39,514   $ (20,516
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-50


Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

For the Year Ended December 31, 2012

(in thousands)

 

    Parent     Subsidiary
Issuer
    Subsidiary
Guarantors
    Non-Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Consolidating
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
 

OPERATING ACTIVITIES:

           

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

  $ —        $ (56,246   $ 130,298     $ 45,419     $ (515   $ 118,956  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

INVESTING ACTIVITIES:

           

Real estate acquisitions

    —          601       (239,248     (121,355     —          (360,002

Capital expenditures and development activities

    —          —          (77,342     (18,753     —          (96,095

Proceeds from dispositions of real estate investments

    —          —          25       153,722       —          153,747  

Investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

    —          (19,403     (14     —          —          (19,417

Proceeds from casualties and involuntary conversion

    —          —          1,093       (412     —          681  

Distributions of investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

    —          22,877       —          —          —          22,877  

Other investing activities

    —          —          (673     (256     —          (929
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

    —          4,075       (316,159     12,946       —          (299,138
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FINANCING ACTIVITIES:

           

Proceeds from senior unsecured revolving line of credit

    —          450,000       —          —          —          450,000  

Repayments of senior unsecured revolving line of credit

    —          (340,000     —          —          —          (340,000

Proceeds from senior unsecured notes

    —          90,000       —          —          —          90,000  

Principal payments on mortgage notes

    —          —          (45,449     (27,223     —          (72,672

Settlement of cash flow hedge

    —          (33,550     —          —          —          (33,550

Proceeds from issuance of common stock and OP Units

    177,628       177,628       —          —          (177,628     177,628  

Offering costs for issuance of common stock and OP Units

    (6,361     (6,361     —          —          6,361       (6,361

Net payments relating to intercompany financing

    (100,346     (204,615     231,167       (27,067     100,861       —     

Redemption of noncontrolling interests

    —          (3,293     —          —          —          (3,293

Dividends to common stockholders

    (70,921     (70,921     —          —          70,921       (70,921

Distributions to noncontrolling interests

    —          (7,025     —          (31     —          (7,056

Contributions from noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          30       —          30  

Other financing activity

    —          (2,089     —          (1,672     —          (3,761
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

    —          49,774       185,718       (55,963     515       180,044  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net change in cash and cash equivalents

    —          (2,397     (143     2,402       —          (138

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period

    —          13,559       240       (965     —          12,834  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of period

  $ —        $ 11,162     $ 97     $ 1,437     $ —        $ 12,696  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-51


Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss)

For the Year Ended December 31, 2011

(in thousands)

 

    Parent     Subsidiary
Issuer
    Subsidiary
Guarantors
    Non-Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Consolidating
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
 

REVENUES:

           

Rental revenues

  $ —        $ —        $ 178,167     $ 33,369     $ —        $ 211,536  

Institutional capital management and other fees

    —          2,508       —          2,253       (470     4,291  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

    —          2,508       178,167       35,622       (470     215,827  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

OPERATING EXPENSES:

           

Rental expenses

    —          —          24,510       4,421       —          28,931  

Real estate taxes

    —          —          26,878       5,558       —          32,436  

Real estate related depreciation and amortization

    —          —          85,109       18,224       —          103,333  

General and administrative

    —          22,074       225       2,952       —          25,251  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

    —          22,074       136,722       31,155       —          189,951  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

    —          (19,566     41,445       4,467       (470     25,876  

OTHER INCOME (EXPENSE):

           

Equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated joint ventures, net

    —          (2,803     (223     —          470       (2,556

Impairment losses on investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

    —          (1,953     —          —          —          (1,953

Interest expense

    —          (44,786     (8,149     (14,724     4,014       (63,645

Interest and other income (expense)

    —          4,241       43       6,414       (10,791     (93

Income tax (benefit) expense and other taxes

    —          (834     727       (25     —          (132
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

    —          (65,701     33,843       (3,868     (6,777     (42,503
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from discontinued operations

    —          —          653       6,558       6,449       13,660  

Equity in earnings (loss) of consolidated subsidiaries

    (24,922     38,144        (392     —          (12,830     —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consolidated net income (loss)

    (24,922     (27,557     34,104        2,690       (13,158     (28,843

Net loss attributable to noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          —          3,593       3,593  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

    (24,922     (27,577     34,104        2,690       (9,565     (25,250
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Distributed and undistributed earnings allocated to participating securities

    —          (443     —          —          —          (443
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

  $ (24,922   $ (28,000   $ 34,104      $ 2,690     $ (9,565   $ (25,693
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  $ (24,922   $ (27,557   $ 34,104      $ 2,690     $ (13,158   $ (28,843

Other comprehensive income (loss):

           

Net derivative loss on cash flow hedging instruments

    —          (16,508     —          —          —          (16,508

Net reclassification adjustment on cash flow hedging instruments

    —          970       —          —          —          970  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive loss

    —          (15,538     —          —          —          (15,538
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

    (24,922     (43,095     34,104        2,690       (13,158     (44,381

Comprehensive loss attributable to noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          —          5,084       5,084  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to common stockholders

  $ (24,922   $ (43,095   $ 34,104      $ 2,690     $ (8,074   $ (39,297
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-52


Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

For the Year Ended December 31, 2011

(in thousands)

 

    Parent     Subsidiary
Issuer
    Subsidiary
Guarantors
    Non-Guarantor
Subsidiaries
    Consolidating
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
 

OPERATING ACTIVITIES:

           

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

  $ —        $ (44,768   $ 116,354     $ 35,223     $ (327   $ 106,482  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

INVESTING ACTIVITIES:

           

Real estate acquisitions

    —          —          (158,155     (42,754     —          (200,909

Capital expenditures and development activities

    —          —          (44,409     (31,142     —          (75,551

Proceeds from dispositions of real estate investments

    —          —          —          106,455       —          106,455  

Investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

    —          (21,937     (54     —          —          (21,991

Proceeds from casualties and involuntary conversion

    —          —          —          3,813       —          3,813  

Distributions of investments in unconsolidated joint ventures

    —          12,941       —          —          —          12,941  

Other investing activities

    —          (1,559     (154     (868     —          (2,581
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

    —          (10,555     (202,772     35,504       —          (177,823
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

FINANCING ACTIVITIES:

           

Proceeds from senior unsecured revolving line of credit

    —          260,500       —          —          —          260,500  

Repayments of senior unsecured revolving line of credit

    —          (311,500     —          —          —          (311,500

Proceeds from senior unsecured notes

    —          400,000       —          —          —          400,000  

Repayments of senior unsecured notes

    —          (200,000     —          —          —          (200,000

Proceeds from mortgage notes

    —          —          —          20,000       —          20,000  

Principal payments on mortgage notes

    —          —          (106,081     (27,817     —          (133,898

Proceeds from issuance of common stock and OP Units

    116,898       116,898       —          —          (116,898     116,898  

Offering costs for issuance of common stock and OP Units

    (5,315     (5,315     —          —          5,315       (5,315

Net payments relating to intercompany financing

    (46,219     (131,140     192,177       (59,478     44,660       —     

Redemption of noncontrolling interests

    —          (371     —          —          —          (371

Dividends to common stockholders

    (67,250     (67,250     —          —          67,250       (67,250

Distributions to noncontrolling interests

    —          (7,404     —          (18     —          (7,422

Contributions from noncontrolling interests

    —          —          —          231       —          231  

Other financing activity

    —          (4,733     (62     (233     —          (5,028
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

    (1,886     49,685       86,034       (67,315     327       66,845  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net change in cash and cash equivalents

    (1,886     (5,638     (384     3,412       —          (4,496

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period

    1,886       19,197       624       (4,377     —          17,330  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of period

  $ —        $ 13,559     $ 240     $ (965   $ —        $ 12,834  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-53


Table of Contents

Note 18—Subsequent Events

GAAP requires an entity to disclose events that occur after the balance sheet date but before financial statements are issued or are available to be issued (“subsequent events”) as well as the date through which an entity has evaluated subsequent events. There are two types of subsequent events. The first type consists of events or transactions that provide additional evidence about conditions that existed at the date of the balance sheet, including the estimates inherent in the process of preparing financial statements, (“recognized subsequent events”). The second type consists of events that provide evidence about conditions that did not exist at the date of the balance sheet but arose subsequent to that date (“nonrecognized subsequent events”). No significant recognized or nonrecognized subsequent events were noted other than those mentioned in Note 4 – Investments in and Advances to Unconsolidated Joint Ventures.

 

F-54


Table of Contents

SCHEDULE III—REAL ESTATE AND ACCUMULATED DEPRECIATION

December 31, 2013

 

                Initial Cost to Company(4)           Gross Amount Carried at 12/31/2013                    

Property

  Number
of
Buildings
    Encum-
brances (5)
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs
    Costs
Capitalized
Subsequent
to
Acquisition
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs (3)(6)
    Accumulated
Depreciation (6)
    Acquisition
Date
    Year
Built
 
          (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
             

Newpoint I

    1      $ —        $ 2,143      $ 12,908      $ 15,051      $ (780 )(2)    $ 2,088      $ 12,183      $ 14,271      $ (3,720     03/31/04        1997   

Eagles Landing

    1        —          2,595        13,475        16,070        (603 )(2)      2,595        12,872        15,467        (4,725     06/08/04        2003   

Southcreek

    4        —          7,843        45,385        53,228        6,701        8,342        51,587        59,929        (16,636    
 
6/8/2004-
2/13/2009
  
  
    1999-2006   

Breckinridge Industrial

    2        —          1,950        10,159        12,109        (952 )(2)      1,950        9,207        11,157        (2,603     10/01/04        2000   

Westgate Industrial

    1        3,350        2,140        4,801        6,941        1,501        2,140        6,302        8,442        (1,859     10/01/04        1988   

Westpark Industrial

    2        —          2,176        6,719        8,895        995        2,176        7,714        9,890        (2,708     10/01/04        1981   

Cobb Industrial

    2        —          1,120        5,249        6,369        (291 )(2)      1,120        4,958        6,078        (1,423     10/01/04        1996   

Cabot Parkway Industrial

    1        —          1,103        6,616        7,719        (542 )(2)      1,103        6,074        7,177        (1,623     10/01/04        2000   

Atlanta NE Portfolio

    1        3,795        1,197        9,647        10,844        (282 )(2)      1,197        9,365        10,562        (2,644     11/05/04        1987   

Northmont Parkway

    5        3,894        4,556        22,726        27,282        1,643        4,556        24,369        28,925        (7,444     12/03/04        2003   

Fulton Industrial Boulevard

    3        —          1,850        13,480        15,330        1,642        1,850        15,122        16,972        (6,143     07/21/05        1973-1996   

Penney Road

    1        —          401        4,145        4,546        325        401        4,470        4,871        (1,319     07/21/05        2001   

Southfield Parkway

    1        1,661        523        3,808        4,331        (14 )(2)      523        3,794        4,317        (1,122     07/21/05        1994   

Livingston Court

    2        —          919        6,878        7,797        (266 )(2)      919        6,612        7,531        (2,708     07/21/05        1985   

Peterson Place

    3        —          466        6,015        6,481        21        466        6,036        6,502        (2,281     07/21/05        1984   

McGinnis Ferry

    1        —          700        6,855        7,555        1,558        691        8,422        9,113        (1,849     07/21/05        1993   

South Royal Atlanta Drive

    1        —          174        1,896        2,070        189        174        2,085        2,259        (722     07/21/05        1986   

Buford Development

    1        2,738        1,370        7,151        8,521        1,879        1,370        9,030        10,400        (2,335     03/31/06        2006   

Evergreen Boulevard

    2        8,829        3,123        14,265        17,388        (360 )(2)      3,123        13,905        17,028        (3,909     06/09/06        1999   

Pleasantdale

    1        —          790        1,503        2,293        312        819        1,786        2,605        (305     07/11/11        1995   

Evergreen Drive

    1        4,497        1,580        7,359        8,939        582        1,580        7,941        9,521        (659     04/10/12        2001   

Johnson Road

    2        —          1,372        4,707        6,079        222        1,372        4,929        6,301        (317     03/28/13        2007   

Southfield

    1        —          954        3,153        4,107        42        954        3,195        4,149        (285     05/10/13        1997   

Battle Drive

    1        —          4,950        13,990        18,940        172        4,950        14,162        19,112        (201     10/03/13        1999   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL ATLANTA MARKET

    41        28,764        45,995        232,890        278,885        13,694        46,459        246,120        292,579        (69,540 )     

Delta Portfolio

    7        —          8,762        36,806        45,568        2,344        8,699        39,213        47,912        (11,018     04/12/05        1986-1993   

Charwood Road

    1        4,656        1,960        10,261        12,221        438        1,960        10,699        12,659        (3,314     07/21/05        1986   

Greenwood Place

    2        4,713        2,566        12,918        15,484        1,095        2,566        14,013        16,579        (3,950     07/21/05        1978-1984   

Guilford Road

    1        —          1,879        6,650        8,529        1,876        1,879        8,526        10,405        (2,894     06/09/06        1989   

Bollman Place

    1        —          1,654        6,202        7,856        448        1,654        6,650        8,304        (1,713     06/09/06        1986   

 

F-55


Table of Contents
                Initial Cost to Company(4)           Gross Amount Carried at 12/31/2013                    

Property

  Number
of
Buildings
    Encum-
brances (5)
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs
    Costs
Capitalized
Subsequent
to
Acquisition
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs (3)(6)
    Accumulated
Depreciation (6)
    Acquisition
Date
    Year
Built
 
          (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
             

Dulles

    6        —          11,125        34,066        45,191        2,034        11,125        36,100        47,225        (5,652     08/04/06        2007-2012   

Beckley

    1        —          3,002        10,700        13,702        572        3,002        11,272        14,274        (2,928     09/10/10        1992   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL BALTIMORE/WASHINGTON MARKET

    19        9,369        30,948        117,603        148,551        8,807        30,885        126,473        157,358        (31,469 )     

Marine Drive

    1        —          2,764        17,419        20,183        —          2,765        17,418        20,183        (531     05/10/13        1994   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL CHARLOTTE MARKET

    1        —          2,764        17,419        20,183        —          2,765        17,418        20,183        (531 )     

Route 22

    1        —          5,183        20,100        25,283        (3,599 )(2)      5,183        16,501        21,684        (4,661     07/20/05        2003   

High Street Portfolio

    3        —          4,853        10,334        15,187        1,115        4,853        11,449        16,302        (3,900     10/26/05        1975-1988   

Independence Avenue

    1        —          3,133        17,542        20,675        483        3,133        18,025        21,158        (4,144     12/26/06        1999   

Bobali Drive

    3        —          4,107        9,288        13,395        540        4,107        9,828        13,935        (2,625     02/09/07        1998-1999   

Snowdrift

    1        —          972        3,770        4,742        786        972        4,556        5,528        (326     12/27/12        1989   

Silver Springs

    1        —          940        3,120        4,060        143        940        3,263        4,203        (243     05/10/13        2001   

Commerce Circle

    1        —          6,449        20,873        27,322        1,573        6,449        22,446        28,895        (790     05/10/13        2006   

Bethlehem Crossing

    3        —          10,855        35,912        46,767        248        10,855        36,160        47,015        (1,287     06/28/13        2004   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL PENNSYLVANIA MARKET

    14        —          36,492        120,939        157,431        1,289        36,492        122,228        158,720        (17,976 )     

Gary Ave

    1        —          3,191        18,505        21,696        1,668        3,191        20,173        23,364        (4,409     01/05/05        2001   

Blackhawk Portfolio

    5        —          6,671        40,877        47,548        2,358        6,667        43,239        49,906        (15,978     06/13/05        1974-1987   

East Fabyan Parkway

    1        —          1,790        10,929        12,719        880        1,790        11,809        13,599        (5,480     07/21/05        1975   

Frontenac Road

    1        —          1,647        5,849        7,496        269        1,647        6,118        7,765        (2,510     07/21/05        1995   

South Wolf Road

    1        8,252        4,836        18,794        23,630        2,136        4,836        20,930        25,766        (8,414     07/21/05        1982   

Laramie Avenue

    1        3,578        1,442        7,985        9,427        856        1,412        8,871        10,283        (3,417     07/21/05        1972   

West 123rd Place

    1        684        644        5,935        6,579        1,804        644        7,739        8,383        (3,360     07/21/05        1975   

Stern Avenue

    1        —          505        4,947        5,452        (1,867 )(2)      505        3,080        3,585        (1,566     07/21/05        1979   

Mitchell Court

    1        6,746        5,036        8,578        13,614        751        5,036        9,329        14,365        (3,398     05/01/07        1985   

Veterans Parkway

    1        —          2,108        —          2,108        7,336        2,108        7,336        9,444        (2,375     10/20/05        2005   

Lunt Avenue

    1        —          1,620        1,988        3,608        222        1,620        2,210        3,830        (842     03/17/06        2005   

Mission Street

    1        —          1,765        2,377        4,142        249        1,765        2,626        4,391        (1,592     09/08/08        1991   

Wolf Rd

    1        —          1,908        2,392        4,300        70        1,930        2,440        4,370        (582     11/22/10        1971   

S Lombard Rd

    1        —          1,216        2,136        3,352        2,065        1,216        4,201        5,417        (746     04/15/11        2012   

Arthur Avenue

    1        —          3,231        1,469        4,700        468        3,203        1,965        5,168        (301     12/30/11        1959   

Center Avenue

    1        —          4,128        9,896        14,024        3,513        4,128        13,409        17,537        (1,274     04/19/12        2000   

 

F-56


Table of Contents
                Initial Cost to Company(4)           Gross Amount Carried at 12/31/2013                    

Property

  Number
of
Buildings
    Encum-
brances (5)
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs
    Costs
Capitalized
Subsequent
to
Acquisition
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs (3)(6)
    Accumulated
Depreciation (6)
    Acquisition
Date
    Year
Built
 
          (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
             

Greenleaf

    1        —          625        952        1,577        3,683        698        4,562        5,260        (49     10/19/12        1962   

Supreme Drive

    1        4,677        1,973        5,828        7,801        541        1,973        6,369        8,342        (749     11/15/12        1994   

White Oak

    1        —          3,114        5,136        8,250        23        3,114        5,159        8,273        (469     12/10/12        1998   

Della Court

    1        —          1,278        3,613        4,891        25        1,278        3,638        4,916        (322     12/27/12        2003   

Joliet Road

    1        —          5,382        12,902        18,284        1,853        5,382        14,755        20,137        (863     12/27/12        2004   

Veterans

    1        —          2,009        7,933        9,942        20        2,009        7,953        9,962        (386     05/10/13        2005   

Central Ave

    1        —          11,975        2,625        14,600        352        11,975        2,977        14,952        (740     05/10/13        1960   

Fox River Business Center

    6        —          11,828        41,346        53,174        2,010        11,828        43,356        55,184        (856     10/09/13        2007   

Morse Avenue

    1        —          2,400        1,119        3,519        14        2,400        1,133        3,533        (59     10/31/13        1969   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL CHICAGO MARKET

    34        23,937        82,322        224,111        306,433        31,299        82,355        255,377        337,732        (60,737 )     

Park West

    5        —          5,893        39,878        45,771        (2,396 )(2)      5,771        37,604        43,375        (11,096     06/08/04        1997-2003   

Northwest Business Center

    1        —          299        4,486        4,785        (1,959 )(2)      299        2,527        2,826        (990     05/03/04        1995   

New Buffington Road

    2        5,124        1,618        8,500        10,118        3,953        1,618        12,453        14,071        (5,096     07/21/05        1981   

Olympic Boulevard

    3        (1     2,096        11,788        13,884        1,895        2,096        13,683        15,779        (4,784     07/21/05        1989   

Mineola Pike

    1        —          625        4,642        5,267        54        625        4,696        5,321        (1,572     07/21/05        1983   

Industrial Road

    2        —          629        3,344        3,973        1,256        628        4,601        5,229        (1,647     07/21/05        1987   

Dolwick Drive

    1        (1     579        4,670        5,249        256        579        4,926        5,505        (1,728     07/21/05        1979   

Best Place

    1        —          1,131        5,516        6,647        2,299        1,131        7,815        8,946        (2,819     07/21/05        1996   

Distribution Circle

    1        —          688        6,838        7,526        1,579        688        8,417        9,105        (2,842     07/21/05        1981   

Creek Road

    1        —          377        4,925        5,302        248        377        5,173        5,550        (2,046     06/09/06        1983   

Power Line Drive

    1        —          70        261        331        (3 )(2)      70        258        328        (60     06/09/06        1984   

Foundation Drive

    4        —          706        3,471        4,177        404        706        3,875        4,581        (1,221     06/09/06        1984-1987   

Jamilke Drive

    6        —          1,206        8,887        10,093        1,182        1,206        10,069        11,275        (3,100     06/09/06        1984-1987   

Port Union

    2        —          7,649-        22,780-        30,429-        3,420        7,649        26,200        33,849        (3,091     11/09/07        2007   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL CINCINNATI MARKET

    31        5,122        23,566        129,986        153,552        12,188        23,443        142,297        165,740        (42,092 )     

Commodity Boulevard

    2        —          3,891        36,799        40,690        (728 )(2)      3,891        36,071        39,962        (11,064     07/21/05        2000-2005   

Industrial Drive

    1        2,848        683        7,136        7,819        (313 )(2)      683        6,823        7,506        (1,954     07/21/05        1995   

Zane Trace Drive

    1        —          288        3,091        3,379        182        288        3,273        3,561        (1,427     03/14/06        1980   

Rickenbacker

    1        —          1,781        17,014        18,795        158        1,781        17,172        18,953        (4,583     05/19/06        2000   

Creekside

    3        —          3,617        37,470        41,087        119        3,617        37,589        41,206        (12,239     05/19/06        1999-2002   

SouthPark

    3        —          1,628        13,504        15,132        533        1,628        14,037        15,665        (4,320     05/19/06        1990-1999   

Lasalle Drive

    1        6,650        1,839        12,391        14,230        614        2,304        12,540        14,844        (3,952     08/08/07        2004   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL COLUMBUS MARKET

    12        9,498        13,727        127,405        141,132        565        14,192        127,505        141,697        (39,539 )     

 

F-57


Table of Contents
                Initial Cost to Company(4)           Gross Amount Carried at 12/31/2013                    

Property

  Number
of
Buildings
    Encum-
brances (5)
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs
    Costs
Capitalized
Subsequent
to
Acquisition
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs (3)(6)
    Accumulated
Depreciation (6)
    Acquisition
Date
    Year
Built
 
          (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
             

Freeport Parkway

    1        —          981        10,392        11,373        (1,181 )(2)      981        9,211        10,192        (2,757     12/15/03        1999   

Pinnacle

    1        —          521        9,683        10,204        (653 )(2)      521        9,030        9,551        (2,829     12/15/03        2001   

Market Industrial

    5        —          1,481        15,507        16,988        (487 )(2)      1,481        15,020        16,501        (4,228     10/01/04        1981-1985   

Shiloh Industrial

    1        —          459        4,173        4,632        60        459        4,233        4,692        (1,203     10/01/04        1984   

Avenue R Industrial I

    1        —          189        2,231        2,420        145        189        2,376        2,565        (729     10/01/04        1980   

Avenue R Industrial II

    1        —          271        1,139        1,410        168        271        1,307        1,578        (460     10/01/04        1980   

Westfork Center Industrial

    3        —          503        5,977        6,480        499        503        6,476        6,979        (1,909     10/01/04        1980   

Grand River Rd

    1        —          1,380        14,504        15,884        (1,540 )(2)      1,380        12,964        14,344        (4,786     12/03/04        2004   

Diplomat Drive

    1        —          532        3,136        3,668        1,980        532        5,116        5,648        (1,996     05/26/05        1986   

North 28th Street

    1        —          —          6,145        6,145        (844 )(2)      —          5,301        5,301        (2,234     07/21/05        2000   

Esters Boulevard

    1        —          —          22,072        22,072        (1,160 )(2)      —          20,912        20,912        (6,958     07/21/05        1984-1999   

West Story Drive

    1        —          777        4,646        5,423        478        777        5,124        5,901        (2,185     07/21/05        1997   

Meridian Drive

    1        1,222        410        4,135        4,545        327        410        4,462        4,872        (1,879     07/21/05        1975   

Gateway Drive

    1        —          463        2,152        2,615        667        463        2,819        3,282        (1,069     07/21/05        1988   

Valwood Parkway

    1        —          1,252        6,779        8,031        169        1,252        6,948        8,200        (1,991     07/21/05        1984-1996   

108th Street

    1        —          83        899        982        (60 )(2)      83        839        922        (360     07/21/05        1972   

Champion Drive

    1        1,401        672        2,598        3,270        1,072        672        3,670        4,342        (1,129     07/21/05        1984   

Sanden Drive

    1        —          207        2,258        2,465        412        207        2,670        2,877        (741     07/21/05        1994   

North Great Southwest Parkway

    2        2,317        1,384        3,727        5,111        1,867        1,904        5,074        6,978        (1,591     07/21/05        1963-1964   

Royal Lane

    1        —          —          3,200        3,200        238        —          3,438        3,438        (1,453     07/21/05        1986   

GSW Gateway Three

    1        —          1,669        11,622        13,291        61        1,669        11,683        13,352        (4,717     01/13/06        2001   

Pinnacle Point Drive

    1        7,820        3,915        18,537        22,452        3,582        3,915        22,119        26,034        (1,656     06/29/12        2006   

Ashmore Lane

    1        —          3,856        16,352        20,208        1,727        3,856        18,079        21,935        (985     12/27/12        2004   

La Reunion

    1        —          1,469        6,778        8,247        283        1,469        7,061        8,530        (454     04/09/13        1983   

Statesman Drive

    1        —          574        1,978        2,552        —          574        1,978        2,552        (70     08/14/13        1987   

Diplomacy

    1        —          878        3,057        3,935        —          878        3,057        3,935        —          12/20/13        1985   

Eisenhower

    1        —          1,105        5,545        6,650        5        1,105        5,550        6,655        —          12/30/13        2006   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL DALLAS MARKET

    34        12,760        25,031        189,222        214,253        7,815        25,551        196,517        222,068        (50,369 )     

Interpark 70

    1        4,343        1,383        7,566        8,949        (859 )(2)      1,383        6,707        8,090        (2,162     09/30/04        1998   

Pecos Street

    1        —          1,860        4,821        6,681        91        1,860        4,912        6,772        (789     08/08/11        2003   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL DENVER MARKET

    2        4,343        3,243        12,387        15,630        (768 )      3,243        11,619        14,862        (2,951 )     

 

F-58


Table of Contents
                Initial Cost to Company(4)           Gross Amount Carried at 12/31/2013                    

Property

  Number
of
Buildings
    Encum-
brances (5)
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs
    Costs
Capitalized
Subsequent
to
Acquisition
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs (3)(6)
    Accumulated
Depreciation (6)
    Acquisition
Date
    Year
Built
 
          (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
             

West By Northwest

    1        —          1,033        7,564        8,597        (227 )(2)      1,033        7,337        8,370        (2,345     10/30/03        1997   

Bondesen Business Park

    7        —          1,007        23,370        24,377        (223 )(2)      988        23,166        24,154        (6,957     06/03/04        2001-2002   

Beltway 8 Business Park

    7        8,206        1,679        25,565        27,244        (1,294 )(2)      1,679        24,271        25,950        (8,397    
 
6/3/2004-
7/1/2005
  
  
    2001-2003   

Greens Crossing

    3        —          1,225        10,202        11,427        1,595        1,225        11,797        13,022        (3,677     07/01/05        1998-2000   

Gateway at Central Green

    2        —          1,079        9,929        11,008        631        1,079        10,560        11,639        (3,404     09/20/05        2001   

Fairbanks Center

    1        —          707        5,205        5,912        537        707        5,742        6,449        (1,735     03/27/06        1999   

Bondesen North

    4        —          3,345        11,030        14,375        (317 )(2)      2,975        11,083        14,058        (2,586     06/08/07        2006   

Northwest Place

    1        —          1,821        11,406        13,227        1,511        1,821        12,917        14,738        (3,255     06/14/07        1997   

Warehouse Center Drive

    1        2,910        1,296        6,782        8,078        12        1,296        6,794        8,090        (2,165     12/03/07        2006   

Air Center Drive

    1        —          763        1,876        2,639        305        711        2,233        2,944        (497     11/09/10        1997   

Beltway Antoine

    7        —          7,058        31,875        38,933        1,018        7,058        32,893        39,951        (6,775     08/11/11        2007-2008   

Proterra

    1        —          2,573        8,289        10,862        2,383        2,573        10,672        13,245        (535     08/31/12        2013   

Greens Parkway

    1        —          704        4,093        4,797        148        704        4,241        4,945        (550     12/07/11        2007   

Claymoore Business Center

    2        —          1,491        4,967        6,458        1,193        1,491        6,160        7,651        (879     05/09/12        2001   

Pinemont

    1        2,488        1,448        6,969        8,417        212        1,448        7,181        8,629        (1,484     06/29/12        2000   

State Highway 225

    2        5,893        4,062        10,657        14,719        1,196        4,062        11,853        15,915        (983     12/13/12        1981-1983   

Aeropark

    1        —          1,723        7,065        8,788        (98 )(2)      1,723        6,967        8,690        (37     12/06/13        1999   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL HOUSTON MARKET

    43        19,497        33,014        186,844        219,858        8,582        32,573        195,867        228,440        (46,261 )     

Plainfield

    2        —          3,095        31,369        34,464        (595 )(2)      3,095        30,774        33,869        (7,955    
 
4/13/2003-
4/13/2006
  
  
    1997-2000   

Guion Road

    1        —          2,200        11,239        13,439        261        2,200        11,500        13,700        (3,261     12/15/05        1995   

Franklin Road

    3        —          2,292        11,949        14,241        5,185        2,292        17,134        19,426        (6,851     02/27/06        1973   

Perry Road

    1        —          1,106        7,268        8,374        (182 )(2)      1,106        7,086        8,192        (1,785     10/10/07        1995   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL INDIANAPOLIS MARKET

    7        —          8,693        61,825        70,518        4,669        8,693        66,494        75,187        (19,852 )     

Riverport

    1        —          1,279        8,812        10,091        (1,009 )(2)      1,279        7,803        9,082        (2,623     05/03/04        1996   

Freeport

    1        —          2,523        18,693        21,216        (455 )(2)      2,523        18,238        20,761        (4,872     03/14/07        1999   

Louisville Logistics Center

    1        —          2,177        11,932        14,109        (987 )(2)      2,177        10,945        13,122        (2,523     10/12/07        2002   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL LOUISVILLE MARKET

    3        —          5,979        39,437        45,416        (2,451 )      5,979        36,986        42,965        (10,018 )     

 

F-59


Table of Contents
                Initial Cost to Company(4)           Gross Amount Carried at 12/31/2013                    

Property

  Number
of
Buildings
    Encum-
brances (5)
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs
    Costs
Capitalized
Subsequent
to
Acquisition
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs (3)(6)
    Accumulated
Depreciation (6)
    Acquisition
Date
    Year
Built
 
          (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
             

Chickasaw

    2        —          1,141        13,837        14,978        (1,149 )(2)      1,141        12,688        13,829        (4,060     07/22/03        2000-2002   

Memphis Portfolio

    5        8,780        12,524        73,700        86,224        2,513        12,574        76,163        88,737        (24,861    
 
2/16/2005-
4/6/2005
  
  
    1997-2000   

Deltapoint

    1        —          2,299        24,436        26,735        5,527        2,299        29,963        32,262        (6,337     06/29/07        2006   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL MEMPHIS MARKET

    8        8,780        15,964        111,973        127,937        6,891        16,014        118,814        134,828        (35,258 )     

Miami Service Center

    1        —          1,110        3,811        4,921        607        1,110        4,418        5,528        (1,625     04/07/05        1987   

Miami Commerce Center

    1        2,948        3,050        10,769        13,819        4,474        3,050        15,243        18,293        (4,389     04/13/05        1991   

Northwest 70th Avenue

    2        —          10,025        16,936        26,961        5,743        10,025        22,679        32,704        (9,763     06/09/06        1972-1976   

North Andrews Avenue

    1        —          6,552        6,101        12,653        715        6,552        6,816        13,368        (2,179     06/09/06        1999   

Northwest 30th Terrace

    1        —          3,273        4,196        7,469        1,364        3,273        5,560        8,833        (873     02/18/11        1994   

Pan America

    2        —          6,386        19,497        25,883        403        6,396        19,890        26,286        (790     07/19/11        2013   

Northwest 34th Street

    1        —          946        3,239        4,185        240        946        3,479        4,425        (419     06/25/12        2000   

Miami Gardens

    1        —          4,480        7,562        12,042        (38 )(2)      4,480        7,524        12,004        (209     10/22/13        1969   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL MIAMI MARKET

    10        2,948        35,822        72,111        107,933        13,508        35,832        85,609        121,441        (20,247 )     

Eastgate

    1        —          1,445        13,352        14,797        (627 )(2)      1,445        12,725        14,170        (3,468     03/19/04        2002   

Mid South Logistics Center

    1        —          1,772        18,288        20,060        1,781        1,850        19,991        21,841        (6,705     06/29/04        2001   

Rockdale Distribution Center

    1        —          2,940        12,188        15,128        6,845        2,940        19,033        21,973        (3,225     12/28/05        2013   

Logistics Way

    1        —          621        17,763        18,384        (1,151 )(2)      621        16,612        17,233        (3,622     09/28/09        2007   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL NASHVILLE MARKET

    4        —          6,778        61,591        68,369        6,848        6,856        68,361        75,217        (17,020 )     

Brunswick Avenue

    1        —          3,665        16,380        20,045        2,508        3,665        18,888        22,553        (4,807     07/21/05        1986   

Campus Drive

    1        —          1,366        4,841        6,207        1,136        1,366        5,977        7,343        (2,276     07/21/05        1975   

Hanover Ave

    1        —          4,940        8,026        12,966        (232 )(2)      4,940        7,794        12,734        (1,732     12/28/05        1988   

Rockaway

    3        —          5,881        12,521        18,402        2,870        5,881        15,391        21,272        (6,312     12/29/05        1974   

Lake Drive

    1        —          1,699        6,898        8,597        675        1,699        7,573        9,272        (1,985     05/25/06        1988   

Market Street

    2        —          2,298        7,311        9,609        (334 )(2)      2,298        6,977        9,275        (2,175     06/06/06        1990   

Kennedy Drive

    1        —          3,044        6,583        9,627        400        3,044        6,983        10,027        (1,351     04/14/10        2001   

Railroad Avenue

    1        —          6,494        10,996        17,490        312        6,494        11,308        17,802        (3,133     01/28/11        1964   

Pierce Street

    1        —          2,472        4,255        6,727        1,432        2,472        5,687        8,159        (306     12/27/12        2003   

Pencader

    1        —          1,738        2,558        4,296        64        1,738        2,622        4,360        (206     05/10/13        1989   

Seaview

    1        —          5,910        10,423        16,333        —          5,910        10,423        16,333        —          12/20/13        1980   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL NEW JERSEY MARKET

    14        —          39,507        90,792        130,299        8,831        39,507        99,623        139,130        (24,283 )     

 

F-60


Table of Contents
                Initial Cost to Company(4)           Gross Amount Carried at 12/31/2013                    

Property

  Number
of
Buildings
    Encum-
brances (5)
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs
    Costs
Capitalized
Subsequent
to
Acquisition
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs (3)(6)
    Accumulated
Depreciation (6)
    Acquisition
Date
    Year
Built
 
          (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
             

Eden Rock Industrial

    1        —          998        2,566        3,564        146        998        2,712        3,710        (1,216     10/01/04        1973   

Bayside Distribution Center

    2        9,530        6,875        15,254        22,129        (1,077 )(2)      6,875        14,177        21,052        (3,790     11/03/04        1998-2000   

Fite Court

    1        —          5,316        15,499        20,815        1,161        5,316        16,660        21,976        (4,452     12/28/06        2003   

California Logistics Centre

    1        —          5,672        20,499        26,171        (2,987 )(2)      5,672        17,512        23,184        (4,544     04/21/06        2001   

Cherry Street

    3        —          12,584        24,582        37,166        2,202        12,584        26,784        39,368        (8,557     06/09/06        1960-1990   

Pike Lane

    3        —          2,880        8,328        11,208        (41 )(2)      2,880        8,287        11,167        (2,401     06/09/06        1982   

South Vasco Road

    1        —          2,572        14,809        17,381        (485 )(2)      2,572        14,324        16,896        (3,882     06/09/06        1999   

McLaughlin Avenue

    1        —          3,424        5,507        8,931        75        3,424        5,582        9,006        (2,075     06/09/06        1975   

Park Lane

    5        —          10,977        17,216        28,193        (182 )(2)      10,977        17,034        28,011        (6,398     06/09/06        1960-1966   

Valley Drive

    4        —          11,238        14,244        25,482        1,883        11,238        16,127        27,365        (5,506     06/09/06        1960-1971   

Old Country Road

    1        —          1,557        1,503        3,060        182        1,557        1,685        3,242        (675     06/09/06        1969   

Cypress Lane

    1        —          2,211        2,196        4,407        454        2,211        2,650        4,861        (1,326     06/09/06        1970   

Rollins Road

    1        19,021        17,800        17,621        35,421        338        17,659        18,100        35,759        (2,957     11/04/11        1997   

Coliseum Way

    1        —          10,229        18,255        28,484        2,032        10,229        20,287        30,516        (1,391     12/11/12        1967   

Alpine Way

    1        —          2,321        2,502        4,823        —          2,321        2,502        4,823        (85     06/25/13        1986   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL NORTHERN CALIFORNIA MARKET

    27        28,551        96,654        180,581        277,235        3,701        96,513        184,423        280,936        (49,255 )     

Cypress Park East

    2        8,617        2,627        13,055        15,682        1,448        2,627        14,503        17,130        (3,768     10/22/04        2000   

East Landstreet Road

    3        —          2,251        11,979        14,230        321        2,251        12,300        14,551        (3,421     06/09/06        1997-2000   

Boggy Creek Road

    8        —          8,098        30,984        39,082        1,830        8,098        32,814        40,912        (8,389     06/09/06        1993-2007   

ADC North Phase I

    2        —          2,475-        11,941        14,416-        1,676        2,475        13,617        16,092        (2,321    
 
12/19/2006-
12/20/2006
  
  
    2008-2009   

American Way

    1        —          3,603        8,667        12,270        (399 )(2)      3,603        8,268        11,871        (1,648     08/16/07        1997   

Director’s Row

    1        —          524        2,519        3,043        33        524        2,552        3,076        (616     03/01/11        1994   

GE Portfolio

    3        —          4,715        12,513        17,228        937        4,715        13,450        18,165        (2,218     09/01/11        1975-1999   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL ORLANDO MARKET

    20        8,617        24,293        91,658        115,951        5,846        24,293        97,504        121,797        (22,381 )     

North Industrial

    2        4,689        4,566        15,899        20,465        1,613        4,566        17,512        22,078        (5,654     10/01/04        1995-1999   

South Industrial I

    2        3,912        2,876        14,120        16,996        1,440        2,829        15,607        18,436        (5,427     10/01/04        1987   

South Industrial II

    1        —          1,235        4,902        6,137        (1,189 )(2)      1,235        3,713        4,948        (944     10/01/04        1990   

West Southern Industrial

    1        —          555        3,376        3,931        (335 )(2)      555        3,041        3,596        (831     10/01/04        1984   

West Geneva Industrial

    3        —          413        2,667        3,080        326        413        2,993        3,406        (970     10/01/04        1981   

West 24th Industrial

    2        —          870        4,575        5,445        871        870        5,446        6,316        (2,574     10/01/04        1979-1980   

Sky Harbor Transit Center

    1        —          2,534        7,597        10,131        (843 )(2)      2,534        6,754        9,288        (1,890     11/24/04        2002   

 

F-61


Table of Contents
                Initial Cost to Company(4)           Gross Amount Carried at 12/31/2013                    

Property

  Number
of
Buildings
    Encum-
brances (5)
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs
    Costs
Capitalized
Subsequent
to
Acquisition
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs (3)(6)
    Accumulated
Depreciation (6)
    Acquisition
Date
    Year
Built
 
          (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
             

Roosevelt Distribution Center

    1        —          1,154        6,441        7,595        (211 )(2)      1,154        6,230        7,384        (1,429     05/19/06        1988   

North 45th Street

    1        —          3,149        5,051        8,200        14        3,149        5,065        8,214        (940     06/30/11        2001   

Broadway Industrial Portfolio

    3        —          4,725        17,708        22,433        79        4,725        17,787        22,512        (501     08/22/13        1981   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL PHOENIX MARKET

    17        8,601        22,077        82,336        104,413        1,765        22,030        84,148        106,178        (21,160 )     

Industry Drive North

    2        8,493        5,753        16,039        21,792        1,297        5,753        17,336        23,089        (5,536     07/21/05        1996   

South 228th Street

    1        8,978        3,025        13,694        16,719        1,586        3,025        15,280        18,305        (3,801     07/21/05        1996   

64th Avenue South

    1        5,570        3,345        9,335        12,680        642        3,345        9,977        13,322        (2,647     07/21/05        1996   

South 192nd Street

    1        —          1,286        3,433        4,719        136        1,286        3,569        4,855        (1,054     07/21/05        1986   

South 212th Street

    1        —          3,095        10,253        13,348        556        3,095        10,809        13,904        (2,823     08/01/05        1996   

Southwest 27th Street

    1        6,805        4,583        8,353        12,936        48        4,583        8,401        12,984        (4,371     07/21/05        1995   

13610 52nd St

    1        —          4,018        9,571        13,589        1        4,018        9,572        13,590        (1,349     12/01/10        2006   

Southwest 27th Street-Alpak

    1        —          4,313        4,687        9,000        130        4,313        4,817        9,130        (644     10/14/11        2003   

Milwaukee Avenue

    1        —          2,287        7,213        9,500        12        2,278        7,234        9,512        (663     08/31/12        1987   

Sumner II

    1        —          672        1,178        1,850        326        672        1,504        2,176        (22     10/15/12        2007   

East Park Bldg 5

    1        —          980        2,061        3,041        6        980        2,067        3,047        (114     08/30/13        1997   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL SEATTLE MARKET

    12        29,846        33,357        85,817        119,174        4,740        33,348        90,566        123,914        (23,024 )     

Rancho Technology Park

    1        —          2,790        7,048        9,838        (400 )(2)      2,790        6,648        9,438        (1,873     10/16/03        2002   

Foothill Business Center

    3        —          13,315        9,112        22,427        (605 )(2)      13,315        8,507        21,822        (2,865     12/09/04        2000   

East Slauson Avenue

    3        9,162        5,499        14,775        20,274        3,083        5,499        17,858        23,357        (8,046     07/21/05        1962-1976   

Airport Circle

    1        —          3,098        8,368        11,466        1,213        3,098        9,581        12,679        (2,746     07/21/05        1992   

Cota Street

    1        —          2,802        7,624        10,426        48        2,802        7,672        10,474        (2,344     07/21/05        1987   

Twin Oaks Valley Road

    2        —          1,815        7,855        9,670        152        1,815        8,007        9,822        (2,050     07/21/05        1978-1988   

Meyer Canyon

    1        —          5,314        9,929        15,243        1,488        5,608        11,123        16,731        (2,592     06/30/06        2001   

Mira Loma

    1        —          7,919        6,668        14,587        203        7,919        6,871        14,790        (1,189     12/23/08        1997   

Sycamore Canyon

    2        —          6,356        36,088        42,444        1,346        6,356        37,434        43,790        (7,636     09/09/09        2007   

Colombard Ct

    1        1,972        1,264        3,237        4,501        (1 )(2)      1,264        3,236        4,500        (1,098     07/29/10        1990   

E Airport Drive

    1        —          905        2,744        3,649        —          905        2,744        3,649        (783     12/23/10        1990   

Truck Courts

    3        —          26,392        17,267        43,659        5        26,392        17,272        43,664        (2,537     12/29/10        1971-1988   

Haven A

    1        7,676        5,783        19,578        25,361        (2,107 )(2)      5,783        17,471        23,254        (1,892     12/31/10        2001   

Haven G

    1        965        479        1,131        1,610        (190 )(2)      479        941        1,420        (100     12/31/10        2003   

6th and Rochester

    1        3,147        3,111        6,428        9,539        (324 )(2)      3,088        6,127        9,215        (1,358     01/04/11        2001   

Palmyrita

    2        6,155        3,355        8,665        12,020        (995 )(2)      3,355        7,670        11,025        (1,052     01/11/11        2006   

Central Avenue

    1        —          3,898        4,642        8,540        1,666        3,898        6,308        10,206        (899     01/27/11        2011   

Byron Road

    1        —          2,042        2,715        4,757        326        2,042        3,041        5,083        (444     04/15/11        1972   

Desoto Place

    1        3,264        2,255        4,339        6,594        570        2,255        4,909        7,164        (995     07/01/11        1982   

 

F-62


Table of Contents
                Initial Cost to Company(4)           Gross Amount Carried at 12/31/2013                    

Property

  Number
of
Buildings
    Encum-
brances (5)
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs
    Costs
Capitalized
Subsequent
to
Acquisition
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs (3)(6)
    Accumulated
Depreciation (6)
    Acquisition
Date
    Year
Built
 
          (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
             

Slover

    1        —          13,786        23,017        36,803        —          13,786        23,017        36,803        (160     07/28/11        2013   

White Birch

    1        —          5,081        6,177        11,258        344        5,081        6,521        11,602        (825     07/03/12        1984   

Pomona Blvd

    4        —          6,524        9,630        16,154        1,697        6,524        11,327        17,851        (1,036     10/31/12        1987-1988   

Air Freight Portfolio

    3        48,294        29,978        48,469        78,447        4,336        29,928        52,855        82,783        (3,800     11/15/12        1993-2004   

Sampson

    1        —          4,848        6,277        11,125        —          4,848        6,277        11,125        (365     03/20/13        2000   

Painter

    2        —          8,529        10,413        18,942        35        8,529        10,448        18,977        (684     03/20/13        1966   

4th Street

    1        —          3,349        6,789        10,138        1        3,349        6,790        10,139        (128     10/15/13        1988   

Arthur

    1        —          4,044        6,063        10,107        —          4,043        6,064        10,107        (45     11/27/13        1979   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

TOTAL SOUTHERN CALIFORNIA MARKET

    42        80,635        174,531        295,048        469,579        11,891        174,751        306,719        481,470        (49,542 )     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

SUB TOTAL CONSOLIDATED OPERATING PROPERTIES

    395        281,268        760,757        2,531,975        3,292,732        149,710        761,774        2,680,668        3,442,442        (653,505 )     

Mallard Lake

    1        —          2,561        8,809        11,370        13        2,561        8,822        11,383        (3,474     10/29/2003        2000   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Assets held for sale

    1        —          2,561        8,809        11,370        13        2,561        8,822        11,383        (3,474 )     

116 Lehigh Dr

    1        4,453        2,193        5,168        7,361        2,006        2,193        7,174        9,367        —          6/29/2012        1986   

4802 Van Buren

    1        —          839        961        1,800        1,027        839        1,988        2,827        (32     1/11/2012        1984   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Properties under redevelopment

    2        4,453        3,032        6,129        9,161        3,033        3,032        9,162        12,194        (32 )     

DCT 55

    1        —          6,832        —          6,832        19,386        6,832        19,386        26,218        —         

DCT Airtex Industrial Center

    1        —          2,595        —          2,595        9,566        2,597        9,564        12,161        —         

DCT Beltway Tanner Business Park

    0        —          3,353        —          3,353        6,848        3,360        6,841        10,201        —         

DCT Sumner South Distribution Center

    0        —          2,855        —          2,855        6,339        2,881        6,313        9,194        —         

DCT Auburn 44

    0        —          1,016        —          1,016        2,325        1,054        2,287        3,341        —         

DCT White River Corporate Center Phase I

    0        —          7,867        —          7,867        15,184        8,534        14,517        23,051        —         

Slover Logistics Center II

    0        —          14,189        —          14,189        10,052        14,239        10,002        24,241        —         

DCT Rialto Logistics Center

    0        —          19,219        —          19,219        2,261        19,230        2,250        21,480        —         

8th & Vineyard A

    0        —          1,467        —          1,467        6,306        1,467        6,306        7,773        —         

8th & Vineyard B

    0        —          960        —          960        4,283        960        4,283        5,243        —         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Properties under development

    2        —          60,353        —          60,353        82,550        61,154        81,749        142,903        —         

8th & Vineyard C

    0        —          670        —          670        461        676        455        1,131        —         

8th & Vineyard E

    0        —          520        —          520        310        520        310        830        —         

 

F-63


Table of Contents
                Initial Cost to Company(4)           Gross Amount Carried at 12/31/2013                

Property

  Number
of
Buildings
    Encum-
brances (5)
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs
    Costs
Capitalized
Subsequent
to
Acquisition
    Land     Building &
Improvements (1)
    Total
Costs (3)(6)
    Accumulated
Depreciation (6)
    Acquisition
Date
  Year
Built
          (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
    (in
thousands)
         

8th & Vineyard D

    0        —          910        —          910        539        910        539        1,449        —         

DCT White River Corporate Center Phase II

    0        —          4,626        —          4,626        2,476        4,626        2,476        7,102        —         

DCT River West

    0        —          2,848        —          2,848        3,779        2,857        3,770        6,627        —         

DCT Airtex Industrial Center II

    0        —          1,124        —          1,124        331        1,152        303        1,455        —         

DCT Northwest Crossroads Phase I

    0        —          3,024        —          3,024        374        3,059        339        3,398        —         

DCT Northwest Crossroads Phase II

    0        —          2,918        —          2,918        130        2,950        98        3,048        —         

ADC North Phase II Building C

    0        —          662        —          662        693        662        693        1,355        —         

Seneca Commerce Center Phase I

    0        —          1,262        —          1,262        8        1,262        8        1,270        —         

Seneca Commerce Center Phase II

    0        —          1,267        —          1,267        8        1,267        8        1,275        —         

Seneca Commerce Center Phase III

    0        —          1,267        —          1,267        8        1,267        8        1,275        —         

DCT Port Union Building 1

    0        —          1,965        —          1,965        1,535        1,965        1,535        3,500        —         

DCT Port Union Building 3

    0        —          1,310        —          1,310        2,071        1,310        2,071        3,381        —         

ADC North Phase II Building D

    0        —          611        —          611        561        611        561        1,172        —         

Stonefield Industrial Park Land

    0        —          4,959        —          4,959        6        4,959        6        4,965        —         

Boone Industrial Park Land

    0        —          854        —          854        27        861        20        881        —         

DCT Jurupa Ranch Land

    0        —          2,733        —          2,733        —          2,733        —          2,733        —         

8th & Vineyard Additional Land

    0        —          186        —          186        110        186        110        296        —         

DCT Jurupa Ranch

    0        —          23,925        2,242        26,167        202        24,011        2,358        26,369        (560    
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Properties in pre-development including land held

    —          —          57,641        2,242        59,883        13,629        57,844        15,668        73,512        (560 )     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

GRAND TOTAL CONSOLIDATED

    400      $ 285,721      $ 884,344      $ 2,549,155      $ 3,433,499      $ 248,935      $ 886,365      $ 2,796,069      $ 3,682,434      $ (657,571 )     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

(1) Included in Building & Improvements are intangible lease assets.
(2)  Generally these reductions in basis include one or more of the following: i) payments received under master lease agreements and pursuant to GAAP, rental and expense recovery payments under master lease agreements are reflected as a reduction of the basis of the underlying property rather than revenues; ii) write-offs of fixed asset balances due to early lease terminations by contracted customers; iii) write-offs of fully amortized lease related intangible assets and improvements; iv) write-offs of fully amortized tenant leasing costs; and v) other miscellaneous basis adjustments.
(3)  As of December 31, 2013, the aggregate cost for federal income tax purposes of investments in real estate was approximately $3.3 billion.
(4) For properties developed by the Operating Partnership, included in Initial Cost to Company are development costs capitalized prior to substantial completion of the properties.

 

F-64


Table of Contents
(5)  Reconciliation of total debt to consolidated balance sheet caption as of December 31, 2013:

 

Total per Schedule III

   $ 285,721   

Unencumbered mortgage notes

     —     

Premiums, net of amortization

     5,239   
  

 

 

 

Total mortgage notes

   $ 290,960   
  

 

 

 

 

(6)  A summary of activity for real estate and accumulated depreciation for the year ended December 31, 2013 is as follows:

 

Investments in properties:

  

Balance at beginning of year

   $ 3,385,527   

Assets held for sale

     55,801   
  

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year, including held for sale

     3,441,328   

Acquisition of properties

     411,041   

Improvements, including development properties

     165,744   

Divestiture of properties

     (288,305

Improvements, intangibles, tenant leasing cost write-offs

     (29,608

Impairments

     (13,279

Other adjustments

     (4,487
  

 

 

 

Balance at end of year, including held for sale

   $ 3,682,434   

Held for sale

     (11,383
  

 

 

 

Balance at end of year, excluding held for sale

   $ 3,671,051   
  

 

 

 

Accumulated depreciation and amortization:

  

Balance at beginning of year

   $ (605,888

Assets held for sale

     (3,912
  

 

 

 

Balance at beginning of year, including held for sale

     (609,800

Depreciation and amortization expense, including discontinued operations

     (137,703

Divestiture of properties

     60,032   

Improvements, intangibles, tenant leasing cost write-offs

     29,608   

Other adjustments

     292   
  

 

 

 

Balance at end of year, including held for sale

   $ (657,571
  

 

 

 

Held for sale

     3,474   
  

 

 

 

Balance at end of year, excluding held for sale

   $ (654,097
  

 

 

 

 

F-65


Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

LOGO

$275,000,000

DCT Industrial Operating Partnership LP

Exchange Offer for

4.500% Senior Notes due 2023

 

 

PROSPECTUS

 

 

April 25, 2014